summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/26639-h
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 02:31:51 -0700
committerRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 02:31:51 -0700
commit2dc686532c8ae2c9a40678805a384661a565034b (patch)
treed225db2d28ea0e29a750c62790bc10a375d97982 /26639-h
initial commit of ebook 26639HEADmain
Diffstat (limited to '26639-h')
-rw-r--r--26639-h/26639-h.html16203
1 files changed, 16203 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/26639-h/26639-h.html b/26639-h/26639-h.html
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..206dd87
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26639-h/26639-h.html
@@ -0,0 +1,16203 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" lang="en" xml:lang="en"><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=utf-8" /><meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" /><link rel="schema.DC" href="http://purl.org/dc/elements/1.1/" /><meta name="DC.Creator" content="Sylvester Bliss" /><meta name="DC.Title" content="A Brief Commentary on the Apocalypse" /><meta name="DC.Date" content="September 16, 2008" /><meta name="DC.Language" content="English" /><meta name="DC.Publisher" content="Project Gutenberg" /><meta name="DC.Identifier" content="http://www.gutenberg.org/etext/26639" /><meta name="DC.Rights" content="This text is in the public domain." /><title>The Project Gutenberg EBook of A Brief Commentary on the Apocalypse by Sylvester Bliss</title><style type="text/css">/*
+The Gnutenberg Press - default CSS2 stylesheet
+
+Any generated element will have a class "tei" and a class "tei-elem"
+where elem is the element name in TEI.
+The order of statements is important !!!
+*/
+
+.tei { margin: 0; padding: 0;
+ font-size: 100%; font-weight: normal; font-style: normal }
+
+.block { display: block; }
+.inline { display: inline; }
+.floatleft { float: left; margin: 1em 2em 1em 0; }
+.floatright { float: right; margin: 1em 0 1em 2em; }
+.shaded { margin-top: 1em; margin-bottom: 1em;
+ padding: 1em; background-color: #eee; }
+.boxed { margin-top: 1em; margin-bottom: 1em;
+ padding: 1em; border: 1px solid black; }
+
+body.tei { margin: 4ex 10%; text-align: justify }
+div.tei { margin: 2em 0em }
+p.tei { margin: 0em 0em 1em 0em; text-indent: 0em; }
+blockquote.tei { margin: 2em 4em }
+
+div.tei-lg { margin: 1em 0em; }
+div.tei-l { margin: 0em; text-align: left; }
+div.tei-tb { text-align: center; }
+div.tei-epigraph { margin: 0em 0em 1em 10em; }
+div.tei-dateline { margin: 1ex 0em; text-align: right }
+div.tei-salute { margin: 1ex 0em; }
+div.tei-signed { margin: 1ex 0em; text-align: right }
+div.tei-byline { margin: 1ex 0em; }
+
+ /* calculate from size of body = 80% */
+div.tei-marginnote { margin: 0em 0em 0em -12%; width: 11%; float: left; }
+
+div.tei-sp { margin: 1em 0em 1em 2em }
+div.tei-speaker { margin: 0em 0em 1em -2em;
+ font-weight: bold; text-indent: 0em }
+div.tei-stage { margin: 1em 0em; font-weight: normal; font-style: italic }
+span.tei-stage { font-weight: normal; font-style: italic }
+
+div.tei-eg { padding: 1em;
+ color: black; background-color: #eee }
+
+hr.doublepage { margin: 4em 0em; height: 5px; }
+hr.page { margin: 4em 0em; height: 2px; }
+
+ul.tei-index { list-style-type: none }
+
+dl.tei { margin: 1em 0em }
+
+dt.tei-notelabel { font-weight: normal; text-align: right;
+ float: left; width: 3em }
+dd.tei-notetext { margin: 0em 0em 1ex 4em }
+
+span.tei-pb { position: absolute; left: 1%; width: 8%;
+ font-style: normal; }
+
+span.code { font-family: monospace; font-size: 110%; }
+
+ul.tei-castlist { margin: 0em; list-style-type: none }
+li.tei-castitem { margin: 0em; }
+table.tei-castgroup { margin: 0em; }
+ul.tei-castgroup { margin: 0em; list-style-type: none;
+ padding-right: 2em; border-right: solid black 2px; }
+caption.tei-castgroup-head { caption-side: right; width: 50%; text-align: left;
+ vertical-align: middle; padding-left: 2em; }
+*.tei-roledesc { font-style: italic }
+*.tei-set { font-style: italic }
+
+table.rules { border-collapse: collapse; }
+table.rules caption,
+table.rules th,
+table.rules td { border: 1px solid black; }
+
+table.tei { border-collapse: collapse; }
+table.tei-list { width: 100% }
+
+th.tei-head-table { padding: 0.5ex 1em }
+
+th.tei-cell { padding: 0em 1em }
+td.tei-cell { padding: 0em 1em }
+
+td.tei-item { padding: 0; font-weight: normal;
+ vertical-align: top; text-align: left; }
+th.tei-label,
+td.tei-label { width: 3em; padding: 0; font-weight: normal;
+ vertical-align: top; text-align: right; }
+
+th.tei-label-gloss,
+td.tei-label-gloss { text-align: left }
+
+td.tei-item-gloss,
+th.tei-headItem-gloss { padding-left: 4em; }
+
+img.tei-formula { vertical-align: middle; }
+
+</style></head><body class="tei">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<div lang="en" class="tei tei-text" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em" xml:lang="en">
+ <div class="tei tei-front" style="margin-bottom: 6.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">
+ <div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+ <div id="pgheader" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em"><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em">The Project Gutenberg EBook of A Brief Commentary on the Apocalypse by Sylvester Bliss</p></div><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost
+ and with almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it,
+ give it away or re-use it under the terms of the Project
+ Gutenberg License <a href="#pglicense" class="tei tei-ref">included with this
+ eBook</a> or online at <a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/license" class="tei tei-xref">http://www.gutenberg.org/license</a></p></div><pre class="pre tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">Title: A Brief Commentary on the Apocalypse
+
+Author: Sylvester Bliss
+
+Release Date: September 16, 2008 [Ebook #26639]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: UTF-8
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A BRIEF COMMENTARY ON THE APOCALYPSE***
+</pre></div>
+ </div>
+ <div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+
+ </div>
+
+ <hr class="page" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.44em"><span style="font-size: 144%">A</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.73em"><span style="font-size: 173%">BRIEF COMMENTARY</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.44em"><span style="font-size: 144%">ON THE</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.73em"><span style="font-size: 173%">APOCALYPSE</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.73em"><span style="font-size: 173%">By SYLVESTER BLISS,</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.20em"><span style="font-size: 120%">AUTHOR OF </span><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: center"><span style="font-size: 120%">“</span><span style="font-size: 120%">ANALYSIS OF SACRED CHRONOLOGY,</span><span style="font-size: 120%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 120%"> ETC.</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.20em"><span style="font-size: 120%">SECOND EDITION</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.20em"><span style="font-size: 120%">BOSTON:</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.20em"><span style="font-size: 120%">PUBLISHED BY J. V. HIMES,</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.20em"><span style="font-size: 120%">No. 8 CHARDON STREET.</span></p>
+ <p class="tei tei-p" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 1.20em"><span style="font-size: 120%">1853.</span></p>
+ </div>
+ <hr class="page" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+ <h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">Contents</span></h1>
+ <ul class="tei tei-index tei-index-toc"><li><a href="#toc1">PREFACE.</a></li><li><a href="#toc3">ELEMENTS OF PROPHETIC INTERPRETATION.</a></li><li><a href="#toc5">EXPOSITION OF THE APOCALYPSE.</a></li><li><a href="#toc7">Footnotes</a></li></ul>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+<div class="tei tei-body" style="margin-bottom: 6.00em; margin-top: 6.00em">
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page005">[pg 005]</span><a name="Pg005" id="Pg005" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<hr class="page" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+<a name="toc1" id="toc1"></a>
+<a name="pdf2" id="pdf2"></a>
+<h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">PREFACE.</span></h1>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Apocalypse should be regarded as a peculiarly interesting
+portion of scripture: a blessing being promised those
+who read, hear, and keep the things which are written
+therein. It has been subjected to so many contradictory
+interpretations, that any attempt to comprehend its meaning
+is often regarded with distrust; and the impression has
+become very prevalent, that it is a <span class="tei tei-q">“sealed book,”</span>—that
+its meaning is so hidden in unintelligible symbols, that very
+little can be known respecting it; and that to attempt to
+unfold its meaning, is to tread presumptuously on forbidden
+ground.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The attention of the Christian community has been called
+more of late to its study, by the publication of several elaborate
+Expositions. One in two large volumes, 8vo., by
+Prof. Stuart, was published at Andover, Mass., in 1845. A
+large 8vo. volume, by David N. Lord, was issued from the
+press of the Harpers, in New York, in 1847; and a smaller
+work, by Rev. Thomas Wickes, appeared in that city in
+1851. These are the more important works on the subject
+which have been published in this country. In England,
+the <span class="tei tei-q">“Horæ Apocalypticæ,”</span> by the Rev. E. B. Elliott, A.M.,
+late Vicar of Tuxford, and fellow of Trinity College, Cambridge,
+has passed through several editions,—the fourth
+of which, in four large vols. 8vo., was published in London,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page006">[pg 006]</span><a name="Pg006" id="Pg006" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+in 1851. These works, with the writings of Habershon,
+Cunningham, Croly, Bickersteth, Birks, Brooks, Keith, and
+other distinguished English writers, have caused the study
+of the Apocalypse to be regarded with more favor of late
+than heretofore.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Expositions of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Mr. Lord</span></span> have thrown much light
+on the nature and laws of symbols, by unfolding the principles
+in accordance with which they are used. The evolving
+of these has removed from many passages the obscurity
+which had before caused them to be regarded as enigmatical.
+There are, doubtless, many portions of the Apocalypse,
+the meaning of which is as yet only dimly perceived,
+and which will be more clearly unfolded by the transpiring
+of future events; and it would be arrogant to claim that
+its interpretation had been freed from all perplexities. But
+it is believed that it may be as profitably and as satisfactorily
+studied as other portions of Scripture; and that the
+reader may feel an assurance of approximating to a knowledge
+of the true meaning of its symbolic teachings.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Bible is its own interpreter; and when practicable,
+scripture should be explained by scripture. The meaning
+imputed to any passage must never contradict, but must
+harmonize with that of parallel texts. In illustrating the
+several references in the Apocalypse to the same events and
+epochs, a repetition of scripture is somewhat unavoidable.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These pages have resulted from notes prepared in a familiar
+course of Bible-class instruction, where the study of
+brevity was necessary. Without designing to speak dogmatically,
+the didactic was found the more direct and simple
+mode of expression. In presenting this exposition, merely
+as the opinion of the writer, it is with the hope that it will
+give, in a small compass, a common-sense view of the intricacies
+of this book, and be acceptable to those interested in
+the study of prophecy.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page007">[pg 007]</span><a name="Pg007" id="Pg007" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<hr class="page" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+<a name="toc3" id="toc3"></a>
+<a name="pdf4" id="pdf4"></a>
+<h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">ELEMENTS OF PROPHETIC INTERPRETATION.</span></h1>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+1. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">The Grammar</span></span> of any science is a development of the
+principles by which it is governed. As the science of interpretation
+must be founded on some fixed and uniform laws,
+the unfolding of these is the first step in the study of
+prophecy.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+2. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Biblical Exegesis</span></span> and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Sacred
+Hermeneutics</span></span>, are terms applied to the science of interpretation, or of learning
+the meaning of Biblical words and phrases.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+3. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">The Usus Loquendi</span></span>, is the usual mode of speaking.
+When applied to the Scriptures, it denotes the general
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">scriptural use</span></span> of words.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+4. To learn the meaning of scriptural terms, their general
+use must be ascertained, by comparing their contexts in the
+several places of their occurrence.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+5. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Prophecy</span></span> is the prediction of a future event. The
+term sometimes denotes a book of prophecies (Rev. 22:18);
+and sometimes a history.—2 Chron. 9:29.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+6. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Consecutive</span></span> Prophecy gives the succession of future
+events in the order in which they will transpire.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—See
+Dan. 2d, 7th, 8th, 11th, and Rev. 6th and 7th,
+9th to the 11th; 12th and 15th, &amp;c.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+7. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Discursive</span></span> Prophecy presents future events, irrespective
+of the order of their occurrence.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Isaiah</span></span>
+and the minor prophets.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+8. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Conditional</span></span> Prophecy is when the fulfilment is dependent
+on the compliance of those to whom the promise is
+made, with the conditions on which it is given.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">If</span></em>
+ye walk in my statutes and keep my commandments,
+and do them: then I will give you rain in due season,
+and the land shall yield her increase, and the trees of
+the field shall yield their fruit.”</span> Lev. 26:3, 4. <span class="tei tei-q">“But <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">if</span></em>
+ye will <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">not</span></em> hearken unto me, and will <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">not</span></em> do all
+these commandments; and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">if</span></em> ye shall despise my statutes, or if your
+soul abhor my judgments, so that ye will not do all my
+commandments, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">but</span></em> that ye break my covenant: I also will
+do this unto you, I will even appoint over you terror, consumption,
+and the burning ague, that shall consume the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page008">[pg 008]</span><a name="Pg008" id="Pg008" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+eyes, and cause sorrow of heart: and ye shall sow your
+seed in vain; for your enemies shall eat it.”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 14-16.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And it shall come to pass, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">if</span></em> thou shalt hearken diligently
+unto the voice of the Lord thy God, to observe and
+to do all his commandments which I command thee this
+day: that the Lord thy God will set thee on high above all
+nations of the earth: and all these blessings shall come on
+thee, and overtake thee, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">if</span></em> thou shalt hearken unto the voice
+of the Lord thy God.”</span> Deut. 28:1, 2. <span class="tei tei-q">“But it shall
+come to pass, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">if</span></em> thou wilt not hearken unto the voice of the
+Lord thy God, to observe to do all his commandments and
+his statutes which I command thee this day: that all these
+curses shall come upon thee, and overtake thee,”</span> &amp;c. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Predictions of mere national prosperity, or adversity, are
+usually conditional. When the condition is not expressed,
+it is implied. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—The Lord said unto Jonah,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Arise, go unto Nineveh, that great city, and preach unto
+it the preaching that I bid thee.... And Jonah began to
+enter into the city a day's journey, and he cried, and said,
+Yet forty days, and Nineveh shall be overthrown. So the
+people of Nineveh believed God, and proclaimed a fast, and
+put on sackcloth, from the greatest of them even to the least
+of them.... And God saw their works, that they turned
+from their evil way; and God repented of the evil that
+he had said that he would do unto them: and he did it
+not.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+For all cases of this kind, the Lord has given the following
+general <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Rule</span></span>: <span class="tei tei-q">“At what instant I shall speak concerning
+a nation, and concerning a kingdom, to pluck up,
+and to pull down, and to destroy it: if that nation against
+whom I have pronounced turn from their evil, I will repent
+of the evil that I thought to do unto them. And at what
+instant I shall speak concerning a nation, and concerning a
+kingdom, to build and to plant it; if it do evil in my
+sight, that it obey not my voice, then I will repent of the
+good wherewith I said I would benefit them.”</span> Jer. 18:7-10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+9. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Unconditional</span></span> Prophecy includes all predictions
+which are absolute in their nature. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“But
+as truly as I live, all the earth shall be filled with the glory
+of the Lord.”</span> Num. 14:21.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page009">[pg 009]</span><a name="Pg009" id="Pg009" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For behold, the darkness shall cover the earth, and
+gross darkness the people: but the Lord shall arise upon
+thee, and his glory shall be seen upon thee. And the Gentiles
+shall come to thy light, and kings to the brightness of
+thy rising.... For the nation and kingdom that will not
+serve thee shall perish; yea, those nations shall be utterly
+wasted.... Thy people also shall be all righteous: they
+shall inherit the land for ever, the branch of my planting,
+the work of my hands, that I may be glorified.”</span> Isa. 60:2,
+3, 12, 21.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“But in the last days it shall come to pass, that the
+mountain of the house of the Lord shall be established in
+the top of the mountains, and it shall be exalted above the
+hills; and people shall flow unto it.”</span> Micah 4:1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+10. A <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Vision</span></span> is a revelation from
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>, supernaturally
+presented. Future events are made to pass before the mind
+of the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">seer</span></em>, as if actually transpiring.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—See
+the prophecies of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Isaiah</span></span>, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Amos</span></span>,
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Obadiah</span></span>, &amp;c.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+11. A <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Symbolic Vision</span></span> is where the future events, instead
+of being presented to the mind of the prophet, are
+represented by analogous objects. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—The prophecies
+of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Ezekiel</span></span>, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Daniel</span></span>,
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Zechariah</span></span>, and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">John</span></span>, are of this
+kind.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+12. A <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Literal</span></span> Prophecy is where the prediction is given
+in words used according to their primary and natural import.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—Num. 14:21-35; Jer. 25:1-33.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+13. Prophecy is <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">figurative</span></span> when it abounds in tropes, as
+in much of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Isaiah</span></span> and the minor prophets; and it is symbolic,
+when symbols instead of the objects themselves are
+presented—as in <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Daniel</span></span> and
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">John</span></span>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+14. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Poetry</span></span> is writing thus constituted by the metrical
+or rhythmical structure of its sentences; and is not necessarily
+any more figurative or obscure than prose writing. It
+is, also, a term sometimes applied to the language of excited
+imagination and feeling.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Poetry of the Bible consists in Hebrew parallelisms,
+where the idea of the preceding line is repeated, or contrasted,
+in the succeeding one. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—The Psalms,
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Isaiah</span></span>, and other prophets.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+15. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Highly Figurative</span></span>, or <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Symbolic</span></span>
+Prophecies—the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page010">[pg 010]</span><a name="Pg010" id="Pg010" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+laws and use of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Tropes</span></span> and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Symbols</span></span> being
+understood are not necessarily more equivocal, enigmatical or obscure,
+than those which are literal.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+16. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Literal Fulfilment</span></span> of prophecy is prophecy fulfilled
+in accordance with the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">grammatical interpretation</span></em> of
+its language.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+17. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Literal Interpretation</span></span>, when <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">technically</span></em>
+applied to the interpretation of prophecy, is not opposed to tropes
+or figures of speech, but to <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">spiritual</span></em> interpretation. It interprets
+the language of the Scriptures, as similar language
+would be interpreted <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">in all other writings</span></em>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+18. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Spiritual Interpretation</span></span> (<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">mystical</span></em>) seeks, in
+the language of Scripture, a meaning that is not expressed by
+any of the ordinary rules of language. It sets at defiance
+all the laws of language, and makes fancy the interpreter
+of prophecy. <span class="tei tei-q">“It subjects clear predictions to an exegetical
+alembic that effectually subtilizes and evaporates their
+meaning.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Bush.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+19. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Ultra Literal Interpretation</span></span> is a disregard of the
+peculiarities of symbols and of the several kinds of tropes—understanding
+them as if they were <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">literally</span></em> expressed.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+20. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Symbols</span></span> and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Tropes</span></span> are
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">literally</span></em> explained, when
+interpreted in accordance with the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">grammatical laws</span></em> which
+respectively govern their use.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+21. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Prophetic Symbols</span></span> are objects, real or imaginary,
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">representative</span></em> of agents or objects possessing analogous characteristics.
+All agents or objects <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">seen</span></em> in symbolic visions
+are symbols. The inspired <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">explanations</span></em> of symbols are always
+literal, except when they are affirmed to be the same
+as some other symbol which represents the same object, as
+in Rev. 17:9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+22. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Laws of Symbols.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+I. <span class="tei tei-q">“The Symbol and that which it represents resemble
+each other in the station they fill, the relation they sustain,
+and the agencies they exert in their respective
+spheres.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+II. The Symbol and that which it represents are of the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">same</span></em>,
+or they are of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">different</span></em> species, kinds, or rank, according
+to the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">nature</span></em> and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">use</span></em> of the symbol.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+III. <span class="tei tei-q">“When the Symbol is of such nature, or is used in
+such a relation that it can properly symbolise something
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page011">[pg 011]</span><a name="Pg011" id="Pg011" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">different</span></em> from itself, the representative and that which it
+represents, while the counterpart of each other, are of
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">different</span></em> species, kinds, or rank.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—Dan. 7:3, beasts; v. 17, governments.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+IV. <span class="tei tei-q">“Symbols that are of such a nature, station or relation,
+that there is nothing of an analogous kind that they can
+represent, symbolize agents, objects, acts, or events of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">their
+own</span></em> kind.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—Dan. 7:9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+V. <span class="tei tei-q">“When the Symbol and that which it symbolizes
+differ from each other, the correspondence between the representative
+and that which it represents, still extends to
+their chief parts; and the elements or parts of the symbols denote
+corresponding parts in that which is symbolized.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+VI. <span class="tei tei-q">“The Names of Symbols are their literal and proper
+names, not metaphorical titles.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+VII. <span class="tei tei-q">“A single agent, in many instances, symbolizes a
+body and succession of agents.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+VIII. Symbols of the same kind, and used in the same
+relations, always represent one class of objects; and when
+the office of a symbol has been once shown, the same symbol,
+similarly used, always fills a like office. They are never
+used arbitrarily.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+IX. While like symbols represent like objects, the same
+agents are often indicated by different symbols.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Thus, a church may be symbolized by a city and a woman;
+and government, by a beast and a mountain, &amp;c.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+23. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Inspired Explanations of Symbolic Representations</span></span>:—
+</p>
+
+<a name="Pg012" id="Pg012" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><table summary="This is a list." class="tei tei-list" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em"><tbody><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Ancient of Days—The Most High.—Dan. 7:9, 22.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Candlesticks—Churches.—Rev. 1:20.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Carpenters—Destroyers of governments.—Zech. 1:21.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Days—Years.—Num. 14:34. Ezek. 4:4-6.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Horns, of a wild beast—Kings or kingdoms succeeding
+to a divided empire.—Dan. 8:22 and 7:24.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Heads, of a wild beast—Kings or forms of government.—Rev.
+17:9, 10.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Image, of different metals—A succession of governments.—Dan.
+2:37-42.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Incense, or odors—Prayers.—Rev. 5:8 and 8:4.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Lamb, the—Christ.—Rev. 5:6, 9, 10.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Lamb's wife—Risen saints.—Rev. 19:7, 8.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Lake of fire and brimstone—The place of the second
+death.—Rev. 20:15.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Likeness of a man—The Lord.—Ezek. 1:26, 28, and
+8:2, 4.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Linen, fine and clean—Righteousness of saints—Rev.
+19:8.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Mountains—Kings, or forms of government.—Rev. 17:9,
+10.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">New Jerusalem—The redeemed Church, or the Bride,
+the Lamb's wife.—Rev. 21:9, 10.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Revivification of dry bones—Resurrection of the dead.—Ezek.
+37:11, 12.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Stars—Angels, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, messengers of the
+churches.—Rev. 1:20.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Souls of martyrs living again—The first resurrection.—Rev.
+20:4, 5.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Stone, becoming a mountain—Kingdom of God.—Dan.
+2:45.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Waters—Peoples.—Rev. 17:15.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Wild Beasts—Governments.—Dan. 7:17.</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Woman—A city.—Rev. 17:18. Explained to be a
+church.—21:9, 10.</td></tr></tbody></table>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+24. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Tropes</span></span> are figures of various kinds, used to
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">illustrate</span></em> the subjects to which they are applied.—They embrace the
+Simile, Metaphor, Prosopopœia, Apostrophe, Synecdoche,
+Allegory, &amp;c.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+25. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Laws of Figures</span></span>—(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">a.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+terms in which they are expressed are used in their ordinary and literal
+sense.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">b.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“The agents or objects to which figures are applied
+are always expressly mentioned. Figures, in that respect,
+differ wholly from symbols, which never formally indicate,
+unless an interpretation is given, who the agents, or what
+the objects are which they represent.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">c.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“The figurative terms are always predicates, or are
+employed in affirming something of some other agent or object;
+and are therefore either nouns, verbs, adjectives or
+adverbs.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">d.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“As their terms are used literally, the figure lies,
+when they are employed in an unusual manner, simply in
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page013">[pg 013]</span><a name="Pg013" id="Pg013" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+their being applied to objects to which they do not properly
+belong.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">e.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“They are used accordingly in all such cases for the
+purpose of illustration, and their explication is accomplished,
+not by assigning to them some new and extraordinary
+meaning, but simply by conjoining with them the terms of
+a comparison which expresses the relation in which they are
+employed.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">f.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“It is in metaphors and personification only that
+acts and qualities are ascribed to agents and objects that
+are incompatible with their nature; or do not properly belong
+to them.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib. Theo. &amp; Lit. Jour.</span></span>, vol. 1, p.
+354.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+26. A <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Simile</span></span>, or comparison, is an affirmation that one
+agent, object, or act, is <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">like</span></em>, or as, another,—there being
+a real or imaginary resemblance. Sometimes only the mere
+fact of a resemblance is affirmed. At others, the nature of
+the resemblance is indicated.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“As for man, his days are <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">as</span></em>
+grass.”</span> Psa. 103:15. <span class="tei tei-q">“Whose garment was <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">white</span></em> as <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">snow</span></em>.”</span>
+Dan. 7:9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+27. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Antithesis</span></span> is a contrast, or placing in opposite
+lights things dissimilar.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“The wicked are overthrown and are not;
+but the house of the righteous shall stand.”</span> Prov. 12:7.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+28. A <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Metaphor</span></span> is a simile comprised in a word, without
+the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">sign</span></em> of comparison. It is an affirmation of an object,
+incompatible with its nature—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, it affirms that an
+object is, what literally it is only <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">like</span></em>; or attributes to it
+acts, to which its acts only bear a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">resemblance</span></em>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“He is the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Rock</span></em>.”</span> Deut. 32:4.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Her gates shall <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">lament</span></em> and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">mourn</span></em>.”</span> Isa. 3:25.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A metaphor may be a simple affirmation of what an object
+is, or it may embrace <span class="tei tei-q">“the agent, the act, the object,
+and the effect of an action.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">a.</span></span>) When an object is affirmed to be what it only resembles,
+that of which the affirmation is made is always <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">literally</span></em>
+expressed.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">b.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“When a nature is ascribed to an object that does
+not belong to it, the acts or results affirmed to it are proper to
+that <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">imputed nature</span></em>, not to its own.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page014">[pg 014]</span><a name="Pg014" id="Pg014" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">c.</span></span>) <span class="tei tei-q">“The meaning of a metaphorical passage is precisely
+what it would be if a comparison only were affirmed.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+29. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">An Elliptical Metaphor</span></span> is where the figure is incomplete.
+An object, instead of being affirmed to be what
+it only resembles, is introduced by the name proper only to
+that resemblance. The literal name of the object and the
+affirmation to complete the figure are to be supplied.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To find the meaning of an elliptical metaphor, trace the
+word through the Bible, and find to what object such metaphorical
+term is applied. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“And in that day there
+shall be a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Root</span></em> of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Jesse</span></span>, which shall stand for
+an ensign of the people.”</span> Isa. 11:10. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Explanation.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“I
+[<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Jesus</span></span>] am the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Root</span></em> and the offspring of
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">David</span></span>.”</span> Rev. 22:16.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+30. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Prosopœia</span></span>, or <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Personification</span></span>, is
+an address to an inanimate object, as if it were a person, and had
+intelligence.—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“Give ear, O ye heavens,
+and I will speak; and hear, O earth, the words of my
+mouth.”</span> Deut. 32:1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+31. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">An Apostrophe</span></span> is a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">digression</span></em> from the order
+of any discourse, and a direct <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">address</span></em> to the persons of whom it
+treats, or to those who are to form a judgment respecting
+the subject of which it treats.—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“Hear
+the word of the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Lord</span></span>, ye rulers of Sodom: give ear
+unto the law of our <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>, ye people of Gomorrah.”</span> Isa.
+1:10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+32. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">An Allegory</span></span> is a narrative in which the subject of
+the discourse is described by an analogous subject, resembling
+it in its characteristics and circumstances—the subject of
+which it is descriptive being indicated in its connection.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—See
+Ezek. 31:3-9; Ps. 80:8-16; Jud. 9:8-15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Past <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">historical</span></em> events, instead of supposititious ones, are
+sometimes used for illustration. When thus used they serve
+as allegories, without affecting their original historical significance.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—Gal. 4: 22-31. See also Rom.
+9:7, 8; 1 Cor. 9:9, 10, and 10:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+33. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">A Parable</span></span> is a similitude taken from natural things, to
+instruct us in the knowledge of spiritual. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—Matt.
+13th, and 21:28-41.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Parable differs from the Allegory in that the acts ascribed
+are appropriate to the agents to which they are attributed.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page015">[pg 015]</span><a name="Pg015" id="Pg015" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+In the Allegory, acts may be ascribed to real objects
+which are not natural to those objects. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—See
+Judges 9:7-15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Parable is sometimes used to denote a prophecy,
+(Num. 23:7); sometimes a discourse, (Job 27:1); sometimes
+a lamentation, (Micah 2:4); sometimes a proverb,
+or wise saying, (Prov. 26:7); and sometimes to indicate
+that a thing is apocryphal. Ezek. 20:49. The terms
+parable and allegory, are often wrongfully applied.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+34. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">A Riddle</span></span> is an enigma—something to be guessed.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—See Judges 14:24-18. It is sometimes used
+to denote an allegory. Ezek. 17:1-10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+35. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Types</span></span> are emblems—greater events in the future
+being prefigured by typical observances, <span class="tei tei-q">“which are a
+shadow of good things to come.”</span> Col. 2:17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+36. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">The Hypocatastasis</span></span>, or substitution, is a figure introduced
+by Mr. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Lord</span></span>, in which the objects, or agents, of
+one class are, without any formal notice, employed in the
+place of the persons or things of which the passages in
+which they occur treat; and they are exhibited either as exerting,
+or as subjected to an agency proper to their nature,
+in order to represent by analogy, the agency which those
+persons are to exert, or of which those things are to be the
+subjects. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“O, my people, they which lead thee
+cause thee to err, and destroy the way of thy paths.”</span>—Isa.
+3:12,—expressive of the manner in which they were misled
+by their rulers and kept from the truth.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+37. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">A Metonymy</span></span> is a reversion, or the use of a noun to
+express that with which it is intimately connected, instead
+of using the term which would literally express the idea.
+Thus the cause is used for the effect, the effect for the cause,
+the thing containing for that which is contained in it, &amp;c.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“Ye have eaten up the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">vineyard</span></em>.”</span>
+Isa. 3:14—meaning the fruit of the vineyard.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+38. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">A Synecdoche</span></span> is the use of a word expressive of a
+part, to signify the whole; or that expressive of the whole,
+to denote only a part—as the genus for the species, or the
+species for the genus, &amp;c.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Man</span></em> dieth and
+wasteth away; yea <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">man</span></em> giveth up the ghost, and where is
+he?”</span> Job 14:10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+39. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">A Hyperbole</span></span> is an exaggeration in which more is
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page016">[pg 016]</span><a name="Pg016" id="Pg016" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+expressed than is intended to be understood. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“I
+suppose that even the world itself could not contain the
+books that should be written.”</span> John 21:25—meaning
+that a great number might be written.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+40. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Irony</span></span> is the utterance of pointed remarks, contrary
+to the actual thoughts of the speaker or writer—not to deceive,
+but to add force to the remark. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“No
+doubt but ye are the people, and wisdom shall die with
+you.”</span> Job 12:2.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And it came to pass at noon, that Elijah mocked them,
+and said, Cry aloud: for he <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">is</span></em> a god: either he is talking,
+or he is pursuing, or he is in a journey, or peradventure he
+sleepeth and must be awaked.”</span> 1 Kings 18:27.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+41. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">The Interrogation</span></span>—while its legitimate use is to
+ask a question—is also used to affirm or deny with great
+emphasis. Affirmative interrogations usually have <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">no</span></em> or
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">not</span></em> in connection with the verb.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“Is <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">not</span></em> God
+in the height of the heavens?”</span> Job 22:12. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Examples
+of a negative.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“Shall the earth be made to bring forth
+in one day? or shall a nation be born at once?”</span> Isa. 66:8.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Can the rush grow up without mire?”</span> Job 8:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+42. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Exclamations</span></span> are digressions from the order of a
+discourse or writing, to give expression to the emotions of
+the speaker, or writer. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Example.</span></span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“O that I had wings like
+a dove! for then would I fly away and be at rest!”</span> Psa.
+55:6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+43. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Fables</span></span> are fictions—additions to the word of
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>. All false theories and doctrines supposed to be based on
+the Bible, all interpretations of Scripture which do violence to
+the laws of language and falsify their meaning, and all
+opinions which are the result of mere traditions and doctrines
+of men, are to be classed as fables. Mark 7:8-13;
+1 Pet. 1:18; 1 Tim. 1:4; 4:7; Tit. 1:14.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+44. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Synchronous Scriptures</span></span> are the several passages
+which have reference to any one and the same event.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Each portion of Scripture respecting any subject, must be
+considered in connection with all the Scriptures that refer
+to the same subject.—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Compare</span></span>, for example, Dan. 2:34,
+35, 44; 7:18, 27; Matt. 6:10; 13:37-43; 35:34; 1
+Tim. 4:1; Rev. 11:15-18.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page017">[pg 017]</span><a name="Pg017" id="Pg017" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<hr class="page" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+<a name="toc5" id="toc5"></a>
+<a name="pdf6" id="pdf6"></a>
+<h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">EXPOSITION OF THE APOCALYPSE.</span></h1>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Title of the Book.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">The Revelation of Jesus Christ, which God gave to him,
+to show to his servants things which must shortly come to
+pass; and sending, he signified </span><em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-size: 90%; font-style: italic">them</span></em><span style="font-size: 90%"> through his angel to
+his servant John: who testified the word of God, and the
+testimony of Jesus Christ, and whatever he saw.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+1:1, 2.—</span><span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-size: 90%; font-style: italic">Prof. Whiting's Translation.</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The very title of John's predictions, Apocalypse,
+implies the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">unveiling</span></em> or <span class="tei tei-q">‘<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">revelation</span></em>’</span>
+of the mystic and hidden sense of the prophetic
+oracles, previously uttered by his inspired
+predecessors.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Prof. Bush.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Αποκαλυψις, from which we have our
+word Apocalypse, signifies, literally, a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">revelation</span></em>,
+or <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">discovery</span></em>, of what was <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">concealed</span></em>, or
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">hidden</span></em>.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Dr. Clarke.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The work of the apostles was <span class="tei tei-q">“to make all
+men see what is the fellowship of the mystery,
+which, from the beginning of the world, hath
+been hid in God, who created all things by
+Jesus Christ,”</span> (Eph. 3:9); <span class="tei tei-q">“even the mystery
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page018">[pg 018]</span><a name="Pg018" id="Pg018" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+which hath been hid from ages and from
+generations, but now is made manifest to his
+saints,”</span> Col. 1:26. The entire record of the
+New Testament, is a revelation that God
+<span class="tei tei-q">“hath in these last days spoken unto us by
+his Son;”</span> in distinction from the records of
+the Old Testament, which He, <span class="tei tei-q">“at sundry
+times and in divers manners, spake in time
+past unto the fathers by the prophets,”</span> Heb.
+1:1. But the closing book of the new series
+is called, in distinction from the others, <span class="tei tei-q">“<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">The
+Revelation of Jesus Christ</span></span>.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It contains the <span class="tei tei-q">“many things”</span> he had to
+say to his disciples, in addition to those recorded
+by the evangelists; but which they
+could not then bear, John 16:12. It is the
+revelation <span class="tei tei-q">“which God gave unto him;”</span> for
+<span class="tei tei-q">“there is a God in heaven that revealeth secrets,
+and maketh known ... what shall be
+in the latter days,”</span> Dan. 2:28. God communicated
+by his servants the prophets what
+should <span class="tei tei-q">“come to pass hereafter,”</span> by visions
+which were <span class="tei tei-q">“certain,”</span> and by <span class="tei tei-q">“the interpretation
+thereof”</span> which was <span class="tei tei-q">“sure,”</span> Dan. 2:46.
+But Daniel was commanded to <span class="tei tei-q">“shut up
+the words, and seal the book, even to the time
+of the end,”</span> when many should <span class="tei tei-q">“run to and
+fro,”</span> and knowledge should <span class="tei tei-q">“be increased.”</span>
+And it was added, <span class="tei tei-q">“Go thy way, Daniel; for
+the words are closed up and sealed till the
+time of the end: Many shall be purified and
+made white, and tried; but the wicked shall
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page019">[pg 019]</span><a name="Pg019" id="Pg019" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+do wickedly: and none of the wicked shall
+understand; but the wise shall understand.”</span>
+Dan. 12:4, 9, 10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It will thus be seen, that provision had
+been made for the future <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">unveiling</span></em> of what
+was left obscure in the predictions of the Old
+Testament writers; and for the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">unsealing</span></em> of
+what was then closed up and sealed. This
+revelation must come from God; for the Saviour
+has testified, that <span class="tei tei-q">“of that day and hour
+knoweth no man, no, not the angels of heaven,
+but my Father only.”</span> Matt. 24:36. <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+secret things belong unto the Lord our God:
+but those things which are revealed belong
+unto us and to our children forever.”</span> Deut.
+29:29.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As God had provided for a more full <span class="tei tei-q">“revelation”</span>
+respecting the events of the future, it
+was necessary that it should be communicated
+through <span class="tei tei-q">“the appointed Heir of all things,”</span> by
+whom he was to speak in the last days, Heb.
+1:2. The <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Baptist</span></span> said of Christ, that <span class="tei tei-q">“what
+he hath seen and heard, this he testifieth,”</span>
+John 3:22. And the Saviour said of him by
+whom he was sent, <span class="tei tei-q">“I speak to the world
+those things which I have heard of him,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+8:2, 6. And again, he saith, <span class="tei tei-q">“I have not
+spoken of myself; but the Father which sent
+me, he gave me a commandment; what I
+should say, and what I should speak,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+12:49. <span class="tei tei-q">“The Lion of the tribe of Judah,
+the Root of David, hath prevailed to open the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page020">[pg 020]</span><a name="Pg020" id="Pg020" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+book, and to loose the seven seals thereof,”</span>
+Rev. 5:5.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The design of God in giving this additional
+revelation, was that he might <span class="tei tei-q">“show unto
+his servants things which must shortly come
+to pass;”</span> for <span class="tei tei-q">“surely the Lord God doeth
+nothing, but he revealeth his secrets unto his
+servants the prophets,”</span> Amos 3:7. And he
+saith, <span class="tei tei-q">“I have told you before it come to pass,
+that when it is come to pass ye might believe,”</span>
+John 14:29. When the old world was
+to be destroyed by water, <span class="tei tei-q">“Noah, being
+warned of God of things not seen as yet, prepared
+an ark to the saving of his house,”</span> Heb.
+11:7. And when the Lord had purposed the
+destruction of Sodom, he said, <span class="tei tei-q">“Shall I hide
+from Abraham that thing which I do?”</span> and
+angels were sent to Lot, that he might say to
+his children, <span class="tei tei-q">“Up get ye out of this place; for
+the Lord will destroy this city,”</span> Gen. 18:17,
+and 19:14. So of the times and seasons of
+the second advent: while <span class="tei tei-q">“the day of the Lord
+so cometh as a thief in the night,”</span> he has said
+to his chosen ones, <span class="tei tei-q">“Ye brethren are not in
+darkness that that day should overtake you
+as a thief,”</span> 1 Thess. 5:1-4. He has condescended
+to give his people <span class="tei tei-q">“a more sure word
+of prophecy: whereunto ye do well that ye
+take heed, as unto a light that shineth in a
+dark place, until the day dawn, and the day
+star arise in your hearts,”</span> 2 Pet. 1:19.
+Therefore it was said to John, <span class="tei tei-q">“I will show
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page021">[pg 021]</span><a name="Pg021" id="Pg021" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+thee things which must be hereafter,”</span> Rev. 4:1;
+which things were shortly to begin to come
+to pass,—they being a series of successive
+events, commencing near the time in which
+John wrote, and extending to the end of the
+world and the establishment of the everlasting
+kingdom.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These were shown to John by symbolic representations,
+in a series of visions, the import
+of which was signified to him by an angelic
+interpreter. Said the Saviour, <span class="tei tei-q">“I, Jesus, have
+sent my angel to testify unto you these things
+in the churches,”</span> 22:16. And <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">these things</span></em>
+were not to be sealed up, like the words of
+Daniel; for John was commanded to <span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">seal
+not</span></em> the sayings of the prophecy of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">this</span></em> book:
+for the time is at hand,”</span> 22:10. He recorded
+the words which God thus gave him,—<span class="tei tei-q">“the
+testimony of Jesus Christ, and of all things
+that he saw.”</span> He has given us, in graphic
+language, such descriptions of the visions
+shown, that we can easily imagine the symbols
+which he saw; and we have the inspired
+explanations of those which were <span class="tei tei-q">“signified”</span>
+to him. Therefore we may read, and receive
+the blessings promised to those who keep this
+testimony of Jesus.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Benediction.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Happy is he, who readeth, and those, who hear the
+words of this prophecy, and keep the things, written in it:
+for the season is near.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 1:3.
+</span></div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page022">[pg 022]</span><a name="Pg022" id="Pg022" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those who teach that the Apocalypse is a
+<span class="tei tei-q">“sealed book,”</span> most clearly contradict the
+testimony of Christ respecting it. To discourage
+the study of it, is to treat with neglect,
+and to despise what God has spoken in these
+last days by his Son, Heb. 1:2; of whom it is
+said: <span class="tei tei-q">“See that ye refuse not him that speaketh;
+for if they escaped not who refused him
+who spake on earth, much more shall not we
+escape, if we turn away from him that speaketh
+from heaven,”</span> Heb. 12:25. Those who
+thus neglect it, cannot regard the blessing
+promised to those who read, hear, and keep
+its sayings.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Apocalypse is not to be undervalued as
+unprofitable; for <span class="tei tei-q">“all scripture is given by inspiration
+of God, and is profitable for doctrine,
+for reproof, for correction, for instruction in
+righteousness: that the man of God may be
+perfect, thoroughly furnished unto all good
+works,”</span> 2 Tim. 3:16, 17. <span class="tei tei-q">“For whatsoever
+things were written aforetime, were written
+for our learning, that we through patience and
+comfort of the scriptures might have hope,”</span>
+Rom. 15:4. <span class="tei tei-q">“Search the scriptures; for in
+them ye think ye have eternal life: and they
+are they which testify of me,”</span> John 5:39.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Thus saith the Lord, the Holy One of
+Israel, and his Maker, Ask me of things to
+come concerning my sons, and concerning the
+work of my hands command ye me,”</span> Isa. 45:11.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Behold, I come quickly: blessed is he
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page023">[pg 023]</span><a name="Pg023" id="Pg023" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+that keepeth the sayings of the prophecy of
+this book,”</span> Rev. 22:7.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">John's Salutation to the Churches.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">John to the seven congregations in Asia: grace be to
+you and peace, from Him who is, and who was, and who
+is to be; and from the seven Spirits, that are before his
+throne; and from Jesus Christ, the faithful Witness, and
+the First-born of the dead, and the Ruler of the kings of the
+earth. To him who loved us, and washed us from our sins
+in his own blood, and hath made us kings and priests to
+God even his father: to him be glory and dominion for ever
+and ever. Amen. Behold, he cometh with clouds; and
+every eye will see him, and those, who pierced him: and all
+the tribes of the earth will wail because of him. Yea, so
+be it! I am the Alpha and the Omega, saith the Lord God,
+who is, and who was, and who is to be, the Almighty.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+1:4-8.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The seven churches to which John sends
+salutation, were those of Ephesus, Smyrna,
+Pergamos, Thyatira, Sardis, Philadelphia, and
+Laodicea, 1:11. The Asia, in which they
+were situated, was a province in Asia Minor,
+distinct from Pontus, Gallatia, and Bithynia;
+which also were in Asia Minor, 1 Pet. 1:1,
+and Acts 2:9. Of the province of Asia,
+Ephesus was the capital, and was the principal
+place of John's residence. The seven
+cities which contained those churches, were
+situated in a kind of amphitheatre, surrounded
+by mountains. Smyrna was 46 miles north of
+Ephesus, and Pergamos 64 miles; Thyatira
+was 48 miles to the east, and Sardis 33 miles;
+Philadelphia 27 miles to the south, and Laodicea
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page024">[pg 024]</span><a name="Pg024" id="Pg024" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+42 miles. These churches had all been
+under the general supervision of John's ministry;
+and for this reason, doubtless, they are
+especially designated, instead of those with
+which he had not been so intimately connected.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+John writes to the seven churches, in obedience
+to the command,—<span class="tei tei-q">“What thou seest,
+write in a book, and send it unto the seven
+churches which are in Asia,”</span> 1:11. He
+seems to have written what he saw, at the
+time of its exhibition, and not at the close of
+the entire presentation; for when he was
+about to write the discordant utterances of
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the seven thunders,”</span> he was told to <span class="tei tei-q">“write
+them not,”</span> 10:4.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+John observes the oriental custom of placing
+his name at the commencement, instead
+of the close of his communication. Few persons
+now deny that this was John the Evangelist.
+Irenæus, who was born only about
+30 years after the death of John, speaks of
+the writer of the Apocalypse, as <span class="tei tei-q">“the disciple
+of Christ,—that same John that leaned on
+his breast at the last supper.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Most beautiful reference is here made to the
+attributes of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Deity</span></span>: <span class="tei tei-q">“Him who is, and who
+was, and who is to be,”</span> can be no other
+than the great Preëxistent, who said to Moses,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“I AM THAT I AM,”</span> Ex. 13:14.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The seven Spirits, would seem to be irrelevantly
+placed between the Father and the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page025">[pg 025]</span><a name="Pg025" id="Pg025" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Son,—the place always occupied by the
+Holy Spirit, when spoken of in connection
+with them,—if they were merely seven
+angels. Grace would also seem to be irreverently
+invoked from such,—its presence
+being implied where it is invoked,—unless
+they are expressive of the Holy Spirit, in
+which grace is inherent, and from whom it
+may be communicated; as it may not be from
+angels. Seven is a full and perfect number,
+and it may be here used because in another
+place <span class="tei tei-q">“seven lamps of fire burning before the
+throne”</span> are symbolic of <span class="tei tei-q">“the seven Spirits of
+God,”</span> (4:5); which, if angels, would be expressly
+named, as in other inspired explanations,—as
+they are in that of the stars, 1:20.
+A burning <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">flame</span></em> is often used as a symbol of
+the Holy Spirit. Thus, when God would
+make a covenant with Abraham, and the victims
+between which the covenanting parties
+were to pass, were divided, the presence of
+God was symbolized by <span class="tei tei-q">“a burning lamp
+that passed between those pieces,”</span> Gen. 15:17.
+And the descent of the Holy Spirit on the
+day of Pentecost, was manifested by <span class="tei tei-q">“cloven
+tongues, like as of fire,”</span> which <span class="tei tei-q">“sat upon
+each of them,”</span> Acts 2:3. In Zechariah 3:9,
+we read of the symbol of a stone laid before
+Joshua, that on it were engraved <span class="tei tei-q">“seven
+eyes,”</span> which <span class="tei tei-q">“are the eyes of the Lord which
+run to and fro, through the whole earth,”</span>
+(Zech. 4:10);—an expressive figure of
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page026">[pg 026]</span><a name="Pg026" id="Pg026" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+God's Omniscience. The same is symbolized in
+Rev. 5:6, by the <span class="tei tei-q">“seven eyes”</span> of the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Lamb</span></span>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Jesus Christ is the faithful Witness. He
+<span class="tei tei-q">“was faithful to him that appointed him,”</span>
+(Heb. 3:2); and he was given as a Witness
+to the people, a Leader and Commander to
+the people, Isa. 55:4. He is the <span class="tei tei-q">“first-begotten
+of the dead,”</span> having <span class="tei tei-q">“risen from the
+dead, and become the first fruits of them that
+slept,”</span> 1 Cor. 15:20: he is <span class="tei tei-q">“declared to be
+the Son of God, with power according to the
+spirit of holiness, by the resurrection from the
+dead,”</span> Rom. 1:4. He is <span class="tei tei-q">“the Prince of the
+kings of the earth,”</span> the <span class="tei tei-q">“King of kings and
+Lord of lords,”</span> 19:16; <span class="tei tei-q">“all kings shall fall
+down before him: all nations shall serve
+him,”</span> Psa. 72:11. He hath shown how he
+<span class="tei tei-q">“loved us,”</span> by giving himself for us, (Gal.
+2:20); and hath cleansed his people from all
+sin, not <span class="tei tei-q">“by the blood of goats and calves,
+but by his own blood, he entered in once into
+the holy place, having obtained eternal redemption
+for us,”</span> Heb. 9:12. He has redeemed
+us to God <span class="tei tei-q">“out of every kindred, and
+tongue, and people, and nation,”</span> Rev. 5:9.
+He is the one who is to come in the clouds of
+heaven, in resplendent majesty, to reward his
+saints, and to destroy those who destroy the
+earth, 11:18. The announcement that he
+<span class="tei tei-q">“cometh with clouds”</span> is as if John had said
+that what he was commanded to write, was a
+revelation of the events which were to precede
+and usher in that coming.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page027">[pg 027]</span><a name="Pg027" id="Pg027" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Christ's Annunciation.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">I John, your brother, and partner in the affliction, and
+kingdom and patience of Jesus Christ, was in the island
+called Patmos, for the word of God, and for the testimony
+of Jesus Christ. I was in the Spirit on the Lord's day,
+and heard behind me a great voice, like that of a trumpet,
+saying, What thou seest, write in a book, and send it to
+the seven congregations, to Ephesus, and to Smyrna, and
+to Pergamos, and to Thyatira, and to Sardis, and to Philadelphia,
+and to Laodicea.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 1:9-11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This gives a clue to the date of the Apocalypse.
+It was written when John was in the
+Isle of Patmos: <span class="tei tei-q">“It is the general testimony
+of ancient authors, that St. John was banished
+into Patmos in the time of Domitian, in the
+latter part of his reign, and restored by his
+successor, Nerva. But the book could not be
+published till after John's release, and return
+to Ephesus, in Asia. Domitian died in 96,
+and his persecution did not commence till near
+the close of his reign.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Dr. Clarke.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Domitian</span></span>, having exercised his cruelty
+against many, and unjustly slain no small
+number of noble and illustrious men at Rome, ...
+at length established himself as the successor
+of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Nero</span></span>, in his hatred and hostility to
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>. He was the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">second</span></em> that raised a persecution
+against us. In this persecution, it is
+handed down by tradition, that the apostle
+and evangelist, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">John</span></span>, ... was condemned to
+dwell on the island of Patmos. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Irenæus</span></span>, indeed,
+in his fifth book against the heresies,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page028">[pg 028]</span><a name="Pg028" id="Pg028" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+where he speaks of the calculation formed on
+the epithet of Antichrist, in the above-mentioned
+Revelation of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">John</span></span>, speaks in the following
+manner respecting him: <span class="tei tei-q">‘If, however,
+it were necessary to proclaim his name (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>
+Antichrist's), openly at the present time, it
+would have been declared by him who saw
+the Revelation, for it was not long since it
+was seen, but <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">almost in our own times</span></em>, at the
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">close</span></em> of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Domitian</span></span>'s
+reign.’</span> ”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Eusebius.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Prof. Stuart, who dissents from the opinion,
+admits that <span class="tei tei-q">“a majority of the older critics
+have been inclined to adopt the opinion of
+Irenæus, viz.: that it was written during the
+reign of Domitian, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, during the last part
+of the first century, or in A. D. 95 or 96.”</span>—Com.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Apoc.</span></span>, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">V. I.</span></span>, p. 263.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+John's adherence to the word and testimony
+of Christ, had caused his banishment—as
+others <span class="tei tei-q">“were slain—for the word of God,
+and for the testimony which they held,”</span> (6:9);
+and whose living again and reigning with
+Christ, was subsequently shown John in a
+vision, 20:4.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+John was in the spirit; <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, he was in a
+state of prophetic ecstasy, in which he was,
+as it were, caught away from a realization of
+the actual and the present, and shown <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+things which must be hereafter.”</span> It was on
+the <span class="tei tei-q">“Lord's day,”</span> the first day of the week,
+which was so called because on that day the
+Lord arose from the dead. It was a day
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page029">[pg 029]</span><a name="Pg029" id="Pg029" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+which has been observed by all Christians in
+especial remembrance of that event. John
+does not appear to have anticipated any such
+announcement, until he was suddenly startled
+from his meditation by a voice in trumpet
+tones, announcing itself by the titles of Christ,
+and commanding him to write to the churches
+what he <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">saw</span></em>. Hearing the voice, he turned
+to see who had spoken to him, and beheld a
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Vision of Christ.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I turned to see the voice, that spoke with me. And
+having turned, I saw seven golden lamp-stands; and in the
+midst of the seven lamp-stands one like a Son of man,
+clothed with a garment reaching the feet, and girded
+around the breasts with a golden girdle. His head, even
+his hair, was white like white wool, like snow; and his eyes
+were like a flame of fire; and his feet like fine brass,
+as if they burned in a furnace; and his voice like the sound
+of many waters. And he had in his right hand seven stars:
+and from his mouth went forth a sharp two-edged sword:
+and his countenance was like the sun shining in its strength.
+And when I saw him, I fell at his feet as if dead. And he
+laid his right hand on me, saying, Fear not; I am the first
+and the last, and am he, who liveth, and I became dead;
+and behold, I am alive for ever and ever, and have the keys
+of death and the pit. Therefore, write the things, which
+thou hast seen, and the things, which are, and the things,
+which will take place hereafter; the secret of the seven
+stars, which thou hast seen in my right hand, and the
+seven golden lamp-stands. The seven stars, are the messengers
+of the seven congregations: and the seven lamp-stands
+are the seven congregations.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 1:12-20.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The voice, by a metonymy, is used for the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page030">[pg 030]</span><a name="Pg030" id="Pg030" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+person speaking. He turned to see the glorious
+personage by whom the trumpet-tones
+were uttered. Being turned, he saw the commencement
+of those great panoramic presentations,
+by which the events of the future were
+revealed to him, and the significance of which
+were explained by an angelic interpreter.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“seven golden candlesticks,”</span> symbolize
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the seven churches”</span> (1:20), to which
+John was commanded to write. By this, and
+other symbols which are divinely interpreted,
+are unfolded the principles on which symbols
+are used. A candle or lamp stand, supports
+the light placed on it, as churches are the recipients
+and dispensers of the light of the Holy
+Scriptures. They are therefore appropriate
+symbols of churches.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In the midst of the candlesticks”</span> is one
+in the form of humanity, surrounded by the
+insignia of Deity. It is the same appearance
+that Ezekiel saw, when he had a vision <span class="tei tei-q">“of
+the likeness of the glory of the Lord,”</span> (Ezek.
+1:26-28); and before which Daniel fell
+trembling, Dan. 10:5-9. The sublime
+spectacle was too overwhelming for John's
+endurance, and, like Isaiah, Ezekiel, and
+Daniel, his strength turned to corruption.
+But the glorified Saviour was the same sympathetic
+being on whose breast John leaned,
+at the last supper, and he lays his endearing
+hand on John, and, by soothing words, restores
+his confidence. He explains the mystery
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page031">[pg 031]</span><a name="Pg031" id="Pg031" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+contained in the symbols shown, and
+enjoins on him to write the things he had seen—symbolic
+of the things which then were,
+and of those which were then in the future.
+As no created resemblance is a fit representative
+of Deity, Christ is shown to John by the
+symbol of his own likeness.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“seven stars”</span> in the right hand of
+the Saviour, are the angels,—the messengers,
+or pastors of the seven churches, 1:20. As
+the Saviour holds the stars in his hand, so
+does he sustain all his gospel ministers, enabling
+them to impart light to those who sit
+under their ministrations. And as he walked
+in the midst of the golden candlesticks, so the
+Lord is ever in the midst of those who fear
+him, and call upon his name.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Epistles to the Seven Churches.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Epistle to the Church in Ephesus.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">To the messenger of the congregation of Ephesus write:
+These things saith He who holdeth the seven stars in his
+right hand, who walketh in the midst of the seven golden
+lamp-stands: I know thy works, and thy toil, and thy patience,
+and that thou canst not endure the evil; and thou
+hast tried those, who say they are apostles, and are not;
+and hast found them liars; and hast patience, and hast endured
+on account of my name, and hast not fainted. Nevertheless,
+I have this against thee, that thou hast left thy first
+love. Remember therefore whence thou hast fallen, and repent
+and do the first works; or else I will come to thee quickly,
+and will remove thy lamp-stand out of its place, except
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page032">[pg 032]</span><a name="Pg032" id="Pg032" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+thou repentest. But thou hast this, that thou hatest the
+deeds of the Nicolaitanes, which I also hate. He, who hath
+an ear, let him hear what the Spirit saith to the congregations:
+To him, who overcometh, I will grant to eat of the tree
+of life, which is in the paradise of God.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 2:1-7.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The seven churches are not, themselves, seen
+in vision; they were symbolized by seven
+golden candlesticks. Consequently, these are
+seven literal churches that are addressed, and
+not allegorical, as some teach. The symbolic
+portions of the Apocalypse, are the descriptions
+of what John saw, and the attendant utterances.
+What was addressed to the ear by way
+of explanation and instruction, does not come
+under the laws of symbolization.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As churches, in all ages, are often in the
+several conditions ascribed to the seven
+churches, the warnings, admonitions, and consolations
+addressed to them, may serve for instruction
+to all Christians, as implied in the
+declaration: <span class="tei tei-q">“He that hath an ear, let him
+hear what the Spirit saith to the churches,”</span>
+2:29.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“By αγγελος, angel [or messenger], we are
+to understand the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">messenger</span></em>, or person sent by
+God to preside over the church; and to him
+the epistle is directed, not as pointing out his
+state, but the state of the church under his
+care. The Angel of the Church, here answers
+exactly to that officer of the synagogue among
+the Jews, called the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">messenger</span></em> of the church,
+whose business it was to <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">read</span></em>, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">pray</span></em>, and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">teach</span></em>
+in the synagogue.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Dr. Clarke.</span></span> Timothy is
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page033">[pg 033]</span><a name="Pg033" id="Pg033" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+supposed to have had the care of the Ephesian
+church till A. D. 97, when he was martyred.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Ephesus was a large, idolatrous city, <span class="tei tei-q">“a
+worshipper of the great goddess Diana, and
+of the image which,”</span> as they claimed, <span class="tei tei-q">“fell
+down from Jupiter,”</span> Acts 19:35. The gospel
+was first preached there by Paul, and with
+such success, that <span class="tei tei-q">“Many of them also which
+used curious arts, brought their books together,
+and burned them before all men; and they
+counted the price of them, and found it fifty
+thousand pieces of silver: So mightily grew the
+word of God, and prevailed,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 19, 20. They
+continued a fine and prosperous church, but had
+fallen away from their first love. Therefore He
+who walketh in the midst of the seven golden
+candlesticks, and holdeth in his hand the messengers
+of the churches, admonished them
+that, unless they repented he would remove
+their candlestick, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, their church, of which
+the candlestick was a symbol, out of its place.
+They did not repent; and, says Gibbon, <span class="tei tei-q">“In
+the year 1312, began the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">captivity</span></em>, or ruin of
+the seven churches by the Ottoman power.
+In the loss of Ephesus, the Christians deplored
+the loss of the first <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Angel</span></em>, the extinction of
+the first <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">candlestick</span></em> of the Revelations. The
+desolation is complete, and the temple of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Diana</span></em>,
+or the church of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Mary</span></em>, will equally elude the
+search of the curious traveller.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Nicolaitanes, whose deeds God hated,
+were a sect of heretics, who assumed the name
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page034">[pg 034]</span><a name="Pg034" id="Pg034" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+from Nicholas of Antioch, one of the first
+seven deacons of the church in Jerusalem.
+It is believed that he was rather the innocent
+occasion, than the author of the infamous
+practices of those who assumed his name,—who
+allowed a community of wives, and ate
+meats offered in sacrifice to idols. It was a
+short-lived sect.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+For hating their deeds, the church of Ephesus
+was commended, and also for not giving
+countenance to false teachers, who claimed to
+be apostles, and were proved to be liars.
+Thus are Christians to <span class="tei tei-q">“believe not every
+spirit, but try the spirits whether they are of
+God: because many false prophets are gone
+out into the world,”</span> 1 John 4:1. <span class="tei tei-q">“Such
+are false apostles, deceitful workers, transforming
+themselves into the apostles of
+Christ,”</span> 2 Cor. 11:13. <span class="tei tei-q">“There were false
+prophets also among the people, even as there
+shall be false teachers among you, who privily
+shall bring in damnable heresies,”</span> 2 Pet. 2:1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The promise to him that overcometh, that
+he shall <span class="tei tei-q">“eat of the tree of life,”</span> points to the
+resurrection and to the new creation. As in
+Eden was made to grow <span class="tei tei-q">“the tree of life”</span>
+(Gen. 2:9), so in Eden restored, <span class="tei tei-q">“they that
+do his commandments ... may have right to
+the tree of life, and may enter in through the
+gates into the city,”</span> Rev. 22:2.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page035">[pg 035]</span><a name="Pg035" id="Pg035" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Epistle to the Church in Smyrna.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And to the messenger of the congregation in Smyrna,
+write: These things saith the First and the Last, who became
+dead and is alive: I know thy works, and affliction,
+and poverty (but thou art rich); and I know the reviling
+of those, who say they are Jews, and are not, but are a synagogue
+of Satan. Fear none of the things, which thou wilt
+suffer. Behold, the devil will cast some of you into prison,
+that ye may be tried, and ye will have affliction ten days.
+Be thou faithful to death, and I will give thee the crown of
+life. He, who hath an ear, let him hear what the Spirit
+saith to the Congregations: he who overcometh, will not be
+hurt by the second death.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 2:8-11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The angel of the church in Smyrna is supposed
+to have been Polycarp, who, rather than
+to apostatize, was burnt alive in that city
+about A. D. 166. That church had passed
+through the trial of poverty, and was found
+<span class="tei tei-q">“rich toward God,”</span> Luke 12:21. It had suffered
+from the blasphemy of unbelieving Jews,
+who had a synagogue there and were particularly
+active at the martyrdom of Polycarp.
+But <span class="tei tei-q">“He is not a Jew, which is one outwardly;
+neither is that circumcision which is
+outward in the flesh: but he is a Jew which
+is one inwardly; and circumcision is that of
+the heart, in the spirit and not in the letter;
+whose praise is not of men, but of God,”</span> Rom.
+2:28, 29. And the crucified and risen Saviour
+has said, that they are <span class="tei tei-q">“of the synagogue
+of Satan which say they are Jews, and
+are not, but do lie,”</span> Rev. 3:9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Not a word of reproof is addressed to this
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page036">[pg 036]</span><a name="Pg036" id="Pg036" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+faithful flock; but they were to be still further
+tried, and a terrible persecution was foretold,
+which should continue ten prophetic
+days. Ten years was the duration of the last
+and bloodiest persecution under Diocletian,
+from A. D. 302 to 312, during which all the
+Asiatic churches were grievously afflicted.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This church passed triumphantly through
+all those trials; and Smyrna is now the most
+flourishing city of the Asiatic churches. It
+contains a population of 100,000, and is the
+seat of an archbishop. From 15,000 to
+20,000 of its inhabitants are still professedly
+Christian.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“crown of life,”</span> promised to those who
+are faithful unto death, is to be given at
+Christ's second coming, <span class="tei tei-q">“who shall judge the
+quick and the dead at his appearing and kingdom,”</span>
+2 Tim. 4:1: <span class="tei tei-q">“Henceforth there is
+laid up for me a crown of righteousness,
+which the Lord, the righteous Judge, shall
+give me at that day; and not to me only, but
+unto all them also that love his appearing,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 8. <span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed is the man that endureth
+temptation: for when he is tried he shall receive
+the crown of life, which the Lord hath
+promised to them that love him,”</span> Jam. 1:12.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those who shall not be hurt of the <span class="tei tei-q">“second
+death,”</span> are those who shall attain unto the
+resurrection of the just, at the commencement
+of the millennium. <span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed and holy is he
+that hath part in the first resurrection: on
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page037">[pg 037]</span><a name="Pg037" id="Pg037" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+such the second death hath no power; but
+they shall be priests of God and of Christ, and
+shall reign with him a thousand years,”</span> Rev.
+20:6. <span class="tei tei-q">“But the fearful, and unbelieving,
+and the abominable, and murderers, and
+whoremongers, and sorcerers, and idolaters,
+and all liars, shall have their part in the lake
+which burneth with fire and brimstone:
+which is the second death,”</span> 21:8.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Epistle to the Church in Pergamos.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em"><span style="font-size: 90%">
+And to the messenger of the congregation in Pergamos
+write: These things saith He who hath the sharp two-edged
+sword: I know thy works, and where thou dwellest, even
+where Satan's throne is; and thou holdest fast my name,
+and hast not denied my faith, even in those days in which
+Antipas was my faithful witness: who was slain among you,
+where Satan dwelleth. But I have a few things against
+thee, because thou hast there those, who hold fast the doctrine
+of Balaam, who taught Balak to cast an enticement
+to sin before the children of Israel: to eat idol-sacrifices,
+and to commit fornication. So thou hast also those, who
+hold fast the doctrine of the Nicolaitanes, in like manner.
+Repent; or else I will come to thee quickly, and will fight
+against them with the sword of my mouth. He, who hath
+an ear, let him hear what the Spirit saith to the congregations:
+To him, who overcometh, I will grant to eat of the
+hidden manna, and will give him a white stone, and on the
+stone a new name written, which no one knoweth, but he,
+who receiveth it.—Rev. 2:12-17.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“He which hath the sharp sword with
+two edges,”</span> is the one who walked in the
+midst of the seven golden lamp-stands—out
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page038">[pg 038]</span><a name="Pg038" id="Pg038" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of whose <span class="tei tei-q">“mouth went a sharp two-edged
+sword,”</span> 1:16. This identifies him as the
+one who was followed by the armies of heaven,
+when <span class="tei tei-q">“the remnant were slain with the sword
+of him that sat upon the horse: which sword
+proceeded out of his mouth,”</span> 19:21. <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+sword of the Spirit ... is the word of God,”</span>
+Eph. 6:17. <span class="tei tei-q">“He shall smite the earth with
+the rod of his mouth, and with the breath of
+his lips shall he slay the wicked,”</span> Isa. 11:4.
+The One who indites this epistle is thus designated,
+probably, because, unless they repented
+of the things alleged against them, he would
+fight against them with the sword of his
+mouth.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The church of Pergamos had refrained from
+apostasy, although situated in a wicked and
+corrupt city,—even where Satan reigned almost
+supreme and received the obedience of
+its inhabitants. They had been faithful in
+those days when Antipas, a faithful Christian,
+and probably the former pastor of the church,
+was slain (Dr. Hales thinks) in Domitian's
+persecution, in A. D. 94. Yet, the Lord had
+some things against them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The doctrine of Balaam is what that prophet
+counselled Balak to cast as a stumbling-block
+before Israel: For <span class="tei tei-q">“the people began to commit
+whoredom with the daughters of Moab.
+And they called the people unto the sacrifices
+of their gods; and the people did eat and
+bowed down to their gods. And Israel joined
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page039">[pg 039]</span><a name="Pg039" id="Pg039" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+himself unto Baal-peor,”</span> Num. 25:1-3.
+And Moses said of the women of Midian,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Behold, these caused the children of Israel,
+through the counsel of Balaam, to commit trespass
+against the Lord in the matter of Peor,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 31:16. This was also, probably, the same
+as the doctrine of the Nicolaitanes, p. <a href="#Pg034" class="tei tei-ref">34</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“hidden manna”</span> seems to be a reference
+to that hidden in the ark, where it was laid
+up before the Lord (Ex. 16:33), in memory
+of what was sent for the sustenance of Israel
+in the wilderness, where <span class="tei tei-q">“man did eat angel's
+food,”</span> Ps. 78:25. The law having a shadow
+of good things to come (Heb. 10:1), the manna
+hidden in the ark may be typical of the angelic
+sustenance to be revealed in the future
+world. The Saviour said, <span class="tei tei-q">“Verily, verily, I
+say unto you, He that believeth on me hath
+everlasting life. I am that bread of life.
+This is the bread which cometh down from
+heaven, that a man may eat thereof, and not
+die,”</span> John 6:47, 48, 50.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“white stone”</span> has received divers interpretations.
+In ancient trials, the votes of
+the judges were given by <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">white</span></em> and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">black</span></em> pebbles.
+The former signified acquittal, and the
+latter condemnation. Conquerors in public
+games sometimes received a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">white stone</span></em> with
+their name inscribed on it, which entitled
+them, during the remainder of their life, to be
+maintained at the public expense. Persons
+were sometimes invited to feasts or banquets,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page040">[pg 040]</span><a name="Pg040" id="Pg040" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+by the presentation of a white stone, with their
+name on it in connection with that of their
+hosts. The possession of the white stone evidently
+entitles the possessor to all the privileges
+of the heavenly inheritance.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“new name”</span> is unknown to all but
+its possessor; who, on its possession, becomes
+a child of God, and will receive, saith God,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“in my house and within my walls, a place
+and a name better than of sons and of daughters:
+I will give them an everlasting name
+that shall not be cut off,”</span> Isa. 56:5. The
+Saviour has promised that <span class="tei tei-q">“him that overcometh
+will I make a pillar in the temple
+of my God, and he shall go no more out: and
+I will write upon him the name of my God,
+and the name of the city of my God, which
+is new Jerusalem, which cometh down out of
+heaven from my God; and I will write upon
+him my new name,”</span> Rev. 3:12. And his
+new <span class="tei tei-q">“name”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“no man knew but he himself,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 19:12.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Pergamos still contains a few thousand inhabitants.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Epistle to the Church in Thyatira.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And to the messenger of the congregation in Thyatira
+write: These things saith the Son of God, who hath his eyes
+like a flame of fire, and his feet like fine brass: I know thy
+works, and love, and faith, and service, and thy patience,
+and thy works; and thy last works to be greater than the
+first. Notwithstanding, I have something against thee, because
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page041">[pg 041]</span><a name="Pg041" id="Pg041" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+thou allowest thy woman Jezebel, who calleth herself
+a prophetess, to teach and seduce my servants to commit
+fornication, and to eat idol sacrifices. And I gave her time
+to repent, and she would not repent of her fornication. Behold,
+I will cast her into a bed, and those, who commit adultery
+with her, into great affliction, unless they repent of
+their deeds. And I will kill her children with pestilence;
+and all the congregations will know that I am he, who
+searcheth the reins and hearts: and I will give to each of
+you according to your works. But to you I say, and to the
+rest in Thyatira, As many as have not this doctrine, and
+who have not known the depths of Satan, as (they say;) I
+will not put on you another burden: but what ye have,
+hold fast till I come. And he, who overcometh, and keepeth
+my works to the end, to him, I will give power over the
+nations: (and he will rule them with a rod of iron; like
+the vessels of a potter they will be dashed in pieces:) even
+as I received of my Father. And I will give him the morning-star.
+He, who hath an ear, let him hear what the
+Spirit saith to the congregations</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 2:18-29.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In commending the general piety of this
+church, they are censured for permitting a
+woman to teach false doctrines among them.
+The church is not only made responsible for
+what it teaches, but also for what it suffers
+others to teach. In this particular the church
+in Thyatira appears in contrast with the
+church in Ephesus. The doctrines which
+this wicked woman taught appear to be similar
+to those of the Nicolaitanes, p. <a href="#Pg034" class="tei tei-ref">34</a>. She is
+probably called Jezebel, from her being a
+woman of power and influence, like the wife
+of Ahab, who <span class="tei tei-q">“did sell himself to work wickedness
+in the sight of the Lord: whom Jezebel
+his wife stirred up,”</span> 1 Kings 21:25.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They who had not fallen into those depths
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page042">[pg 042]</span><a name="Pg042" id="Pg042" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of Satan, and should continue faithful to the
+end, were to have <span class="tei tei-q">“power over the nations.”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The saints of the Most High shall take the
+kingdom, and possess the kingdom for ever,
+even for ever and ever. And the kingdom
+and dominion, and the greatness of the kingdom
+under the whole heaven, shall be given
+to the people of the saints of the Most High,
+whose kingdom is an everlasting kingdom,
+and all dominions shall serve and obey him,”</span>
+Dan. 7:18, 27. <span class="tei tei-q">“Ask of me, and I shall give
+thee the heathen for thine inheritance, and the
+uttermost parts of the earth for thy possession.
+Thou shalt break them with a rod of
+iron; thou shalt dash them in pieces like a
+potter's vessel,”</span> Ps. 2:8, 9. <span class="tei tei-q">“To execute
+vengeance upon the heathen, and punishments
+upon the people; To execute upon them the
+judgment written: this honor have all the
+saints. Praise ye the Lord,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 149:7, 9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To receive the morning star, is to receive
+Christ, who testifieth of himself. <span class="tei tei-q">“I am ...
+the bright and morning star,”</span> Rev. 22:16.
+We are commanded to take heed to the <span class="tei tei-q">“sure
+word of prophecy ... as unto a light that
+shineth in a dark place, until the day dawn,
+and the day-star arise in your hearts,”</span> 2 Pet.
+1:19. As <span class="tei tei-q">“the testimony of Jesus is the
+spirit of prophecy”</span> (19:10), those who refuse
+to consider the revelation he has given of things
+which shortly after began to come to pass, and
+which must now be verging towards their
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page043">[pg 043]</span><a name="Pg043" id="Pg043" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+consummation, may fail of becoming illuminated
+by the day-star in their hearts.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Says Gibbon: <span class="tei tei-q">“The God of Mahomet,
+without a rival or a Son, is invoked in the
+mosques of Thyatira and Pergamos.”</span>
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Epistle to the Church in Sardis.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And to the messenger of the congregation in Sardis write:
+These things saith He, who hath the seven Spirits of God,
+and the seven stars: I know thy works, that thou hast a
+name that thou livest, and art dead. Be watchful, and
+strengthen the things, which remain, which are about to
+die: for I have not found thy works complete before God.
+Remember therefore how thou hast received and heard, and
+hold fast and repent. If therefore thou shalt not watch, I
+will come on thee like a thief, and thou wilt not know what
+hour I will come on thee. But thou hast a few names in
+Sardis, that have not defiled their garments; and they will
+walk with me in white: for they are worthy. He, who
+overcometh, the same one will be clothed in white raiment;
+and I will not blot out his name from the book of life, but I
+will acknowledge his name before my Father, and before
+his angels. He, who hath an ear, let him hear what the
+Spirit saith unto the congregations.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 3:1-6.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The church in Sardis was Christian in
+name, but was destitute of spiritual life, with
+the exception of a few names who had not
+defiled their garments. Having become dead
+to the revivifying influences of the Holy
+Spirit, they are reminded that he who addresses
+them is the one who holds their messenger
+in his hand, and who hath the seven
+Spirits of God; <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, that it was from the One
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page044">[pg 044]</span><a name="Pg044" id="Pg044" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+who said of <span class="tei tei-q">“the Comforter, which is the
+Holy Ghost”</span> (John 14:26), <span class="tei tei-q">“when the Comforter
+is come, whom I will send unto you
+from the Father, even the Spirit of truth which
+proceedeth from the Father, he shall testify
+of me,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 15:26.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They had doubtless become greatly conformed
+to the corrupt worldly influences by
+which they were surrounded, without having
+actually denied the faith, or embraced the
+hated doctrines of the Nicolaitanes. Therefore
+they were exhorted to hold fast all that
+they still retained, and, by repentance, to recover
+what they had lost; and they were
+admonished that if they neglected those precautions,
+they would be suddenly visited;
+without its being designated what would be
+the precise nature, time, or manner, of their
+visitation: which made the threatening the
+more terrible.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“few names”</span> which had not defiled
+their garments, were used by a metonymy to
+signify persons. When an apostle was to be
+chosen in the place of Judas, <span class="tei tei-q">“the number
+of the names together were about one hundred
+and twenty,”</span> Acts 1:15. Purity of raiment
+is significant of purity of character:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed is he that watcheth and keepeth
+his garments,”</span> 16:15. White is an emblem
+of purity. To the <span class="tei tei-q">“bride,”</span> it <span class="tei tei-q">“was granted
+that she should be arrayed in fine linen clean
+and white: for the fine linen is the righteousness
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page045">[pg 045]</span><a name="Pg045" id="Pg045" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of the saints,”</span> 19:8. Those who came
+out of great tribulation, had <span class="tei tei-q">“washed their
+robes and made them white in the blood of
+the Lamb,”</span> (7:13); and therefore they were
+symbolized as standing before the throne and
+before the Lamb, clothed with white robes,
+and palms of victory in their hands, 7:9.
+To be clothed in white raiment, is therefore to
+be accepted of the Saviour.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To blot one's name out of the book of life,
+is to erase his title to heaven. The figure
+seems to be an allusion to the ancient custom
+of enrolling in a book the names of all free
+citizens. If their names were confessedly
+written there, they were entitled to all the
+privileges and immunities of citizenship; but
+if blotted out, they had forfeited these. <span class="tei tei-q">“They
+that dwell on the earth shall wonder, whose
+names were not written in the book of life
+from the foundation of the world, when they
+behold the beast that was, and is not, and yet
+is,”</span> 17:8. Moses said, if God would not forgive
+Israel, <span class="tei tei-q">“blot me, I pray thee, out of thy
+book which thou hast written,”</span> Ex. 32:32. Of
+his enemies, David said, <span class="tei tei-q">“Let them be blotted
+out of the book of the living, and not be
+written with the righteous,”</span> Ps. 67:28.
+Those only enter the New Jerusalem, <span class="tei tei-q">“which
+are written in the Lamb's book of life,”</span> 21:27.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The church in Sardis, has long been utterly
+extinct; and what remains of the city is a
+miserable Turkish village.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page046">[pg 046]</span><a name="Pg046" id="Pg046" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Epistle to the Church in Philadelphia.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And to the messenger of the congregation in Philadelphia
+write: These things saith the Holy, the True One, he who
+hath the key of David, he who openeth, and no one shutteth;
+and shutteth, and no one openeth: I know thy works:
+behold, I have set before thee an open door, and no one can
+shut it; for thou hast a little strength, and hast held fast
+my word, and hast not denied my name. Behold, I will
+make those of the synagogue of Satan, who say they are
+Jews, and are not, but who lie; behold, I will make them
+come and bow down before thy feet, and know that I have
+loved thee. Because thou hast kept the word of my patience,
+I also will keep thee from the hour of trial, which
+will come on all the world, to try those, who dwell on the
+earth. I come quickly: hold fast that which thou hast,
+that no one take thy crown. I will make him, who overcometh,
+a pillar in the temple of my God, and he will go
+out no more: and I will write on him the name of my God,
+and the name of the city of my God, the new Jerusalem,
+(which cometh down out of heaven from my God:) and my
+new name. He, who hath an ear, let him hear what the
+Spirit saith to the congregations.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 3:7-13.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The church of Philadelphia had maintained
+her integrity, and is therefore addressed in the
+language of commendation, without the rebukes
+which were directed to her sister
+churches. Having remained true to Him
+who <span class="tei tei-q">“was called Faithful and True”</span> (19:11),
+the epistle to this church makes mention
+of the Saviour by those titles, which are significant
+of his own faithfulness and inherent
+holiness.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The key of David,”</span> brings to view the
+prediction of that which was to be laid <span class="tei tei-q">“upon
+his shoulder;”</span> so that <span class="tei tei-q">“he shall open, and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page047">[pg 047]</span><a name="Pg047" id="Pg047" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+none shall shut; and he shall shut, and none
+shall open,”</span> Isa. 22:22. A key symbolizes that
+which will open or unlock, or will close fast:
+therefore said the Saviour, <span class="tei tei-q">“I ... have the
+keys of hell and of death.”</span> By virtue of this
+power, an open door was set before the church
+of Philadelphia, which no man should be able
+to close.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Jews in Philadelphia, who had claimed
+to be the only true church of God, but who
+were in reality of the synagogue of Satan,
+were to cease their opposition to the Christians,
+and to seek instruction and protection
+from them—recognizing the love of God to
+Gentiles as well as to Jews. History is silent
+respecting the fulfilment of this; but there is
+no reason to suppose that it was not literally
+fulfilled.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“hour of temptation,”</span> which was to
+<span class="tei tei-q">“come upon all the world, to try them that
+dwell on the earth,”</span> was to be one of peculiar
+trial. Some suppose it had reference to the
+persecution under Trajan, which was more
+severe and extensive than those under Nero,
+or Domitian: and others that it was the Mohammedan
+delusion. In such times there are
+peculiar temptations to apostatize, and the less
+faithful are in more danger of apostasy than
+others. But because the Philadelphian church
+had been faithful thus far, they were to be kept
+from that trying hour. When the scourge
+of Mohammedanism swept over all the other
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page048">[pg 048]</span><a name="Pg048" id="Pg048" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+churches of Asia, this church maintained its
+integrity. Says Gibbon: <span class="tei tei-q">“Among the Greek
+colonies and churches of Asia, Philadelphia is
+still erect, a column in a scene of ruins. At a
+distance from the sea, forgotten by the emperors,
+encompassed on all sides by the Turks,
+her valiant citizens defended their religion and
+their freedom above fourscore years, and at
+length capitulated with the proudest of the
+Ottomans.”</span> Philadelphia is still the seat of
+an archbishop, and contains from six hundred
+to seven hundred Greek houses, and several
+places of Christian worship. <span class="tei tei-q">“The Lord
+knoweth how to deliver the godly out of
+temptations,”</span> 2 Pet. 2:9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They are encouraged to constancy by the
+prospect of the coming coronation day, when
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the Lord; the righteous Judge shall give”</span> a
+<span class="tei tei-q">“crown of righteousness,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“unto all them
+that love his appearing,”</span> 2 Tim. 4:8. He
+has said <span class="tei tei-q">“Be thou faithful unto death, and I
+will give thee a crown of life”</span> (2:10); and
+therefore <span class="tei tei-q">“when the chief Shepherd shall appear,
+ye shall receive a crown of glory that
+fadeth not away,”</span> 1 Pet. 5:4.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A pillar in the temple of God, is expressive
+of a position which shall give support to the
+church, which is erected <span class="tei tei-q">“upon the foundation
+of the apostles and prophets, Jesus Christ
+himself being the chief corner-stone; In whom
+the building, fitly framed together, groweth
+unto a holy temple in the Lord: In whom ye
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page049">[pg 049]</span><a name="Pg049" id="Pg049" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+also are builded together for a habitation of
+God through the Spirit,”</span> Eph. 2:20-22.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To receive the name of God, is to be recognized
+as belonging to God. As masters designated
+their servants by branding their name
+on them, or by some peculiar mark, so the
+children of God are referred to by the same
+figure. In a subsequent vision John saw with
+the Lamb on Mount Zion, <span class="tei tei-q">“an hundred and
+forty and four thousand, having his Father's
+name written in their foreheads,”</span> 14:1. Their
+connection with new Jerusalem is similarly
+designated.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Epistle to the Church in Laodicea.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And to the messenger of the congregation in Laodicea
+write: These things saith the Amen, the faithful and true
+Witness, the Ruler of the creation of God: I know thy
+works, that thou art neither cold nor hot: I would that
+thou wast cold or hot. So, because thou art lukewarm, and
+neither cold nor hot, I will cast thee out of my mouth: because
+thou sayest, I am rich, and have become wealthy,
+and have need of nothing; and knowest not that thou art
+wretched, and miserable, and poor, and blind, and naked:
+I counsel thee to buy of me gold tried by fire, that thou
+mayest be rich; and white raiment, that thou mayest be
+clothed, and that the shame of thy nakedness may not appear;
+and to anoint thine eyes with eye-salve, that thou
+mayest see. As many as I love, I rebuke and chastise: be
+fervent therefore, and repent. Behold, I stand at the door,
+and knock: if any one heareth my voice, and openeth the
+door, I will come in to him, and will sup with him, and he
+shall sup with me. To him, who overcometh I will grant
+to sit with me in my throne, even as I also overcame, and
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page050">[pg 050]</span><a name="Pg050" id="Pg050" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+have sat down with my Father in his throne. He, who hath
+an ear, let him hear what the Spirit saith to the congregations.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+3:14-22.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+By his titles of truth and verity, the Saviour
+prepares the Laodiceans for the humiliating
+threatenings, which are uttered against them.
+By that of <span class="tei tei-q">“the beginning of the creation of
+God,”</span> is indicated Christ's kingship as head
+and governor of all; and hence the authority
+on which his declarations are founded.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Laodiceans seemed to have been very
+well satisfied with their own condition, without
+possessing any very marked characteristics.
+They were neither good, nor very
+wicked; but supposed that they abounded in
+all spiritual wealth, when they were destitute
+of all the Christian graces. They could not
+appreciate their own condition; and not realizing
+their need, were unlikely to heed the
+counsel given them, and therefore they have
+long since ceased to have a name and a place
+on the earth. Says Gibbon: <span class="tei tei-q">“The circus
+and three stately temples of Laodicea, are
+now peopled with wolves and foxes.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The great majority of them seemed to have
+become unworthy even of the chastisement
+which God bestows on those he loves. <span class="tei tei-q">“Behold,
+happy is the man whom God correcteth;
+therefore despise not the chastening of the Almighty,”</span>
+Job 5:17. <span class="tei tei-q">“My son, despise not
+the chastening of the Lord: neither be weary
+of his correction: For whom the Lord loveth
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page051">[pg 051]</span><a name="Pg051" id="Pg051" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+he correcteth, even as a father the son in
+whom he delighteth,”</span> Prov. 3:11, 12.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed is the man that endureth temptation:
+for when he is tried, he shall receive
+the crown of life, which the Lord hath promised
+to them that love him,”</span> Jas. 1:12.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Saviour shows his readiness to receive
+those who will open unto him. He is saying,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Open to me ... for my head is filled with
+dew, and my locks with the drops of the
+night,”</span> Cant. 5:2. <span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed are those servants,
+whom the Lord, when he cometh, shall
+find watching: verily I say unto you, That
+he shall gird himself, and make them to sit
+down to meat, and will come forth and serve
+them,”</span> Luke 12:37. Said Jesus, <span class="tei tei-q">“If any
+man love me, he will keep my words: and
+my Father will love him, and we will come
+unto him, and make our abode with him,”</span>
+John 14:23.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To him that overcometh, as in another
+place he is promised a crown, so now there is
+the promise of a seat with the Saviour in his
+throne. Said the Saviour, <span class="tei tei-q">“Ye which have
+followed me, in the regeneration when the Son
+of man shall sit in the throne of his glory, ye
+also shall sit upon twelve thrones, judging the
+twelve tribes of Israel,”</span> Matt. 19:28. <span class="tei tei-q">“And
+I appoint unto you a kingdom, as my Father
+hath appointed unto me,”</span> Luke 22:29. <span class="tei tei-q">“If
+we suffer”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> with Christ, <span class="tei tei-q">“we shall also
+reign with him,”</span> 2 Tim. 2:12.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page052">[pg 052]</span><a name="Pg052" id="Pg052" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Vision of the Deity.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">After this, I looked, and behold, a door opened in heaven:
+and the first voice, which I heard, was like a trumpet talking
+with me; saying, Ascend here, and I will show thee
+things, which must take place hereafter. And immediately
+I was in the Spirit: and behold, a throne was set in heaven,
+and One sat on the throne. And, He, who sat, was in appearance
+like a jasper and a cornelian stone: and there was
+a rainbow around the throne, in appearance, like an emerald.
+And around the throne were twenty-four thrones;
+and on the thrones I saw twenty-four elders sitting, clothed
+in white raiment; and crowns of gold on their heads. And
+from the throne came forth lightnings, and voices and thunders.
+And seven lamps of fire were burning before the
+throne, which are the seven Spirits of God. And before the
+throne there was a transparent sea like crystal: and in the
+midst of the throne, and around the throne, were four living
+beings, full of eyes before and behind. And the first
+living being was like a lion, and the second living being
+like a calf, and the third living being had a face like a man,
+and the fourth living being was like a flying eagle. And
+each of the four living beings had six wings around him;
+and within they were full of eyes: and they rest not day or
+night, saying, Holy, holy, holy, Lord God Almighty, who
+was, and is, and is to be! And when the living beings give
+glory, and honor, and thanks to Him seated on the throne,
+who liveth for ever and ever, the four and twenty elders fall
+down before Him seated on the throne, and worship Him,
+who liveth for ever and ever, and cast their crowns before
+the throne, saying, Worthy art thou, O Lord, our God, to
+receive glory, and honor, and power: for thou hast created
+all things, and for thy pleasure they existed and were created.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+4:1-11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This vision is preparatory to the revelations
+of <span class="tei tei-q">“things which must be hereafter,”</span> which
+were given John in the series of visions following.
+Their divine origin, and, consequently,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page053">[pg 053]</span><a name="Pg053" id="Pg053" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the deference with which they are to
+be received as a revelation from God, are demonstrated
+by this symbolization of the presence
+chamber of the Almighty.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The revelator had before heard a voice
+speaking to him, (1:10); and turning to look,
+he beheld the risen Saviour. He then writes
+the epistles which the Saviour dictated to the
+churches; and again he turns his eyes to the
+place where the voice spake to him.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The opening of a door in heaven, appears
+to be no part of the <span class="tei tei-q">“things which must be
+hereafter;”</span> and is, therefore, no symbol. It
+was doubtless an appearance of an aperture
+in the sky above, through which the revelator
+saw the vision. It indicates that he looked
+through and beyond the limits prescribed to
+human vision; and the summons to <span class="tei tei-q">“come
+up hither,”</span> indicates that he was to have free
+access to the secrets there to be unfolded.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A <span class="tei tei-q">“throne set in heaven,”</span> is a symbol of
+sovereignty there. Consequently the one who
+sits thereon is the Almighty—his greatness,
+glory and majesty, being indicated by the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“lightnings, thunderings and voices,”</span> the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“rainbow round about the throne,”</span> and the
+resemblance to brilliant gems. It is the same
+Being, seen in vision by Ezekiel (1:28), round
+about whom was <span class="tei tei-q">“as the appearance of the
+bow in the day of rain;”</span> and who was explained
+to be <span class="tei tei-q">“the appearance of the likeness
+of the glory of the Lord.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page054">[pg 054]</span><a name="Pg054" id="Pg054" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“elders”</span> seated about the throne, and
+the <span class="tei tei-q">“four living creatures,”</span> improperly rendered
+beasts, are representatives of the redeemed
+of our race; for they subsequently
+unite in the new song, saying to Christ,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Thou wast slain, and hast redeemed us to
+God by thy blood, out of every kindred and
+tongue, and people and nation; and hast
+made us unto our God kings and priests, and
+we shall reign on the earth,”</span> 5:8-10. The
+difference between the two orders, is not fully
+apparent. They have <span class="tei tei-q">“vials full of odors,
+which are the prayers of saints.”</span> The four
+beasts are evidently of the same order as the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“living creatures”</span> in Ezek. 1:5; the cherubim
+of Ezek. 10:20, and the seraphim of
+Isa. 6:1. The entire hosts of the redeemed
+are thus represented as interested spectators
+in the visions which are to be unfolded.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“seven lamps of fire,”</span> are explained
+to be <span class="tei tei-q">“the seven Spirits of God,”</span> which, as
+before shown, is expressive of the Holy Spirit.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“sea of glass,”</span> corresponds to the
+brazen sea, or laver, under the law, which
+stood at the door of the tabernacle, Ex. 38:8.
+It was an emblem of purity. Before entering
+the tabernacle the priest must there
+wash. Those admitted on the sea of glass,
+are those who are purified and made white in
+the blood of the Lamb, 15:2.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With this preliminary representation, the
+first series of events extending to the final
+consummation, is shown under the symbol of:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page055">[pg 055]</span><a name="Pg055" id="Pg055" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Sealed Book.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw in the right hand of Him seated on the
+throne, a book written within and without, sealed with seven
+seals. And I saw a mighty angel proclaiming with a loud
+voice, Who is worthy to open the book, and to loose its seals?
+and no one in heaven, or on the earth, or under the earth,
+was able to open the book nor to look in it. And I was
+weeping much, because no one was found worthy to open,
+and to read the book, nor to look in it. And one of the
+elders saith to me, Weep not: behold, the Lion of the tribe
+of Judah, the Root of David, hath prevailed to open the
+book, and to loose its seven seals. And I saw in the midst
+of the throne, and of the four living beings, and in the
+midst of the elders, the Lamb standing, as having been slain,
+having seven horns, and seven eyes, which are the seven
+Spirits of God sent forth into all the earth. And he came
+and took the book out of the right hand of Him seated on the
+throne. And when he took the book, the living beings, and
+twenty-four elders fell down before the Lamb, all of them
+having harps, and golden bowls full of incense, which are
+the prayers of saints. And they sung a new song, saying,
+Worthy art thou to take the book and to open its seals: for
+thou wast slain, and hast redeemed us to God by thy blood
+out of every tribe, and tongue, and people, and nation; and
+hast made us kings and priests to our God, and we shall
+reign on the earth! And I beheld, and I heard the voice
+of many angels around the throne, and the living beings,
+and the elders: and the number of them was ten thousand
+times ten thousand, and thousands of thousands; saying
+with a loud voice, Worthy is the Lamb, that was slain, to
+receive power, and riches, and wisdom, and strength, and
+honor, and glory, and blessing. And every creature which
+is in heaven, and on the earth, and under the earth, and
+those on the sea, even all that are in them, I heard saying,
+Blessing, and honor, and glory, and power, be to Him sitting
+on the throne, and to the Lamb, for ever and ever!
+And the four living beings said, Amen. And the elders
+fell down and worshipped.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 5:1-14.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The written book, must symbolize God's purposes,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page056">[pg 056]</span><a name="Pg056" id="Pg056" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+which were about to be unfolded on
+the loosening of the seals. Its being written
+within and without, indicates the fulness of
+its contents, the completeness of the record:—God's
+purposes being fully and unalterably
+formed. In like manner Ezekiel was shown
+<span class="tei tei-q">“a roll of a book ... written within and without,”</span>
+symbolizing the <span class="tei tei-q">“lamentations, mourning
+and woe”</span> (Ezek. 2:9), which were soon
+to overtake Israel.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A sealed book is one whose contents are
+hidden: <span class="tei tei-q">“The vision of all is become unto
+you as the words of a book that is sealed,
+which men deliver to one that is learned,
+saying, Read this I pray thee: and he saith,
+I cannot; for it is sealed,”</span> Isa. 29:11. God
+said to Daniel, <span class="tei tei-q">“Shut up the words, and seal
+the book, till the time of the end,”</span> Dan. 12:4.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To open the seals, no one was found worthy.
+There was no being in heaven among the
+angels, no human being on the earth, and no
+disembodied spirit, or demon, under the earth,
+who was able to unfold the future. The
+tears of the revelator are, however, dried, and
+his drooping spirits cheered, by the announcement
+of one of the elders, that <span class="tei tei-q">“the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Lion</span></span> of
+the tribe of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Judah</span></span>, the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Root</span></span>
+of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">David</span></span>, hath
+prevailed to open the book,”</span> and to unfold its
+mysteries. He stood in the midst of the
+assembled intelligences,—his human nature
+and sacrificial office, being designated by his
+metaphorical title of the <span class="tei tei-q">“Lamb:”</span>—John
+seeing Jesus coming to him said, <span class="tei tei-q">“Behold the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page057">[pg 057]</span><a name="Pg057" id="Pg057" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Lamb of God, which taketh away the sin of
+the world,”</span> John 1:29. His sovereignty is
+shown by the <span class="tei tei-q">“seven horns,”</span> the symbols of
+power; and his relation to the Godhead, by
+the seven eyes, the seven Spirits of God;—expressive
+of the Holy Spirit. See p. <a href="#Pg025" class="tei tei-ref">25</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The rejoicings on the announcement of
+Christ's ability to take the book, and to open
+the seals, indicate the greatness of the blessing
+which God gives the church, when he
+thus reveals a knowledge of the future.
+All creatures should join in these hosannas,
+and praise the Lord for his great condescension,
+in showing his servants the things
+which must shortly come to pass. To neglect
+this revelation, is not joining in the ascription
+of praise.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The golden vials, full of odors, symbolize
+the prayers of saints. Under the Mosaic dispensation,
+the frankincense and odors offered at
+the tabernacle were emblematic of prayer and
+praise to God. <span class="tei tei-q">“Let my prayer be set forth
+before thee as <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">incense</span></em>; and the lifting up of
+my hands as the evening sacrifice,”</span> Psa.
+141:2.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Christ takes the book from the hand of him
+who sits on the throne, and opens the seals.
+Thus he makes known unto his servants the
+revelation which God had given him, 1:1.
+As each successive seal is opened, successive
+portions of the writing in the book become
+accessible,—an <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">epoch</span></span> is marked, following
+which, and previous to that symbolized by the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page058">[pg 058]</span><a name="Pg058" id="Pg058" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+opening of the next seal, are to be fulfilled,
+the events symbolized under it.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The First Seal.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw when the Lamb opened one of the seven
+seals, and I heard one of the four living beings, saying,
+with a voice like thunder, Come! And I saw, and behold, a
+white horse: and he, who sat on him, had a bow; and a
+crown was given him: and he went forth conquering and
+to conquer.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 6:1, 2.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The voice is evidently addressed to the personage
+on the white horse, or to the agencies
+thus symbolized. It is the signal for their
+appearance on the stage of action.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The symbol is that of a victorious warrior,
+armed with weapons of conquest,—success
+being indicated by the crown given him. As
+there is no analogous order, except in the religious
+world, Mr. Lord very properly regards
+it as a symbol of the body of religious teachers,
+those faithful soldiers of the cross, who,
+from the middle of the first to the middle of
+the third century, as <span class="tei tei-q">“soldiers of Jesus
+Christ”</span> (2 Tim. 2:3), went forth to war
+<span class="tei tei-q">“against principalities and powers, against
+the rulers of the darkness of this world,
+against spiritual wickedness in high places,”</span>
+Eph. 6:12. The apostle, when they received
+their commission, said to them, <span class="tei tei-q">“Take
+unto you the whole armor of God, that ye
+may be able to withstand in the evil day, and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page059">[pg 059]</span><a name="Pg059" id="Pg059" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+having done all, to stand. Stand, therefore,
+having your loins girt about with truth, and
+having on the breast-plate of righteousness;
+and your feet shod with the preparation of the
+gospel of peace; above all, taking the shield
+of faith, wherewith ye shall be able to quench
+all the fiery darts of the wicked. And take
+the helmet of salvation, and the sword of the
+Spirit, which is the word of God,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 13-17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Thus equipped, they went forth, conquering
+and to conquer. They assailed the strong-holds
+of sin and Satan, and planted the standard of
+the cross in all portions of the then civilized
+world. And at the end of their warfare thousands
+of them could say with the apostle: <span class="tei tei-q">“I
+have fought a good fight, I have finished my
+course, I have kept the faith: henceforth there
+is laid up for me a crown of righteousness,
+which the Lord, the righteous Judge, shall
+give me at that day: and not to me only, but
+unto all them also that love his appearing,”</span>
+2 Tim. 4:7, 8.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The period symbolized under this seal, was
+distinguished for purity of faith in the church,
+and devotion to the cause of Christ,—indicated
+by the whiteness of the horse that the
+warrior rides.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Second Seal.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And when he opened the second seal, I heard the
+second living being say, Come! And there went out another
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page060">[pg 060]</span><a name="Pg060" id="Pg060" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+horse that was red: and power was given to him,
+who sat on him, to take peace from the earth, and that they
+should kill each other: and a great sword was given to
+him.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 6:3, 4.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This symbol, like the former, is that of a
+mounted warrior, and must also symbolize a
+body of religious teachers. The color of the
+horse, indicates that the doctrine and character
+of the body symbolized will have lost the
+original purity of the church, and become
+more sanguinary; which is also indicated by
+the great sword given him.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The warfare under this seal is not against
+outside enemies; for they kill each other.
+This, then, indicates an era when the church
+shall be disquieted, and her peace interrupted
+by internal dissensions. Such was its history
+during the third, fourth, and fifth centuries.
+This period was distinguished for the contentions
+of the clergy; their usurpation of
+power not conferred by the apostles; their
+divisions and sub-divisions into parties; their
+opposing councils; their collisions and distractions;
+their love of power; their pride,
+discord, strife, and tyranny; their mutual
+anathemas and excommunications; the envy,
+jealousy, and detraction they indulged in, and
+the other hateful passions which they exercised.
+Thus they marred the peace of the
+church; and by causing many to apostatize,
+killed each other with spiritual death.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page061">[pg 061]</span><a name="Pg061" id="Pg061" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Third Seal.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And when he opened the third seal I heard the third
+living being say, Come! And I beheld, and lo, a black
+horse; and he, who sat on him, had a balance in his hand.
+And I heard a voice in the midst of the four living beings say,
+A measure of wheat for a penny, and three measures of barley
+for a penny; and injure thou not the oil and the wine.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+6:5, 6.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This foreshadows a period of great scarcity
+and cruel exactions. Applying it to the only
+department of society which is analogous to
+civil life, and the famine symbolized, is like
+that predicted by Amos: <span class="tei tei-q">“Behold, the days
+come, saith the Lord God, that I will send a
+famine into the land, not a famine of bread,
+nor a thirst for water, but of hearing the
+words of the Lord: and they shall wander
+from sea to sea, and from the north even to
+the east; they shall run to and fro to seek the
+word of the Lord, and shall not find it,”</span>
+Amos 8:11, 12.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This, then, marks a period when the traditions
+and opinions of men are substituted for
+the word of God. With Origen was introduced
+a new mode of interpreting scripture,
+which afterwards became prevalent. The
+scriptures, instead of being received in their
+natural and obvious sense, were regarded as
+mystical and allegorical. Milner, in his
+Church History, says: <span class="tei tei-q">“From the fanciful
+mode of allegory, introduced by him, and uncontrolled
+by scriptural rule and order, there
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page062">[pg 062]</span><a name="Pg062" id="Pg062" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+arose a vitiated method of commenting on the
+sacred pages.”</span> And Mosheim says: <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+few who explained the sacred writings with
+judgment and a true spirit of criticism, could
+not oppose, with any success, the torrent of
+allegory that was overflowing the church.”</span>
+Following this example, Luther says, <span class="tei tei-q">“men
+make just what they please of the Scriptures,
+until some accommodate the word of God
+to the most extravagant absurdities.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Substituting the conceptions of their own
+fancy for the word of God, they withheld
+from the people the bread of life, and produced
+a famine for the word of the Lord. Crude
+notions took the place of Bible doctrines; and
+pernicious speculations were substituted for
+the teachings of Christ and his apostles. Baptism
+and the Lord's supper, lost their emblematic
+significance, and were regarded as
+saving ordinances. Heaven was sought to be
+merited by works, and sanctification was supposed
+to be gained by penance and mortification
+of the flesh. In short, all the corruptions
+of the apostasy were substituted for the primitive
+faith, and the Bible became a sealed book
+to the great mass of the people.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Fourth Seal.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And when he opened the fourth seal, I heard the voice
+of the fourth living being saying, Come! And I looked,
+and behold, a pale horse: and his name, who sat on him,
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page063">[pg 063]</span><a name="Pg063" id="Pg063" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+was Death, and the pit followed with him. And power was
+given to them over the fourth part of the earth, to kill with
+sword, and with famine, and with pestilence, and with the
+wild beasts of the earth.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 6:7, 8.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Christian church alone being analogous
+to the civil power, it is within its pale
+that the fulfilment of this symbol is to be
+looked for. During this period, violence is
+substituted for famine; and men are compelled
+to apostatize, which results in spiritual death.
+The Papacy having the power to enforce her
+decrees, Christians had to embrace her faith,
+or be handed over to the secular power for
+punishment. They produced death by compelling
+men to apostatize, by withholding
+from them the word of life, by infusing into
+their minds pestiferous doctrines, and by the
+fear of the civil power,—symbolized by the
+sword, famine, pestilence, and beasts of the
+earth.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Fifth Seal.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And when he opened the fifth seal, I saw under the
+altar the souls of those slain on account of the word of God,
+and on account of the testimony, which they held: and they
+cried with a loud voice, saying, How long, O Lord, holy and
+true, dost thou not judge and avenge our blood on those,
+who dwell on the earth? And a white robe was given to
+each of them; and it was said to them, that they should
+rest yet for a short time, until their fellow-servants also and
+their brethren, that were to be slain as they were, should
+be filled up.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 6:9-11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This symbolized a period intervening between
+the time of the martyrdom, of those
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page064">[pg 064]</span><a name="Pg064" id="Pg064" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+whose souls are seen in vision, and another
+time of persecution to follow. Consequently,
+the symbol represents the disembodied spirits
+of those who had already been slain. They
+symbolize the souls of martyrs who counted
+not their lives dear unto themselves for the
+sake of Christ; and being faithful unto death,
+were in expectation of a crown of life. Says
+Mr. Lord: <span class="tei tei-q">“The term τα πτωματα is used in
+the prophecy to denote the dead bodies of the
+martyrs (chap. 11:9), and αι ψυψαι (20:4)
+to denote their disembodied spirits. They are
+represented as having been slain, and as uttering
+their appeal to God because of their blood
+having been shed.”</span> Also: <span class="tei tei-q">“The martyr
+souls are exhibited in their own persons;
+and obviously because no others could serve
+as their symbol,—there being no others that
+have undergone a change from a bodied to a
+disembodied life, nor that sustain such relations
+to God, of forgiveness, acceptance, and
+assurance of a resurrection from death, and a
+priesthood with Christ during his victorious
+reign on the earth,”</span> Ex. Apoc. p. 155.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The altar, symbolizes the atonement made
+by Christ for sin; and, consequently, the position
+of the souls of the martyrs under it,
+indicates their reliance on him for an inheritance
+in his everlasting kingdom,—when <span class="tei tei-q">“he
+shall come to be glorified in his saints,”</span> and
+to <span class="tei tei-q">“take vengeance on them that know not
+God, and obey not the gospel,”</span> 2 Thess. 1:8,
+10.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page065">[pg 065]</span><a name="Pg065" id="Pg065" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The presentation of white robes to them,
+symbolizes their acceptance and justification.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The declaration that they must rest till <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">their
+fellow-servants are killed</span></em>, as they have been,
+implies another persecution, to be subsequent
+to the period symbolized by the opening of
+this seal. The persecutions which followed
+the Reformation, in which the fires of Smithfield
+were lighted in England, the Huguenots
+were driven from France, and thousands suffered
+martyrdom, probably fulfilled this.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The interest taken by the souls of the martyrs
+in the avenging of their blood on the
+earth, shows that the spirits of departed saints
+look forward with intense interest to the time
+of their glorification. And although the dead
+who die in the Lord are blessed, the glories of
+the resurrection morn are not less desired by
+those who are absent from the body and present
+with the Lord, than by humble, devoted,
+waiting Christians here.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The opening of this seal evidently synchronizes
+with the commencement of the reformation,
+when they might have supposed the
+kingdom of God would immediately appear.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Sixth Seal.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I beheld when he opened the sixth seal, and there
+was a great earthquake; and the sun became black like
+sackcloth of hair, and the moon became like blood: and the
+stars of heaven fell to the earth, as a fig-tree casteth its unripe
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page066">[pg 066]</span><a name="Pg066" id="Pg066" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+figs, when shaken by a mighty wind. And the heaven
+departed like a scroll rolled together; and every mountain
+and island were removed from their places. And the kings
+of the earth, and the nobles, and the rich, and the commanders,
+and the strong men, and every bond-man, and every
+freeman, hid themselves in the dens and in the rocks of the
+mountains; and said to the mountains and rocks, Fall on
+us, and hide us from the face of Him seated on the throne,
+and from the wrath of the Lamb: for the great day of his
+wrath is come; and who can stand?</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 6:12-17.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The laws of symbolization require that
+symbols should not be representatives of their
+own order when there is any analogous order
+to be representatives of. In other places in
+the Apocalypse, these symbols are used, under
+circumstances where it is impossible to
+regard them as symbols of their own order.
+And here, as the kings of the earth call on
+the rocks and mountains to fall on them
+after the heaven has departed as a scroll and
+every mountain and island is moved out of
+its place, it is necessary to regard them as
+symbols of objects of analogous orders.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The earthquake, then, as in corresponding
+Scriptures, symbolizes a political revolution.
+The darkening of the sun and moon, would
+represent a change in the character of the
+rulers and legislators of the world, so that instead
+of extending a genial influence over their
+subjects, they should exert a deleterious one;
+and the fall of the stars, their ejection from
+their stations—synchronizing with the first
+five vials (16:1-11), and fulfilled in the political
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page067">[pg 067]</span><a name="Pg067" id="Pg067" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+revolutions of Europe during the past
+century.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+By the passing away of the heavens and
+the removal of mountains and islands from
+their places, is symbolized the total dissolution
+of all human governments—corresponding
+to the seventh vial (16:20).
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+On the occurrence of this unprecedented
+state of anarchy, the inhabitants of earth will
+be aware of the proximity of the Advent.
+They flee from the face of the Lamb, which
+indicates his appearance in the clouds of
+heaven at his personal advent. The great day
+of wrath will have come; but before the infliction
+of merited punishment on his enemies,
+the servants of God are to be designated, the
+righteous dead are to be raised, and they with
+the righteous living are to be caught up to
+meet the Lord in the air, 1 Thess. 4:17. The
+living righteous are designated by:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Sealing of the Servants of God.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And after these things I saw four angels standing on the
+four corners of the earth, holding fast the four winds of the
+earth, that a wind might not blow on the earth, nor on the
+sea, nor on any tree. And I saw another angel ascending
+from the rising of the sun, having a seal of the living God:
+and he cried with a loud voice to the four angels, to whom
+it was given to injure the earth and the sea, saying, Injure
+not the earth, nor the sea, nor the trees, till we have sealed
+the servants of our God on their foreheads! And I heard
+the number of those sealed: a hundred and forty-four thousand
+were sealed out of all the tribes of the children of Israel.
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page068">[pg 068]</span><a name="Pg068" id="Pg068" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+Of the tribe of Judah, twelve thousand were sealed.
+Of the tribe of Reuben twelve thousand were sealed. Of
+the tribe of Gad twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe
+of Asher twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of
+Naphtali, twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of
+Manasseh twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of
+Simeon twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of Levi
+twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of Issachar
+twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of Zebulon
+twelve thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of Joseph twelve
+thousand were sealed. Of the tribe of Benjamin twelve
+thousand were sealed.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 7:1-8.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The symbols here presented, were seen immediately
+subsequent to the exhibition of the
+preceding ones. This alone would not prove
+that the events symbolized follow in order, but
+it is indicated by their being a continuation
+of the symbolization under the sixth seal, and
+before the opening of the seventh.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In the sixth chapter, the great men and rich
+men, as well as bond-men, are aware of the
+proximity of the day of the Lord, and seek
+for a refuge from the face of the Lamb. The
+next events in consecutive order, would be the
+resurrection of the righteous dead, the change
+of the living, their ascension to meet the Lord
+in the air, and the infliction of the wrath of
+God on the wicked.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+After the wicked seek to escape from God's
+presence, the righteous are still unchanged
+upon the earth. But before the wrath of God
+is poured upon his enemies, the winds of
+heaven are to be holden while the angel of
+the living God seals his servants in their foreheads.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page069">[pg 069]</span><a name="Pg069" id="Pg069" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+The holding of the winds and the
+sealing are, consequently, subsequent to the
+terror of the wicked, at the appearance of the
+Saviour.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The four winds are the winds coming from
+all directions; and symbolize strife, war, and
+commotion among men, analogous to the violent
+action of the winds of heaven.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In Dan. 7:2, the striving of the four winds
+upon the great sea preceded the rising of the
+four beasts: in other words, the various contests
+and strifes among the different people
+and tongues of earth resulted in the establishment
+of the successive empires which have
+arisen to universal dominion. The blowing
+of the wind seems to be any influence exerted
+upon men. In Ezek. 37:9 the breathing of
+the wind revives the dead; and in Zech. 5:9
+it symbolizes the removal of the wickedness
+of the Jews.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The angels holding the winds, consequently,
+must symbolize the agencies which have the
+power to excite or quell these disturbing influences.
+They do the bidding of the Lord in
+restraining or exerting the influences which
+should produce the effect symbolized. The
+holding of them indicates the proximity and
+certainty of their blowing unless they are
+restrained. The earth, sea, and trees, which
+would be hurt by the blowing of the wind,
+evidently symbolize the different classes of
+inhabitants of the earth, on whom an effect
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page070">[pg 070]</span><a name="Pg070" id="Pg070" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+would be produced by the blowing of the
+winds, analogous to the effect produced on
+those elements by a violent tempest, or hurricane.
+The storm here symbolized is evidently
+that of which the Scriptures speak.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“On the wicked he shall rain snares, fire
+and brimstone, and an horrible tempest,”</span> Psa.
+11:6. <span class="tei tei-q">“Thou shalt be visited of the Lord
+of hosts with thunder, and with earthquake,
+and great noise, with storm and tempest, and
+the flame of devouring fire,”</span> Isa. 29:6. <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+Lord hath a mighty and strong one, which
+as a tempest of hail, and a destroying storm,
+as flood of waters overflowing, shall cast
+down to the earth with the hand,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 28:2.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sealing of the servants of God in their
+foreheads, designates them, but does not constitute
+them such; for none are sealed, only
+those who are previously his. This is in allusion
+to the ancient custom of stamping with
+a hot iron the name of the owner on the forehead
+or shoulder of his slave. Before the
+final destruction of Jerusalem by the Babylonians,
+Ezekiel saw in vision a man clothed in
+linen, with a writer's ink-horn by his side,
+who was commissioned to go through the
+midst of Jerusalem and set a mark on the
+foreheads of the men that sigh and that cry
+for all the abominations that be done in the
+midst thereof. And the destroying angels
+who were commanded to slay all, both old
+and young, to spare not, nor to have pity,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page071">[pg 071]</span><a name="Pg071" id="Pg071" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+were expressly told to <span class="tei tei-q">“come not near any
+man upon whom is the mark,”</span> Ezek. 9:2-6.
+When the destroying angel passed through
+Egypt, on the night of the Passover, <span class="tei tei-q">“to slay
+all the first-born of that nation, the houses
+of the Israelites were indicated by the blood
+of the Paschal Lamb sprinkled on their lintels
+and door-posts; and by these the angels
+passed,”</span> Ex. 12:23. Thus in the present
+instance, before the descent of the impending
+storm, the servants of the Lord are to be indicated
+by the seal of the living God in their
+foreheads, and will be spared the horrible tempest
+which will <span class="tei tei-q">“hurt”</span> all those on whom it
+shall fall.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The 144,000,—the whole number sealed,
+is a perfect number,—an appropriate symbol
+of all the living righteous on the earth. The
+twelve tribes, then, would symbolize all the
+branches of Christ's mystical body in which
+the servants of God are found. The pious
+dead would need no mark indicative of their
+acceptance, having previously, in the white
+robes given them, received the symbols of
+their justification, 6:11. That their resurrection
+and the changing of the living, immediately
+succeeded, is evident from:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Palm-bearing Multitude.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">After these things I looked, and lo, a great crowd, which
+no one could number, out of all nations, and tribes, and
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page072">[pg 072]</span><a name="Pg072" id="Pg072" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+people, and tongues, stood before the throne, and before the
+Lamb, clothed with white robes, and palm-branches in their
+hands; and they cried with a loud voice, saying, Salvation
+to our God seated on the throne, and to the Lamb! And
+all the angels stood around the throne, and the elders and
+the four living beings, and fell before the throne on their
+faces, and worshipped God, saying, Amen: blessing and
+glory, and wisdom, and thanksgiving, and honor, and
+power, and might, be to our God for ever and ever. Amen!
+And one of the elders answered, saying to me, Who are
+these arrayed in white robes? and whence came they? And
+I said to him, My Lord, thou knowest. And he said to me,
+These are they who came out of great affliction, and have
+washed their robes, and made them white in the blood of
+the Lamb. For this, they are before the throne of God, and
+serve him day and night in his temple: and He, who sitteth
+on the throne, will dwell among them. They will hunger
+no more, and will thirst no more; nor will the sun light on
+them, nor any heat. For the Lamb, who is in the midst of
+the throne, will tend them, and lead them to fountains of
+living waters: and God will wipe away every tear from
+their eyes.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 7:9-17.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This great multitude of white-robed palm-bearers,
+must include those who, under the
+preceding seal, anxiously inquired how long
+was to be deferred the avenging of their blood
+on those who dwell on the earth. That epoch
+had now arrived; and they come forth arrayed
+in the white robes then given them.
+The palm-branches in their hands, are emblems
+of victory. They symbolize the subjects
+of the first resurrection, caught up to
+meet the Lord in the air. That they are
+gathered from every land and every age, is
+asserted when it is said they are from every
+kindred, tongue, and people; and that they
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page073">[pg 073]</span><a name="Pg073" id="Pg073" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+triumph over death and the grave, is evident
+from the answer of one of the elders to the
+questions: <span class="tei tei-q">“What are these?”</span> and <span class="tei tei-q">“Whence
+came they?”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The epoch, is a point of time intervening
+between the first resurrection, and the descent
+of the new Jerusalem, 21:2. The loud and
+united voice, with which the redeemed multitude
+cry <span class="tei tei-q">“Salvation to our God which sitteth
+upon the throne, and unto the Lamb,”</span>—synchronizes
+with that of the <span class="tei tei-q">“great multitude,”</span>
+which, like the voice of many waters, and of
+<span class="tei tei-q">“mighty thunderings,”</span> shouted <span class="tei tei-q">“Alleluia:
+for the Lord God omnipotent reigneth”</span> (19:6),
+immediately preceding the marriage-supper
+of the Lamb (19:6-9). They are removed
+above the troubles of earth, which are impending
+upon the wicked, under:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Seventh Seal.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And when he opened the seventh seal, silence took
+place in heaven for about half an hour. And I saw the
+seven angels, who stood before God; and seven trumpets
+were given to them. And another angel came and stood by
+the altar, having a golden censer; and much incense was
+given to him, that he should offer it with the prayers of all
+the saints on the golden altar before the throne. And the
+smoke of the incense, with the prayers of the saints, ascended
+before God from the angel's hand. And the angel
+took the censer, and filled it with the fire of the altar, and
+out it into the earth: and there were voices, and thunders,
+and lightnings, and an earthquake.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 8:1-5.
+</span></div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page074">[pg 074]</span><a name="Pg074" id="Pg074" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The epoch of this seal, is sometimes regarded
+as anterior to that of the trumpets; and those
+are often supposed to be included in the events
+of this seal; but no conclusive reason has ever
+been given for removing it from its obvious
+position as the closing one, of a series of successive
+periods, commencing with the gospel,
+and extending to the end of the world. If the
+first six are successive in their respective order,
+analogy would require that the seventh
+be thus considered.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Under the sixth seal, the great men and
+rich, are seen fleeing to the rocks for refuge
+from the wrath of the Lamb; and the risen
+saints symbolized, are in the Saviour's presence;
+but the infliction of the wrath of God
+on the wicked is not there symbolized. The
+events of that seal come down as far as those
+in the 19th chapter, which precede the marriage
+of the Lamb, 19:7.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The half-hour's silence, is the first thing
+indicated under the seventh seal. Being so
+expressly noticed, it would seem to be of some
+significance. As a period of symbolic time,
+on the scale of a day for a year, <span class="tei tei-q">“about half
+an hour,”</span> would equal a week's duration—corresponding
+to the time which intervened
+between the entrance of Noah into the ark,
+and the commencement of the deluge, Gen.
+7:1-4. As the period evidently synchronizes
+with the parable of the Saviour, when
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the Bridegroom came; and they that were
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page075">[pg 075]</span><a name="Pg075" id="Pg075" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+ready went in with him to the marriage, and
+the door was shut”</span> (Matt. 25:10),—the others
+being still without,—it would seem to
+symbolize the time, between the entrance to
+the marriage of the Lamb (19:7), and the
+going forth of the Word of God with his armies,
+to judge, make war, and to slay the
+remnant with the sword, 19:11-21. It
+would be a period of holy joy to the righteous
+in the Saviour's presence, and of awful suspense
+to the wicked.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The seven angels, to whom were given
+seven trumpets, being introduced here, have
+doubtless caused the events of this seal to be
+regarded as anterior to the first trumpet. As
+those immediately following, evidently synchronize
+with occurrences of the closing epoch,
+the angels can only be introduced here in anticipation
+of the symbolization which they are
+to unfold under the sounding of the successive
+trumpets—the same as the seven angels with
+the last plagues are introduced, before the
+epoch of the commencement of their allotted
+work, 15:1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The golden censer was the instrument in
+which incense was burned in the Jewish worship.
+Incense symbolizes prayers (5:8).
+The offering of much incense with the prayers
+of all saints and the smoke of the incense ascending
+up before God, indicates the acceptance
+of their offerings in heaven—the act
+being before the throne, and not on the earth.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page076">[pg 076]</span><a name="Pg076" id="Pg076" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+The acceptance of their prayers, also implies
+their own acceptance, when presented <span class="tei tei-q">“faultless
+before the presence of his glory with exceeding
+joy,”</span> Jude 24.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The fire from the altar, symbolizes the instruments
+of divine justice; and the filling the
+censer with coals after the acceptance of the
+saints, and the casting of both the censer and
+fire to the earth, indicate that thenceforth
+there would be no more acceptance of prayer
+from those left on the earth, but the speedy
+infliction of impending judgments.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“voices, and thunderings, and lightnings,
+and an earthquake,”</span> which followed,
+evidently synchronize with the same events
+which follow the seventh trumpet: when the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“wrath of God”</span> has come, with <span class="tei tei-q">“the time of
+the dead that they should be judged;”</span> and
+when those are to be destroyed who have
+destroyed the earth, 11:19. They are the
+same, also, as those under the seventh vial,
+(16:18); and symbolize the final overturn
+and commotion, previous to the cleansing of
+the earth and the ushering in of a better day:
+Then will the
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 8.00em"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“fire purge all things new,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">Both Heaven and Earth, wherein the just shall dwell.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Milton, Book xi.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page077">[pg 077]</span><a name="Pg077" id="Pg077" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Seven Trumpets.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the seven angels having seven trumpets prepared
+themselves to sound.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 8:6.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sounding of each successive trumpet
+marks the commencement of an era, of a longer
+or shorter duration, as the striking of a clock
+does the succession of hours. During each
+era, were to be fulfilled the events symbolized
+in connection with its respective trumpet.
+Those under the trumpets are more of a political
+character than those presented in connection
+with the seals.
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The First Trumpet.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the first angel sounded, and there was hail and
+fire mingled with blood, and they were cast into the earth;
+and the third part of the earth was burnt up, and the third
+part of the trees was burnt up, and every green herb was
+burnt up.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 8:7.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The earth of the Apocalypse is regarded by
+most expositors as the Roman empire, in a
+state of comparative quiet. As no tornado
+like this described has ever happened, its correspondence
+must be sought for in the political
+relations of the empire. There is great
+unanimity among commentators respecting
+the period and the agents here symbolized,—that
+it refers to the invasions of the Goths and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page078">[pg 078]</span><a name="Pg078" id="Pg078" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+other barbarians, from A. D. 363 to 410. After
+395, their incursions were more severe than
+during the earlier portion of that period. The
+third part of the earth, would be the third part
+of the Roman empire, in distinction from the
+other two-thirds.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The green grass of the earth, the trees, &amp;c.,
+are distinguished from <span class="tei tei-q">“those men which
+have <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">not</span></em> the seal of God in their foreheads”</span>
+(9:4), and must therefore symbolize the
+people of God in the third part of the empire.
+As all the green grass is burnt up,
+while only one-third of the trees suffer, the
+latter cannot include one-third of all the trees
+in the empire, but only one-third in the parts
+affected,—the grass indicating the more
+weakly, and the trees the more hardy classes
+of Christians.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The infidel historian, Gibbon, has given the
+events which fitly correspond with the symbolization
+of these trumpets. After the death
+of Theodosius, in January, A. D. 395, Alaric,
+the bold leader of the Gothic nation, took
+arms against the empire. The terrible effects
+of this invasion, are thus described:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The barbarian auxiliaries erected their independent
+standard; and boldly avowed hostile
+designs, which they had long cherished in
+their ferocious minds. Their countrymen,
+who had been condemned, by the conditions
+of the last treaty, to a life of tranquillity and
+labor, deserted their farms at the first sound
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page079">[pg 079]</span><a name="Pg079" id="Pg079" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of the trumpet, and eagerly assumed the
+weapons which they had reluctantly laid
+down. The barriers of the Danube were
+thrown open; the savage warriors of Scythia
+issued from their forest; and the uncommon
+severity of the winter, allowed the poet to remark,
+that <span class="tei tei-q">‘they rolled their ponderous wagons
+over the broad and icy back of the indignant
+river.’</span> The unhappy nations of the
+provinces to the south of the Danube, submitted
+to the calamities, which, in the course
+of twenty years, were almost grown familiar
+to their imagination; and the various troops
+of barbarians, who gloried in the Gothic name,
+were irregularly spread from the woody
+shores of Dalmatia, to the walls of Constantinople.
+The Goths were directed by the bold
+and artful genius of Alaric. In the midst of
+a divided court, and a discontented people, the
+emperor, Arcadius, was terrified by the aspect
+of the Gothic arms. Alaric disdained to
+trample any longer on the prostrate and
+ruined countries of Thrace and Dacia, and he
+resolved to seek a plentiful harvest of fame
+and riches in a province which had hitherto
+escaped the ravages of war.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Alaric traversed, without resistance, the
+plains of Macedonia and Thessaly. The
+troops which had been posted to defend
+the Straits of Thermopylæ, retired, as they
+were directed, without attempting to disturb
+the secure and rapid passage of Alaric; and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page080">[pg 080]</span><a name="Pg080" id="Pg080" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the fertile fields of Phocis and Bœotia were
+instantly covered with a deluge of barbarians,
+who massacred the males of an age to bear
+arms, and drove away the beautiful females,
+with the spoil and cattle of the flaming villages.
+The travellers who visited Greece
+several years afterwards, could easily discover
+the deep and bloody traces of the march of
+the Goths. The whole territory of Attica
+was blasted by his baneful presence; and if
+we may use the comparison of a cotemporary
+philosopher, Athens itself resembled the bleeding
+and empty skin of a slaughtered victim.
+Corinth, Argos, Sparta, yielded without resistance
+to the arms of the Goths; and the most
+fortunate of the inhabitants were saved, by
+death, from beholding the slavery of their families,
+and the conflagration of their cities.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon's
+Rome</span></span>, vol. v., p. 177.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Being tempted by the fame of Rome, Alaric
+hastened to subjugate it. He put to flight the
+Emperor of the West; but deliverance soon
+came, and Rome was saved from his hands.
+Alaric was first conquered in 403. But another
+cloud was gathering, and is thus described
+by Gibbon:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“About four years after the victorious
+Toulan had assumed the title of Khan of the
+Geougen, another barbarian, the haughty
+Rhodogast, or Radagaisus, marched from the
+northern extremities of Germany almost to
+the gates of Rome, and left the remains of his
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page081">[pg 081]</span><a name="Pg081" id="Pg081" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+army to achieve the destruction of the West.
+The Vandals, the Suevi, and the Burgundians,
+formed the strength of this mighty host;
+but the Alani, who had found a hospitable
+reception in their new seats, added their active
+cavalry to the heavy infantry of the Germans;
+and the Gothic adventurers crowded so eagerly
+to the standard of Radagaisus, that, by some
+historians, he has been styled the King of the
+Goths. Twelve thousand warriors, distinguished
+above the vulgar by their noble birth,
+or their valiant deeds, glittered in the van;
+and the whole multitude, which was not less
+than two hundred thousand fighting men,
+might be increased by the accession of women,
+of children, and of slaves, to the amount of
+four hundred thousand persons.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The correspondence of nations was, in
+that age, so imperfect and precarious, that the
+revolutions of the North might escape the
+knowledge of the court of Ravenna, till the
+dark cloud, which was collected along the
+coast of the Baltic, burst in thunder upon the
+banks of the Upper Danube, &amp;c. Many cities
+of Italy were pillaged or destroyed; and the
+siege of Florence by Radagaisus, is one of the
+earliest events in the history of that celebrated
+republic, whose firmness checked or delayed
+the unskilful fury of the barbarians.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“While the peace of Germany was secured
+by the attachment of the Franks, and the neutrality
+of the Alemanni, the subjects of Rome,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page082">[pg 082]</span><a name="Pg082" id="Pg082" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+unconscious of the approaching calamities,
+enjoyed a state of quiet and prosperity, which
+had seldom blessed the frontiers of Gaul.
+Their flocks and herds were permitted to
+graze in the pastures of the barbarians: their
+huntsmen penetrated, without fear or danger,
+into the darkest recesses of the Hercynian
+wood. The banks of the Rhine were crowded,
+like those of the Tiber, with elegant houses
+and well-cultivated farms; and if the poet descended
+the river, he might express his doubt
+on which side was situated the territory of the
+Romans. This scene of peace and plenty was
+suddenly changed into a desert; and the prospect
+of the smoking ruins, could alone distinguish
+the solitude of nature, from the desolation
+of man. The flourishing city of Mentz
+was surprised and destroyed; and many thousand
+Christians were inhumanly massacred in
+the church. Worms perished, after a long
+and obstinate siege; Strasburg, Spires, Rheims,
+Tournay, Arras, Amiens, experienced the
+cruel oppression of the German yoke; and the
+consuming flames of war spread from the
+banks of the Rhine over the greatest part of
+the seventeen provinces of Gaul. That rich
+and extensive country, as far as the ocean,
+the Alps, and the Pyrenees, was delivered to
+the barbarians, who drove before them, in a
+promiscuous crowd, the bishop, the senator,
+and the virgin, laden with the spoils of their
+houses and altars.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ibid.</span></span>, vol. v., p. 224.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page083">[pg 083]</span><a name="Pg083" id="Pg083" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+After this invasion of the empire by Radagaisus,
+Alaric again returned, invaded Italy
+in 408, and in 410 he besieged, took, and
+sacked Rome, and died the same year. In
+412 the Goths voluntarily retired from Italy.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In this last year, <span class="tei tei-q">“a public conference was
+held in Carthage, by order of the magistrate;”</span>
+and it was there agreed to inflict the most
+severe penalties on those who dissented
+from the Catholic doctrines, in the African
+part of the Roman empire. Says Gibbon:—<span class="tei tei-q">“Three
+hundred bishops, with many thousands
+of the inferior clergy, were torn from
+their churches, stripped of their ecclesiastical
+possessions, banished to the islands, and
+proscribed by the laws, if they presumed to
+conceal themselves in the provinces of Africa.
+Their numerous congregations, both in the
+cities and country, were deprived of the rights
+of citizens, and of the exercise of religious
+worship.”</span>
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Second Trumpet.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the second angel sounded, and it was as if a great
+mountain burning with fire were cast into the sea: and the
+third part of the sea became blood; and the third part of the
+creatures in the sea, and having life, died; and the third
+part of the ships was destroyed.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 8:8, 9.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A mountain differs from a tornado, and
+must symbolize a compact, organized body of
+invaders. Its being of a volcanic nature, renders
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page084">[pg 084]</span><a name="Pg084" id="Pg084" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+it so much the more terrible and destructive.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As waters symbolize <span class="tei tei-q">“peoples, multitudes,
+nations, and tongues,”</span> the sea into which the
+mountain is cast, is a people already agitated
+by previous commotions.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The ships and fish in the sea, must necessarily
+symbolize agents sustaining a relation to
+the Roman Sea, analogous to the relation of
+such to the literal sea. They are those who
+live upon, and are supported by, the people:—the
+rulers and the officers of state.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The symbol of a burning mountain fitly represents
+the armed invaders under Genseric. In
+the year 429, with fifty thousand effective
+men he landed on the shores of Africa, established
+an independent government in that
+part of the Roman empire, and from thence,
+harassed the southern shores of Europe and
+the intermediate islands, by perpetual incursions.
+Says Gibbon:—<span class="tei tei-q">“The Vandals, who,
+in twenty years, had penetrated from the Elbe
+to Mount Atlas, were united under the command
+of their warlike king; and he reigned
+with equal authority over the Alarici, who
+had passed within the term of human life,
+from the cold of Scythia, to the excessive heat
+of an African climate.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Vandals and Alarici, who followed
+the successful standard of Genseric, had acquired
+a rich and fertile territory, which
+stretched along the coast from Tangiers to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page085">[pg 085]</span><a name="Pg085" id="Pg085" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Tripoli; but their narrow limits were pressed
+and confined on either side by the sandy desert
+and the Mediterranean. The discovery
+and conquest of the black nations that might
+dwell beneath the torrid zone, could not tempt
+the rational ambition of Genseric; but he cast
+his eyes towards the sea; he resolved to create
+a new naval power, and his bold enterprise
+was executed with steady and active perseverance.
+The woods of Mount Atlas afforded
+an inexhaustible nursery of timber; his new
+subjects were skilled in the art of navigation
+and ship-building; he animated his daring
+Vandals to embrace a mode of warfare which
+would render every maritime country accessible
+to their arms; the Moors and Africans
+were allured by the hope of plunder; and,
+after an interval of six centuries, the fleet that
+issued from the port of Carthage again claimed
+the empire of the Mediterranean. The success
+of the Vandals, the conquest of Sicily,
+the sack of Palermo, and the frequent descents
+on the coast of Lucania, awakened and
+alarmed the mother of Valentinian, and the
+sister of Theodosius.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The naval power of Rome was unequal
+to the task of saving even the imperial city
+from the ravages of the Vandals. Sailing
+from Africa, they disembarked at the port of
+Ostia, and Rome and its inhabitants were delivered
+to the licentiousness of Vandals and
+Moors, whose blind passions revenged the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page086">[pg 086]</span><a name="Pg086" id="Pg086" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+injuries of Carthage. The pillage lasted fourteen
+days and nights; and all that yet remained
+of public and private wealth, of
+sacred or profane treasure, was diligently
+transported to the vessels of Genseric. In
+the forty-five years that had elapsed since
+the Gothic invasion, the pomp and luxury of
+Rome were in some measure restored; and it
+was difficult either to escape, or to satisfy the
+avarice of a conqueror, who possessed leisure
+to collect, and ships to transport, the wealth
+of the capital.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Third Trumpet.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the third angel sounded, and a great star fell
+from heaven, burning like a torch, and it fell on the third
+part of the rivers, and on the fountains of waters; and the
+name of the star is called Wormwood: and the third part
+of the waters became wormwood; and many men died by
+the waters, because they were made bitter.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 8:10,
+11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sounding of the third trumpet marks
+the advent of a third invader of the Roman
+empire. And such was Attila, the king of the
+Huns, who invaded Gaul A. D. 451. Gibbon
+says:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The kings and nations of Germany and
+Scythia, from the Volga perhaps to the Danube,
+obeyed the warlike summons of Attila.
+From the royal village in the plains of Hungary,
+his standard moved towards the west;
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page087">[pg 087]</span><a name="Pg087" id="Pg087" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and, after a march of seven or eight hundred
+miles, he reached the conflux of the Rhine
+and the Necker.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“The hostile myriads
+were poured with resistless violence into the
+Belgic provinces.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“The consternation of
+Gaul was universal.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“From the Rhine and
+the Moselle, Attila advanced into the heart of
+Gaul, crossed the Seine at Auxerre, and,
+after a long and laborious march, fixed his
+camp under the walls of Orleans.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“An alliance
+was formed between the Romans and
+Visigoths.”</span> The hostile armies approached.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“ <span class="tei tei-q">‘I myself,’</span> said Attila, <span class="tei tei-q">‘will throw the
+first javelin, and the wretch who refuses
+to imitate the example of his sovereign, is devoted
+to inevitable death.’</span> The spirit of the
+barbarians was rekindled by the presence, the
+voice, and the example, of their intrepid leader;
+and Attila, yielding to their impatience, immediately
+formed his order of battle. At the
+head of his brave and faithful Huns, Attila
+occupied, in person, the centre of the line.”</span>
+The nations from the Volga to the Atlantic
+were assembled on the plains of Chalons; and
+there fought a battle, <span class="tei tei-q">“fierce, various, obstinate,
+and bloody, such as could not be paralleled,
+either in the present, or in past ages!
+The number of the slain amounted to one
+hundred and sixty-two thousand, or according
+to another account, three hundred thousand
+persons; and these incredible exaggerations
+suppose a real or effective loss, sufficient to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page088">[pg 088]</span><a name="Pg088" id="Pg088" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+justify the historian's remark, that whole generations
+may be swept away, by the madness
+of kings, in the space of a single hour.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Attila was compelled to retreat; but neither
+his forces nor reputation suffered. He
+<span class="tei tei-q">“passed the Alps, invaded Italy, and besieged
+Aquileia with an innumerable host of barbarians.”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The succeeding generation could
+scarcely discover the ruins of Aquileia. After
+this dreadful chastisement, Attila pursued
+his march; and, as he passed, the cities of
+Altinum, Concordia, and Padua were reduced
+into heaps of stones and ashes. The inland
+towns, Vicenza, Verona, and Bergamo, were
+exposed to the rapacious cruelty of the Huns.
+Milan and Pavia submitted, without resistance,
+to the loss of their wealth;”</span> and <span class="tei tei-q">“applauded
+the unusual clemency which preserved
+from the flames the public as well as private
+buildings, and spared the lives of the captive
+multitude.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“Attila spread his ravages over
+the rich plains of modern Lombardy; which
+are divided by the Po, and bounded by the
+Alps and Apennines.”</span> He took possession of
+the royal palace of Milan. <span class="tei tei-q">“It is a saying
+worthy of the ferocious pride of Attila, that
+the grass never grew on the spot where his
+horse had trod.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+He advanced into Italy, only as far as the
+plains of Lombardy and the banks of the Po,
+reducing the cities he passed to stones and
+ashes; but there his ravages ceased. He concluded
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page089">[pg 089]</span><a name="Pg089" id="Pg089" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a peace with the Romans in the year
+of his invasion of Italy (451), and the next
+year he died. Thus he appeared like a fiery
+meteor, exerted his appointed influence upon
+the tongues and people, who were tributary
+to the Romans,—as rivers and fountains of
+waters are to the sea; and like a burning
+star, he as suddenly expired. As a specimen
+of the bitterness which followed his course, it
+is recorded of the Thuringians who served in
+his army, and who traversed, both in their
+march and in their return, the territories of
+the Franks, <span class="tei tei-q">“that they massacred their hostages
+as well as their captives. Two hundred
+young maidens were tortured with exquisite
+and unrelenting rage; their bodies were torn
+asunder by wild horses, or were crushed under
+the weight of rolling wagons; and their unburied
+limbs were abandoned on public roads,
+as a prey to dogs and vultures.”</span>
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Fourth Trumpet.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the fourth angel sounded, and the third part of the
+sun was smitten, and the third part of the moon, and the
+third part of the stars; so that the third part of them was
+darkened, and the day shone not for a third part of it, and
+the night in like manner.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 8:12.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sun, moon, and stars cannot here, any
+more than under the sixth seal (6:12,13),
+symbolize agents of their own order, but must
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page090">[pg 090]</span><a name="Pg090" id="Pg090" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+represent the rulers of the Roman empire.
+Says Dr. Keith:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“At the voice of the first angel, and the
+blast of his trumpet, the whole Roman world
+was in agitation, and <span class="tei tei-q">‘the storms of war’</span>
+passed over it all. <span class="tei tei-q">‘The union of the empire
+was dissolved;’</span> a third part of it fell; and the
+<span class="tei tei-q">‘transalpine provinces were separated from
+the empire.’</span> Under the second trumpet, the
+provinces of Africa, another, or the maritime,
+part, was in like manner reft from Rome, and
+the Roman ships were destroyed in the sea,
+and even in their harbors. The empire of
+Rome, hemmed in on every side, was then
+limited to the kingdom of Italy. Within its
+bounds, and along the fountains and rivers of
+waters, the third trumpet reëchoed from the
+Alps to the Apennines. The last barrier of
+the empire of Rome was broken. The plains
+of Lombardy were ravaged by a foreign foe:
+and from thence new enemies arose to bring
+to an end the strife of the world with the imperial
+city.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“ <span class="tei tei-q">‘In the space of twenty years since the
+death of Valentinian’</span> (two years subsequent to
+the death of Attila), <span class="tei tei-q">‘nine emperors had successively
+disappeared; and the son of Orestes,
+a youth recommended only by his beauty,
+would be the least entitled to the notice of
+posterity, if his reign, which was marked by
+the extinction of the Roman empire in the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page091">[pg 091]</span><a name="Pg091" id="Pg091" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+west, did not leave a memorable era in the
+history of mankind.’</span> ”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The throne of the Cæsars had been for
+ages the sun of the world; while other kings
+were designated as stars. The imperial power
+had first been transferred to Constantinople by
+Constantine; and it was afterwards divided
+between the east and the west; but the eastern
+empire was not yet doomed to destruction.
+The precise year in which the western empire
+was extinguished, is not positively ascertained,
+but it is usually assigned to A. D. 476. Some
+place it in 479. The imperial Roman power, of
+which either Rome or Constantinople had been
+jointly or singly the seat, whether in the West
+or the East, ceased to be recognized in Italy;
+and the third part of the sun was smitten, till
+it emitted no longer the faintest rays. The
+power of the Cæsars became unknown in
+Italy; and a Gothic king reigned over Rome.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Dr. Keith considers that <span class="tei tei-q">“the concluding
+words of the fourth trumpet imply the future
+restoration of the Western empire: <span class="tei tei-q">‘The day
+shone not for a third part of it, and the
+night likewise.’</span> In respect to civil authority,
+Rome became subject to Ravenna; and Italy
+was a conquered province of the Eastern empire.
+But, as more appropriately pertaining
+to other prophecies, the defence of the worship
+of images first brought the spiritual and temporal
+powers of the Pope and of the emperor
+into violent collision; and, by conferring on
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page092">[pg 092]</span><a name="Pg092" id="Pg092" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the Pope all authority over the churches, Justinian
+laid his helping hand to the promotion
+of the papal supremacy, which afterwards assumed
+the power of creating monarchs. In
+the year of our Lord 800, the Pope conferred
+on Charlemagne the title of Emperor of the
+Romans. The title was again transferred from
+the King of France to the Emperor of Germany.
+By the latter it was formally renounced,
+within the memory of the existing generation.
+In our own days the iron crown of Italy was
+on the head of another <span class="tei tei-q">‘emperor.’</span> ”</span> Then
+the sun was suddenly darkened, as symbolized
+under the sixth seal, 6:12. p. 66.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Woe-denouncing Angel.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I beheld, and heard an eagle flying in the midst
+of heaven, saying with a loud voice, Woe, woe, woe, to the
+inhabitants of the earth, from the remaining voices of the
+trumpet of the three angels, who are to sound.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+8:13.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The word eagle, instead of angel, is in accordance
+with the more recent revised editions
+of the Greek. It must symbolize persons peculiarly
+apprehensive at this crisis, of disasters
+to follow the extinction of the Roman
+empire in the west. During the first half of
+the sixth century, the Sclavonians invaded the
+east, <span class="tei tei-q">“spread from the suburbs of Constantinople
+to the Ionian Gulf, destroyed thirty-two
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page093">[pg 093]</span><a name="Pg093" id="Pg093" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+cities or castles, razed Potidæa, which Athens
+had built, and Philip had besieged, and repassed
+the Danube, dragging at their horses'
+heels one hundred and twenty thousand of
+the subjects of Justinian.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon.</span></span> And
+they continued their inroads, until the citizens
+became apprehensive that the Empire of the
+East would be extinguished like that of the
+West.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This symbol also indicates that the events
+under the trumpets which were to follow,
+would be far more dreadful and terrible than
+those of the preceding ones. For this reason,
+the last three are sometimes denominated <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">The
+Woe Trumpets</span></span>.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Fifth Trumpet.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the fifth angel sounded, and I saw a star, which
+had fallen from heaven to the earth: and to him was given
+the key of the pit of the abyss. And he opened the pit of
+the abyss: and a smoke arose out of the pit, like the smoke
+of a great furnace; and the sun and the air were darkened
+by the smoke of the pit. And locusts came out of the smoke
+into the earth: and power was given to them, as the scorpions
+of the earth have power. And it was said to them
+that they should not injure the herbage of the earth, nor
+any green thing, nor any tree; but only those men who
+have not the seal of God on their foreheads. And they
+were not allowed to kill them, but to torment them five
+months: and their torment was like the torment of a scorpion,
+when he striketh a man. And in those days men will
+seek death, and will not find it; and will desire to die, and
+death will flee from them. And the shapes of the locusts
+were like horses prepared for battle; and on their heads
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page094">[pg 094]</span><a name="Pg094" id="Pg094" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+were as it were crowns like gold, and their faces were like
+the faces of men. And they had hair like the hair of
+women, and their teeth were like those of lions. And they
+had breast-plates, like breast-plates of iron; and the sound
+of their wings was like the sound of chariots with many
+horses rushing into battle. And they had tails like scorpions,
+and there were stings in their tails: and their power
+was to injure men five months. They had a king over them,
+the messenger of the abyss, whose name in Hebrew is
+Abaddon, but in the Greek tongue he hath the name Apollyon.
+One woe is past away; and behold, there come yet
+two woes hereafter.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 9:1-12.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The previous trumpets reveal the agencies
+which effected the dismemberment and overthrow
+of Western Rome. The fifth and sixth
+unfold those which terminated that empire in
+the east, embracing the territory between the
+Adriatic and Euphrates, the Lybian desert
+and the Danube.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A star (1:20) symbolizes a messenger,
+or head of a religious body, p. <a href="#Pg031" class="tei tei-ref">31</a>. Mohammed
+is generally regarded as represented by
+this symbol. He was, by birth, of the princely
+house of the Koreish, Governors of Mecca, a
+family of eminence.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The star had fallen to the earth before opening
+the pit of the abyss, which illustrates the
+flight of Mohammed from Mecca, and the seeming
+termination of all his hopes. To save his
+life, he took refuge, with one companion, in a
+cave near Medina, in A. D. 622, which forms
+the epoch of the Hegira, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, of his flight.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The bottomless pit, is where Satan is subsequently
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page095">[pg 095]</span><a name="Pg095" id="Pg095" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+cast (20:3); and the key of it being
+given to this agent, symbolizes his power to
+open and to cause the smoke to issue from it;
+the Satanic origin of which is thus indicated:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Smoke is an appropriate representative of
+error, and symbolizes the Mohammedan doctrines;
+which, like the smoke of a great furnace,
+were disseminated far and wide, subverting
+the religion, and, in time, effecting
+the overthrow of the remaining portion of the
+Roman empire—the sun, one-third of which
+was smitten under the fourth trumpet.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The locusts were generated in the smoke
+from whence they issued. In a corresponding
+manner, the spread of Mohammedanism resulted
+in the organization of hordes of Saracens,
+who propagated the religion of the false
+prophet by the sword, and founded the famous
+Arabian empire, which extended from the
+Atlantic ocean to the river Euphrates.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The shapes of the locusts were like horses
+prepared for battle; and the Saracenic hordes,
+thus symbolized, were mounted horsemen,
+famous for the swiftness of their flight or pursuit,
+and ever ready for the contest.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their crowns, faces, hair, teeth, breast-plates,
+&amp;c., seem to be indicative of their personal
+appearance: on their heads they wore
+yellow turbans, like coronets; their demeanor
+was grave and firm; their hair, like that of
+women, was suffered to grow uncut; they
+were defended by the cuirass or breast-plate;
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page096">[pg 096]</span><a name="Pg096" id="Pg096" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and in rushing to battle, their onset was like
+that of chariots and many horses.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They had a king over them, named Abaddon
+in the Hebrew, and Apollyon in the Greek,
+both of which signified the Destroyer. The
+Saracens acknowledged the authority of Mohammed
+during the whole period of their conquests;
+not only recognizing him as their
+prophet and king during his lifetime, but his
+successors, after his death, considered and
+called themselves Mohammed's <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Caliphs</span></span>, or
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Vicars</span></span>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their mission was not against the grass, green
+things, and trees, but had express reference to
+the men who had <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">not</span></em> the seal of God in their
+foreheads. The antithesis here expressed,
+shows that by the former were symbolized the
+servants of God, and that these locust-warriors
+were particularly commissioned against infidels
+and apostates. Christians were not to be molested;
+and provision was made for their protection,
+in the circular letter which Abubekir sent
+to the Arabian tribes, A. D. 633. He said:
+</p>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“ </span><span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">‘</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Remember, that you are always in the presence of
+God, on the verge of death, in the assurance of judgment,
+and the hope of paradise: avoid injustice and oppression;
+consult with your brethren, and study to preserve the love
+and confidence of your troops. When you fight the battles
+of the Lord, acquit yourselves like men, without turning
+your backs; but let not your victory be stained with the
+blood of women and children. Destroy </span><em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-size: 90%; font-style: italic">no palm-trees, nor
+burn any fields of corn</span></em><span style="font-size: 90%">. Cut down no fruit-trees, nor do
+any mischief to cattle, only such as you kill to eat. When
+you make any covenant, or article, stand to it, and be as
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page097">[pg 097]</span><a name="Pg097" id="Pg097" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+good as your word. As you go on, you will find some </span><em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-size: 90%; font-style: italic">religious
+persons</span></em><span style="font-size: 90%"> who live in retired monasteries, and propose
+to themselves to serve God that way; let them alone, and
+neither kill them nor destroy their monasteries; and you
+will find another sort of people that belong to the synagogue
+of Satan, who have </span><em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-size: 90%; font-style: italic">shaven crowns</span></em><span style="font-size: 90%">; be sure you cleave their
+skulls, and give them no quarter </span><em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-size: 90%; font-style: italic">till they either turn
+Mohammedans or pay tribute</span></em><span style="font-size: 90%">.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">’</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> ”</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+At this epoch, the Greek church at Constantinople
+had been preserved from the reproach
+of image worship, and still later it
+made strenuous efforts against it; but the
+churches of the north of Africa, and the Asiatic
+portion of the Eastern empire, had become
+greatly debased, and worshipped saints and
+images. And while the territories of these
+were speedily subverted to Mohammedanism,
+and became a part of the Arabian empire, the
+east of Europe was wonderfully preserved
+from their inroads.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their power was not to kill, but to torment
+men five months. To kill, symbolically, according
+to the significance of the second seal,
+p. <a href="#Pg060" class="tei tei-ref">60</a>, is to compel men to apostasize; and they
+could not be in a condition to force their religion
+on the men of the eastern empire, without
+first subjecting it by force of arms.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The time of this torment was limited to five
+prophetic months. In one hundred and fifty
+years from the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Hegira</span></span> the Saracen empire
+had ceased to be aggressive. In 762 Bagdad,
+the city of peace, was founded on the Tigris,
+by Al-Mansur, who died in 774. <span class="tei tei-q">“From this
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page098">[pg 098]</span><a name="Pg098" id="Pg098" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+time,”</span> says <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Rottick</span></span>, <span class="tei tei-q">“the Arabian history
+assumes an entirely different character.”</span> It
+was no longer progressive; the proud Saracen
+empire became dismembered, and three independent
+and hostile Caliphates, and several
+fragments of kingdoms, were formed from its
+ruins. In 841, the reigning Caliph at Bagdad,
+distrusting the spirit of his own troops, hired
+a body of fifty thousand Turkish soldiers,
+which he distributed in his dominions. These
+accelerated the ruin of the Caliphate, and, in
+time, the whole of the Saracen territory became
+subject to the Tartar rule, which had
+become Mohammedan, and also aimed to subject
+the eastern empire.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The declaration that <span class="tei tei-q">“one woe is past,”</span>
+v. 12, implies an interval between that and
+the woe following. In a corresponding manner,
+the crusaders from Europe, like the successive
+overflowing of a mighty river, restrained
+the Tartars from the conquest of Constantinople,
+which had now consented to image
+worship, till the sounding of:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Sixth Trumpet.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the sixth angel sounded, and I heard a voice out
+of the four horns of the golden altar before God, saying to
+the sixth angel having the trumpet, Loose the four messengers
+bound near the great river Euphrates. And the four
+messengers were loosed, prepared for an hour, and day,
+and month, and year, to slay the third part of men. And
+the number of the army of the horsemen were two hundred
+thousand thousand: I heard the number of them. And
+thus I saw on the horses in the vision, and those, who sat
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page099">[pg 099]</span><a name="Pg099" id="Pg099" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+on them, having red, blue and yellow breast-plates: and
+the heads of the horses were like the heads of lions; and fire,
+and smoke, and brimstone issued from their mouths. By
+these three plagues the third part of men was killed; by the
+fire, and by the smoke, and by the brimstone, which issued
+from their mouths. For the power of the horses is in their
+mouth, and in their tails: for their tails having heads were
+like serpents, and they injure with them. And the rest of
+the men, who were not killed by these plagues, yet repented
+not of the works of their hands, that they should not worship
+demons, and idols of gold, and silver, and brass, and
+stone, and of wood: which can neither see, nor hear, nor
+walk; nor did they repent of their murders, nor of their
+sorceries, nor of their fornication, nor of their thefts.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+9:13-21.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The great river, the Euphrates,—waters
+being a symbol of people, (17:15)—must
+symbolize those who sustain a relation to the
+Roman hierarchy, as its defenders and supporters;
+analogous to that sustained by the
+river Euphrates to the city of Babylon;
+which was situated on, and drew its wealth
+and support from it.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The angels bound near the Euphrates,
+must then be those powers, which, approaching
+and attacking the Roman Empire, were
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">restrained</span></em> from effecting its conquest and enforcing
+the profession of Mohammedanism.
+Their being loosed, signifies the removal of
+those restraints. Mr. Lord suggests that they
+symbolize leaders of the four armies of the
+Tartars, which successively overran the surrounding
+provinces. He says:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The first horde were the Seljukians, who
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page100">[pg 100]</span><a name="Pg100" id="Pg100" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+invaded the Eastern empire about the middle
+of the eleventh century, under Togrul Beg.</span>
+He suddenly overran, with myriads of cavalry,
+the frontier, from Taurus to Arzeroum,
+and spread it with blood and devastation.
+Alp Arslan, his successor, soon renewed the
+invasion, conquered Armenia and Georgia,
+penetrated into Cappadocia and Phrygia, and
+scattered detachments over the whole of lesser
+Asia. His troops being subsequently driven
+back, he renewed the war, and recovered
+those provinces. His descendants, and others
+of the race, soon after extended their conquests,
+and established the kingdoms in the
+east of Persia and Syria, and Roum, in lesser
+Asia, which they maintained through many
+generations, and made their sway a scorpion
+scourge to the idolatrous inhabitants. The
+Christians were allowed the exercise of their
+religion on the conditions of tribute and servitude,
+but were compelled to endure the scorn
+of the victors, to submit to the abuse of their
+priests and bishops, and to witness the apostasy
+of their brethren, the compulsory circumcision
+of many thousands of their children,
+and the subjection of many thousands to
+a debasing and hopeless slavery.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The second army was that of the Moguls,
+who, in the thirteenth century, after the conquest
+of Persia, passed the Euphrates, plundered
+and devastated Syria, subdued Armenia,
+Iconium, and Anatolia, and extinguished
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page101">[pg 101]</span><a name="Pg101" id="Pg101" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the Seljukian dynasty. Another army advancing
+to the west, devastated the country
+on both sides of the Danube, Thrace, Bulgaria,
+Servia, Bosnia, Hungary, Austria, and
+spread them with the ruins of their cities and
+churches, and the bones of their inhabitants.
+This horde had been prepared for this invasion
+by vast conquests in the East.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The third were the Ottomans, who in the
+beginning of the fourteenth century conquered
+Bithynia, Lydia, Ionia, Thrace, Bulgaria,
+Servia, and in the following century Constantinople
+itself, and have maintained their empire
+to the present time. They were released
+from restraint on the one hand by the decay
+of the Mogul Khans, to whom they had been
+subject, and on the other by the dissensions
+and weakness of the Greeks.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The last was that of the Moguls under
+Tamerlane, who in the beginning of the fifteenth
+century overran Georgia, Syria, and
+Anatolia, and spread them with slaughter and
+desolation. He also had been prepared for
+this incursion by his previous victories and
+conquests.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ex. Apoc.</span></span>, pp. 225, 226.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These armies, the number of which is literally
+<span class="tei tei-q">“myriads of myriads,”</span> were not all
+subsequent to the time when they had power
+to subject the Eastern Roman empire; but may
+be the four, from the fact that the Mohammedan
+power was extended by these armies, which
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page102">[pg 102]</span><a name="Pg102" id="Pg102" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+till this time had been restrained from accomplishing
+the subjugation of Constantinople.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The restraints being removed, they were
+now to have power to kill, by compelling the
+third part of men to embrace the doctrines of
+Mohammed,—evident reference being had to
+the men of the eastern empire; the conquest
+of which was now to be effected, the dial of
+heaven having indicated the arrival of the
+predicted epoch.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In 1449 Constantine Deacoses, being entitled
+to the throne of Constantinople by the
+death of John Paleologus, did not venture to
+take possession till he had sent ambassadors
+and gained the consent of Amurath, the Turkish
+Sultan. From this fact, Ducas, the historian,
+counts Paleologus as the last Greek
+emperor—for he did not consider as such, a
+prince who did not dare to reign without permission
+of his enemy. Amurath died and
+was succeeded in the empire, in 1451, by
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Mahomet II.</span></span>, who set his heart on Constantinople,
+and made preparations for besieging
+the city. The siege commenced on the 6th
+of April, 1453, and ended in the taking of the
+city, and death of the last of the Constantines,
+on the 16th of May following, when the
+eastern city of the Cæsars became the seat of
+the Ottoman empire; and its <span class="tei tei-q">“religion was
+trampled in the dust by the Moslem conquerors.”</span>
+Thus the two-horned beast (13:11),
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page103">[pg 103]</span><a name="Pg103" id="Pg103" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+became merged in, and identified with the false
+prophet, 16:13, and 19:20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The description of the horses, and those
+who sat on them (v. 17), is strikingly emblematic
+of the Turkish warriors who subjugated
+Constantinople. Says Dr. Keith:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The breast-plates of the horsemen, in reference
+to the more destructive implements of
+war, might then, for the first time, be said to
+be fire, and jacinth, and brimstone. The
+musket had recently supplied the place of the
+bow. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Fire</span></span> emanated from their breasts.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Brimstone</span></span>, the flame of which is <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">jacinth</span></span>,
+was an ingredient both of the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">liquid fire</span></span> and of
+gunpowder.... A new mode of warfare
+was at that time introduced, which has
+changed the nature of war itself, in regard to
+the form of its instrument of destruction; and
+sounds and sights unheard of and unknown
+before, were the death-knell and doom of the
+Roman empire. Invention outrivalled force,
+and a new power was introduced, that of
+musketry as well as of artillery, in the art of
+war, before which the old Macedonian phalanx
+would not have remained unbroken, nor
+the Roman legions stood. That which <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">John</span></span>
+saw <span class="tei tei-q">‘in the vision,’</span> is read in the history of
+the times.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+By these three, the fire, smoke, and brimstone,
+were the third part of men killed (v.
+18), and by these was the conquest of Constantinople
+effected. Says Gibbon: <span class="tei tei-q">“At the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page104">[pg 104]</span><a name="Pg104" id="Pg104" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+request of Mahomet II., Urban produced a
+piece of brass ordnance of stupendous and
+almost incredible magnitude. A measure of
+twelve palms was assigned to the bore, and
+the stone bullet weighed about six hundred
+pounds. A vacant place before the new palace
+was chosen for the first experiment; but
+to prevent the sudden and mischievous effects
+of astonishment and fear, a proclamation was
+issued that the cannon would be discharged
+the ensuing day. The explosion was felt or
+heard in a circuit of a hundred furlongs; the
+ball, by the force of the gunpowder, was driven
+about a mile, and on the spot where it fell,
+it buried itself a fathom deep in the ground.
+For the conveyance of this destructive engine,
+a frame or carriage of thirty wagons was
+linked together, and drawn along by a train
+of sixty oxen; two hundred men, on both
+sides, were stationed to poise or support the
+rolling weight; two hundred and fifty workmen
+marched before to smooth the way and
+repair the bridges, and near two months were
+employed in a laborious journey of a hundred
+and fifty miles.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In the siege, the incessant volleys of
+lances and arrows were accompanied with the
+smoke, the sound, and the fire of their musketry
+and cannon. Their small arms discharged
+at the same time five or even ten
+balls of lead of the size of a walnut, and according
+to the closeness of the ranks, and the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page105">[pg 105]</span><a name="Pg105" id="Pg105" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+force of the powder, several breast-plates and
+bodies were transpierced by the same shot.
+But the Turkish approaches were soon sunk
+into trenches, or covered with ruins. Each
+day added to the science of the Christians,
+but their inadequate stock of gunpowder
+was wasted in the operation of each day.
+Their ordnance was not powerful either in
+size or number, and if they possessed some
+heavy cannon, they feared to plant them on
+the walls, lest the aged structure should be
+shaken and overthrown by the explosion.
+The same destructive secret had been revealed
+to the Moslems, by whom it was employed
+with the superior energy of zeal, riches, and
+despotism. The great cannon of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Mahomet</span></span>
+was flanked by two fellows almost of equal
+magnitude: the long order of the Turkish
+artillery was pointed against the walls: fourteen
+batteries thundered at once on the most
+accessible places, and of one of these it is ambiguously
+expressed that it was mounted with
+one hundred and thirty guns, or that it discharged
+one hundred and thirty bullets.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The conquest of Constantinople being accomplished,
+they were to have power to kill
+men during an hour, day, month, and year
+of prophetic time—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> three hundred and
+ninety-one years, fifteen days. If reckoned
+from the conquest of the city, this would extend
+to June 1844. Whether any particular
+act has transpired to mark the precise point
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page106">[pg 106]</span><a name="Pg106" id="Pg106" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of its termination, may not be important; but
+it is interesting to consider that within a
+few years the Mohammedan government has
+formally granted permission for the full enjoyment
+of the Protestant religion; and has
+renounced the right of punishing by death,
+apostates from Islamism.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In August 1843, an Armenian, who had
+become a Mussulman and subsequently returned
+to the religion of his fathers, was beheaded
+at Constantinople. The Christian
+powers of Europe immediately remonstrated,
+and it was hoped that the law against apostates
+from Mohammedanism would be permitted
+to become a dead letter. In a few
+months, however, a firman issued from the
+government ordering the decapitation of a
+young man near Brooza, who was put to
+death for having promised in a passion, but
+had afterwards refused, to become a Mohammedan.
+Lord Aberdeen, the British Secretary
+of Foreign Affairs, then demanded of the
+Turkish Sultan that the Porte should not
+insult and trample on Christianity, <span class="tei tei-q">“by treating
+as a criminal any person who embraces
+it;”</span> but should <span class="tei tei-q">“renounce, absolutely and
+without equivocation, the barbarous practice
+which has called forth the remonstrance now
+addressed to it.”</span> To this communication the
+following answer was made early in 1844:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Sublime Porte engages to take effectual
+measures to prevent, henceforward, the execution
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page107">[pg 107]</span><a name="Pg107" id="Pg107" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and putting to death of the Christian
+who is an apostate.”</span> On the 15th of November,
+1847, for the first time, a firman was
+issued recognizing Protestant Christians as a
+distinct community, forbidding any molestation
+or interference <span class="tei tei-q">“in their temporal or
+spiritual concerns,”</span> and permitting them <span class="tei tei-q">“to
+exercise the profession of their creed in security.”</span>
+This coming from the Vizier, did
+not necessarily survive a change of ministry;
+but in November, 1850, a firman was issued
+from the Sultan himself, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">establishing</span></em> the policy
+of the empire in respect to Protestants, and
+confirming them in all needed civil and religious
+privileges. Thus has the Mohammedan
+government formally and forever renounced
+the power it had so long wielded, of causing
+spiritual death by compelling men to apostatize
+from Christianity.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The rest of the men not killed, must be
+those in portions of the Roman territory not
+included in the eastern third. The Roman
+Catholics in the western parts, were not reformed
+by the judgments inflicted on the east.
+They continued to worship the canonized
+dead, and to bow down to images of the
+saints. Under this trumpet, a mighty movement
+was to be there effected, which was
+symbolized by the descent of:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page108">[pg 108]</span><a name="Pg108" id="Pg108" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Rainbow Angel.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw another mighty angel descending from
+heaven, clothed with a cloud: and the rainbow was over
+his head, and his face was like the sun, and his feet like
+pillars of fire; and he had in his hand a little book opened:
+and he set his right foot on the sea, and his left foot on the
+land. And shouted with a loud voice, as a lion roareth:
+and when he shouted, seven thunders uttered their voices.
+And when the seven thunders had uttered their voices, I was
+about to write: and I heard a voice from heaven saying, Seal
+up those things, which the seven thunders uttered, and write
+them not. And the angel, whom I saw standing on the sea and
+on the land, raised his hand to heaven, and swore by him who
+liveth for ever and ever, who created heaven, and the things
+in it, and the earth, and the things in it, and the sea, and the
+things in it, that the time should not yet be; but in the days
+of the voice of the seventh angel, when he will sound, the
+secret of God will be finished, as he hath announced to his
+servants the prophets. And the voice, which I heard from
+heaven, spoke with me again, and said, Go, take the little
+book, which is opened in the hand of the angel, who standeth
+on the sea and on the land. And I went away to the
+angel, and said to him, Give me the little book. And he
+said to me, Take, and eat it up; and it will make thy stomach
+bitter, but in thy mouth, it will be sweet as honey.
+And I took the little book from the angel's hand, and ate it
+up; and it was in my mouth sweet as honey: and when I
+had eaten it my stomach was bitter. And he said to me,
+Thou must prophesy again concerning many people, and
+nations, and tongues, and kings.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 10:1-11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This angel, like those in corresponding passages,
+must symbolize a body of men, whose
+importance is indicated by the might and
+splendor of the symbol.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His descent from heaven, the cloud, the
+rainbow, the sun-like face, and the fire-like
+feet of the Mighty Messenger, attest the heaven-inspired
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page109">[pg 109]</span><a name="Pg109" id="Pg109" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+origin of his utterances. His
+<span class="tei tei-q">“eyes as a flame of fire, and his feet like unto
+fine brass, as if they burned in a furnace,”</span>
+would not be given to one who came to announce
+other than heaven-inspired truths.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">open book</span></em> in the hand of the angel,
+fixes the chronology of the fulfilment of this
+vision at an epoch when the Scriptures cease
+to be a closed and sealed book, and the people
+are permitted to have free access to them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">position</span></em>—one foot resting on the sea,
+and one on the land—attests the universality
+of the movement which is to date from that
+epoch.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His lion voice, must symbolize the manner
+in which would be announced the great truths,
+at which the whole world would be startled.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">singleness</span></em> of his cry, is also symbolic
+of the simplicity of the truth, which is
+never symbolized by discordant multitudinous
+sounds.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">responsive thunders</span></em>, unlike the single
+voice of the angel, are multitudinous and discordant;
+and consequently symbolize errors.
+Their <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">following</span></em> so immediately on the shout
+of the angel, shows the proximity of their
+promulgation to the utterance of the truths to
+which they are responsive.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">John's</span></span> <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">readiness to write</span></em> what the seven
+thunders uttered, shows that what they uttered
+was <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">professedly</span></em> in harmony with the
+truths previously announced, and that men
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page110">[pg 110]</span><a name="Pg110" id="Pg110" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+would be liable to be deceived, by their promulgation.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His being <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">forbidden</span></em> by the cloud-robed angel,
+to write what they uttered—while he
+was commanded to <span class="tei tei-q">“seal not the sayings of
+the prophecy of this book”</span> (22:10),—shows
+that their utterances were not heaven-inspired,
+and constituted no part of <span class="tei tei-q">“the word of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>,
+and of the testimony of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Jesus Christ</span></span>,”</span> which
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">John</span></span> bare record of.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">subsequent oath</span></em> of the angel, by Him
+who liveth forever, that <span class="tei tei-q">“the time is not yet,”</span>
+shows that those thunders, however erroneous
+in their form manner and connection with
+other errors, had respect to some great event
+foretold in Scripture; but which the thunders
+had <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">antedated</span></em> and presented in an <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">unscriptural</span></em>
+form.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His further announcement that it would be
+fulfilled under the sounding of the <span class="tei tei-q">“seventh
+trumpet,”</span> and that then the mystery of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>
+should be finished in the manner foretold to
+his servants the prophets, shows that the great
+event, the time of which was <span class="tei tei-q">“not yet,”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>,
+under the sixth trumpet, was the coming of
+the kingdom of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>—the fifth universal empire;
+that at a period anterior to the time
+when it might rationally be expected, it would
+be proclaimed in a form repugnant to the
+teachings of the prophets; and that when thus
+heralded, it would be met by the party uttering
+the heaven-inspired truths, with the denial
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page111">[pg 111]</span><a name="Pg111" id="Pg111" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+that the time had arrived, and by arguments
+to show its true nature and epoch, under the
+seventh trumpet.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The command to take and eat the little
+book, shows that its contents were such as the
+soul might feed on; which should be sweet to
+the believer's taste, but would subject him to
+bitter persecution. And the announcement
+that they were to prophesy <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">again</span></em> before many
+nations and peoples and tongues and kings,
+marks this as the commencement of an era
+when the Gospel should again begin to go
+forth into distant lands.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+All of the above particulars harmonize in
+the time of the reformation of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Luther</span></span> in the
+sixteenth century, and with no other epoch.
+The great truths then promulgated, of which
+<span class="tei tei-q">“justification by faith”</span> was the cardinal one,
+electrified the whole world, as the loud roaring
+of a lion would startle the passer-by.
+These were immediately responded to by the
+multitudinous errors of the Anabaptists and
+others, who thought to set up the kingdom of
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span> in
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">this world</span></em>, and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">before the resurrection</span></em>,
+by putting to death the ungodly and sparing
+only the saints.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As in all efforts for good Satan is careful to
+attempt a counterfeit, or to mingle impure
+elements to the injury of the truth, so in
+the Reformation there were false reformers.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Thomas Munzer</span></span>, and others, in 1525, incited
+vast numbers on the borders of the Danube to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page112">[pg 112]</span><a name="Pg112" id="Pg112" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+make physical war on the Papal ecclesiastics.
+He denounced <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Luther</span></span>, also, with the same
+violence that he did the Pope. In his mad
+attempt to slay the ungodly, he took possession
+of Muhlhausen, appointed a new city
+council, pillaged the houses of the rich, proclaimed
+a community of goods, and committed
+various excesses; but they were finally defeated
+in a pitched battle, with a loss of from
+five thousand to seven thousand killed. Others
+succeeded him, teaching that <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span> spake to them
+in person, instructing them how to act. They
+professed the most extravagant doctrines, setting
+aside both <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Luther</span></span> and the Bible. The
+former did not go near far enough for them;
+and the latter was in their view insufficient
+for man's instruction, who could only be
+taught of God. They taught that the world
+was to be immediately devastated; and no
+priest or ungodly person be left alive; and
+that then the kingdom of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span> would commence,
+and the saints possess the earth.
+Those who adhered to <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Luther</span></span>, united with
+him in bearing a faithful testimony against
+such extravagances, adhered to the written
+word, denounced new revelations, and showed
+from the Bible that Antichrist was to be overthrown
+by the personal advent of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Christ</span></span>, and
+not by the sword of man. The following
+extracts are from <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Mr. Lord</span></span>:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The pretences of the Anabaptists to inspiration
+were in like manner denounced by
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page113">[pg 113]</span><a name="Pg113" id="Pg113" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Melancthon. <span class="tei tei-q">‘The Anabaptists, infatuated by
+the devil, have boasted a new species of
+sanctity, as though they had left the earth,
+and ascended to the skies; and given out,
+moreover, that they enjoy extraordinary inspiration.
+But as the pretence was hypocritical,
+and designed merely to subserve appetite
+and ambition, they soon plunged into debauchery,
+and then excited seditions, and undertook
+to establish a New Jerusalem, as other enthusiasts
+have often attempted. A like tragedy
+was formerly acted at Pepuza in Phrygia,
+which fanatical prophets denominated the
+new Jerusalem.’</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“He also refuted by the Scriptures, the
+expectation of the Anabaptists of the immediate
+establishment of Christ's millennial kingdom.
+He regarded the term Antichrist as
+denoting both the Mohammedan empire and
+the Papacy, and held that they were not to be
+overthrown till the time of the resurrection of
+the dead, and that a considerable period was
+to pass before that event. <span class="tei tei-q">‘God showed to
+Daniel a series of monarchies and kingdoms,
+which it is certain has already run to the end.
+Four monarchies have passed away. The
+cruel kingdom of the Turks, which arose out
+of the fourth, still remains, and as it is not to
+equal the Roman in power, and has certainly,
+therefore, already nearly reached its height,
+must soon decline, and then will dawn the
+day in which the dead shall be recalled to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page114">[pg 114]</span><a name="Pg114" id="Pg114" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+life.’</span> He then repeats the saying ascribed to
+Elias, that six thousand years were to pass
+before the advent of Christ; two thousand
+before the law, two under the law, and two
+under the gospel; and proceeds to show that
+four hundred and fifty-eight years were,
+therefore, to intervene before the advent of
+the Redeemer, the destruction of Antichrist,
+and the establishment of the kingdom of the
+saints. <span class="tei tei-q">‘It is known that Christ was born
+about the end of the fourth millenary,<a id="noteref_1" name="noteref_1" href="#note_1"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">1</span></span></a> and
+one thousand five hundred and forty-two
+years have since revolved. We are not,
+therefore [in 1542], far from the end.’</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“These views corresponding so conspicuously
+with the symbol, continued to be repeated by
+a crowd of writers, till at the distance of sixty-seven
+years from the death of Melancthon,
+the celebrated Joseph Mede published his
+<span class="tei tei-q">‘Clavis Apocalyptica,’</span> in which he showed
+from the coincidence of the periods of the
+wild beast and the witnesses, that the advent
+of the Redeemer, and the destruction of the
+anti-Christian powers were not to be expected
+until twelve hundred and sixty years had
+passed from the rise of the ten kingdoms, and
+that near one hundred of them, therefore, were
+still to revolve. As that period expired and
+the knowledge of the prophecy advanced, the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page115">[pg 115]</span><a name="Pg115" id="Pg115" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+catastrophe of the wild beast was referred to
+a later time. Many recent expositors regard
+the twelve hundred and sixty years as having
+reached their end in 1792; and most refer the
+fall of the anti-Christian powers to the last
+half of the present, or the beginning of the
+next century.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ex. of Apoc.</span></span>, pp. 238-240.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+All the vagaries of the various sects of
+heretics were connected with an expectation
+of the immediate establishment of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Christ's</span></span>
+kingdom. That the seven thunders gave
+utterance to such an expectation, is evident
+from the response of the angel, when he lifted
+up his hand to heaven and with the solemnity
+of an oath, by Him who liveth forever,
+affirmed that <span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the time should not yet be</span></em>;”</span>
+but that <span class="tei tei-q">“in the days of the voice of the
+seventh angel, when he delays to sound,<a id="noteref_2" name="noteref_2" href="#note_2"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">2</span></span></a> the
+secret of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span> will be finished, as he hath
+announced to his servants the prophets.”</span>
+Why such an annunciation at this stage of
+the vision? It must be to correct a misapprehension
+which would exist at a corresponding
+time in its fulfilment, respecting the
+immediate appearance of the kingdom. Thus
+did <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Paul</span></span> correct the Thessalonian brethren,
+when he wrote to them in his second epistle
+not to be shaken in mind, as that the day of
+the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Lord</span></span> was then impending, 2 Th. 2:2.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Bible, was, at this epoch, first opened
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page116">[pg 116]</span><a name="Pg116" id="Pg116" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+to the common people. Before, it was only
+found in languages which they were entirely
+ignorant of. It was translated by <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Luther</span></span> into
+their own language, and thus made accessible.
+The art of printing, discovered at about
+that time, enabled all who wished, to avail
+themselves of its unsealed contents. They
+feasted on the words of inspiration, which
+were sweeter to them than honey, or the honey-comb.
+But afterwards, they had to endure bitterness
+for the sake of the Gospel. Divisions
+and subdivisions followed, parties multiplied,
+and heresies abounded, accompanied
+with bitter and mischievous discussions, and
+fierce and rancorous contentions. These being
+based on the understanding which the several
+parties attached to portions of scripture, were
+fitly symbolized by the bitterness that followed
+the eating of the book. At this time,
+also, was revived a system of religious teachings
+which has gone forth into many lands.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The reörganization of the church at this
+epoch, is next symbolized.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Measuring Reed, Temple, &amp;c.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And there was given me a measuring reed like a rod,
+and it was said, Arise, and measure the temple of God,
+(and the altar,) and those who worship in it. But the
+court which is without the temple, leave out, and measure
+it not; for it is given to the Gentiles: and they will tread
+the holy city under foot
+forty-two months.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 11:1, 2.
+</span></div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page117">[pg 117]</span><a name="Pg117" id="Pg117" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These symbols are evidently taken from
+the temple and altar of Jewish worship, and
+represent corresponding analogies under the
+Christian dispensation.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To measure anything, is to examine and
+take notice of its parts and proportions; and
+that by which it is measured, is the standard
+or rule to which it should conform.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The temple, is a proper symbol of the
+church of God; which is <span class="tei tei-q">“built upon the
+foundation of the apostles and prophets, Jesus
+Christ himself being the Chief Corner Stone,
+in whom all the building, fitly framed together,
+groweth unto a holy temple in the Lord,”</span>
+Eph. 2:20, 21.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+At the epoch of the Reformation, the nominal
+church was subjected to the scrutiny of
+the word of God; and its pretensions were
+measured by the scriptural rule. The reformers
+found the Man of Sin, <span class="tei tei-q">“as God sitting
+in the temple of God,”</span> (2 Thess. 2:4);
+and they had to re-model their church relationship,
+in accordance with the pattern presented
+in the New Testament. This involved
+the consideration of what constituted the
+church,—its organization, its ministry, its
+sacraments, and its membership,—their mutual
+relation to God, and to each other.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The altar, must symbolize the sacrifice
+and atonement of Christ,—the <span class="tei tei-q">“altar whereof
+they have no right to eat which serve the
+tabernacle,”</span> Heb. 13:10. The great question,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page118">[pg 118]</span><a name="Pg118" id="Pg118" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of justification by faith in the death of
+Christ, was the rallying cry of the Reformation.
+The fundamental principles of Christian
+truth were then unfolded anew, and the
+doctrines of the Papacy, including the sacrifice
+of the mass, were rejected as contrary to
+Bible teachings.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The worshippers in the temple, who were to
+be measured by the same rule, are Christians.
+All who were to be recognized as such, were
+to give evidence of conformity to the Bible
+standard. Regeneration by the Holy Ghost,
+was held by the reformers to be necessary to
+church membership. The Papists required
+only baptism and confirmation.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The court without the temple, was that to
+which the Gentiles had access, and beyond
+which their entrance was prohibited. Devout
+foreigners were there permitted to pay their
+devotions to the God of heaven. As the
+Gentiles must symbolize those who are not
+Christians, the occupants of the outer court,
+must be the congregation—the nominal worshippers
+who throng the outer courts of the
+Lord, in distinction from the true worshippers.
+Such were to have free and unrestricted access
+to the places of Christian worship.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The holy city is that in which the temple is
+situated, and must embrace the church as a
+whole, subjected to Gentile rule. Its being
+trodden under foot, indicates that the civil
+polity under which the church would subsist,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page119">[pg 119]</span><a name="Pg119" id="Pg119" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+should, during the period specified, be under
+the control of those who worship only in the
+outer court.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The forty and two months, is a period of
+time, corresponding with the thousand two
+hundred and three score days of the verse
+following, the time and times and half a time
+of Rev. 12:14, and the corresponding periods
+of Rev. 12:6; 13:5; Dan. 7:25; and 12:7;
+symbolizing a period of twelve hundred and
+sixty years, according to the almost unanimous
+opinion of Protestant writers.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This period does not commence with this
+epoch, but began with the subjection of Christianity
+to the power of the civil arm, which
+was to continue during the time predicted,—notwithstanding
+the reädjustment of the temple-worship,—when
+Christians should cease
+to be responsible to any human tribunal for
+the orthodoxy of their faith.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+During the same period, also, power to
+prophesy, though shrouded in sackcloth, was
+to be given to:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Christ's Two Witnesses.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I will give charge to my two witnesses, and they
+will prophesy one thousand two hundred sixty days, clothed
+in sackcloth. These are the two olive-trees, and the
+two lamp-stands, standing before the Lord of the earth.
+And if any one wisheth to injure them, fire proceedeth from
+their mouth, and devoureth their enemies: and if anyone
+wisheth to injure them, he must thus be killed. These
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page120">[pg 120]</span><a name="Pg120" id="Pg120" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+have power to shut heaven, that it may not rain in the
+days of their prophecy: and they have power over the
+waters to turn them to blood, and to smite the earth with
+every plague, as often as they wish. And when they shall
+have finished their testimony, the wild beast that ascendeth
+out of the abyss will make war with them, and will overcome
+them, and kill them. And their dead body </span><em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-size: 90%; font-style: italic">will lie</span></em><span style="font-size: 90%">
+on the wide street of the great city, which is spiritually
+called Sodom and Egypt, where also their Lord was crucified.
+And those of the people, and tribes, and tongues, and
+nations, will see their dead body three days and a half, and
+will not allow their dead body to be put into a tomb.
+And those, who dwell on the earth, will rejoice over them,
+and exult, and send gifts to each other; because these
+two prophets tormented those, who dwell on the earth.
+And after the three days and a half the Spirit of life from
+God entered them, and they stood on their feet; and great
+fear fell on those, who saw them. And they heard a great
+voice from heaven, saying to them, Ascend here! And
+they ascended into heaven in a cloud; and their enemies
+saw them. And in that hour there was a great earthquake,
+and the tenth part of the city fell, and in the
+earthquake seven thousand names of men were slain: and
+the remnant became terrified, and gave glory to the God
+of heaven. The second woe is past away; behold, the third
+woe cometh quickly.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 11:3-14.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The two witnesses are not symbolically
+exhibited, but are referred to by an elliptical
+metaphor, and are explained to be the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“two olive-trees, and the two candlesticks.”</span>
+Therefore, they are not two living men, as
+some suppose, shown to John in vision, symbolizing
+analogous agents; but their nature is
+to be determined by a consideration of the
+olive-trees and candlesticks which symbolize
+them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Candlesticks symbolize churches. Thus
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page121">[pg 121]</span><a name="Pg121" id="Pg121" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the Saviour said to John: <span class="tei tei-q">“The seven candlesticks
+which thou sawest are the seven
+churches,”</span> 1:20. When <span class="tei tei-q">“men light a candle,”</span>
+they put <span class="tei tei-q">“it on a candlestick, and it
+giveth light unto all that are in the house,”</span>
+Matt. 5:15. The candlestick does not originate,
+but sustains the light in a position to be
+seen and exert a beneficial influence. It is
+thus that the church is said to be <span class="tei tei-q">“the light
+of the world,”</span> and is required to let her light
+<span class="tei tei-q">“shine before men,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+vs. 14-16,—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>
+She is to disseminate the light committed to
+her; and in so doing, she becomes a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">witness</span></em> for
+Jesus.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The church comprises all the holy persons
+who have lived on earth, and is symbolized
+by two candlesticks, corresponding to the two
+dispensations of its existence. Those who
+lived under the former dispensation, are called
+<span class="tei tei-q">“a great cloud of witnesses,”</span> Heb. 12:1.
+Of Christ, <span class="tei tei-q">“give all the prophets witness,”</span>
+Acts 10:43. They constitute the voice of
+the church in that age. Under the gospel
+dispensation, also, Christ had chosen witnesses
+of himself. He said to his disciples,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Ye shall be witnesses unto me, both in
+Jerusalem and in all Judea, and in Samaria,
+and unto the uttermost parts of the earth,”</span>
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 1:8); and they said, <span class="tei tei-q">“We are his witnesses,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 5:32. <span class="tei tei-q">“We are witnesses of
+all things which he did, ... witnesses
+chosen before of God,”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 10:39-41);—<span class="tei tei-q">“his
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page122">[pg 122]</span><a name="Pg122" id="Pg122" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+witnesses unto the people,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 13:31.
+They and their successors have <span class="tei tei-q">“testified and
+preached the word of the Lord,”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 8:25),
+overcoming <span class="tei tei-q">“by the word of their testimony,”</span>
+(Rev. 12:11),—many of them being <span class="tei tei-q">“slain
+for the word of God, and for the testimony
+which they held,”</span> 6:9. The church, one in
+all ages, symbolized by the two candlesticks,
+is thus a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">witness</span></em> of Jesus.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The two olive-trees, symbolize the other
+witness, which must sustain a relation to the
+church, analogous to that sustained by the
+olive-trees to the candlesticks. The declaration,
+that the witnesses are <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the</span></em> two olive-trees
+and candlesticks, implies the existence of some
+previous symbolization, where those objects
+and their relation to each other are presented.
+And the connection shows clearly that reference
+is made to the vision, wherein Zechariah
+beheld <span class="tei tei-q">“a candlestick all of gold, with a bowl
+upon the top of it, and his seven lamps thereon,
+and seven pipes to the seven lamps, which
+are upon the top thereof; and two olive-trees
+by it, one upon the right side of the bowl, and
+the other upon the left side thereof,”</span> Zech.
+4:2, 3. The relation which the olive-trees
+sustain to the candlestick, is shown by the
+questions of the prophet: <span class="tei tei-q">“What are these,
+my Lord?”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> v. 4); <span class="tei tei-q">“What are these
+two olive-trees upon the right side of the
+candlestick and upon the left side thereof?
+What be these two olive-branches which
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page123">[pg 123]</span><a name="Pg123" id="Pg123" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+through the two golden pipes empty the
+golden oil out of themselves?”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> vs. 11, 12.
+The office of the olive-trees, was to supply
+the candlestick with oil which alone enabled
+them to give light. The oil of the olive-tree,
+was burned before the Lord continually.
+The light committed to the church, is the
+truth of God's word. And thus the angel
+explains the meaning of the olive-trees:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“This is the word of the Lord unto Zerubbabel,”</span>
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> v. 6); <span class="tei tei-q">“These are the two
+anointed ones [<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">mar</span></span>, sons of oil], that stand
+by the Lord of the whole earth,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> v. 14.
+And this expression, corresponding with that
+in Rev. 11:4, shows that this vision of
+Zechariah is the one referred to, and that it is
+explanatory of the witnesses.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Scriptures, as well as the church,
+testify of Christ: <span class="tei tei-q">“Search the Scriptures,”</span>
+said the Saviour, speaking of those then
+written; <span class="tei tei-q">“they are they which <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">testify</span></em> [or
+bear witness] of me,”</span> (John 5:39); and
+of the New Testament, he said: <span class="tei tei-q">“This gospel
+of the kingdom shall be preached in all
+the world for a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">witness</span></em> unto all nations,”</span>
+Matt. 24:4. Like two olive-trees supplying
+the candlesticks with oil, the Scriptures of the
+Old, and of the New Testament give light
+to the church, and testify of Christ. They
+stand on either side of him,—the one beginning
+with the creation and pointing to a
+Messiah to come, testifying of him by types
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page124">[pg 124]</span><a name="Pg124" id="Pg124" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and shadows; and the other looking back to
+the death and resurrection of Christ, and
+cheering the heart of the believer by the evidence
+of his second coming at the end of the
+world. Thus stood within the oracle of the
+temple the two cherubim, which Solomon
+made <span class="tei tei-q">“of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">olive-tree</span></em>,”</span> and whose wings met
+over the ark of the covenant: <span class="tei tei-q">“He set the
+cherubim within the inner house, and they
+stretched forth the wings of the cherubim,
+so that the wing of the one touched the one
+wall, and the wing of the other cherub
+touched the other wall; and their wings
+touched one another in the midst of the
+house,”</span> 1 Kings 6, 27. Thus symbolized, the
+Scriptures and the church are Christ's two
+witnesses.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To prophesy, is to make known the truths
+of God. Thus, at the epoch of the Reformation,
+they were to prophesy <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">again</span></em> before
+many peoples, and nations, and tongues and
+kings, 10:11. It was to enable the witnesses
+to do this, that the necessary power
+was to be given them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Sackcloth, is a symbol of humiliation and
+sorrow; and the witnesses being thus clothed,
+indicates that during the time specified, they
+should be in a despised and oppressed condition.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The one thousand two hundred and sixty
+days, symbolize years. God said to Israel,
+after the evil report of the twelve spies:
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page125">[pg 125]</span><a name="Pg125" id="Pg125" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Your children shall wander in the wilderness
+forty <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">years</span></em> ... after the number of the
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">days</span></em> which ye searched the land,”</span> Num. 14:33,
+34. And to Ezekiel, <span class="tei tei-q">“This shall be a
+sign to the house of Israel: Lie thou upon
+thy left side, and lay the iniquity of the house
+of Israel upon it, ... for I have laid upon
+thee the years of their iniquity, according to
+the number of the days, three hundred and
+ninety days.... And when thou hast accomplished
+them, lie again on thy right side,
+and thou shalt bear the iniquity of the house
+of Judah forty days: I have appointed thee
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">each day for a year</span></em>,”</span> Ezek. 4:3-6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This period of one thousand two hundred
+and sixty years, is not the whole time in
+which the witnesses prophesy, but marks the
+duration of their prophesying in sackcloth.
+It commenced when the light of the Bible
+began to be obscured by the secondary place
+which was accorded to it in the estimation of
+the Papal church, and the living witnesses
+were no longer permitted to preach the gospel
+in its purity.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 533, the Emperor Justinian,
+wrote a letter to the Pope declaring him to be
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the head of all the holy churches,”</span> and
+subjecting to his control <span class="tei tei-q">“all the priests of
+the whole East.”</span> By the edicts and mandates
+of Justinian, who was master of the Roman
+world, the supremacy of the Pope received
+the fullest sanction; and the highest authorities
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page126">[pg 126]</span><a name="Pg126" id="Pg126" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+among the civilians and annalists of
+Rome, refer to these as evidence of the
+right of the Pope to the title of <span class="tei tei-q">“Universal
+Bishop,”</span> and date it from A. D. 533. p. <a href="#Pg200" class="tei tei-ref">200</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With this supremacy, the power of the
+Papacy commenced. The Bible was permitted
+only in a dead language, and the
+faithful Christian was obliged to seek refuge
+in the wilderness. False doctrines obscuring
+the Bible, and persecuting enactments oppressing
+the church, clothed the witnesses in sackcloth;
+and thus only did they testify, till the
+power of the papacy was broken.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Fire proceeded out of their mouth, when
+they made known the fiery judgments predicted
+in the Scriptures against all their
+enemies. And they shut heaven, smite with
+plagues, turn water to blood, &amp;c., when, in
+accordance with the inspired record, are fulfilled
+the predictions which, in various places,
+are thus symbolized.—See Rev. 15:6; 16:4,
+&amp;c.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The finishing of their testimony, refers to
+the termination of the sackcloth period,—twelve
+hundred and sixty years from A. D. 533; <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>
+in 1793,—if the former date is correct.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The beast that ascendeth out of the bottomless
+pit, is that on which, in a subsequent
+vision, the woman is seated, 17:7, 8. John
+saw this beast arise out of the sea, (13:1);
+and the subsequent exposition given of it, will
+show that it symbolized the civil power of the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page127">[pg 127]</span><a name="Pg127" id="Pg127" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Roman empire in its divided form.—See p.
+<a href="#Pg169" class="tei tei-ref">169</a>. As the ten kingdoms constitute the beast,
+what is done by any of these kingdoms, is
+done by the beast. France was one of the
+more prominent of these kingdoms, and at one
+period, under Napoleon, controlled the greater
+portion of the whole.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To war against the witnesses, is to oppose,
+resist, and endeavor to crush them; and to
+overcome them, is to be successful in such
+efforts.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To kill, when used symbolically and applied
+to Christians, is to cause them to apostatize—producing
+spiritual death, 9:5. When
+applied to the Scriptures, it can only denote
+their prohibition.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The great city, as shown in connection with
+Rev. 16:19, p. 290, is the Roman hierarchy:—symbolized
+by Babylon, and <span class="tei tei-q">“spiritually
+called Sodom and Egypt.”</span> By being thus
+<span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">spiritually</span></em> called Sodom,”</span> some understand
+that it is a <span class="tei tei-q">“spiritual Sodom,”</span> &amp;c., which
+would be a contradiction of terms; others
+understand that it is called <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">figuratively</span></em> by
+those names, and deduce from it an argument
+for spiritualizing the Scriptures; but the use of
+the word <span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">spiritually</span></em>,”</span> it is believed, will not
+sanction any such meaning. It occurs only
+in two other passages:—in Rom. 8:7, to be
+<span class="tei tei-q">“spiritually minded,”</span> is to have a mind in
+accordance with the will of the Spirit; and in
+1 Cor. 2:14, things <span class="tei tei-q">“spiritually discerned,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page128">[pg 128]</span><a name="Pg128" id="Pg128" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+signifies that they are discerned by the aid of
+the Spirit. The great city, then, is called by
+the Spirit, <span class="tei tei-q">“Sodom and Egypt;”</span> and is so
+called because of her licentiousness and idolatries,
+and her subjecting the saints to bondage.
+To crucify the Lord afresh, is to apostatize
+from his teachings, Heb. 6:6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In 1793, twelve hundred and sixty years
+from the date of the Papal supremacy, the
+Bible was abolished in France, by the solemn
+decree of the government, which declared that
+the nation acknowledged no God. A copy of
+the Bible could not be found in a single bookstore
+in Paris. Inquiry also was made for it in
+Rome, in <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">all</span></em> the book establishments of that
+city, and the invariable reply was, that it was
+prohibited. All the churches of Paris were
+shut, and the church plate was declared the
+property of the nation. Professors of religion,
+at the same time, in large numbers openly
+apostatized and embraced infidelity. Says
+Dr. Croley:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“On the 1st of November, 1793, Gobet,
+with the republican priests of Paris, had
+thrown off the gown and abjured religion.
+On the 11th, a <span class="tei tei-q">‘grand festival,’</span> dedicated to
+<span class="tei tei-q">‘Reason and Truth,’</span> was celebrated instead
+of divine service in the ancient cathedral of
+Notre Dame, which had been desecrated, and
+been named, <span class="tei tei-q">‘the Temple of Reason;’</span> a pyramid
+was erected in the centre of the church,
+surmounted by a temple, inscribed, <span class="tei tei-q">‘To Philosophy.’</span>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page129">[pg 129]</span><a name="Pg129" id="Pg129" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+The torch of <span class="tei tei-q">‘Truth’</span> was on the
+altar of <span class="tei tei-q">‘Reason,’</span> spreading light, &amp;c. The
+National Convention, and all the authorities,
+attended at this burlesque and insulting ceremony.
+In February, 1794, a grand fête was
+ordered by the convention, in which hymns
+to Liberty were chanted, and a pageant in
+honor of the abolition of slavery in the colonies,
+was displayed in the <span class="tei tei-q">‘Temple of Reason.’</span>
+In June another festival was ordered—to
+the Supreme Being: the God of Philosophy.
+But the most superb exhibition was
+the <span class="tei tei-q">‘general festival,’</span> in honor of the republic.
+It was distinguished by a more audacious
+spirit of scoffing and profanation than the
+former. Robespierre acted the <span class="tei tei-q">‘high-priest of
+Reason’</span> on the day, and made himself conspicuous
+in blasphemy. He was then at
+the summit of power,—actual sovereign of
+France.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The dead bodies of the witnesses, would be
+their existence in that prohibited condition,
+when, in France, neither the Scriptures, nor
+the church showed any symptoms of life. In
+the street, would be the conspicuous and public
+manner in which indignities should be
+heaped on them. France had been one of the
+principal states yielding homage to the Roman
+church. Surrounding nations beheld, but
+would not permit the extermination of the
+Bible and Christianity.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page130">[pg 130]</span><a name="Pg130" id="Pg130" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The French made merry over their blasphemous
+work. Says Dr. Croley:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“A very remarkable and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">prophetic</span></em> distinction
+of this period, was the spirit of frenzied
+festivity which seized upon France. The
+capital, and all the republican towns, were
+the scene of civic feasts, processions, and
+shows of the most extravagant kind. The
+most festive times of peace under the most
+expensive kings were thrown into the shade
+by the frequency, variety, and extent of the
+republican exhibitions. Yet this was a time
+of perpetual miseries throughout France. The
+guillotine was bloody from morn till night.
+In the single month of July, 1794, nearly <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">eight
+hundred persons</span></em>, the majority, principal individuals
+of the state, and all possessing some
+respectability of situation, were guillotined in
+Paris alone. In the midst of this horror, there
+were twenty-six theatres open, filled with the
+most profane and profligate displays in honor
+of the <span class="tei tei-q">‘triumph of reason.’</span> ”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In Lyons a Bible was tied to the tail of an
+ass and dragged in a procession through the
+streets of that city. Thus they rejoiced over
+the supposed end of religion in France; and
+congratulated themselves that the terrors of
+God's word, and the church would no more
+torment them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“After three days and a half,”</span> would be
+that number of years from the suppression of
+Christianity in November, 1793. On the 17th
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page131">[pg 131]</span><a name="Pg131" id="Pg131" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+day of June, 1797, three and a half years from
+the abolition of the Bible and religious worship,
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Camille Jourdan</span></span>, in the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Council of Five
+Hundred</span></span>, brought up the memorable report
+on the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Revision of the Laws Relative to Religious
+Worship</span></span>, by which France gave permission
+to all citizens to buy or hire edifices
+for the free exercise of it; repealing all opposing
+laws, and subjecting those to a heavy fine
+who should in any way impede or interrupt
+any religious service. The Bible and the
+church again stood erect, to the dismay of
+all who had rejoiced over their overthrow.
+Those two witnesses were again in a position
+to resume their testimony.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They were not only to be thus restored, but
+were to be elevated far above their former
+position. Since that epoch, have been made
+all those great efforts to evangelize the world,
+by means of missionary, tract, Bible, and
+other benevolent societies, which have caused
+the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Scriptures</span></em> to be translated into nearly all
+known languages, and carried by the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">living
+preacher</span></em> to the ends of the earth. The very
+room in which Voltaire uttered his famous
+prediction—that <span class="tei tei-q">“the time would arrive
+when the Bible would be regarded only in
+the light of an old curiosity,”</span>—is now used
+for a Bible depository, and is <span class="tei tei-q">“piled to the
+ceiling with that rare old book.”</span> Copies of
+the Bible have been multiplied a million fold,
+and scattered broadcast over the earth. The
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page132">[pg 132]</span><a name="Pg132" id="Pg132" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+other witness,—the church, has since then,
+also, been greatly magnified. In this age of
+missions and Bibles, the number of believers
+has been greatly multiplied; and missionaries
+have penetrated all lands. The last half-century
+has been distinguished for its wonderful
+revivals; and the servants of the cross
+have <span class="tei tei-q">“prophesied [or testified] again before
+many peoples, and nations, and tongues, and
+kings,”</span> 10:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The same hour, is the time of the slaughter
+of the witnesses. Its epoch was to be marked
+by a great political revolution, which, in the
+Apocalypse, is symbolized by an earthquake.
+In the year in which Christianity was suppressed
+by France, they beheaded their king, abolished
+the monarchy, and entirely revolutionized
+the government. In the reign of terror following,
+the best blood of the nation was shed
+like water, and no man of influence could
+consider his life secure. Men, women and
+children were dragged before the revolutionary
+tribunals, had their accusations read to
+them, and were immediately condemned, and
+hurried off in crowds without a trial, to be
+shot, drowned or beheaded. At Lyons thirty-one
+thousand persons were thus slain; at
+Nantes thirty-two thousand,—and throughout
+France in proportion. The number thus
+slain, has been estimated at over one million,—a
+number hardly credible, and which might
+well be symbolized by seven thousand—a
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page133">[pg 133]</span><a name="Pg133" id="Pg133" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+perfect number. Well might the remnant be
+affrighted, and hasten to give glory to the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span>
+of heaven, by the restoration of that book, the
+setting aside of which had involved them in
+such dire calamities.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The tenth of the city which fell, must be
+the tenth of the Roman hierarchy, which is
+symbolized by the city. With the suppression
+of religion, the Catholic church was prohibited,
+with all others. France was one of
+the ten kingdoms, and the overthrow of the
+church in France, would be the fall of one-tenth
+of that city.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Thus passed the second woe—the prelude
+to the third woe, which cometh quickly.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">
+<h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">The Seventh Trumpet.</span></h3>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the seventh angel sounded; and there were loud
+voices in heaven, saying, The kingdom of the world hath
+become the kingdom of our Lord, and of his Anointed; and
+he will reign for ever and ever. And the twenty-four elders,
+who sat before God on their thrones, fell on their faces,
+and worshipped God, saying, We thank thee, O Lord God
+Almighty, who art, and who wast, because thou hast taken
+to thyself thy great power, and reigned. And the nations
+were enraged, and thy wrath is come, and the season of the
+dead, when they should be judged, and a reward should be
+given to thy servants the prophets, and to the saints, and
+to those who fear thy name, small and great; and when
+thou shouldest destroy those, who destroy the earth. And
+the temple of God was opened in heaven, and the ark of
+his covenant in his temple appeared, and there were lightnings,
+and voices, and thunders, and an earthquake, and
+great hail.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 11:15-19.
+</span></div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page134">[pg 134]</span><a name="Pg134" id="Pg134" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The seventh, like the preceding trumpets,
+marks an epoch from which an era dates.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The days of the voice of the seventh angel”</span>
+(10:7), are indicative of a period of time to
+follow its sounding, in which will be fulfilled
+the events predicted of that era.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The voices in heaven, which immediately
+follow its sounding, are prophetic utterances
+of events then to transpire; and are distinct
+from the response of the elders. When Christ
+<span class="tei tei-q">“shall be revealed from heaven,”</span> he will be
+accompanied <span class="tei tei-q">“with his mighty angels,”</span> 2
+Thess. 1:7. He will descend <span class="tei tei-q">“with a shout,
+with the voice of the archangel, and with the
+trump of God,”</span> (1 Thess. 4:16); and the
+shout is evidently that of the attending angels,
+symbolized by those voices, which will
+announce the revolution which is to be made
+in the empire of the earth, and of the substitution
+of the kingdom of God in the place of
+human governments.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The kingdom here established, is the long
+promised consummation, foretold by prophets,
+and anticipated by saints of every age. It is
+that predicted by Daniel, when he says: <span class="tei tei-q">“In
+the days of these kings shall the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">God</span></span> of
+heaven set up a kingdom, which shall never
+be destroyed: and the kingdom shall not be
+left to other people, but it shall break in pieces
+and consume all these kingdoms, and it shall
+stand forever.”</span> Dan. 2:44. He also <span class="tei tei-q">“saw
+in the night visions, and behold, one like the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page135">[pg 135]</span><a name="Pg135" id="Pg135" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Son of Man came with the clouds of heaven,
+and came to the Ancient of Days, and they
+brought him near before him. And there was
+given him dominion, and glory, and a kingdom,
+that all people, nations, and languages,
+should serve him: his dominion is an everlasting
+dominion, which shall not pass away,
+and his kingdom that which shall not be destroyed....
+And the kingdom and dominion,
+and the greatness of the kingdom under
+the whole heaven, shall be given to the people
+of the saints of the Most High, whose
+kingdom is an everlasting kingdom, and all
+dominions shall serve and obey him.”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 7:13,
+14, 27. It is that referred to in the simple
+petition, <span class="tei tei-q">“Thy kingdom come”</span> (Matt. 6:10),
+which was to be the great object of our
+prayer till the final consummation; which the
+disciples thought was to appear immediately,
+when they journeyed towards, and were nigh
+to, Jerusalem, and which misapprehension
+the Saviour corrected by the parable of a nobleman
+going into a far country to receive for
+himself kingly authority, and to return, Luke
+20:12. It is that respecting which they inquired,
+as the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Saviour</span></span> was about to be taken
+from them, if he would at that time restore it
+to Israel, (Acts 1:6); and to which the apostle
+refers, when he declares to <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Timothy</span></span> that
+the Lord <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Jesus Christ</span></span> will judge the living
+and the dead at his appearing and kingdom,
+2 Tim. 4:1.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page136">[pg 136]</span><a name="Pg136" id="Pg136" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Thy kingdom come! Thus, day by day</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">We lift our hands to God and pray;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">But who has ever duly weighed</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">The meaning of the words he said?”</span></div>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This kingdom is to be an eternal kingdom:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“He will reign for ever and ever.”</span> This is
+in accordance with the declaration in Daniel,
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“the saints of the Most High shall take the
+kingdom, and possess the kingdom forever, even
+for ever and ever,”</span> Dan. 7:18. To its eternity
+Nathan testifies when he says to David, <span class="tei tei-q">“Thy
+house and thy kingdom shall be established
+forever before thee: thy throne shall be established
+forever,”</span> 2 Sam. 7:16. Though this
+was spoken to David, it was to be fulfilled in
+Christ; for we read in Luke (1:32, 33), <span class="tei tei-q">“He
+shall be great, and shall be called the Son of
+the Highest: and the Lord God shall give
+unto him the throne of his father David: and
+he shall reign over the house of Jacob forever;
+and of his kingdom there shall be no
+end.”</span> It is predicted in Isaiah, that <span class="tei tei-q">“Unto
+us a child is born, unto us a son is given, and
+the government shall be upon his shoulder;
+and his name shall be called Wonderful, Counsellor,
+the Mighty God, the Everlasting Father,
+the Prince of Peace. Of the increase of his
+government and peace there shall be no end;
+upon the throne of David, and upon his kingdom,
+to order it and to establish it with judgment
+and with justice, from henceforth, even
+forever,”</span> Isa. 9:6, 7. To the Son the Father
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page137">[pg 137]</span><a name="Pg137" id="Pg137" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+saith, <span class="tei tei-q">“Thy throne, O God, is for ever and
+ever,”</span> (Heb. 1:8); and the blood-washed
+throng ascribe to him <span class="tei tei-q">“glory and dominion
+for ever and ever,”</span> 1:5, 6.
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Thy kingdom come! O day of joy,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">When praise shall every tongue employ;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">When hate and strife and war shall cease,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And man with man shall be at peace.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Jesus shall reign on Zion's hill,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And all the earth with glory fill;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">His word shall Paradise restore,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And sin and death afflict no more.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">God's holy will shall then be done</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">By all who live beneath the sun;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">For saints shall then as angels be,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">All changed to immortality.”</span></div>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The four-and-twenty elders,—symbolizing
+those who are redeemed <span class="tei tei-q">“out of every kindred
+and tongue and people and nation,”</span> 5:8,
+9,—at the establishment of the kingdom,
+are to be made <span class="tei tei-q">“kings and priests,”</span> and are
+to <span class="tei tei-q">“reign on the earth,”</span> 5:10. They are
+<span class="tei tei-q">“saints of the Most High,”</span> who are to <span class="tei tei-q">“take
+the kingdom,”</span> and possess it <span class="tei tei-q">“forever.”</span> With
+the announcement of its establishment, they
+immediately respond with glad hosannas,
+which spontaneously and unitedly burst forth
+from the enraptured hosts of the ransomed
+ones, as they find themselves clothed upon
+with immortality, and in the joyful presence
+of their Lord. They are raised from the dead
+at this epoch; or are among the living who
+will then be translated, as says the apostle:
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page138">[pg 138]</span><a name="Pg138" id="Pg138" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Behold I show you a mystery; we shall not
+all sleep, but we shall all be changed, in a
+moment, in the twinkling of an eye, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">at the
+last trump</span></em>,”</span>—the last of the seven;—<span class="tei tei-q">“for
+the trumpet shall sound, and the dead shall be
+raised incorruptible, and we shall be changed.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The nations who are angry, will be the nations
+out from whom the righteous are taken,
+and who are left to the recompense of their
+reward;—<span class="tei tei-q">“when the Lord Jesus shall be
+revealed from heaven with his mighty angels,
+in flaming fire taking vengeance on them that
+know not God and obey not the gospel of our
+Lord Jesus Christ: who shall be punished
+with everlasting destruction from the presence
+of the Lord, and from the glory of his power;
+when he shall come to be glorified in his
+saints, and to be admired in all them that
+believe,”</span> 2 Thess. 1:7-10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The heathen had raged, and the people imagined
+a vain thing. The kings of the earth
+had set themselves, and the rulers taken counsel
+against the Lord, and against his anointed.
+Now the time of their anger is to end: the time
+for the exercise of the wrath of Jehovah upon
+them, has arrived, and they are filled with
+fear, consternation, and shame. The time
+has come when the dead are to be avenged,—when
+those who had been slain for the word
+of God, and for the testimony which they
+held, whose souls under the altar during the
+fifth seal, cried with a loud voice, saying,
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page139">[pg 139]</span><a name="Pg139" id="Pg139" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“How long, O Lord, holy and true, dost thou
+not judge and avenge our blood on them that
+dwell on the earth?”</span> (6:10) find their expectations
+answered, and the destroyers, or perverters
+of the earth, in like manner perverted
+and destroyed. This winds up the kingdom
+of Satan on earth; his reign terminates, and
+his subjects are banished. The absence of all
+the wicked, with the transfiguration of all the
+righteous living and resurrection of the just,
+leave for subjects only those who have passed
+the period of their probation, and are introduced
+into the everlasting kingdom of God.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The opening of the temple in heaven, and
+the presentation of the Ark of the Covenant,
+symbolize the unfolding of the mystery, in
+which the administration of God may have
+been shrouded, making apparent all which
+may have been inexplicable in his dealings
+with men; and rendering evident the verity
+of his promises to his chosen ones.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The voices, lightnings, thunders, earthquake,
+and hail, are appropriate symbols of
+the plagues which will fall upon the wicked.
+These are fearfully depicted in the Scriptures.
+God says to Job, <span class="tei tei-q">“Hast thou seen the treasures
+of hail which I have reserved against the
+time of trouble, against the day of battle and
+war,”</span> 38:22, 23. Judgment then will be
+laid <span class="tei tei-q">“to the line, and righteousness to the
+plummet, and the hail shall sweep away the
+refuge of lies. The Lord shall cause his glorious
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page140">[pg 140]</span><a name="Pg140" id="Pg140" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+voice to be heard, and shall show the
+lighting down of his arm with the indignation
+of his anger, and with the flame of devouring
+fire, with scattering, and tempest, and hailstones,”</span>
+Isa. 28:17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This prepares the way for the purification
+of the earth as foretold by Peter (2 Pet. 3:12,
+13), the restitution of all things (3:21),
+the new heavens and new earth (21:1), the
+descent of the saints (21:2), and the kingdom
+of God on the earth, 21:3. Assuming the
+correctness of the view here given, how near
+to the time now present does it seem to fix the
+consummation!
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 4.00em"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“So shall the world go on,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">To good malignant, to bad men benign,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Under her own weight groaning: till the day</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Appear, of respiration to the just,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And vengeance to the wicked; at return</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Of him—thy Saviour and thy Lord:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Last in the clouds from heaven, to be revealed</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">In glory of the Father, to dissolve</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Satan, with his perverted world; then raise</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">From the conflagrant mass, purged and refined,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">New heavens, new earth, ages of endless date,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Founded in righteousness, and peace, and love,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">To bring forth fruits, joy, and eternal
+bliss.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Milton.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“The world shall burn, and from her ashes spring</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">New heavens and earth, wherein the just shall dwell,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And after all their tribulations long,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">See golden days, fruitful of golden deeds,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">With joy and love triumphing, and fair
+truth.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page141">[pg 141]</span><a name="Pg141" id="Pg141" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Woman and Dragon.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And a great sign appeared in heaven: a woman clothed
+with the sun, and the moon was under her feet, and on her
+head a crown of twelve stars; and she, being with child,
+cried, travailing in birth, and pained to be delivered. And
+another sign appeared in heaven: and behold, a great red
+dragon, having seven heads and ten horns, and seven diadems
+on his heads. And his tail dragged the third part of
+the stars of heaven, and cast them to the earth: and the
+dragon stood before the woman, who was about to be delivered,
+to devour her child as soon as it was born. And she
+brought forth a male child, who was to rule all nations with
+a rod of iron; and her child was snatched up to God, and
+to his throne. And the woman fled into the desert, where
+she hath a place there prepared of God, that they should
+feed her there one thousand two hundred and sixty days.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+12:1-6.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With this chapter commences a new series
+of events, extending through the entire gospel
+dispensation; the former series being terminated
+by the events of the last trumpet.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The heaven, where these great <span class="tei tei-q">“wonders”</span>
+are exhibited, must symbolize the theatre of
+their fulfilment—the station to be occupied
+by the agents symbolized, which must be as
+conspicuous as heaven is relatively high above
+the earth.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The woman, according to the use of the
+symbol in other places, must be a representative
+of the church. As the harlot on a scarlet-colored
+beast (17:3), is a symbol of a corrupt
+and apostate church, so a virtuous woman is
+a chosen symbol of the true church.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page142">[pg 142]</span><a name="Pg142" id="Pg142" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“Jerusalem which is above is the
+mother”</span> of all true Christians (Gal. 4:26);
+she is also <span class="tei tei-q">“the bride, the Lamb's wife”</span>
+(21:9); and <span class="tei tei-q">“the remnant of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">her seed</span></em>,”</span> are
+those <span class="tei tei-q">“which keep the commandments of
+God, and have the testimony of Jesus Christ,”</span>
+v. 17. Her robe of light, her position above
+the moon, and her crown of stars, indicate her
+greatness and glory.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The epoch symbolized, as appears from the
+relative position of the woman and dragon, is
+evidently just prior to the first advent of the
+Messiah, when his coming was eagerly anticipated
+and ardently desired by the church,
+and the Roman power had thereby been excited
+to jealousy.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The church is the same in all ages, comprising
+only the true people of God; all of
+whom will have part in the first resurrection,
+20:6. The Jewish church was continued
+by the breaking off of unbelieving branches,
+and the grafting in of believing Gentiles with
+believing Jews, who alike partake of the root
+and fatness of the same olive-tree, Rom.
+11:17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Previous to the first advent, the Jewish
+church occupied a high political position, above
+that of the inferior officers of state, and was
+in the enjoyment of imperial favor. Patriarchs
+and prophets—the messengers of the
+church—were stars in her crown of rejoicing,
+1:20. From the utterance of the prediction
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page143">[pg 143]</span><a name="Pg143" id="Pg143" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+that the woman's seed should bruise the serpent's
+head (Gen. 3:15), the coming of the
+promised deliverer was the great desire of
+the church. Even Eve exclaimed, at the
+birth of her first-born (<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">literally</span></em>), <span class="tei tei-q">“I have gotten
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the</span></em> man from the Lord,”</span> Gen. 4:1. For
+his coming,
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Kings and prophets waited long</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">But died without the sight.”</span></div>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They <span class="tei tei-q">“inquired and searched diligently, who
+prophesied of the grace that should come
+unto you: searching what, or what manner
+of time the spirit of Christ which was in them
+did signify, when it testified beforehand the
+sufferings of Christ, and the glory that should
+follow,”</span> 1 Pet. 1:10, 11. <span class="tei tei-q">“Many righteous
+men desired”</span> to see his day (Matt. 13:17);
+Abraham rejoiced and was made glad at its
+prospect, when in the distant future (John, 8:56);
+and Hezekiah lamented that because of
+death he should not see <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lord in the land
+of the living,”</span> Isa. 38:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The seventy weeks indicated to the Jews
+the time of <span class="tei tei-q">“the Messiah, the Prince,”</span> Dan.
+9:26-27. When these were near their termination,
+to the pious and devout Simeon who
+was <span class="tei tei-q">“waiting for the consolation of Israel,”</span>
+it <span class="tei tei-q">“was revealed by the Holy Ghost, that he
+should not see death before he had seen the
+Lord's Christ,”</span> Luke 2:25, 26. And the
+opinion was so general, that when the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Baptist</span></em>
+preceded him, <span class="tei tei-q">“the people were in expectation,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page144">[pg 144]</span><a name="Pg144" id="Pg144" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and all men mused in their hearts of
+John, whether he were the Christ or no,”</span>
+Luke 3:15. This expectation is testified to
+by the Jewish historians Philo and Josephus;
+and it was that which so troubled Herod,
+when wise men came, saying, <span class="tei tei-q">“Where is he
+that is born King of the Jews?”</span> Matt. 2:1-3.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The belief that some remarkable personage
+was about to appear in Judea, was not confined
+to Palestine, but extended to Egypt,
+Rome, Greece, and wherever the Jews were
+scattered abroad. Says Suetonius, a Roman
+historian: <span class="tei tei-q">“An ancient and settled persuasion
+prevailed throughout the East, that the
+Fates had decreed some one to proceed from
+Judea, who should attain universal empire.”</span>
+And Tacitus, another Roman historian, says:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Many were persuaded that it was contained
+in the ancient books of their priests, that at
+that very time the East should prevail, and
+that some one should proceed from Judea,
+and possess the dominion.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The great red dragon sustains a relation to
+the woman, analogous to that sustained by
+the nondescript beast (of Dan. 7:7), to the
+saints of the Most High; and his position respecting
+the man-child is like that of the exceeding
+great horn (Dan. 8:9), to the Prince of
+princes, Dan. 8:25. Like the beast referred
+to, the dragon has ten horns; and its characteristics
+indicate that it also symbolizes the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page145">[pg 145]</span><a name="Pg145" id="Pg145" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Roman empire,—<span class="tei tei-q">“the fourth kingdom upon
+earth,”</span> Dan. 7:23. The dragon is a monster
+serpent. <span class="tei tei-q">“That old serpent”</span> who seduced
+Eve (Gen. 3:5), <span class="tei tei-q">“called the devil”</span> (Matt.
+4:1-12), and <span class="tei tei-q">“Satan”</span> (2 Cor. 2:11),
+<span class="tei tei-q">“who deceiveth the whole world,”</span> is an appropriate
+representative of Rome.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“head”</span> of a beast, sustains a relation
+to the beast analogous to that of the government
+to the people of an empire. It is that
+by which the beast is directed and governed.
+When distinguished from the body of the
+beast (Dan. 7:11), according to the analogy,
+it must be understood as a symbol of the directing
+and controlling power, in the kingdom
+indicated by the beast. Several heads on the
+same beast, on this principle, must indicate the
+several forms of government to which the nation
+is subject. As these cannot be contemporary,
+like the divisions of a kingdom represented
+by the horns, they must be successive.
+To suppose they represent different governments,
+destroys the analogy, and makes them
+separate beasts, instead of heads of the same
+beast; and no government can be subject to
+more than one head at the same time.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“seven heads”</span> of the dragon, then,
+symbolize the directing and controlling powers
+which ruled the Roman empire,—the seven
+successive forms of government under which
+it existed. Rome was founded about B. C.
+753, from small beginnings, on the summit of
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page146">[pg 146]</span><a name="Pg146" id="Pg146" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Mount Palatine, and gradually increased in
+extent, till it spread over seven hills: the Palatine,
+Capitoline, Aventine, Esquiline, Cœlius,
+and Quirinalia; and its population of about
+three thousand in the time of Romulus, increased
+to about two millions in the time of
+Augustus Cæsar.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Previous to the subversion of the empire,
+Rome existed under different forms of government,
+as follows:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+1. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Kingly.</span></span>—The first government established
+was a monarchy, and lasted two hundred
+and forty-four years, under seven kings,
+viz., Romulus, Numa, Tullus Hostilius, Ancus
+Martius, Tarquin Priscus, Servius Tullius,
+and Tarquin the Proud, who was afterwards
+expelled from the throne. This was denominated
+the infancy of the Roman empire.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+2. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Consular.</span></span>—In B. C. 509, the constitution
+of Rome was remodelled, and the executive
+power committed to two consuls, to
+be elected annually. This commenced the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Commonwealth of Rome.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+3. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Dictatorial.</span></span>—The office of dictator was
+the highest known in Rome, and was only resorted
+to in cases of emergency. He was
+elected for six months only, and usually resigned
+his authority, which, for the time, was
+nearly absolute, as soon as he had effected the
+object for which he was chosen.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+4. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Decemviral.</span></span>—In B. C. 451, the government
+was so changed, that, instead of the two
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page147">[pg 147]</span><a name="Pg147" id="Pg147" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+consuls, the government was committed to ten
+men, to be chosen annually, and jointly exercise
+the sovereign power. After two years the
+decemvirs were banished, and the consular
+government was restored.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+5. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Tribunitial.</span></span>—In B. C. 426, Rome having
+become a military state, military tribunes
+were substituted for the consular power, till
+B. C. 366, when the latter was again restored.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+6. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Pagan Imperial.</span></span>—With the battle of
+Actium, B. C. 31, the Roman Commonwealth
+terminated; and Augustus Cæsar united in
+his own person not only the offices of Consul,
+Tribune, &amp;c., but also that of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Supreme Pontiff</span></span>,—the
+head of the pagan hierarchy. This
+last office, says Gibbon, <span class="tei tei-q">“was constantly exercised
+by the emperors.”</span> Thus were united
+the highest civil and ecclesiastical powers of
+the state.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+7. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Christian Imperial.</span></span>—In A. D. 312, the
+government was revolutionized, by the accession
+of Constantine to the throne. He effected
+important changes in the relations of the people
+to the monarch, opposed idolatry, and by
+the introduction of Christianity, effected a
+political change in the laws and administration
+of the empire. This continued, with a slight
+interruption under Julian the Apostate, till the
+subversion of the Western empire, A. D. 476.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Mr. Elliott, in explanation of the first five
+heads, says: <span class="tei tei-q">“I adopt, with the most entire
+satisfaction, that generally-received Protestant
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page148">[pg 148]</span><a name="Pg148" id="Pg148" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+interpretation, which, following the authoritative
+statement of Livy and Tacitus (the latter
+great historian, St. John's own contemporary),
+enumerates kings, consuls, dictators,
+decemvirs, and military tribunes, as the first
+five constitutional heads of the Roman city
+and commonwealth; then as the sixth, the
+Imperial head, commencing with Octavian.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Horæ
+Apoca.</span></span>, vol. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">III.</span></span>, p. 106, 4th ed.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those heads are shown to symbolize seven
+forms of government, by the explanation that
+<span class="tei tei-q">“they are seven mountains where the woman
+sits on them [mountains also symbolizing
+governments], and are seven kings,”</span> 17:9,
+10. And they are shown to be successive, by
+the fact that, when John wrote, the first five
+had passed away, one only then existed,—the
+Pagan Imperial,—and the other head was
+then in the future, 17:10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“ten horns”</span> also symbolize kings, or
+dynasties; but, unlike the heads, instead of being
+successive, they are contemporaneous. According
+to the explanation, they had received
+no kingdom when John wrote, and were all
+to exercise power at the same time: <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+ten horns which thou didst see, are ten kings
+who have not yet received a kingdom; but
+they receive power as kings, one hour with
+the wild beast,”</span> 17:12. These will be more
+particularly noticed in connection with the
+thirteenth chapter, and there shown to be the
+ten contemporaneous governments which succeeded
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page149">[pg 149]</span><a name="Pg149" id="Pg149" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+to the dominion, on the subversion of
+the Western Empire. See p. <a href="#Pg169" class="tei tei-ref">169</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“seven crowns”</span> on the heads of the
+dragon, indicate that the acts here symbolized,
+would be fulfilled during the period when
+the sovereignty of Rome should be vested in the
+forms of government symbolized by the heads,
+and not during that symbolized by the horns.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The woman appeared in the symbolic
+heavens anterior to the dragon. Prior to the
+birth of Christ, the church was conspicuous
+and honored. The sacrifices which smoked
+on Jewish altars, were offered to Jehovah.
+The subjects of the divine government conducted
+their service with all the splendor imparted
+by the Jewish ritual. Royalty was an
+appendage of the nation: the sceptre did not
+depart from Judah, nor a law-giver from between
+his feet, till Shiloh came, Gen. 49:10.
+By an alliance with the Romans, B. C. 135,
+Rome took its position in the presence of the
+woman.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The first act of the dragon was by a sweep
+of its tail to draw down one-third of the stars,
+and to cast them to the earth. This was before
+the birth of the man-child. After Rome
+attained the supremacy, Judea proportionably
+suffered. Her glory was measurably dimmed
+by many indignities before her subjugation
+to Rome was consummated. Jerusalem was
+repeatedly besieged. At one time (B. C.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page150">[pg 150]</span><a name="Pg150" id="Pg150" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+94) Alexander Jannæus slew six thousand
+persons on account of their meeting in the
+temple at the feast of tabernacles. In B. C.
+63, Judea was conquered by Pompey, the Roman
+general. In B. C. 54, Crassus plundered
+the temple of Jerusalem. In B. C. 37, Jerusalem
+was taken, after a siege of six months.
+Various other difficulties occurred between
+Judea and Rome, previous to the Saviour's
+advent, on account of which she was greatly
+depressed and humbled, so that it might with
+propriety be said that one-third of her stars
+were cast to the ground. This depression was
+one great reason why the church within her
+borders looked so earnestly for a Deliverer.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Man-child is the one <span class="tei tei-q">“who was to rule
+all nations with a rod of iron,”</span> according
+to the prediction of Christ in the second Psalm;
+which proves its reference to the Saviour.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The purpose of the dragon to destroy the
+child of the woman as soon as it should be
+born, in accordance with the view here taken,
+would symbolize the purpose of the Roman
+power, by the agency of Herod the Roman
+governor in Judea, to destroy the infant Saviour.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“When he had gathered all the chief
+priests and scribes of the people together, he
+demanded of them where Christ should be
+born. And they said unto him, In Bethlehem,
+in Judea: for thus it is written by the prophet.”</span>
+And Herod <span class="tei tei-q">“sent forth and slew all the
+children that were in Bethlehem, and in all
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page151">[pg 151]</span><a name="Pg151" id="Pg151" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the coasts thereof, from two years old and
+under, according to the time which he had
+diligently inquired of the wise men,”</span> Matt. 2:1-16.
+Thus Rome sought to slay the Saviour
+as soon as he was born; but Joseph took
+the child and fled into Egypt. Afterwards
+Christ was crucified by Roman soldiers, and
+deposited in the tomb, arising again the third
+day.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His being caught up to God and to his
+throne, symbolizes his resurrection from the
+dead, and ascension from the Mount of Olives
+(Acts 1:9), to the right hand of the Majesty
+on high; <span class="tei tei-q">“whom the heaven must receive
+until the times of restitution of all things,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 3:21.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The flight of the woman into the wilderness,
+denotes her descent from the conspicuous
+position she had occupied, and the dispersion
+of the church. With the crucifixion of
+Christ, Judaism was no longer the casket in
+which the church was enshrined. It left its
+place in the moral heavens, and the followers
+of Christ were scattered abroad, Acts 8:1-4.
+Thus she virtually fled into the wilderness—into
+the condition, where, subsequently, she
+was to be nourished for 1260 prophetic days.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It is objected to the application of the man-child
+to the Saviour, that it should be prophetic,
+and not retrospective. This objection
+would be equally valid to the application of
+the symbolic heads, against which it is never
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page152">[pg 152]</span><a name="Pg152" id="Pg152" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+urged. That which is retrospective, to be
+appropriately symbolized, must be in harmony
+with, and explanatory of other parts. Thus,
+by the man-child and previous travail of the
+woman, she is identified, and her relation to
+the dragon established. No other subject
+could fulfil the conditions of the symbol, for
+of no other was it predicted: <span class="tei tei-q">“Thou art my
+Son; this day have I begotten thee.—Ask of
+me, and I shall give thee the heathen for thine
+inheritance, and the uttermost parts of the
+earth for thy possession.—Thou shalt break
+them with a rod of iron; thou shalt dash them
+in pieces like a potter's vessel,”</span> Psa. 2:8-10.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The War in Heaven.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And a war took place in heaven: Michael and his angels
+fought with the dragon;, and the dragon fought and
+his angels, and he prevailed not; nor was their place found
+any more in heaven. And the great dragon was cast out,
+the old serpent, called the Devil, and Satan, who deceiveth
+the whole world: he was cast out into the earth, and his
+angels were cast out with him.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 12:7-9.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The churches,—which on the persecution
+subsequent to the Pentecostal season were
+scattered abroad, and went everywhere preaching
+the word (Acts 8:4),—afterwards had
+rest, and were multiplied, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 9:31. They
+were thus enabled again to act a conspicuous
+part, as symbolized by the contest between
+Michael and the dragon.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page153">[pg 153]</span><a name="Pg153" id="Pg153" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The contest symbolized, is a religious one;
+for the dragon is overcome <span class="tei tei-q">“by the word of
+their testimony,”</span> v. 11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Michael and his angels, then, must symbolize
+the body of Christ,—the apostles, and
+their successor, under the guidance of the
+Lord,—who constituted an army of religious
+teachers. With the arrows of truth they assailed
+the idolatrous combinations of their opponents.
+Under the first seal, they are represented
+by a mounted warrior, with bow and
+crown, going forth conquering and to conquer,
+6:2. See p. 58.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The dragon, with the appendages of heads,
+horns, and diadems, was seen to be a symbol
+of the Roman government. Divested of those,
+it would simply represent the Pagan hierarchy
+with which the contest was waged. The
+heathen priests and their adherents, thus
+warred with the preachers of Christianity.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Its prevailing not, shows the relative success
+of the two parties. The struggle continued
+from the day of Pentecost till the accession
+of Constantine. The church waded
+through bloody scenes of bitter persecution,
+which, instead of diminishing, greatly added
+to her numbers—<span class="tei tei-q">“the blood of the martyrs”</span>
+proving <span class="tei tei-q">“the seed of the church.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The heathen priests were not deficient in
+logic, philosophy, and artful sophistry, by
+which to defend their mythology. They exhausted
+these, and then resorted to persecution,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page154">[pg 154]</span><a name="Pg154" id="Pg154" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+torture, and death; yet they prevailed not.
+With the weapons of truth, the teachers of
+Christianity successfully assailed those antiquated
+forms of error,—overcoming <span class="tei tei-q">“by the
+blood of the Lamb, and by the word of their
+testimony.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“They loved not their lives
+unto the death,”</span> but freely gave themselves
+for Christ, till, in time, the current of popular
+favor ceased to flow in the direction of paganism.
+The accession of Constantine to the
+throne, put an end to the dragonic period of
+Rome; the Pagan service gave place to the
+worship of Jehovah. The rites of heathenism
+were no longer the religion of the state, and
+its ministers were displaced from the exalted
+position they had so long occupied. Their
+place was no longer in the symbolic heavens,
+but in a less conspicuous station.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The casting out of the dragon, would then
+be this expulsion of the pagan hierarchy from
+its national importance, and the dejection of
+the priesthood and their adherents to the
+earth,—below their former high station,—and
+to the sea, among the unsettled tribes
+and nations outside of Rome. This being a
+religious and not a political event, it does not
+immediately affect Rome's nationality. That
+it is not the overthrow of a kingdom, but of
+religious rites, is shown by the rejoicings
+which followed.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page155">[pg 155]</span><a name="Pg155" id="Pg155" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Rejoicings of the Victors.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I heard a loud voice in heaven, saying, Now is
+come the salvation and the strength, and the Kingdom of
+or God, and the power of his Anointed: for the accuser of
+our brethren it cast out, who accused them before our God
+day and night. And they overcame him by the blood of the
+Lamb, and by the word of their testimony; and they loved
+not their lives to death. On this account, rejoice, ye heavens,
+and ye who dwell in them.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 12:10-12.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The loud voice is heard in the symbolic
+heaven from which the Dragon had been
+cast. By the displacement of the Pagan hierarchy,
+and the substitution of Christianity
+under Constantine, the adherents of the latter
+succeeded to the place of the former, and rejoiced
+over them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A loud voice symbolizes the utterance of the
+thoughts and feelings of an interested multitude.
+The nature of the voice indicates the
+nature of the utterance—whether it be one
+of expectation, fear, warning, or instruction.
+This voice is expressive of the then prevalent
+expectation, that, with the displacement of
+Paganism commenced the establishment of the
+Kingdom of God on earth. This belief was
+not necessarily well founded;—its <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">existence</span></em>
+only being symbolized.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+On the triumph of Constantine over Licinius,
+Eusebius says:—<span class="tei tei-q">“There were illuminations
+everywhere. They who were before
+dejected looked on one another with joyful aspects
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page156">[pg 156]</span><a name="Pg156" id="Pg156" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and smiles, and with choirs and hymns
+through the cities and country, gave honor first
+to God, the Supreme Ruler of all, as they were
+taught, and then to the pious emperor and
+his children.”</span> Says Mr Lord:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Eusebius represents the victors at the precipitation
+of Maxentius and his attendants into
+the Tiber, as saying, like Moses at the overthrow
+of the Egyptians in the Red Sea: <span class="tei tei-q">‘Let
+us sing to the Lord, for he is signally glorified.
+Horse and rider he has thrown into the sea.
+The Lord my helper and defender was with
+me unto salvation. Who, O Lord, is like
+to thee among gods? Who is like to thee,
+glorified by the holy, admirable in praise, doing
+wonders? Constantine entered Rome in
+triumph, hymning these and similar passages
+to God, the author of the victory.’</span> And on
+the fall of Licinius he represents the church
+as uniting in thanksgiving for the deliverance,
+and congratulations at the overthrow of idolatry,
+and establishment of Christ's kingdom;
+and devotes the tenth book of his history to
+the edicts of the emperor by which the church
+was nationalized and endowed, and to the
+restoration of the temples, and the public
+rejoicings at their dedication. <span class="tei tei-q">‘Let thanks be
+given by all to the Almighty Ruler of the universe,
+and to Jesus Christ, our Saviour and
+Redeemer, through whom we pray that peace
+from external foes may be uninterruptedly
+preserved to us, and tranquillity of mind.’</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page157">[pg 157]</span><a name="Pg157" id="Pg157" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“ <span class="tei tei-q">‘Let us sing to the Lord a new song, for he
+has done wonderful things. His right hand
+has saved him and his holy arm. The Lord
+has made known his salvation; he has revealed
+his righteousness in the presence of the
+nations. We may now appropriately respond
+to the inspired command to sing a new song,
+inasmuch as after such direful spectacles and
+narrations we now have the happiness to see
+and celebrate what many holy men before us
+and the martyrs for God desired to see on
+earth, and did not see, and to hear, and have
+not heard. But advancing more rapidly they
+attained far superior gifts in heaven, being
+caught up to the paradise of celestial joy;
+while we acknowledge the gifts we enjoy are
+greater than we deserve, and contemplate
+with wonder the largeness of the divine bounty.
+Admiring and adoring with all our souls,
+we testify to the truth of the prophet's words,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Come and see the works of the Lord, what
+wonders he has wrought in the earth, abolishing
+wars to the ends of the world. The
+bow he has broken, he has dashed the arms,
+the shield he has burned in the fire.”</span> Rejoicing
+at the manifest fulfilment of these predictions
+to us, we go on with our history.’</span> He
+goes on accordingly to represent the whole
+population, freed from the domination of the
+tyrants, and relieved from oppression, as acknowledging
+the only true God and protector
+of the pious, and these especially who had
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page158">[pg 158]</span><a name="Pg158" id="Pg158" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+placed their hope in Christ, as filled with inexpressible
+joy; the ministers everywhere delivering
+commemorative addresses, and the
+whole multitude offering praises and thanksgiving
+to God.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Lactantius also: <span class="tei tei-q">‘Let us celebrate the
+triumph of God with gladness; let us commemorate
+his victory with praise; let us make
+mention in our prayers day and night of the
+peace which, after ten years of persecution, he
+has conferred on his people.’</span> ”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ex. of Apoc.</span></span>,
+pp. 343-4.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Multitudes actually supposed the long-predicted
+kingdom of God was now being
+established. Says Mr. Elliott:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Can we wonder, then, at the exultation
+that was felt at this time by many, perhaps by
+most, that bore the Christian name: or at
+their high-raised expectations as to the future
+happy destiny of the Roman, now that it had
+been changed into the Christian, nation? It
+seemed to them as if it had become God's
+covenanted people, like Israel of old: and the
+expectation was not unnatural,—an expectation
+strengthened by the remarkable tranquillity
+which, throughout the extent of the
+now reünited empire, followed almost immediately
+on Constantine's establishment of
+Christianity,—that not only the temporal
+blessings of the ancient Jewish covenant would
+thenceforth in no small measure attach to
+them, but even those prophesied of as appertaining
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page159">[pg 159]</span><a name="Pg159" id="Pg159" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+to the latter day. Hence on the medals
+of that era the emblem of the phœnix, all
+radiant with the rising sunbeams, to represent
+the empire as now risen into new life and
+hope, and its legend which spoke of the happy
+restoration of the times. Hence, in forgetfulness
+of all former prognostications of Antichrist
+and fearful coming evils, the reference
+by some of the most eminent of their bishops
+to the latter-day blessedness, as even then
+about fulfilling. The state of things was such,
+Eusebius tells us, that it looked like <span class="tei tei-q">‘the very
+image of the kingdom of Christ.’</span> The city
+built by the emperor at Jerusalem, beside the
+new and magnificent Church of the Holy
+Sepulchre,—the sacred capital, as it were, to
+the new empire,—might be, perhaps, he suggested,
+the New Jerusalem, the theme of so
+many prophecies. Yet again, on occasion of
+the opening of the new church at Tyre, he
+expressed in the following glowing language,
+not his own feelings only, but those, we may
+be sure, of not a few of the congregated
+Christian ministers and people that heard
+him: <span class="tei tei-q">‘What so many of the Lord's saints
+and confessors before our time desired to see,
+and saw not, and to hear, and heard not, that
+behold now before our eyes! It was of us
+the prophet spake when he told how the wildernesses
+and solitary places should be glad,
+and the desert rejoice and blossom as the lily.
+Whereas the church was widowed and desolate,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page160">[pg 160]</span><a name="Pg160" id="Pg160" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+her children have now to exclaim to her,
+Make room, enlarge thy borders! the place is
+too strait for us. The promise is fulfilling to
+her, In righteousness shalt thou be established:
+all thy children shall be taught of
+God: and great shall be the peace of thy children.’</span> ”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Horæ
+Apoc.</span></span>, v. i., pp. 230-1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They rejoiced over the downfall of the dragon
+as over <span class="tei tei-q">“the Accuser of our brethren, who
+accused them before our God day and night.”</span>
+The phrase <span class="tei tei-q">“our brethren,”</span> proves that those
+who unite in this song are the living saints
+on the earth. The reference to Satan as an
+Accuser bears a close resemblance to Zech.
+3:1, where Joshua, as a symbol of the people
+of Israel, is represented as standing before the
+angel of the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Lord</span></span>, and Satan standing at his
+right hand to resist him.—<span class="tei tei-q">“שטן Satan signifies
+an <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">adversary</span></em>. רשטנו <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">lesiteno</span></span>, to be his
+adversary or accuser.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Dr. Clark.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Satan's most common work is to invent
+false accusations against those whose efforts
+tend to frustrate his designs. The Christians
+had endured false accusations and bitter persecutions,
+and therefore rejoiced the more
+over the defeat of the Pagans.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Flight of the Woman.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Woe to the inhabitants of the earth, and of the sea! for
+the devil is come to you, having great wrath, because he
+knoweth that he hath but a short season.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page161">[pg 161]</span><a name="Pg161" id="Pg161" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And when the dragon saw that he was cast out into the
+earth, he persecuted the woman, who brought forth the
+male child. And two wings of a great eagle were given to
+the woman, that she might fly into the desert, into her place,
+where she is nourished for a time, and times, and half a
+time, from the presence of the serpent. And the serpent
+cast out of his mouth water like a river, after the woman,
+that he might cause her to be carried away by the river.
+And the earth helped the woman; and the earth opened its
+mouth and swallowed up the river, which the dragon cast
+out of his mouth. And the dragon was enraged against the
+woman, and went away to make war with the remnant of
+her seed, that keep the commandments of God, and have
+the testimony of Jesus.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 12:12-17.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The rejoicing of Christians, according to
+this symbolization, is afterwards followed by
+renewed triumphs of the Pagans over them.
+The hatred of the Pagan worshippers to
+Christianity, is strikingly evinced; but it is
+manifested in a manner different from the former
+contest.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+When the church sought only to overcome
+by <span class="tei tei-q">“the blood of the Lamb, and by the word
+of their testimony,”</span> it was owned of Christ;
+but as it became proud and worldly, and
+cared more for popular favor than for purity of
+faith and practice, the true church which the
+woman symbolized, was represented only by
+those who continued faithful to their profession.
+Historians inform us that with the success
+of Constantine, the visible church became
+speedily corrupt. As it became popular, unconverted
+men sought to be enrolled as members.
+The Pagans, instead of approaching as
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page162">[pg 162]</span><a name="Pg162" id="Pg162" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+enemies, came as professed friends. As a
+profession of Christianity was alone necessary
+for admission to the church, multitudes
+sought connection with it. This caused a
+condition of things, of which Dr. Milner thus
+speaks:—<span class="tei tei-q">“In the general appearance of the
+church, we cannot see much of the spirit of
+godliness. External piety flourished. But
+faith, love, heavenly-mindedness appear very
+rare. The doctrine of real conversion was
+very much lost, and external baptism placed
+in its stead: and the true doctrine of justification
+by faith, and true practical use of a crucified
+Saviour for troubled consciences were
+scarcely to be seen at this time. Superstition
+and self-righteousness were making vigorous
+shoots; and the real gospel of Christ was hidden
+from the men that professed it.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To the same effect is the report of Mosheim:—Of
+the life and morals of the professing
+Christians of the fourth century, he says:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Good men were, as before, mixed with bad;
+but the bad were by degrees so multiplied,
+that men truly holy and devoted to God appeared
+more rarely; and the pious few were
+almost oppressed by the vicious multitude.”</span>
+Of their doctrines he says: <span class="tei tei-q">“Fictions, of early
+origin”</span> (about saint veneration and relics,
+a purifying fire, celibacy, &amp;c., &amp;c.), <span class="tei tei-q">“now
+so prevailed as in course of time almost to
+thrust true religion aside, or at least to exceedingly
+obscure and tarnish it.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page163">[pg 163]</span><a name="Pg163" id="Pg163" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Says Mr Lord:—<span class="tei tei-q">“Constantine and his
+successors introduced a flood of false doctrines,
+superstitions and idolatries, into the church,
+which were incompatible with a pure worship,
+and swept all who yielded to their impulse
+to the gulf of apostasy. Such were the
+veneration of the cross, and ascription to it of
+miraculous powers, the homage of relics, the
+invocation of saints, the conversion of religion
+into gorgeous ceremonies, the encouragement
+of celibacy, and the arrogation of the throne
+and prerogatives of God by civil and ecclesiastical
+rulers. These falsehoods, follies, and impieties,
+introduced or adopted by the emperors,
+encouraged by their example, sanctioned
+by their laws, and enforced by the penalties
+of excommunication, imprisonment, the forfeiture
+of civil rights, banishment, and death,
+came armed with an overpowering force to
+all who were not fortified against them by the
+special aids of the divine spirit, and like a resistless
+torrent bore away the great mass of
+the church.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Exp. of Apoc.</span></span>, p. 350.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With the accession of multitudes of unworthy
+members, and the prevalence of false doctrines,
+the true church would have been speedily
+overwhelmed had not the people of God
+been sustained from such deleterious influences.
+To the woman, therefore, were given
+two wings of a great eagle that she might escape.
+Wings are symbolic of power of flight—for
+succor, or escape. The four-winged
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page164">[pg 164]</span><a name="Pg164" id="Pg164" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+leopard of Daniel used his speed to approach
+and demolish the enemy; the woman, to escape
+hers. The church of old was sustained
+in like manner. Thus God said to Israel,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Ye have seen what I did unto the Egyptians,
+and how I bare you on eagles' wings,
+and brought you to myself.”</span>—Ex. 19:4.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+On the introduction of new rites and doctrines
+into the church, multitudes withdrew
+from the public assemblies, and worshipped
+apart. They retired from the observation of
+their rulers and lived secluded for a long period.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Some may inquire for the historical evidence
+of the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">time</span></em> when such a body withdrew.
+This, from the nature of the case, it may be
+difficult to give. If the withdrawal of the
+true worshippers had been an occurrence of
+so much notoriety as to be prominently historically
+noticed, it might have defeated their
+withdrawal. It is sufficient that the prophecy
+makes such a withdrawal necessary; and
+that at a later period such a body was found
+existing as predicted. See p. <a href="#Pg198" class="tei tei-ref">198</a>. Says Mr.
+Lord:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Her retreat into her place from the face of
+the serpent, denotes that the scene of her residence
+was unknown to the rulers. The anger
+of the serpent indicates their continued
+disposition to destroy her, if in their power;
+while its going on to make war with such of
+her seed as had not retreated to the desert, denotes
+that they continued, after her disappearance,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page165">[pg 165]</span><a name="Pg165" id="Pg165" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+to persecute the isolated individuals that
+from time to time dissented from the corrupt
+church, and professed the pure faith.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“As it was by spiritual aids that the
+true worshippers were enabled to resist the
+temptations and force by which the rulers endeavored
+to constrain them to apostasy, and
+to fly to the desert, no specific record of those
+aids is to be sought on the page of history.
+The only evidence that we can ask or possess,
+that they were conferred, is presented in the
+fact that a body of dissentients from the corrupt
+church were in a latter age found in a
+secluded scene, who had survived the endeavors
+of the rulers of the fourth, fifth, sixth,
+and following centuries, to compel all their
+subjects to conformity, and who have continued
+to maintain a separate existence, and offer
+an unidolatrous worship to the present time.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And such a body were the Waldenses, inhabiting
+the eastern valleys of the Cottian
+Alps. They are known, from the testimony
+of cotemporary Catholics and their own authors,
+to have existed there as early as the
+eleventh century. It was then, and is now,
+claimed by themselves, and admitted by their
+enemies, that they had subsisted there from a
+much earlier age. These were a Christian
+church, having the Scriptures of the Old and
+New Testaments, regarding them as a revelation
+from God, and making them the rule of
+their faith; having a ministry of their own,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page166">[pg 166]</span><a name="Pg166" id="Pg166" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+holding religious assemblies, professing and
+teaching the doctrines of the gospel, and celebrating
+the sacraments.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“They were distinguished for the simplicity
+and purity of their lives. It was asserted
+by them, and repeated by the Catholics, that
+they were induced to retreat to the secluded
+valleys which they inhabit, to escape the despotism
+of the rulers and the corruptions and
+tyranny of the church, soon after its nationalization
+by Constantine. They have continued
+to subsist there to the present time, as a
+separate and evangelical church.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Exp.
+Apoc.</span></span>, pp. 348, 349, 359.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Says Mr. Elliott:—<span class="tei tei-q">“I must not pass on
+without pressing on the reader's notice this
+notable pre-figuration of the seclusion of
+Christ's church in the wilderness, as the true
+and fittest answer to the Romish anti-Protestant
+taunt, <span class="tei tei-q">‘Where was your religion before
+Luther?’</span> Protestants have not duly, as it
+seems to me, applied the answer here given.
+For the wilderness-life necessarily, as I must
+repeat,—and that on Bossuet's own showing,—implies
+the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">invisibility</span></em> of her who lives in
+it. And consequently, instead of the long previous
+invisibility of a church like the Lutheran,
+or Anglican Reformed, of the sixteenth century,
+in respect of doctrine and worship, being
+an argument against, it is an argument for it.
+The Romish church, which never knew the
+predicted wilderness-life, could not, for this
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page167">[pg 167]</span><a name="Pg167" id="Pg167" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+very reason, be the woman of the 12th Apocalyptic
+chapter; that is, could not be the true
+church of Christ.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For 1260 prophetic days, then, or years,
+she was to disappear from men's view in the
+Roman world. Is it asked how her vitality
+was preserved? Doubtless in her children,
+known to God, though for the most part unknown
+to men; just like the 7000 that Elijah
+knew not of, who had not bowed the knee to
+Baal; some, it might be, in monasteries, some
+in the secular walks of life; but all alike insulated
+in spirit from those around them, and as
+regards the usual means of grace, spiritually
+destitute and desolate; even as in a barren
+and dry land, where no water is.—Besides
+whom, some few there were of her children,—some
+very few,—prepared, like Elijah of old,
+to act a bolder part, and stand forth, under
+special commission from God, as Christ's witnesses
+before Christendom.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Horæ Apoc.</span></span>,
+pp. 55-57.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The flood of water cast out after the woman,
+is an appropriate symbol of the various
+tribes which subsequently overran the Western
+empire. Waters symbolize peoples, 17:15;
+and by hordes of barbarian Huns, Goths,
+and Vandals, Rome was inundated as by a
+flood, in the 5th century; and in A. D. 476
+its government was entirely subverted.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Such an irruption of barbarians might be
+expected to extirpate Christianity from the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page168">[pg 168]</span><a name="Pg168" id="Pg168" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+earth; but help came from an unexpected
+quarter. The woman had retired to her secure
+retreat, and the earth swallowed up the
+flood. Those barbarous tribes were absorbed
+by, and mixed with, the previous population
+of the empire, and constituted the clay ingredient
+with the iron, in the feet of the metallic
+image.—Dan. 2:41. They rapidly assimilated
+to the character and habits of the
+previous inhabitants; and ultimately adopted
+the forms of government and religion which
+for a time they subverted; and within the
+limits of the Western empire, in the place of
+the Imperial head, constituted ten contemporary
+kingdoms. These were a continuation
+of the former government, and were symbolized
+by:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Ten-Horned Beast.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I was standing on the sand of the sea, and saw a
+wild beast ascending out of the sea, having ten horns and
+seven heads, and on his horns ten diadems, and on his
+heads names of reviling. And the wild beast, which I saw
+was like a leopard, and his feet were like those of a bear,
+and his mouth like the mouth of a lion: and the dragon
+gave him his power, and his throne, and great authority.
+And I saw one of his heads as it were wounded to death;
+and his deadly wound was healed: and all the world admired
+and followed the beast. And they worshipped the
+dragon, for he gave power to the wild beast: and they
+worshipped the wild beast, saying, Who is like the wild
+beast, and who is able to make war with him?</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 18:1-4.
+</span></div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page169">[pg 169]</span><a name="Pg169" id="Pg169" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sea, from which this beast emerged,
+is evidently the turbulent state of anarchy, to
+which the people of the fourth kingdom had
+been reduced, on its subversion. And the
+beast which came up out of the sea, represents
+the forms of government which then arose.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Its heads and horns synchronize with those
+of the dragonic monster, which had preceded
+it, and disappeared from the view of the revelator.
+And they doubtless symbolize the same
+forms of government. See pp. <a href="#Pg145" class="tei tei-ref">145-148</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The ten crowns encircling its horns, indicate
+that an era is foreshadowed, when the
+sovereignty of the kingdom shall have been
+transferred from the forms of government symbolized
+by the heads,—which had before been
+encircled by the crowns,—to that represented
+by the horns. There is great unanimity
+among Protestant writers, in regarding these
+as the first ten kingdoms which existed in
+the western empire arising during the period
+of its decline, viz:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+1. The Huns in Hungary, from A. D. 356.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+2. The Ostrogoths in Mysia, from A. D.
+377. They invaded Italy, and conquered the
+Heruli in 493; and were defeated in 538 by
+Justinian, when the Pope was placed in quiet
+possession of the capital of Rome.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+3. The Visigoths in Pannonia, from A. D.
+378 to 408, when they removed to the south of
+France till 585. They then removed to, and
+subjugated Spain.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page170">[pg 170]</span><a name="Pg170" id="Pg170" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+4. The Franks in France, from A. D. 407.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+5. The Vandals in Spain, from A. D. 407
+till 427, when they removed to Africa, and
+continued an independent kingdom till subjugated
+by Justinian in 533.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+6. The Suevi and Alans in Gascoigne and
+Spain, from 407 till 585.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+7. The Burgundians in Burgundy, from
+A. D. 407 till 524, when they became subject
+for a time to the Franks; but afterwards they
+arose again to an independent kingdom.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+8. The Heruli, who advanced into Italy
+under Attila, and in 476 terminated the imperial
+rule by the dethronement of Agustulus.
+They were in turn conquered by the Ostrogoths
+in A. D. 493.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+9. The Saxons and Angles in Britain from
+about A. D. 450. And,
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+10. The Lombards in Germany, from A.
+D. 483.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The name of blasphemy, on the heads of
+this beast, identifies it as the successor and
+representative of the persecuting power which
+sought the life of the Man-child, (12:4), and
+caused the woman to flee to the wilderness,
+12:14.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Its characteristics resemble those of the
+lion, bear, and leopard, of Daniel's vision
+(Dan. 7:4-6), which respectively symbolized
+the Babylonian, Medo-Persian, and Grecian
+kingdoms. These mark it as their
+successor—synchronizing with Daniel's ten-horned
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page171">[pg 171]</span><a name="Pg171" id="Pg171" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+nondescript beast, (Dan. 7:7); which
+was the fourth kingdom that should exist on
+the earth, and the ten horns of which, symbolized
+the same ten-fold partition of the
+Roman empire.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His power, seat, and great authority being
+given by the dragon, is another evidence that
+it is a continuation of that fourth kingdom
+succeeding to its sovereignty. The laws of
+the ancient empire were generally adopted by
+the ten kingdoms, which assumed and exercised
+the prerogatives of ancient Rome. Says
+Bossuet: <span class="tei tei-q">“Whoever carefully examines the
+laws of the Theodosian and Justinian codes
+against heretics, will see that they are the
+source of the decrees against them, that
+the church, aided by the edicts of princes,
+enacted in the third and fourth Lateran councils.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The head, which was as it were wounded
+to death, would indicate that under the government
+symbolized by that head, the life of the
+beast had become apparently extinct. This
+was the case when the empire was subverted.
+In the succession of the previous forms of
+government, the empire itself was not in any
+particular peril. They gave place, each to its
+successor, without any subversion of the government.
+But when the seventh head ceased
+to exercise sovereignty, the beast itself was
+apparently dead. The wound, however, did
+not prove mortal. The beast still lived. Its
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page172">[pg 172]</span><a name="Pg172" id="Pg172" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+sovereignty was perpetuated by the decemregal
+governments; which constituted the
+eighth form of government—symbolized by
+the beast that was, is not, and yet is again in
+existence and will continue till the day of perdition,
+17:11; 19:20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They worshipped the dragon and beast, by
+regarding the latter as a continuation of the
+former power, and regarding the sovereign
+power of Rome as unparalleled and invincible—as
+is shown by the questions: <span class="tei tei-q">“Who is like
+unto the beast? Who is able to make war
+with him?”</span> Those combined governments
+were regarded by their subjects with wonder
+and veneration. Says Mr. Lord: <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+serfs and common people, sunk for ages to the
+most degraded vassalage, revered the monarchs,
+the various ranks of nobles, and their
+armed followers, as a superior race, while poets
+and historians celebrated their warlike exploits,
+and philosophers and priests justified
+their usurpations, and eulogized the wisdom
+and benignity of their rule.”</span>
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Mouth of the Beast.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And there was given to him a mouth speaking great
+things and revilings; and power was given to him to make
+war forty-two months. And he opened his mouth in reviling
+against God, to revile his name, and his tabernacle, and
+those who dwell in heaven. And it was given to him
+to make war with the saints, and to overcome them: and
+power was given him over every tribe, and people, and
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page173">[pg 173]</span><a name="Pg173" id="Pg173" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+tongue, and nation. And all, who dwell on the earth,
+will worship him, whose names are not written in the book
+of life of the slain Lamb, from the foundation of the world.
+If any one hath an ear, let him hear. If any one leadeth
+into captivity, he will go into captivity: if any one killeth
+by the sword, he must be killed with the sword. Here is the
+patience and the faith of the saints.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 13:5-10.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The mouth of the beast, must symbolize the
+agency by which utterance is given to the
+great things and blasphemies which are
+spoken by it. Its likeness to the mouth of
+the lion, shows its resemblance to the Babylonian
+worship of the dead. Moses was <span class="tei tei-q">“not
+eloquent,”</span>—he was <span class="tei tei-q">“slow of speech and of a
+slow tongue,”</span> and the Lord said to him,
+Aaron <span class="tei tei-q">“shall be thy spokesman unto the
+people: and he shall be, even he shall be to
+thee instead of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">a mouth</span></em>,”</span> Ex. 4:10, 16. As
+Aaron was a mouth to Moses, so did the
+Papacy become a mouth-piece for the Roman
+kingdoms. It was the agency by which the
+people were taught; and through which utterance
+was given to the blasphemies of the
+beast. It fills a place analogous to that of the
+image afterwards symbolized, which also had
+like power to speak blasphemies. See p. <a href="#Pg188" class="tei tei-ref">188</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The beast had power to continue to utter
+blasphemies by the mouth given to it, forty-two
+months. This identifies the mouth
+with that of the <span class="tei tei-q">“little horn”</span> (Dan. 7:25),
+of which it was said, <span class="tei tei-q">“He shall speak
+great words against the Most High, and think
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page174">[pg 174]</span><a name="Pg174" id="Pg174" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+to change times and laws: and they shall be
+given into his hand until a time and times
+and the dividing of time”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> 1260 prophetic
+days.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+1. This mouth uttered blasphemy against
+God by claiming to be Christ's vicegerent—usurping
+the prerogatives of the Almighty.
+The Pope claimed that he was <span class="tei tei-q">“Judge, as
+God's Vicar, and could himself be judged by
+none.”</span> In A. D. 799, a Roman council
+declined to hear accusations against the Pope,
+declaring that <span class="tei tei-q">“he who was Judge of all men,
+was above being judged by any other than
+himself.”</span> Febroni wrote of the Pope: <span class="tei tei-q">“He
+is the Prince of princes and Lord of lords.
+He is, as it were, a God on earth. He is
+above right, superior to law, superior to the
+canons. He can do all things against right,
+and without right. He is able to free from
+obligation in matters of positive right, without
+any cause, and they who are so released are
+safe in respect to God.”</span> Assuming such prerogatives,
+and the power to forgive sins, the
+Holy name of God was blasphemed.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+2. He blasphemed the tabernacle of God
+by <span class="tei tei-q">“exalting himself above all that is called
+God, or that is worshipped; so that he as
+God sitteth in the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">temple</span></em> of God, showing
+himself that he is God,”</span> 2 Thess. 2:2. The
+Pope claimed to be the head of the church and
+that from himself was derived the authority
+of all bishops and other clergy. He usurped
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page175">[pg 175]</span><a name="Pg175" id="Pg175" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the powers in the church, which only Christ,
+its Supreme Head and Lawgiver can exercise.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+3. Those in heaven were blasphemed, by
+the ascription to them of the attributes and
+prerogatives of God; and by representing
+them as being well pleased with the bestowal
+on them of divine honors. Saint-worship by
+the Papists and demon-worship by the Pagans
+are alike. They both ascribe the same attributes
+to the spirits of the departed,—all the
+gods of the heathen being the ghosts of their
+departed heroes. A revival of this blasphemy,
+is subsequently symbolized by the frog-like
+spirits which emerge from the mouths of the
+beast, the dragon, and false prophet, 16:13,—see
+p. <a href="#Pg255" class="tei tei-ref">255</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In connection with and in obedience to this
+mouth, the beast warred with the saints, and
+overcame them. Dissenters from the Papacy
+were subjected to unheard of cruelties and
+persecutions. And they whose names were
+not written in the book of life, sustained their
+rulers in these oppressive acts. In paying
+more deference to the edicts of government
+than to the requirements of Jehovah, they blasphemously
+bestowed on the beast an homage
+which was due only to God.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The revelator being shown what was to be
+endured by the saints during a long period of
+oppression, now receives an annunciation to
+which all were to listen,—all who had ears to
+hear. It was the announcement, that <span class="tei tei-q">“if any
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page176">[pg 176]</span><a name="Pg176" id="Pg176" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+one leadeth into captivity, he will go into captivity:
+if any one killeth with the sword, he
+must be killed with the sword.”</span> Most commentators
+have considered this as applicable
+to the fate of the wild beast,—that its end
+was to be effected by the sword and captivity,
+as it had in the same way tyrannized over the
+saints. Mr. Lord offers some reasons for supposing
+that it was a caution to the saints not
+to resist with the sword the attacks of enemies,
+nor to retaliate by making captives of the subjects
+of the beast who should fall into their
+power. He says:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The prediction that he who led into captivity
+should himself become a captive, and he
+that slew with the sword be himself slain, had
+a signal fulfilment in the slaughter and vassalage
+of all those who attempted to deliver
+themselves by force from the religious tyranny
+of the European monarchs.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Albigenses were nearly exterminated
+by the cruel armies against which they attempted
+to defend themselves, and the small
+number that remained after the devastation of
+their fields, the conflagration of their cities,
+and the promiscuous slaughters to which they
+were subjected, were either forced to conform
+to the Catholic church, or driven into other
+lands. The Waldenses perished in far greater
+numbers by the sword, in their struggles for
+preservation and freedom, than by the fires of
+martyrdom; and sunk, after their contests, to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page177">[pg 177]</span><a name="Pg177" id="Pg177" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a still more hopeless vassalage to their persecutors.
+The resort to the sword by the
+Bohemians and the Huguenots of France, to
+defend their religious freedom, resulted, after
+vast slaughters, in their defeat and helpless
+subjection to the tyranny from which they
+endeavored to extricate themselves. And the
+Protestants of Switzerland, Germany, Holland,
+Denmark, Sweden, and Great Britain,
+who succeeded in delivering themselves from
+the dominion of their ancient tyrants, instead
+of securing thereby their religious liberty, only
+placed themselves, by the nationalization of
+their churches, under the tyranny of Protestant
+rulers in place of Catholics.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Exp. of
+Apoc.</span></span> p. 384.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In this was to be exhibited the patience and
+faith of the saints, who, amid all their persecutions,
+made a wonderful manifestation of
+these. Of the many thousands put to death,
+or subjected to satanic cruelties for their faith,
+only a very few apostatized. Says Mr.
+Lord:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Of those who, under the insupportable
+agonies and distraction of the scourge and the
+rack, recanted, or promised a recantation, a
+large proportion immediately on being released
+from the sufferings which had overcome them,
+abjured their retractions, re-professed with
+redoubled energy the faith of Christ, and met
+without faltering the hideous death to which
+they were immediately hurried. Such is their
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page178">[pg 178]</span><a name="Pg178" id="Pg178" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+uniform history in whatever age they fell, or
+to whatever nation or rank they belonged.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Exp.
+of Apoc.</span></span>, p. 385.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+If there was no other evidence of their constancy,
+faith, and patience, the horrid instruments
+of torture which were resorted to to
+terrify them, testify to their adherence to their
+principles, which required such engines for
+their subversion.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The end of this beast, will be effected by
+his being cast alive into the lake of fire and
+brimstone, when the Lord shall make war
+with him, 19:20. This is also the end of
+Daniel's fourth beast, whose body is to be
+given to the burning flame (Dan. 7:11), and
+of the scarlet-colored beast on which the
+woman was seated, which is to go into perdition,
+17:8.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Two-Horned Beast.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw another wild beast ascending out of the
+earth, and he had two horns like a lamb, and he spoke like
+a dragon. And he exerciseth all the power of the first wild
+beast, in his sight, and causeth the earth and those, who
+dwell in it, to worship the first wild beast, whose deadly
+wound was healed. And he performeth great signs, so that
+he causeth fire to come down from heaven into the earth in
+the sight of men. And he deceiveth those, who dwell on
+the earth, by means of the signs which it was given him to
+perform in the sight of the wild beast; saying to those, who
+dwell on the earth, that they should make an image to the
+wild beast, that had the wound by a sword, and did live.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+13:11-14.
+</span></div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page179">[pg 179]</span><a name="Pg179" id="Pg179" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The coming up of another beast must symbolize
+the rise of another government. As
+the two-horned beast exercises its power before
+(ενωπιον) <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">in the presence</span></em>, of the first
+beast, it is a contemporary power, and must
+necessarily symbolize a kingdom outside of
+the territory of the ten-horned beast. Within
+that territory it would be one of the horns of
+that beast; but a separate beast requires a
+separate territory. As it arises out of the
+earth, while it is outside of the territory occupied
+by the ten kingdoms, it must exist within
+that occupied by the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">former</span></em> Roman empire,
+and commence its existence during a period
+of settled government.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+All the forms of Roman government symbolized
+by the dragon, were also symbolized
+by the wild beast; and as the deadly wound
+of the former was healed in the latter, the two
+constitute one beast. As that is called the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“first beast,”</span> the rise of the kingdom symbolized
+by the two-horned beast must have
+been subsequent to the commencement of the
+Roman empire. And as it caused those who
+dwell on the earth to worship that beast after
+its deadly wound was healed, it must have
+arisen anterior to the healing of that wound;
+and, consequently, before the succession of
+the ten kingdoms to the sovereignty of Rome,
+with which it held an intimate relation.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The only kingdom which has arisen within
+the geographical locality, and at the epoch
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page180">[pg 180]</span><a name="Pg180" id="Pg180" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+required by these conditions of the symbol, is
+the Eastern Roman empire; which, consequently,
+is the government represented by the
+two-horned beast.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The imperial heads of Rome date from the
+battle of Actium, B. C. 31; but the Eastern
+empire was not commenced, till A. D. 324,
+when Constantine removed the seat of empire
+from Rome to Constantinople. Rome was,
+previous to that removal, the undisputed
+queen of nations, and Constantine was without
+a rival. Why he should abandon Rome,
+the citadel and throne of the Cæsars, for an
+obscure corner of Thrace, has never been satisfactorily
+explained. Says Dr. Croly: <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+change of government to Constantinople still
+perplexes the historian. It was an act in
+direct repugnance to the whole course of the
+ancient prejudices.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The indifference with which Constantine
+viewed the country of the Cæsars, was regarded
+by Gibbon as the cause of removal.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+He transferred the customs and forms of
+the Roman government, and there exercised
+all the powers of the empire,—the Italians
+still obeying the edicts which he condescended
+to address from Constantinople to the Senate
+and people of Rome. The western division
+continued dependent on the eastern head, till
+the death of Theodosius, A. D. 395. His two
+sons, Arcadius and Honorius, <span class="tei tei-q">“were saluted
+by the unanimous consent of mankind, as the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page181">[pg 181]</span><a name="Pg181" id="Pg181" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+lawful emperors of the East, and of the
+West,”</span>—the European boundary being <span class="tei tei-q">“not
+very different from that which separates the
+Germans from the Turks.”</span>—Gibbon, v. 2, p.
+199. Gibbon calls this <span class="tei tei-q">“the final and permanent
+division of the Roman empire.”</span> But its
+existence as a beast more properly dates from
+the removal of Constantine.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Its two horns like a lamb, must symbolize
+two divisions of the kingdom. These may be
+contemporary, like those symbolized by the
+ten horns (17:12), or successive, like the two
+horns of the ram, Dan. 8:3, 20. From the
+history of the Eastern empire, the latter is
+the more probable; and its historical resemblance
+to the government symbolized by the
+ram, may be the reason of the comparison to
+<span class="tei tei-q">“horns like a lamb.”</span> As Persia was a government
+outside of Media, and succeeded to
+its sovereignty, so did the kingdom of the
+Turks originate outside of the Eastern empire,
+and at length come in, occupy its territory,
+and succeed to its sovereignty, A. D.
+1253. With this view, the horns would symbolize
+the kings of Eastern Rome and of
+Turkey. See pp. <a href="#Pg099" class="tei tei-ref">99-104</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Its dragon-like speech shows it to be a
+blasphemous, persecuting power, like that
+which persecuted the woman, 12:17. Though
+the Greek empire claimed to be Christian, a
+successor of Constantine, Julian the Apostate,
+renounced Christianity, endeavored to restore
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page182">[pg 182]</span><a name="Pg182" id="Pg182" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the Pagan service in Constantinople, and <span class="tei tei-q">“declared
+himself the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">implacable enemy of Christ</span></em>.”</span>
+He assumed the character of Supreme Pontiff,
+and thus placed himself at the head of the
+Pagan worship. He labored incessantly to
+restore and propagate those dragonic rites, and
+even thought to disprove the predictions of
+Christ by rebuilding the temple of Jerusalem.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“He affected to pity the unhappy Christians, as
+mistaken in the most important object of their
+lives; but his pity was degraded by contempt,
+his contempt was embittered by hatred;
+and the sentiments of Julian were expressed
+in a style of sarcastic wit which
+inflicts a deep and deadly wound whenever it
+issues from the mouth of a sovereign.”</span> And
+he intimated that they might have occasion
+<span class="tei tei-q">“to dread, not only confiscation and exile, but
+fire and the sword.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The successors of Julian, though Christian
+in name, issued cruel and tyrannical edicts.
+Valens embraced Arianism, and bitterly persecuted
+the Orthodox party. Justinian established
+Catholicism by arms. Theodosius
+proscribed Paganism by the infliction
+of severe penalties. Marcian and Leo <span class="tei tei-q">“enforced,
+with arms and edicts, the symbols of
+their faith,”</span> and it was declared that <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+decrees of the synod of Chalcedon might be
+lawfully supported, even with blood.”</span> And
+after the accession of the Mohammedan power,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page183">[pg 183]</span><a name="Pg183" id="Pg183" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+religious intolerance towards dissenting
+creeds was still more rigidly enforced.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Eastern empire exercised all the power
+of the Western. The original organization
+of its government was the same, and it had
+the same titles and prerogatives. Gibbon
+says of Julian: <span class="tei tei-q">“The spirit of his administration,
+and his regard for the place of his nativity,
+induced him to confer on the senate of
+Constantinople the same honors, privileges,
+and authority which were still enjoyed by the
+senate of ancient Rome.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It caused worship to be bestowed on the
+first beast, by extending to the Latin rulers
+that aid which enabled them to perpetuate
+their system of tyranny, to legislate over the
+laws and subjects of Jehovah, and to claim
+the obedience which only God can demand.
+The arms of Justinian, both in the East and
+West, caused the Roman name to be respected,
+and its favor sought for.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The wonders to be performed by it, may be
+as yet involved in some obscurity. But by
+these it is identified as the power which afterwards
+became the seat of the False Prophet.
+When the <span class="tei tei-q">“beast”</span> is taken, <span class="tei tei-q">“the false prophet
+that wrought miracles before him, with which
+he deceived them that had the mark of the
+beast, and them that worshipped his image,”</span>
+is cast with him <span class="tei tei-q">“into a lake of fire burning
+with brimstone,”</span> 19:20. This identifies the
+two-horned beast as the Mohammedan kingdom.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page184">[pg 184]</span><a name="Pg184" id="Pg184" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+It also proves that the Romanic Turkish
+government will continue till the Second Advent.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Among the wonders it would perform,
+making fire come down from heaven is specified.
+John does not intimate that he saw, in
+vision, fire thus descend. The fact is spoken
+of; and therefore it is not necessarily symbolic,
+but may refer to literal fire. Gibbon,
+in speaking of <span class="tei tei-q">“the novelty, the terrors, and
+the real efficacy of the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Greek fire</span></span>,”</span> for which
+the Eastern empire was so famous, says:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The important secret of compounding and
+directing this artificial flame was imparted by
+Callinicus, a native of Heliopolis, in Syria,
+who deserted from the service of the caliph to
+that of the emperor. The skill of a chemist
+and engineer was equivalent to the succor of
+fleets and armies; and this discovery or improvement
+of the military art was fortunately
+reserved for the distressful period, when the
+degenerate Romans of the East were incapable
+of contending with the warlike enthusiasm
+and youthful vigor of the Saracens. The historian
+who presumes to analyze this extraordinary
+composition, should suspect his own
+ignorance and that of his Byzantine guides, so
+prone to the marvellous, so careless, and, in
+this instance, so jealous of the truth. From
+their obscure, and perhaps fallacious hints, it
+should seem that the principal ingredient of
+the Greek fire was the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">naphtha</span></span>, or liquid bitumen,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page185">[pg 185]</span><a name="Pg185" id="Pg185" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a light, tenacious, and inflammable oil,
+which springs from the earth, and catches
+fire as soon as it comes in contact with the
+air. The naphtha was mingled, I know not by
+what methods, or in what proportions, with
+sulphur, and with the pitch that is extracted
+from evergreen firs. From this mixture,
+which produced a thick smoke and a loud explosion,
+proceeded a fierce and obstinate flame,
+which not only rose in perpendicular ascent,
+but likewise burned with equal vehemence in
+descent or lateral progress; instead of being
+extinguished, it was nourished and quickened
+by the element of water; and sand, urine, or
+vinegar, were the only remedies that could
+damp the fury of this powerful agent, which
+was justly denominated by the Greeks, the
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">liquid</span></em>, or <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">maritime</span></em> fire. For the annoyance
+of the enemy, it was employed with equal
+effect by sea and land, in battles or in sieges.
+It was either poured from the rampart in
+large boilers, or launched in red-hot balls of
+stone and iron, or darted in arrows and javelins,
+twisted round with flax and tow, which
+had deeply imbibed the inflammable oil;
+sometimes it was deposited in fire-ships, the
+victims and instruments of a more ample revenge,
+and was most commonly blown through
+long tubes of copper, which were planted on
+the prow of a galley, and fancifully shaped
+into the mouths of savage monsters, that
+seemed to vomit a stream of liquid and consuming
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page186">[pg 186]</span><a name="Pg186" id="Pg186" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+fire. This important art was preserved
+at Constantinople, as the palladium of
+the state; the galleys and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">artillery</span></em> might occasionally
+be lent to the allies of Rome; but
+the composition on the Greek fire was concealed
+with the most jealous scruple, and the
+terror of the enemies was increased and prolonged
+by their ignorance and surprise. In
+the treatise of the administration of the empire,
+the royal author suggests the answers and excuses
+that might best elude the indiscreet curiosity
+and importunate demands of the barbarians.
+They should be told that the mystery
+of the Greek fire had been revealed by an
+angel to the first and greatest of the Constantines,
+with a sacred injunction, that this gift
+of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">heaven</span></em>, this peculiar blessing of the Romans
+should never be communicated to any
+foreign nation; that the prince and subject
+were alike bound to religious silence
+under the temporal and spiritual penalties of
+treason and sacrilege; and that the impious
+attempt would provoke the sudden and supernatural
+vengeance of the God of the Christians.
+By these precautions the secret was
+confined, above four hundred years, to the
+Romans of the East; and at the end of the
+eleventh century, the Pisans, to whom every
+sea and every art were familiar, suffered the
+effects, without understanding the composition,
+of the Greek fire. It was at length
+either discovered or stolen by the Mohammedans;
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page187">[pg 187]</span><a name="Pg187" id="Pg187" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and, in the holy wars of Syria and
+Egypt, they retorted an invention, contrived
+against themselves, on the heads of the Christians.
+A knight, who despised the swords
+and lances of the Saracens, relates, with
+heartfelt sincerity, his own fears and those of
+his companions, at the sight and sound of the
+mischievous engine that discharged a torrent
+of the Greek fire, the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">feu Gregeois</span></span>, as it is
+styled by the more early of the French writers.
+It came flying through the air, says
+Joinville, like a winged long-tailed dragon,
+about the thickness of a hogshead, with the report
+of thunder, and the velocity of lightning;
+and the darkness of night was <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">dispelled by this
+deadly illumination</span></em>.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Hist.
+Rome</span></span>, vol. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">III.</span></span>,
+pp. 465-467.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Its use is thus described by the same author,
+when the Greeks turned its power against
+the Saracens, at the siege of Constantinople,
+A. D. 718:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Greeks would gladly have ransomed
+their religion and empire, by a fine or assessment
+of a piece of gold on the head of each
+inhabitant of the city; but the liberal offer
+was rejected with disdain, and the presumption
+of Moslemah was exalted by the speedy
+approach and invincible force of the natives
+of Egypt and Syria. They are said to have
+amounted to eighteen hundred ships: the
+number betrays their inconsiderable size; and
+of the twenty stout and capacious vessels,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page188">[pg 188]</span><a name="Pg188" id="Pg188" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+whose magnitude impeded their progress,
+each was manned with no more than one
+hundred heavy-armed soldiers. This huge
+armada proceeded on a smooth sea and with
+a gentle gale, towards the mouth of the Bosphorus;
+the surface of the strait was over-shadowed,
+in the language of the Greeks,
+with a moving forest, and the same fatal
+night had been fixed by the Saracen chief for
+a general assault by sea and land. To allure
+the confidence of the enemy, the emperor had
+thrown aside the chain that usually guarded
+the entrance of the harbor: but while they
+hesitated whether they should seize the opportunity
+or apprehend the snare, the ministers
+of destruction were at hand. The fireships
+of the Greeks were launched against them:
+the Arabs, their arms and vessels, were involved
+in the same flames, the disorderly fugitives
+were dashed against each other, or
+overwhelmed in the waves; and I no longer
+find a vestige of the fleet, that had threatened
+to extirpate the Roman name.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>, p. 464.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It deceiveth them that dwell on the earth
+by its miracles. This deception resulted in
+the creation of:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Image of the Beast.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And it was given to him to give breath to the image of
+the wild beast, that the image of the wild beast should even
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page189">[pg 189]</span><a name="Pg189" id="Pg189" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+speak, and to cause, that as many as would not worship
+the image of the wild beast, should be killed. And he
+causeth all, the small and the great, and the rich and the
+poor, and the free and the bond, to receive a mark on their
+right hand, or on their forehead. And that no one might
+buy or sell, but he, who had the mark, the name of the
+wild beast, or the number of his name.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 13:15-18.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This new creation is not another beast, but
+the image of one. An image is only the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">likeness</span></em>
+of something. As the beast symbolizes a political
+power, its image must symbolize some
+analogous power of a different nature; and
+this likeness can only be found in a religious
+government.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+1. The beast which received its death-wound
+(v. 14), was the form of government
+to which the image was made, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, the imperial.
+Of this the Roman hierarchy was a
+perfect counterpart. It was an ecclesiastical
+government, coëxtensive in its authority with
+the political power of the empire. And, like
+the officers of the civil, there was a regular
+gradation of rank in the subordinates of the
+religious government. The head of the former
+was an emperor, chosen by an electoral college,—the
+senators of Rome.<a id="noteref_3" name="noteref_3" href="#note_3"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">3</span></span></a> The head of
+the latter was a Pope, chosen in a similar
+manner by the college of Cardinals,—the
+ecclesiastical senators of the religious empire.
+Each of those bodies constituted the highest
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page190">[pg 190]</span><a name="Pg190" id="Pg190" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+deliberative and legislative body in its respective
+government. The empire had its governors
+of provinces, appointed by the imperial
+head; and the spiritual rule of the church
+was, in like manner, sustained by diocesan
+bishops who, in their respective provinces,
+were governors in spiritual matters and creatures
+of the Pope. Subordinate offices in the
+state and church, also, singularly corresponded.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+2. The religious customs of the empire, as
+well as its political, were likewise imitated by
+the papacy. Rome deified her heroes; the
+papacy canonized her saints. The ghosts of
+the departed were the gods of the heathen;
+and the papists supplicate the dead. The
+Pagans burned incense to their gods; the Papists
+burn incense in their religious ceremonies.
+The ancient heathen sprinkled themselves
+with <span class="tei tei-q">“holy water;”</span> the Papists use
+the same material in a similar manner. Lactantius
+says of the Pagans, they <span class="tei tei-q">“light up
+candles to God as if he lived in the dark;
+and do they not deserve to pass for madmen
+who offer lamps to the author and giver of
+light?”</span> This custom is imitated by the Papists
+in the use of wax candles on their altars.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The ancient Romans prostrated themselves
+before images of wood and stone; and Jerome
+tells us that <span class="tei tei-q">“by idols were to be understood
+the images of the dead.”</span> In Catholic
+Rome, worshippers prostrated themselves before
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page191">[pg 191]</span><a name="Pg191" id="Pg191" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+images of departed saints. The old Roman
+Pantheon, which was dedicated by
+Agrippa <span class="tei tei-q">“to Jove, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">and all the gods</span></em>,”</span> was re-consecrated
+by Pope Boniface IV., about A. D.
+610, <span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">to the blessed Virgin and all the
+saints</span></em>.”</span> As in the old pagan temple, any
+stranger could find the god of his own country;
+so in its re-consecrated state, each country
+could find its patron saint. Other temples
+were changed and re-consecrated in the
+same manner. The ancient statue of Jupiter
+stands now as the statue of St. Peter. The
+pagans had their vestal virgins; the Papists
+their nuns.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Dr. Middleton, who visited Rome in 1729,
+says:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Nothing, I found, concurred so much with
+my original intention of conversing with the
+ancients; or so much helped my imagination,
+to find myself wandering about in old heathen
+Rome, as to observe and attend to their religious
+worship; all whose ceremonies appear
+plainly to have been copied from the rituals
+of primitive Paganism: as if handed down by
+an uninterrupted succession from the priests
+of old, to the priests of new Rome, whilst
+each of them readily explained, and called to
+mind some passages of a classic author, where
+the same ceremony was described, as transacted
+in the same form and manner, and in
+the same place where I now saw it executed
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page192">[pg 192]</span><a name="Pg192" id="Pg192" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+before my eyes.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Dowl. Hist. of Rom.</span></span>, p.
+114.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Says Mr. Lord:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“After a struggle of more than four centuries,
+the ecclesiastics of all the hierarchies in
+the empire were united in one vast organization,
+with the pontiff as their supreme legislative
+and judicial head, and a single ecclesiastical
+government was established over the
+whole Roman church, after the model of the
+civil government of the ancient empire under
+Constantine and his successors. It is, accordingly,
+denominated by Catholics themselves
+a monarchy. <span class="tei tei-q">‘All Catholic doctors agree
+in this, that the ecclesiastical government
+committed to men by God is a monarchy.’</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Bellarmini
+de Rom. Pont.</span></span>, lib. i., c. v. Bellarmine
+devotes his first book <span class="tei tei-q">‘of the Pontiff’</span>
+to prove that such is and ought to be its government.
+<span class="tei tei-q">‘If the monarchical is the best form
+of government, as we have shown, and it is
+certain that the church of God instituted by
+Christ its head, who is supremely wise, ought
+to be governed in the best manner, who can
+deny that its rule ought to be monarchical?’</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>,
+i., c. ix., p. 527.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The canonists are accustomed, accordingly,
+to denominate the Pope a king.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The pontiffs were as absolutely the legislative
+and judicial head of this ecclesiastical
+kingdom, as the emperors from Constantine to
+Augustulus were of the civil empire, and imposed
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page193">[pg 193]</span><a name="Pg193" id="Pg193" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+whatever laws they pleased on subordinate
+ecclesiastics and on the church by decrees,
+in the same manner as those emperors
+enacted laws by edicts. The decrees, bulls of
+canonization, sentences, charters, and other
+legislative and judicial acts of the pontiffs,
+from Gregory VII., in 1073, to Benedict XIV.,
+in 1757, collected in the Bullarium Magnum,
+fill nineteen folios. Many others are contained
+in the decretals and councils.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“They appointed to all ecclesiastical offices
+throughout the empire, as the Christian emperors
+appointed to all civil and military offices
+in their dominions.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“They exacted oaths of fidelity from all
+whom they advanced to important offices; as
+the emperors exacted engagements of fidelity
+from their civil magistrates.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“They established courts in which all violations
+of their laws were tried, and a tribunal
+at the capital for the decision of appeals.
+There were gradations of rank in the hierarchy,
+like those of the magistrates of the civil empire.
+The hierarchies, as nationalized by
+Constantine, were formed in each patriarchate,
+after the model of the civil government in the
+provinces. The hierarchy of the western
+kingdoms, under the Pope, was formed after
+that pattern; having archbishops or metropolitans
+at the head of the clergy of each nation,
+or large district, and bishops, abbots, and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page194">[pg 194]</span><a name="Pg194" id="Pg194" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a long catalogue of subordinate ranks, under
+each metropolitan.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“They levied taxes for their support on
+ecclesiastics and laics.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“They inflicted ecclesiastical penalties on
+the violators of their laws; exclusion from
+communion, suspension from office, deposition,
+excommunication, and a sentence of
+eternal death.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Exp. of Apoc.</span></span>, pp. 429-432.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These, with many other striking resemblances,
+demonstrate that the Roman hierarchy,
+in all its great features, was a counterpart
+to imperial Rome—an image of, and
+belonging to, the seven-headed, ten-horned
+monster, whose deadly wound was healed.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Life was to be given to this image by the
+two-horned beast. The papal hierarchy is created
+when its supremacy over other churches
+is declared and <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">sustained</span></em>; and the power by
+which this is done, is that which gives life to
+it. This was done, according to the following
+history, by the Eastern empire.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The power of the papacy, symbolized by
+the image, had been predicted in Daniel under
+the symbol of <span class="tei tei-q">“a Little Horn,”</span> that came up
+among the previous <span class="tei tei-q">“ten horns,”</span> before whom
+<span class="tei tei-q">“there were three of the first horns plucked
+up by the roots: and behold, in this horn
+were eyes like the eyes of man, and a mouth
+speaking great things,”</span> Dan. 7:8. These
+horns were thus explained to Daniel: <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page195">[pg 195]</span><a name="Pg195" id="Pg195" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+fourth beast shall be the fourth kingdom upon
+earth, which shall be diverse from all kingdoms,
+and shall devour the whole earth, and
+shall tread it down, and break it in pieces.
+And the ten horns out of this kingdom are ten
+kings that shall arise: and another shall
+arise after them; and he shall be diverse from
+the first, and he shall subdue three kings.
+And he shall speak great words against the
+Most High, and shall wear out the saints of
+the Most High, and think to change times
+and laws: and they shall be given into his
+hand until a time and times and the dividing
+of time. But the judgment shall sit,
+and they shall take away his dominion to
+consume and to destroy it unto the end. And
+the kingdom and dominion, and the greatness
+of the kingdom under the whole heaven, shall
+be given to the people of the saints of the
+Most High, whose kingdom is an everlasting
+kingdom, and all dominions shall serve and
+obey him.”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> vs. 23-27.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+When Paul spoke of the second coming of
+Christ, in his first epistle to the Thessalonians,
+they understood that it was an event then
+imminent. The apostle, in his second epistle,
+corrects this impression, by referring to the
+foregoing prediction in Daniel, which must be
+previously fulfilled. He assures them that
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the day of Christ”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“shall not come, except
+there be”</span> an apostasy, or <span class="tei tei-q">“a falling away
+first, and that Man of Sin,”</span> or the lawless
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page196">[pg 196]</span><a name="Pg196" id="Pg196" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+one, <span class="tei tei-q">“be revealed, the son of perdition; who
+opposeth and exalteth himself above all that
+is called God, or that is worshipped; so that
+he, as God, sitteth in the temple of God,
+showing himself that he is God. Remember
+ye not, that when I was yet with you, I told
+you these things? And now ye know what
+withholdeth that he might be revealed in his
+time. For the mystery of iniquity doth already
+work: only he who now letteth will
+let, until he be taken out of the way. And
+then shall that Wicked be revealed, whom the
+Lord shall consume with the spirit of his
+mouth, and shall destroy with the brightness
+of his coming,”</span> 2 Thess. 2:2-8.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The uniform application of these predictions
+to the Papacy, by Protestant writers, renders
+it unnecessary to argue this point. That
+power began early to be manifested, but its
+full development was <span class="tei tei-q">“let,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, hindered, by
+the continuance of the Western empire, which
+had to be taken out of its way. Tertullian,
+near the close of the second century, in expounding
+those words, says: <span class="tei tei-q">“Who can this
+be but the Roman state, the division of which
+into ten kingdoms will bring on Antichrist?”</span>
+And he gives as a reason why the Christians
+of his time prayed for the Roman empire: that
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the greatest calamity hanging over the world
+was retarded by the continuance of it</span></em>. Cyril
+of Jerusalem in the fourth century applied the
+passage in the same manner, and says:
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page197">[pg 197]</span><a name="Pg197" id="Pg197" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Thus the predicted Antichrist will come
+when the times of the Roman empire shall be
+fulfilled, and the consummation of the world
+shall approach. Ten kings of the Romans
+shall arise together, in different places indeed,
+but they shall reign at the same time. Among
+these the eleventh is Antichrist, who, by magical
+and wicked artifice, shall seize the Roman
+power.”</span> A large number of the ancient
+fathers interpreted this text in the same manner.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 257, 1260 years before the time of
+Luther, Stephen, Bishop of Rome, began to
+act the pope in good earnest,—excommunicating
+those who dissented from the doctrines
+of Rome.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In 312, 1260 years before the massacre of
+St. Bartholomew in 1572, Constantine became
+Emperor of Rome, embraced Christianity, and
+terminated the last and bloodiest of the Pagan
+persecutions—that of Diocletian, which had
+continued ten years. Constantine undertook
+to remodel the church, in conformity to the
+government of the state, and the unhallowed
+union of the two resulted in the dignities of
+patriarchs, exarchs, archbishops, canons, prebendaries,
+&amp;c., which he endowed with wealth
+and worldly honors.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+While paganism was superseded by Christianity
+under Constantine, its ceremonies were
+not suppressed. The senate was still pagan;
+and <span class="tei tei-q">“the title, the ensigns, and the prerogatives
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page198">[pg 198]</span><a name="Pg198" id="Pg198" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of Sovereign Pontiff, which had been instituted
+by Numa, and assumed by Augustus,
+were accepted, without hesitation, by seven
+Christian emperors.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon</span></span>, v. 2, p. 183.
+Gratian became emperor, A. D. 376, and was
+the first who refused the pontifical robe. In
+378, he invested Theodosius with the Empire
+of the East; under their rule paganism was
+<span class="tei tei-q">“wholly extirpated,”</span> and the senate was suddenly
+converted.—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> That which hindered
+was thus taken out of the way. In 378, also,
+Gratian refusing the office, Damasus, the
+Bishop of Rome, was <span class="tei tei-q">“declared Pontifix Maximus,”</span><a id="noteref_4" name="noteref_4" href="#note_4"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">4</span></span></a>
+and made <span class="tei tei-q">“the sole judge in religious
+matters.”</span> All who would not adhere
+to the religion <span class="tei tei-q">“professed by the Pontiff Damasus,
+and by Peter, Bishop of Alexandria,”</span>
+were declared heretics.—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon</span></span>, v. 2, p. 156.
+Damasus, by virtue of his power, introduced
+the worship of the saints, and of Mary, <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+mother of God,”</span>—excommunicating those
+who dissented. Thus the apostasy, by adopting
+the gods of the heathen, and the name of
+the heathen pontiff, began to be set up, and
+the excommunicated church disappeared in
+the wilderness.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In the ninth century a document was produced,
+which claimed to be a deed of gift
+from Constantine to the Pope, dated A. D.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page199">[pg 199]</span><a name="Pg199" id="Pg199" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+324, ceding him the city of Rome and all
+Italy, with the crown, the mitre, &amp;c.; but the
+forgery of this has been fully exposed. With
+the removal of the capital of the world to
+Constantinople, the empire began to decline;
+but the church augmented as fast. A provisional
+synod at Sardica, in A. D. 344, and a
+decree of the Emperor Valentinian III., in 445,
+had acknowledged the Bishop of Rome as the
+primate of the five patriarchs, and as the last
+tribunal of appeal from the other bishops; but
+the edicts of the Pope were often disregarded
+and opposed, and he continued subject to the
+civil power till the subversion of the Western
+empire by Odoacer, King of the Heruli, in
+A. D. 476.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The ten kingdoms which had arisen on the
+ruins of the Western empire (p. <a href="#Pg169" class="tei tei-ref">169</a>), had
+nearly all embraced Christianity, corrupted
+by Arianism. And the barbarians transferred
+to their Christian instructors, the profound
+submission and reverence which they were
+accustomed to yield to the teachers of paganism,—many
+of the rites and ceremonies of
+which had been incorporated into the Catholic
+service. Ecclesiastical courts were established,
+in which were tried all questions relating
+to character, office, or property of the
+clergy; and thus they became nearly independent
+of the civil judges.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Heruli, which was the first of the ten
+horns plucked up, were conquered by the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page200">[pg 200]</span><a name="Pg200" id="Pg200" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Ostrogoths, in A. D. 493, when all Italy submitted
+to Theodoric. He fixed his capital at
+Ravenna, which left the Pope the only Prince
+of Rome; and the Romans, for protection,
+were forced to pay more deference to him.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+About A. D. 500, two Popes were simultaneously
+elected, when Theodoric gave the
+papal chair to Symmachus. Gross crimes
+being alleged against him by the defeated
+party, the king summoned a council in A. D.
+503 to investigate the charges; and he was
+acquitted. The other party being dissatisfied,
+Ennodius, Bishop Ticonum, drew up an
+apology for the Pope and council, in which,
+for the first time, the Pope was styled a
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Judge in the place of God, and Vicegerent
+of the Most High;”</span> and <span class="tei tei-q">“subject to no
+earthly tribunal.”</span> Thus did the Lawless
+One attempt, <span class="tei tei-q">“as God,”</span> to <span class="tei tei-q">“sit in the temple
+of God.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 533, Justinian, Emperor at Constantinople,
+being about to attack the Vandals
+in Africa, and wishing first to settle the religious
+disputes of his capital in which he felt
+a great interest, he submitted the controversy
+to the primate of Rome. To induce a decision
+in his own favor, or to give force to it, he
+acknowledged the Bishop of Rome the Chief
+of the whole Ecclesiastical body of the empire;
+and thus addressed him, in a letter sent
+by two distinguished prelates:—
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page201">[pg 201]</span><a name="Pg201" id="Pg201" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Justinian, pious, fortunate, renowned, triumphant emperor,
+consul, &amp;c., to John, the most holy Archbishop of
+our city of Rome, and patriarch.</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Rendering honor to the Apostolic chair, and to your
+Holiness, as has been always and is our wish, and honoring
+your blessedness as a father; we have hastened to bring to
+the knowledge of your Holiness all matters relating to the
+state of the churches. It having been at all times our great
+desire to preserve the unity of your Apostolic chair, and the
+constitution of the holy churches of God which has obtained
+hitherto, and still obtains.</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Therefore we have made no delay in subjecting and
+uniting to your Holiness all the priests of the whole East.</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">For this reason we have thought fit to bring to your
+notice the present matters of disturbance; though they are
+manifest and unquestionable, and always firmly held and
+declared by the whole priesthood according to the doctrine
+of your Apostolic chair. For we cannot suffer that anything
+which relates to the state of the Church, however
+manifest and unquestionable, should be moved, without the
+knowledge of your Holiness, who are The Head of all the
+Holy Churches, for in all things, as we have already declared,
+we are anxious to increase the honor and authority
+of your Apostolic chair.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Says Dr. Croly:—
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The emperor's letter must have been sent
+before the 25th of March, 533. For, in his
+letter of that date to Epiphanius he speaks of
+its having been already despatched, and repeats
+his decision, that all affairs touching the
+church shall be referred to the Pope, <span class="tei tei-q">‘head
+of all bishops, and the true and effective corrector
+of heretics.’</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In the same month of the following year,
+534, the Pope returned an answer repeating the
+language of the emperor, applauding his
+homage to the See, and adopting the titles of
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page202">[pg 202]</span><a name="Pg202" id="Pg202" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the imperial mandate. He observes that,
+among the virtues of Justinian, <span class="tei tei-q">‘one shines as
+a star, his reverence for the Apostolic chair,
+to which he has subjected and united all the
+churches, it being truly the head of all; and
+was testified by the rules of the fathers, the
+laws of the princes, and the declarations of the
+emperor's piety.’</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The authenticity of the title receives unanswerable
+proof from the edicts in the <span class="tei tei-q">‘Novellæ’</span>
+of the Justinian code.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The preamble of the 9th states that <span class="tei tei-q">‘as
+the elder Rome was the founder of the laws,
+so was it not to be questioned that in her was
+the supremacy of the pontificate.’</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The 131st, on the ecclesiastical titles and
+privileges, chapter II. states: <span class="tei tei-q">‘We therefore
+decree that the most holy Pope of the elder
+Rome is the first of all the priesthood, and
+that the most blessed archbishop of Constantinople,
+the new Rome, shall hold the second
+rank after the holy Apostolic chair of the elder
+Rome.’</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The supremacy of the Pope had by those
+mandates and edicts received the fullest sanction
+that could be given by the authority of
+the master of the Roman world. However
+worthless the motives, the act was done, authentic
+and unquestionable, sanctioned by all
+the forms of state, and never abrogated,—the
+act of the first potentate in the world. If the
+supremacy over the church of God had been
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page203">[pg 203]</span><a name="Pg203" id="Pg203" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+for man to give, it might have been given by
+the unrivalled sovereignty of Justinian.</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“From this era the church of Rome dates
+the earthly acknowledgment of her claim.
+Its heavenly authority is referred to the remoter
+source of the apostles.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Apoc.</span></span>, pp.
+14-16, 30, 31.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The war against the Vandals was vigorously
+prosecuted by Belisarius, Justinian's
+general, and resulted in their conquest the
+same year. Thus was the second of the first
+ten divisions of the empire subjugated: the
+second horn was plucked up.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Rome was still in possession of an Arian
+monarch, who was the bitter enemy of the
+Catholic church. Intelligence of the success
+of Belisarius in Africa reached the emperor,
+Dec. 16th, A. D. 533. <span class="tei tei-q">“Impatient to abolish
+the temporal and spiritual tyranny of the
+Vandals, he proceeded, without delay, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">to the
+full establishment of the Catholic
+church</span></em>.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon</span></span>,
+Harpers' ed., v. 3, p. 67. Belisarius
+proceeded to the conquest of Italy, which
+he effected, and marched on to Rome. Only
+4000 soldiers were stationed for its defence;
+and they could not oppose the wishes of the
+Romans, who voluntarily submitted. Seized
+with a momentary enthusiasm, <span class="tei tei-q">“they furiously
+exclaimed that the apostolic throne
+should no longer be profaned by the triumph
+or toleration of Arianism; that the tombs of
+the Cæsars should no longer be trampled on
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page204">[pg 204]</span><a name="Pg204" id="Pg204" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+by the savages of the north; and without reflecting
+that Italy must sink into a province
+of Constantinople, they fondly hailed the restoration
+of a Roman emperor as a new era of
+freedom and prosperity. The deputies of the
+Pope and clergy, of the senate and people, invited
+the lieutenant of Justinian to accept
+their voluntary allegiance, and to enter the
+city.”</span> Thus was <span class="tei tei-q">“the city, after sixty years'
+servitude delivered from the yoke of the barbarians,”</span>
+Dec. 10, A. D. 536. And <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+Catholics prepared to celebrate, without a
+rival, the approaching festival of the nativity
+of Christ.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 80.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In the winter, the Ostrogoths made preparations,
+and besieged Rome with an army of
+150,000 fighting men. Pope Sylverius was
+suspected of treachery, and on proof that he
+had communicated with the enemy, he was
+banished by Belisarius. At the emperor's
+command, the clergy of Rome proceeded to
+the choice of a new bishop, and elected <span class="tei tei-q">“deacon
+Virgilius, who had purchased the papal
+throne by a bribe of two hundred pounds of
+gold.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 85. As he had obtained the
+papal seat by fraud, it was claimed that he
+was not the lawful Pope; but in A. D. 538,
+he was owned as such by the 5th General
+Council, and the whole Christian world.—See
+Bowers' <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Hist. Popes</span></span>, v. 2, p. 374. In
+March of this year (538),—after <span class="tei tei-q">“one year
+and nine days”</span>—the Ostrogoths raised the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page205">[pg 205]</span><a name="Pg205" id="Pg205" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+siege of Rome, and burned their tents—one-third
+of their number having perished under
+its walls. The arms of Justinian triumphed,
+and the Catholic hierarchy was established.
+The third horn had been plucked up by the
+fall of the third of the first ten divisions of
+Rome.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Bishop of Constantinople did not submit
+willingly to the Primacy of Rome. On
+the death of Justinian, the supremacy of the
+Pope was utterly denied; and, in A. D. 588,
+John, Bishop of Constantinople, himself assumed
+the coveted title of <span class="tei tei-q">“Universal Bishop.”</span>
+The Roman bishop, Gregory the Great, indignant
+at this usurpation, denounced him as a
+<span class="tei tei-q">“usurper, aiming at supremacy over the
+whole church,”</span> and declared that whoever
+claims such supremacy <span class="tei tei-q">“has the pride and
+character of <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Antichrist</span></span>.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Boniface succeeded to the Roman See, and
+in the following year, A. D. 606, only two
+years after Gregory's death, applied to Phocas,—who
+had ascended the throne of Constantinople
+by the murder of the Emperor Mauritius,—for
+the same blasphemous title, with
+the privilege of continuing it to his successors.
+His request was granted, the Eastern Bishop
+was forbidden its use, and the Primate of
+Rome was again acknowledged as <span class="tei tei-q">“Universal
+Bishop,”</span> and the unrivalled <span class="tei tei-q">“Head of all
+the churches.”</span> This title has been worn by
+all the succeeding Popes; <span class="tei tei-q">“but the highest
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page206">[pg 206]</span><a name="Pg206" id="Pg206" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+authority,”</span> says Dr. Croly, <span class="tei tei-q">“among the civilians
+and annalists of Rome, spurn the idea
+that Phocas was the founder of the supremacy
+of Rome. They ascend to Justinian as the
+only legitimate source, and rightly date the
+title from the memorable year 533.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Apoc.</span></span>
+p. 117.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 730, Emperor Leo issued an edict
+for the destruction of all images used in religious
+worship. From that time the Pope
+scorned his authority, and acted in defiance
+of the emperor's will, who found himself unable
+to compel the Pope to obey the edict.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Papacy thus defied all human authority;
+but did not as yet attempt the exercise
+of political power.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 756, Pepin, the usurper of the
+crown of France, compelled the King of Lombardy
+to cede the exarchate of Ravenna to
+the Pope, <span class="tei tei-q">“to be forever held and possessed
+by St. Peter and his lawful successors in the
+See of Rome.”</span> The Pope had now become a
+temporal prince, and one of the kings of the
+earth. In A. D. 774, Charlemagne, the successor
+of Pepin, confirmed the former gift, and
+in addition, subjugated the Lombards, and
+annexed a large portion of their kingdom and
+the Duchy of Rome to the Roman See. In A.
+D. 817, Louis the Pious, granted <span class="tei tei-q">“St. Peter's
+patrimony”</span> to the Pope and his successors,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“in their own right, principality, and dominion,
+unto the end of the world.”</span> Hence, as
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page207">[pg 207]</span><a name="Pg207" id="Pg207" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a temporal prince, the Pope wears a triple
+crown.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 800, Charlemagne was solemnly
+crowned and proclaimed emperor by the
+Pope, having reduced under his sway nearly
+the whole of Europe. From this time the
+Popes claimed superiority to all kings and emperors,
+received homage from them, and exercised
+all the rights of sovereignty; but they
+were nominally dependent on the Emperors of
+the West till A. D. 1278, when the Emperor
+Rudolph released the people of the Papal
+States from all allegiance they might still owe
+to the imperial crown. This act was confirmed
+by the electors and princes of the empire.
+The Popes, in the greatness of their
+power, crowned and uncrowned kings at their
+pleasure, absolved subjects from all allegiance
+to their rulers, excommunicated whoever they
+would, and compelled secular princes to put
+to death heretics.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 1294, Boniface VIII. became Pope.
+From his accession Hallam dates the decline
+of the Papacy, which, for <span class="tei tei-q">“more than two
+centuries, had been on throne of the earth,
+and reigned despot of the world.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Dowling</span></span>.
+This was 1260 years from the death of Peter,—the
+earliest time from which they can date.
+His bull of excommunication against Philip
+of France, being disregarded by that monarch,
+who adroitly made the Pope his prisoner, his
+rage brought on a fever, which caused his
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page208">[pg 208]</span><a name="Pg208" id="Pg208" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+death. Only a few succeeding pontiffs claimed,
+and none attempted to enforce, the prerogatives
+exercised by the preceding Popes. For seventy
+years the successors of Boniface resided
+at Avignon, in France, and paid great deference
+to the monarch of that country. After
+this was the Western schism, which divided
+the church for forty years,—two rival Popes
+claiming the mitre, and thundering out their
+anathemas against each other. These events
+greatly weakened the Papacy. About this
+time appeared Wickliffe and Huss, and Jerome
+of Prague; and still later, in 1517, Martin
+Luther, in opposition to the Papal pretensions,
+published his Thesis against Indulgences,
+1260 years from the time of the arrogance
+of Pope Stephen.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In A. D. 1572, 1260 years from the removal
+of Constantine from Rome to Constantinople,
+occurred the bloody massacre of St. Bartholomew,
+when in one day 5000 Protestants were
+murdered in Paris, and in the same proportion
+in other parts of France. The persecutions
+of the Papists continued till near the close of
+the last century; and as late as November,
+1781, a woman was burned alive by the Inquisition
+in Spain.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In 1793, 1260 years from Justinian's letter
+to the Pope, the Papal church, with all religion,
+was entirely suppressed in France. And
+in 1798, which was the same length of time
+from the establishment of the papacy, by the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page209">[pg 209]</span><a name="Pg209" id="Pg209" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+conquest of the Ostrogoths,—the plucking up
+of the last of the three horns in 538, Gen.
+Berthier entered Rome, compelled the Pope to
+flee, and terminated the Papal government.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The temporal power was afterwards restored;
+but in 1848, twelve hundred and sixty
+years from 588 when John assumed the title
+of Universal Bishop, the Pope again fled from
+his throne. Two years subsequently, he was
+again restored.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Flacius, in his <span class="tei tei-q">‘Catalogue of Witnesses,’</span>
+represented the twelve hundred and sixty
+days as having commenced in 606;”</span> and
+Scott, and several others, reckon them from
+the same epoch.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+4. The image had power to speak. It
+thus filled the office of the <span class="tei tei-q">“mouth,”</span> which
+was given to the ten-horned beast (v. 5),
+which synchronizes with the view taken of
+that appendage, p. <a href="#Pg172" class="tei tei-ref">172</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+5. It should <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">cause</span></em> the infliction of death on
+those who should refuse to worship. The
+worship it would exact, is doubtless of the
+kind bestowed on the wild beast, 13:4. The
+Papal hierarchy claimed to be infallible and
+invincible, and to have power to bind and
+loose on earth and in heaven; those who refused
+to recognize its claims, if incorrigible,
+were punished with death.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Image was not to put to death, but
+would <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">cause</span></em> them to be killed. The symbolization
+corresponds with the fulfilment in
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page210">[pg 210]</span><a name="Pg210" id="Pg210" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+this particular. The ecclesiastical officials
+punished rebellious subjects, by delivering
+them over to the civil arm; which punished
+heretics according to the will of the Papacy.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Lucius III. and Innocent III. by formal
+decrees required them to be seized, condemned,
+and delivered by the civil magistrates, to be
+capitally punished; and enjoined the princes
+and magistrates to execute on them the sentences
+denounced by the canon and civil
+laws.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord's Exp. of Apoc.</span></span>, p. 434. This
+is substantiated by Bellarmini and other
+writers. Civil rulers, who refused to enforce
+the decrees of the councils, were anathematized,
+excommunicated, and often deprived of
+their political power. When the Papacy has
+been reminded of the numbers killed and
+otherwise punished for alleged heresy, she has
+replied that the civil power, and not the church,
+has done this! She, however, has caused the
+kings of the earth to execute her wishes.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+6. The image would cause all to receive
+the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">mark</span></em> of the Beast. A mark is a token of
+recognition. Slaves, soldiers, and the devotees
+of various gods, were thus identified on their
+hands or foreheads, both before and after the
+time of St. John—slaves by the name of the
+Emperor on their forehead, and soldiers by
+his name on their hand. Mr. Elliott proves
+this by quotations from Valerius, Maximus,
+Ælian, Ambrose, and others. The devotees
+of particular gods gained admittance to the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page211">[pg 211]</span><a name="Pg211" id="Pg211" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+secret meetings of the worshippers of their respective
+deity, by a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">mark</span></em> by which they identified
+each other. At the present day the
+Hindoos are marked on the forehead by the
+hieroglyphic of the god they are consecrated
+to.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The mark of the beast, is its <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">name</span></em>, or the
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">number</span></em> of its name. The ancients often used
+numbers to indicate names. <span class="tei tei-q">“Among the
+Pagans, the Egyptian mystics spoke of Mercury,
+or Thouth, under the number 1218, because
+the Greek letters composing the name
+Thouth, when estimated according to their
+numerical value, together made up that number.
+By others, Jupiter was invoked under
+the mystical number 717; because the letters
+of Ἡ ΑΡΧΗ, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">the beginning</span></span>,
+or <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">first origin</span></span>, which
+was a characteristic title of the supreme deity
+worshipped as Jupiter, made up that number:
+and Apollo under the number 608, as being
+that of ηυς, or υης, words expressing certain
+solar attributes. Again, the pseudo-Christian
+or semi-pagan Gnostics, from St. John's time
+downwards, affixed to their gems and amulets,
+of which multitudes remain even to the present
+day, the mystic word σβρασαξ, or αβραξας,
+under the idea of some magic virtue attaching
+to its number 365, as being that of the days
+of the annual solar circle; and equal moreover
+with that of Μειθρας, or Mithras, the
+Magian name for the sun, whom they identified
+also with Christ. Once more, the Christian
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page212">[pg 212]</span><a name="Pg212" id="Pg212" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+fathers themselves fell into the same
+fancies, and doctrine of mysteriousness in certain
+verbal numbers. For example, both
+Barnabas and Clement of Alexandria speak
+of the virtue of the number 318 as being that
+of ΙΗΤ the common abbreviation for Jesus
+crucified; and partly ascribe to its magical
+virtue the victory which Abraham gained
+with his 318 servants over the Canaanitish
+kings. Similarly Tertullian refers the victory
+of Gideon, with his 300 men, to the circumstance
+of that being the precise number of Τ,
+the sign of the cross. In the name of Adam,
+St. Cyprian discerned a mysterious numeral
+affinity to certain characteristics in the life
+and history of the second Adam, Jesus Christ.
+Irenæus notes the remarkable number 888 of
+the name Ιησους, Jesus. And in the pseudo-Sibylline
+verses, written by Christians about
+the end, probably, of the second century, and
+consequently not long after Irenæus, we find
+enigmas proposed of precisely the same characters
+as that in the text;—the number being
+given, and the name required.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Elliott's
+Horæ Apoc.</span></span>, vol. iii., pp. 204-6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“number of the beast”</span> is indicated in
+the text by the Greek letters <span class="tei tei-q">“χξς”</span> which
+were severally used to represent the numbers
+600, 60 and 6, making 666. As the name of
+the beast is equivalent to this number, the
+letters in it will represent numbers which
+amount to six hundred threescore and six.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page213">[pg 213]</span><a name="Pg213" id="Pg213" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+After the division of the Roman empire, the
+western kingdom adopted for itself the name
+of the Latin kingdom; and its subdivisions
+were called the Latin kingdoms. The church
+connected with those kingdoms was also
+emphatically called the Latin church. Says
+Dr. More: <span class="tei tei-q">“They Latinize everything. Mass,
+prayers, hymns, litanies, canons, decretals,
+bulls, are conceived in Latin. The Papal
+councils speak in Latin. Women pray in
+Latin. The Scriptures are read in no other
+language under the Papacy than Latin. In
+short, all things are Latin.”</span> The Council of
+Trent declared the Latin Vulgate to be the only
+authentic version of the Scriptures; and their
+doctors have preferred it to the Hebrew and
+Greek text, written by prophets and apostles.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This Latin kingdom is the only one that
+ever corresponded to the characteristics of the
+beast. And its name—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Latinos</span></span> in the Greek,
+and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Romiith</span></span> in the Hebrew—is equivalent
+to the required number.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Greek and Hebrew letters composing
+the words רומיית, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Romiith</span></span>—רמענוש,
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Romanus</span></span>—λατεινος,
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Latinos</span></span>, each of them making in
+numerals exactly 666, plainly point out not
+only his name, and the number of his name,
+but also the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">mark</span></em> of his <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">name</span></em>; as for example:</span>
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">in ר ו מ י י ת <span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Romiith</span></span>; so likewise</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">400 10 10 40 6 200 = 666</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">ר מ ע נ ו ש <span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Romanus</span></span>; and also</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">300 6 50 70 40 200 = 666</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"></div>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page214">[pg 214]</span><a name="Pg214" id="Pg214" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">the Greek λ α τ ε ι ν ο ς <span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Latinos</span></span>,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">30 1 300 5 10 50 70 200 = 666.</div>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+in each of which the exact mark is contained.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“It therefore evidently appears, that each
+name is both a mark and a number; a mark,
+when viewed as made up of so many letters,
+therefore called the mark of his name; a
+number, when viewed as made up of so many
+numerals, then called the number of his name.
+But when considered merely as a name,
+derived from <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Romiith</span></span>, a Roman, or <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Romulus</span></span>,
+the founder of Rome, a name common among
+men, it may then be properly called the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">mark,
+or number of a man</span></em>.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Fleming's Rise and
+Fall of Papacy.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To receive the mark of the beast, would be
+an acknowledgment of subjection to it. The
+connection of the beast and its image was so
+intimate, that submission to the one, was virtual
+submission to the other. To submit to
+the rites of the church modelled after the wild
+beast, to profess its faith, and to honor its
+authority, would be a reception of its mark.
+And all persons were compelled to do this, and
+give evidence of submission to its authority
+on the peril of their lives.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+7. Those who should refuse the mark of
+the beast, were to be prohibited from buying
+and selling. The Lateran Council under Pope
+Alexander II., passed an act forbidding any
+to harbor heretics in their houses or to trade
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page215">[pg 215]</span><a name="Pg215" id="Pg215" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+with them. The Synod of Tours passed a law
+that no one should assist them, <span class="tei tei-q">“no, not so
+much as to exercise commerce with them in
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">selling</span></em> or <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">buying</span></em>.”</span><a id="noteref_5" name="noteref_5" href="#note_5"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">5</span></span></a>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Elliott.</span></span> In 1179, the
+third Lateran Council sentenced certain heretics,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“their defenders and harborers, to an
+anathema, and forbid, under an anathema,
+that any should presume to keep them in their
+house, or on their lands, sustain them, or
+transact any business with them.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lord.</span></span>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“It was just the same fearful penalty of interdict
+from buying and selling, traffic and
+intercourse, that had been inculcated long
+before by the Pagan Dragon's representative
+Diocletian, against the early Christians.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Elliott.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+So exact a correspondence between the wild
+beast and the Western kingdoms, the two-horned
+beast and the Eastern empire, and the
+image to the wild beast and the Roman Hierarchy,
+makes the symbolization of this chapter
+very intelligible. These three agencies will
+severally continue till the end of the world.
+The latter will be destroyed by the brightness
+of Christ's coming (2 Thess. 2:8), and the
+two former will then be taken and <span class="tei tei-q">“cast alive
+into the lake of fire,”</span> 19:20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The vision would have been defective without
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page216">[pg 216]</span><a name="Pg216" id="Pg216" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a representation of the end of those who
+refuse to worship the beast, or its image, or
+to receive their mark, and who, although
+warred against and overcome by the beast,
+should maintain their integrity to Christ.
+Accordingly the revelator has a view of:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Redeemed on Mount Zion.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I looked, and behold a lamb stood on the mount
+Zion, and with him a hundred and forty-four thousand,
+having his name and the name of his Father written on
+their foreheads. And I heard a voice from heaven, like the
+voice of many waters, and like the voice of loud thunder:
+and the voice which I heard was like that of harpers playing
+with their harps: and they sung as it were a new song
+before the throne, and before the four living beings, and the
+elders: and no one could learn the song except the hundred
+and forty-four thousand, who were redeemed from the earth.
+These are they, who were not defiled with women; for they
+are virgins. These are they who follow the Lamb wherever
+he goeth. These were redeemed from among men, the first
+fruit to God and to the Lamb. And in their mouth no lie
+was found for they are faultless.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 14:1-5.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Lamb is shown by the connection to
+be Christ,—here called by one of his metaphorical
+names.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Mount Zion, doubtless, symbolizes the
+place where, in the regeneration, the Lord
+will reign with his saints—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> in the new
+earth. <span class="tei tei-q">“The Lord shall reign over them in
+Mount Zion,”</span> Micah 4:7.—<span class="tei tei-q">“And they sung
+a new song, saying, Thou art worthy to take
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page217">[pg 217]</span><a name="Pg217" id="Pg217" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the book, and to open the seals thereof: for
+thou wast slain, and hast redeemed us to God
+by thy blood out of every kindred and tongue,
+and people, and nation, and hast made us
+kings and priests: and we shall reign on the
+earth,”</span> 5:9,10.—<span class="tei tei-q">“And I saw a new heavens
+and a new earth: for the first heaven
+and the first earth were passed away.... And
+I heard a great voice out of heaven, saying,
+Behold the tabernacle of God is with men,
+and he will dwell with them, and they shall,
+be his people, and God himself shall be with
+them and be their God,”</span> 21:1-3.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The names of Mount Zion, and Jerusalem,
+were both used to denote the city which the
+Lord chose above all the goodly places of
+earth to put his name there. It is proper to
+designate the heavenly city, the new Jerusalem,
+by all the names which were applied to
+the old. The king is to be set upon the holy
+hill of Zion—<span class="tei tei-q">“Walk about Zion, and go round
+about her: tell the towers thereof. Mark ye
+well her bulwarks, consider her palaces,”</span> Psa.
+48:12, 13. <span class="tei tei-q">“When the Lord shall build up
+Zion, he shall appear in glory,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 102:16.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For the Lord hath chosen Zion; he hath
+desired it for his habitation. This is my rest
+forever; here will I dwell; for I have desired
+it,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 132:13, 14. <span class="tei tei-q">“For the Lord shall
+comfort Zion: he will comfort all her waste
+places; and he will make her wilderness like
+Eden, and her desert like the garden of the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page218">[pg 218]</span><a name="Pg218" id="Pg218" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Lord; and joy and gladness shall be found
+therein, thanksgiving and the voice of
+melody.... Therefore the redeemed of the
+Lord shall return and come with singing unto
+Zion; and everlasting joy shall be upon their
+head: they shall obtain gladness and joy,
+and sorrow and mourning shall flee away.”</span>
+Isa. 51:3-11. <span class="tei tei-q">“Awake, awake, put on thy
+strength, O Zion; put on thy beautiful
+garments, O Jerusalem, the holy city; for
+henceforth there shall no more come into
+thee the uncircumcised and the unclean....
+How beautiful on the mountains are the feet
+of him that bringeth good tidings, that publisheth
+peace; that bringeth good tidings of
+good, that publisheth salvation; that saith
+unto Zion, <span class="tei tei-q">‘Thy God reigneth!’</span> Thy watchmen
+shall lift up the voice; with the voice
+together shall they sing: for they shall see
+eye to eye when the Lord shall bring again
+Zion. Break forth into joy, sing together, ye
+waste places of Jerusalem: for the Lord hath
+comforted his people, he hath redeemed Jerusalem.”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 52:1-9. <span class="tei tei-q">“And the Redeemer
+shall come to Zion, and unto them that turn
+from transgression in Jacob, saith the Lord.”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 59:20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The standing of the Lamb on Mount Zion,
+symbolizes an epoch when Christ shall assume
+a corresponding relation to his people. He
+there appears in person; and <span class="tei tei-q">“when Christ
+who is your life, shall appear, then shall ye
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page219">[pg 219]</span><a name="Pg219" id="Pg219" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+also appear with him in glory,”</span> Col. 3:4.
+It will not be till he shall have judged <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+quick and the dead at his appearing,”</span> (2 Tim.
+4:1), that <span class="tei tei-q">“the redeemed from among men”</span>
+will <span class="tei tei-q">“follow the Lamb whithersoever he
+goeth.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The 144,000, who are with Christ, correspond
+with the number which are sealed, <span class="tei tei-q">“of
+all the tribes of the children of Israel,”</span> (7:4);
+and they are doubtless the same persons,
+who, under the sixth seal, are designated,
+among all denominations of Christians, by the
+mark of the living God. They are there
+shown to be the godly, who shall be alive on
+the earth at Christ's coming and shall then be
+changed, and, with the risen dead, caught up
+to meet him in the air.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sealing process there symbolized, is
+here shown to be the inscribing of the Father's
+name on their foreheads. The subjects of the
+beast and its image, receive its mark; but
+the children of God and the Lamb, are designated
+instead, by the name of the Father.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The voice from heaven as the voice of many
+waters, with the voice of harpers, is the
+singing of the new song which none but the
+144,000 could learn. Those who are translated
+at Christ's coming, will be favored above
+all, save two, who will have lived on the
+earth, insomuch as they will have been redeemed
+from the earth without being subjected
+to death.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page220">[pg 220]</span><a name="Pg220" id="Pg220" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These sing in the presence of the four living
+creatures and the elders, who symbolize those
+who also are redeemed from among men and
+will reign on the earth, 5:8-10. Consequently
+those must symbolize the resurrected
+dead, with whom the 144,000 will be ushered
+into the Lord's presence, 1 Thess. 4:16, 17.
+The two bodies of the redeemed, are therefore
+both represented with the Lord on Mount
+Zion.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their not being defiled with women, probably
+implies that they were not guilty of idolatry,
+which is represented by that figure, Ezek.
+16:15. They had not submitted to the wiles
+of the woman seated on the scarlet-colored
+beast, (17:3); had not worshipped the beast
+or its image (14:9), and had been true to
+their Divine Sovereign.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They follow the Lamb whithersoever he
+goeth. All the redeemed will doubtless thus
+follow the Lamb, for of all the <span class="tei tei-q">“great multitude
+which no man could number, of all nations
+and kindreds, and people, and tongues,”</span>
+who stood before the throne and before the
+Lamb, clothed <span class="tei tei-q">“with white robes, and palms
+in their hands,”</span> (7:9)—it was said: <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+Lamb which is in the midst of the throne shall
+feed them, and shall lead them unto living
+fountains of water,”</span> 7:17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those who are redeemed from among men,
+are called the <span class="tei tei-q">“first fruits unto God and to the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page221">[pg 221]</span><a name="Pg221" id="Pg221" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Lamb.”</span> They are not necessarily first fruits
+of the redeemed, to distinguish them from
+others of the redeemed, but are first fruits of
+the race: <span class="tei tei-q">“Of his own will begat he us with
+the word of truth, that we should be a kind
+of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">first fruits</span></em> of his creatures,”</span> James 1:18.
+By his resurrection from the dead, Christ
+became <span class="tei tei-q">“the first fruits of them that slept,”</span>
+1 Cor. 15:20. And at his coming there is to
+be a <span class="tei tei-q">“first resurrection”</span> (20:6), when the
+bodies of the saints will <span class="tei tei-q">“be fashioned like
+unto his glorious body”</span> (Phil. 3:21), and thus
+become the first fruits with their risen Head.
+Those who come up at the second resurrection
+will not attain to that beatific state.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They are faultless, and without guile. They
+are not perfect by reason of any inherent
+goodness in themselves; for <span class="tei tei-q">“all we like sheep
+have gone astray ... and the Lord laid on
+him the iniquity of us all,”</span> Isa. 53:6. The
+redeemed church will be faultless, because its
+members will be sanctified and cleansed by
+the blood of Christ. Such will constitute <span class="tei tei-q">“a
+glorious church, not having spot, or wrinkle,
+or any such thing ... holy and without
+blemish,”</span> Eph. 5:27. While <span class="tei tei-q">“the nations
+of them which are saved shall walk in the
+light”</span> of the New Jerusalem, and shall <span class="tei tei-q">“bring
+their glory and honor into it,”</span> there <span class="tei tei-q">“shall in
+no wise enter into it anything that defileth,
+neither whatsoever worketh abomination, or
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page222">[pg 222]</span><a name="Pg222" id="Pg222" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+maketh a lie: but they which are written in
+the Lamb's book of life,”</span> 21:24-27.
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“There awaiteth at the end</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Such a home, and such a Friend,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Such a crown, and such a throne,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Such a harp of heavenly tone,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Such companions, such employ,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">Such a world of hallowed
+joy!”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Bunyan.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Angel of the Everlasting Gospel.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw another angel flying in the midst of heaven,
+having the everlasting good news to preach to those dwelling
+on the earth, and to every nation, and tribe, and tongue,
+and people, saying with a loud voice, Fear God and give
+glory to him; for the hour of his judgment is come: and
+worship him who made the heaven, and the earth, and the
+sea, and fountains of water!</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 14:6, 7.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The era symbolized by the flight of this
+angel, has been applied, by different writers
+to the epoch of the Reformation, to that of
+modern missions, &amp;c. The view here taken,
+is that it synchronizes with the preaching of
+the gospel to the Gentiles.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The angel flying through the midst of
+heaven, doubtless symbolizes a body of men
+conspicuous for their position, energetic in
+their movements, extensive in their operations,
+and urgent in their proclamation,—whose
+teachings correspond with this announcement
+of the angel.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The message they bear is that of the
+everlasting gospel ευαγγελιον, (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">evangelion</span></span>)—which
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page223">[pg 223]</span><a name="Pg223" id="Pg223" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+is, literally, the good news, the glad
+tidings; that which brings <span class="tei tei-q">“life and immortality
+to light,”</span> 2 Tim. 1:10. It is a message
+which foreshadows the resurrection and
+coming judgment at Christ's appearing; and
+is therefore called <span class="tei tei-q">“the gospel of the kingdom,”</span>
+(Matt. 4:23);—the good news of the
+glorious kingdom of the Son of God.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It is the preaching of the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">everlasting</span></em> gospel
+which is thus symbolized. It is no <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">new</span></em> gospel;
+for, <span class="tei tei-q">“the Scripture foreseeing that God
+would justify the heathen through faith,
+preached before the gospel unto Abraham,—saying:
+In thee shall all nations be blessed,”</span>
+Gal. 3:8. And not Abraham alone, but all
+the fathers <span class="tei tei-q">“did eat the same spiritual meat,
+and did all drink the same spiritual drink: for
+they drank of that spiritual Rock that followed
+them: and that rock was Christ,”</span> 1 Cor. 10:3, 4.
+Of this gospel the Jewish nation and a
+few proselytes, were for ages the sole recipients.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Unto them were committed the oracles
+of God.”</span> Rom. 3:2. To them pertained
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the adoption, and the glory, and the covenants,
+and the giving of the law, and the service
+of God, and the promises,”</span> Rom. 9:4.
+But the time had been foretold when the Gentiles
+should come to their light, and kings to
+the brightness of their rising, Isa. 60:3.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With the coming of Christ, and his rejection
+of that nation, the gospel, was no longer to be
+confined within its former narrow limits. The
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page224">[pg 224]</span><a name="Pg224" id="Pg224" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Savior said to his disciples: <span class="tei tei-q">“Go ye therefore
+and teach all nations, baptizing them in the
+name of the Father, and of the Son, and of
+the Holy Ghost; teaching them to observe all
+things whatsoever I have commanded you:
+and lo, I am with you alway, even unto the
+end of the world,”</span> Matt. 28:19, 20. <span class="tei tei-q">“Go ye
+into all the world and preach the gospel to
+every creature. He that believeth and is
+baptized shall be saved; but he that believeth
+not shall be damned,”</span> Mark 16:15, 16.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Then opened he their understanding that
+they might understand the Scriptures, and he
+said unto them, Thus it is written, and thus
+it behoved Christ to suffer, to rise from the
+dead the third day: and that repentance and
+remission of sins should be preached in his
+name among all nations, beginning at Jerusalem,”</span>
+Luke 24:45-47.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The fulfilment of those predictions and
+commands could not be more beautifully and
+appropriately symbolized, than by an angel
+flying <span class="tei tei-q">“in the midst of heaven having the
+everlasting gospel to preach unto them that
+dwell on the earth, and to every nation, and
+kindred, and tongue, and people.”</span> It could
+be no other gospel: for Paul testified:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Though we, or an angel from heaven,
+preach any other gospel unto you than that
+which we have preached unto you, let him be
+accursed. As we said before, so say I now
+again, If any man preach any other gospel
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page225">[pg 225]</span><a name="Pg225" id="Pg225" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+unto you than that ye have received, let him
+be accursed,”</span> Gal. 1:8, 9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In accordance with the divine command, to
+preach the gospel to all the nations, beginning
+at Jerusalem, the apostles began their mission;
+and when the Jews rejected their message,
+they turned to the Gentiles, and went everywhere
+preaching the word <span class="tei tei-q">“according to the
+revelation of the mystery, which was kept
+secret since the world began, but now is
+made manifest, and by the scriptures of the
+prophets, according to the commandment of
+the everlasting God, made known to all
+nations for the obedience of faith,”</span> Rom. 16:25, 26.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The first converts to the faith, comprised
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Parthians, and Medes, and Elamites, and the
+dwellers in Mesopotamia, and in Judea, and
+Cappadocia, in Pontus, and Asia, Phrygia,
+and Pamphylia, in Egypt, and in the parts of
+Libya about Cyrene, and strangers of Rome,
+Jews and proselytes, Cretes and Arabians,”</span>
+Acts 2:9-12. When the Jews contradicted
+and blasphemed, <span class="tei tei-q">“Paul and Barnabas waxed
+bold, and said, It was necessary that the word
+of God should first have been spoken to you:
+but seeing ye put it from you, and judge
+yourselves unworthy of everlasting life, lo,
+we turn to the Gentiles,”</span> Acts 13:46. Afterwards
+Paul, in writing to the Colossians, refers
+to the gospel as that <span class="tei tei-q">“which was preached to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page226">[pg 226]</span><a name="Pg226" id="Pg226" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+every creature which is under heaven,”</span> Col.
+1:23.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This gospel was to be preached to those
+who dwell on the earth, and also to all nations.
+The symbolic earth of the Apocalypse, being
+generally admitted to be the Roman empire
+under a quiet government, its fulfilment
+would require an early introduction of the
+gospel there. Accordingly we find, within
+thirty years after the crucifixion of Christ, a
+flourishing church existing in the metropolis
+of the Roman empire, to which Paul addressed
+one of his most able letters. In it, he thanks
+God that their <span class="tei tei-q">“faith is spoken of throughout
+all the world,”</span> Rom. 1:8. The apostle had
+then <span class="tei tei-q">“fully preached the gospel of Christ”</span>
+from Jerusalem <span class="tei tei-q">“round about [the coast of
+the Mediterranean] unto Illyricum,”</span> (Rom.
+16:19);—a country on the Adriatic, or Gulf
+of Venice. He afterwards visited Rome,
+and is supposed to have preached the gospel
+as far west as Spain. The apostles spread
+Christianity throughout the Roman empire.
+Palestine, Syria, Natolia, Greece, the islands
+of the Mediterranean, Italy, and the northern
+coast of Africa, contained societies of Christians
+in the first century. In the second
+century societies existed, and Christ was worshipped,
+among the Germans, Spaniards,
+French, Celts, and Britons, and many other
+nations in Europe, and almost throughout the
+whole east. In the fourth century Christianity
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page227">[pg 227]</span><a name="Pg227" id="Pg227" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+had become the prevailing religion of the
+empire.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In later times the gospel which began to
+be preached at Jerusalem, has been extended
+to more distant countries, and is still finding
+its way to every tribe and people that have
+not before heard its joyful sound. Thus has
+the light of the gospel nearly encircled the
+globe, having been, in one age or another, proclaimed
+in every known country—fulfilling
+the words of the Saviour: <span class="tei tei-q">“And this gospel
+of the kingdom shall be preached in all the
+world, for a witness unto all nations; and
+then shall the end come,”</span> Matt. 24:14.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And the gospel must first be published
+among all nations,”</span> Mark 13:10. It would
+not follow from these predictions that it must
+be preached at the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">same time</span></em> to all nations,
+any more than the light of day shines on
+all parts of the earth at once: but all must
+have been illumined by it before the end.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In accordance with this view, those who
+are finally redeemed to God <span class="tei tei-q">“out of every
+kindred, and tongue, and people, and nation”</span>
+(5:9), are those who will <span class="tei tei-q">“have washed
+their robes and made them white in the blood
+of the Lamb”</span> (7:14), in consequence of
+this universal extension of the gospel.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The command to fear and give glory to
+God, and to worship the Creator of all things
+implies that it was to be proclaimed to worshippers
+of false gods, and was not a mere
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page228">[pg 228]</span><a name="Pg228" id="Pg228" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+proclamation addressed to <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">actual Christians</span></em>.
+The Gentiles to whom the apostles preached
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">were</span></em> actual worshippers of such, and needed
+to be taught the worship of the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">true</span></em> God.
+While Paul was at Athens, his spirit was
+stirred within him when he saw the city
+wholly given to idolatry. <span class="tei tei-q">“Then Paul stood
+in the midst of Mars hill, and said, Ye men
+of Athens, I perceive that in all things ye
+are too superstitious. For as I passed by,
+and beheld your devotions, I found an altar
+with this inscription: TO THE UNKNOWN
+GOD. Whom therefore ye ignorantly worship,
+him declare I unto you. God that made
+the world and all things therein, seeing that
+he is the Lord of heaven and earth, dwelleth
+not in temples made with hands,”</span> Acts 17:22-24.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Ye know that ye were Gentiles,
+carried away unto these dumb idols, even as
+ye were led,”</span> 1 Cor. 12:2. <span class="tei tei-q">“For they themselves
+show us of what manner of entering in
+we had unto you, and how ye turned to God
+from idols, to serve the living and true God:
+and to wait for his Son from heaven, whom he
+raised from the dead, even Jesus, which delivered
+us from the wrath to come,”</span> 1 Thess.
+1:9, 10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The great motive, to be held forth to induce
+men to turn from the worship of idols to that
+of God, was the certainty of the approaching
+judgment. In accordance with this, the apostles
+make constant references to it. The Corinthians
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page229">[pg 229]</span><a name="Pg229" id="Pg229" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+are exhorted to <span class="tei tei-q">“come behind in no
+gift; waiting for the coming of our Lord Jesus
+Christ: who shall also confirm you unto the
+end, that ye may be blameless in the day of
+our Lord Jesus Christ,”</span> 1 Cor. 1:7, 8. As
+Paul <span class="tei tei-q">“reasoned of righteousness, temperance,
+and judgment to come, Felix trembled,”</span> Acts
+24:25. He said to the impenitent Romans, that
+they were <span class="tei tei-q">“treasuring up to themselves wrath
+against the day of wrath, and revelation of the
+righteous judgment of God,”</span> Rom. 2:5. The
+first things which were presented in all their
+teachings were <span class="tei tei-q">“the foundation of repentance
+from dead works, and of faith toward God, of
+the doctrine of baptisms, and of laying on of
+hands, and of resurrection of the dead, and of
+eternal judgment,”</span> Heb. 6:1, 2. Thus
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Enoch also, the seventh from Adam, prophesied
+of these, saying, Behold the Lord cometh
+with ten thousand of his saints,”</span> Jude 14, 15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As Christ was to judge the world <span class="tei tei-q">“at his
+appearing and kingdom”</span> (2 Tim. 4:1), a
+reference to his coming always involved a consideration
+of the hour of his judgment; and
+his appearing was a great incentive to holiness.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For our conversation is in heaven, from
+whence also we look for the Saviour, the Lord
+Jesus Christ,”</span> Phil. 3:20. And <span class="tei tei-q">“when
+Christ, who is our life, shall appear, then shall
+ye also appear with him in glory,”</span> Col. 3:4.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For what is our hope, or joy, or crown of
+rejoicing? Are not even ye in the presence
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page230">[pg 230]</span><a name="Pg230" id="Pg230" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of our Lord Jesus Christ at his coming?”</span>
+1 Thess. 2:19. <span class="tei tei-q">“To the end he may establish
+your hearts unblamable in holiness before
+God, even our Father, at the coming of
+our Lord Jesus Christ with all his saints,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>
+3:13. <span class="tei tei-q">“For if we believe that Jesus
+died and rose again, even so them also which
+sleep in Jesus will God bring with him. For
+this we say unto you by the word of the Lord,
+that we which are alive and remain unto the
+coming of the Lord shall not prevent them
+which are asleep. For the Lord himself shall
+descend from heaven with a shout, with the
+voice of the archangel, and with the trump of
+God: and the dead in Christ shall rise first:
+Then we which are alive and remain shall be
+caught up together with them in the clouds,
+to meet the Lord in the air: and so shall we
+ever be with the Lord,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 4:14-17.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And to you who are troubled, rest with us,
+when the Lord Jesus shall be revealed from
+heaven with his mighty angels, in flaming fire
+taking vengeance on them that know not God,
+and that obey not the gospel of our Lord
+Jesus Christ,”</span> 2 Thess. 1:7, 8.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Not only the apostles, but their successors,
+in succeeding ages, have constantly made reference
+to the judgment, as the motive to holiness.
+Beginning in the days of the apostles,
+the same gospel has been continued by a succession
+of men to the present time; and those
+who are now preaching, or who support those
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page231">[pg 231]</span><a name="Pg231" id="Pg231" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+who so preach the everlasting gospel, in connection
+with the warning of approaching judgment,
+must be regarded as belonging to the
+same body of men symbolized by the angel
+flying in the midst of heaven.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Commencing in the apostolic age, sections
+of the globe were evangelized—in Asia and
+Africa, that have never received the gospel
+since, either under the reformers or by modern
+missionaries. But beginning with the dispensation
+of the gospel to the Gentiles, its fulfilment
+is found in China, in Tartary, in Japan,
+in Egypt, and Ethiopia, and in lands so remote
+that no one can say it has not been almost
+universally promulgated.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Angel announcing the Fall of Babylon.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And another angel, a second, followed, saying, She is
+fallen! Babylon the great is fallen! She made all nations
+drink of the wine of the wrath of her fornication!</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+14:8.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This angel, like the former, must symbolize
+a body of religious teachers. The former resulted
+in the spread of Christianity. This announces
+the fall of a corrupt hierarchy.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Babylon being regarded as a symbol of the
+Roman church, her fall must be understood to
+be her loss of power, as mistress of the kings
+of the earth; and synchronizes with her displacement
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page232">[pg 232]</span><a name="Pg232" id="Pg232" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+from her position on the beast, as
+symbolized in the 17th chapter. The epoch of
+her fall, and consequently of the flight of this
+angel, is that of the Reformation, when the
+corruptions of the Papal See were first exposed,
+and it was denounced as the Apocalyptic harlot.
+The argument for this application is
+given in the exposition of Rev. 18:1, which
+is a repetition of the symbol here given, p. <a href="#Pg300" class="tei tei-ref">300</a>.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Wrath-denouncing Angel.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And another angel, a third, followed them, saying with
+a loud voice, If any one worship the wild beast and his image,
+and receive his mark on his forehead, or on his hand,
+even he will drink of the wine of the wrath of God, which
+is poured out unmingled into the cup of his wrath; and he
+will be tormented with fire and brimstone in the presence
+of the holy angels and in the presence of the Lamb: and
+the smoke of their torment ascendeth for ever and ever:
+and they have no rest day or night, who worship the wild
+beast and his image, and whoever receiveth the mark of
+his name!</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 14:9-11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The cry of this angel synchronizes with the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“voice from heaven”</span> (18:4), and follows
+the discovery of the corruptions of Romanism.—See
+the exposition of that Scripture, p. <a href="#Pg307" class="tei tei-ref">307</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The worship of the beast consisted in a regard
+for it, equivalent to saying, <span class="tei tei-q">“Who is
+like unto the beast? and, Who is able to make
+war with him?”</span> 13:4. To worship, is to
+manifest homage and respect. To worship
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page233">[pg 233]</span><a name="Pg233" id="Pg233" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+any inferior object, is to bestow on it the confidence
+and affection which is due only to
+God. It is to trust in it, as invincible, able to
+protect, and infallible in judgment. Thus to
+regard any civil or ecclesiastical organization,
+is to substitute it for Him, by whom the powers
+that be are ordained (Rom. 13:1), who
+giveth the kingdom to whomsoever he will
+(Dan. 4:17), and by whom alone, kings
+reign, and princes decree justice, Prov. 8:15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Whenever any civil or ecclesiastical enactment
+conflicts with the requisitions of Jehovah,
+that power is worshipped, which is
+obeyed in preference to the other: <span class="tei tei-q">“Know ye
+not that to whom ye yield yourselves servants
+to obey, his servants ye are whom ye obey?”</span>
+Rom. 6:16. The worship of God is incompatible
+with obedience to any power which
+compels a violation of His laws. Due obedience
+to government is commanded, when no
+question of conscience is involved. When it
+is, no forcible resistance to the execution of
+the law is permitted; but while God is obeyed,
+the penalty of the law is to be meekly endured.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The early Christians chose death, rather
+than to deny their Saviour at the command of
+Jewish Sanhedrim or Roman emperor. When
+Peter and John were commanded <span class="tei tei-q">“not to
+speak at all, nor teach in the name of Jesus,”</span>
+their answer was, <span class="tei tei-q">“Whether it be right in the
+sight of God to hearken unto you more than
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page234">[pg 234]</span><a name="Pg234" id="Pg234" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+unto God, judge ye; for we cannot but speak
+the things which we have seen and heard,”</span>
+Acts 4:19, 20. In like manner, the Christians
+living at the epoch of this angel, were to
+be similarly tried, which is implied in the
+command, not to worship.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+So soon as the reformers were placed in
+direct conflict with the Church of Rome, her
+anathemas were hurled against all who assented
+not to her mummeries. And the power
+of the civil arm was also brought into exercise
+to compel obedience to her commands.
+Those who maintained their integrity, did so
+in opposition to the requirements of the church
+and state; while those who submitted to the
+state as invincible, or to the church as infallible,
+extended to the beast or its image that homage
+and regard which was due to God. They
+thus acknowledged themselves the servants of
+him whom they obeyed, and subjected themselves
+to the wrath of God.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The smoke of their torment ascendeth up
+for ever and ever, and they have no rest, day
+nor night, who worship the beast and his
+image. While the righteous enter into rest,
+the wicked are like the troubled sea which
+cannot rest, whose waters cast up mire and
+dirt, Isa. 57:20.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page235">[pg 235]</span><a name="Pg235" id="Pg235" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Harvest of the Earth.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Here is the patience of the saints: here are those who
+keep the commandments of God, and the faith of Jesus.
+And I heard a voice from heaven, saying, Write, Happy the
+dead who die in the Lord, from henceforth! Yea, saith the
+Spirit, that they may rest from their toils; and their works
+go with them. And I looked, and behold, a white cloud,
+and one was seated on the cloud like the Son of man, having
+on his head a golden crown, and in his hand a sharp sickle.
+And another angel came out of the temple, crying with a
+loud voice to him seated on the cloud, Thrust forth thy
+sickle and reap: for the hour is come for thee to reap; for
+the harvest of the earth is ripe. And he, who sat on the
+cloud, cast his sickle on the earth; and the earth was
+reaped.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 14:12-16.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The announcement that here are they who
+keep the commandments of God, implies that,
+at the epoch symbolized, they are to be the
+subjects of special notice. By the voice from
+heaven, they are shown to include all of the
+dead who have died in the Lord; and their
+being blessed from thenceforth, indicates that
+they will at that epoch enter upon their eternal
+reward.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“rest”</span> of the righteous, is at the advent
+of Christ:—<span class="tei tei-q">“To you who are troubled,
+rest with us when the Lord Jesus shall be revealed
+from heaven,”</span> 2 Thess. 1:6. <span class="tei tei-q">“There
+remaineth a rest for the people of God,”</span> Heb.
+4:9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+On hearing the voice from heaven, the revelator
+looked, and beheld on a cloud <span class="tei tei-q">“one like
+the Son of man.”</span> In Ezek. 1:26, <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page236">[pg 236]</span><a name="Pg236" id="Pg236" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+likeness as the appearance of a man,”</span> upon
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the likeness of the throne,”</span> is explained to
+be <span class="tei tei-q">“the appearance of the likeness of the
+glory of the Lord.”</span> In Dan. 7:13, <span class="tei tei-q">“one like
+the Son of man,”</span> who comes to the Ancient
+of days, is evidently a symbol of Christ. In
+Rev. 1:13, <span class="tei tei-q">“one like unto the Son of man,”</span>
+is the one who was alive, was dead, and is
+alive forevermore. The same symbol repeated,
+must here also be a representative of
+Christ.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His position on a cloud, indicates the arrival
+of the period when he is to be manifested
+in mid-heaven: <span class="tei tei-q">“Behold he cometh with
+clouds; and every eye shall see him,”</span> 1:7.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“One like the Son of man came with the
+clouds of heaven, and came to the Ancient of
+days, and they brought him near before him.
+And there was given him dominion and glory
+and a kingdom, that all people, nations, and
+languages should serve him,”</span> Dan. 7:13, 14.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And they shall see the Son of man coming
+in the clouds of heaven, with power and great
+glory. And he shall send his angels, with a
+great sound of a trumpet, and they shall
+gather together his elect from the four winds,
+from one end of heaven to the other,”</span> Matt.
+24:30, 31.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The epoch of this manifestation, according
+to the above, is that of the last trump, the
+second advent, and the first resurrection.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“At the last trump ... the dead shall be
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page237">[pg 237]</span><a name="Pg237" id="Pg237" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+raised incorruptible, and we shall be changed,”</span>
+1 Cor. 15:52. <span class="tei tei-q">“For the Lord himself shall
+descend from heaven with a shout, with the
+voice of the archangel, and with the trump
+of God; and the dead in Christ shall rise first;
+then we which are alive and remain, shall be
+caught up together with them in the clouds,
+to meet the Lord in the air,”</span> 1 Thess. 4:16, 17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His <span class="tei tei-q">“golden crown”</span> indicates that he is
+now to take to himself his great power, and to
+reign, <span class="tei tei-q">“when the kingdoms of this world become
+our Lord's and his Christ's,”</span> 11:15, 17.
+Crowns are symbols of sovereignty. As such,
+they respectively denoted the periods, when
+the forms of government, symbolized by the
+heads of the beast (12:3) and its horns (13:1),
+bore rule. Now the diadem is to be transferred
+from them, to encircle the brow of
+earth's rightful Sovereign.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sharp sickle in his hand, indicates that
+the time of harvest has arrived; and the
+act of reaping, the gathering of the harvest.
+There are two gatherings symbolized, corresponding
+to the two classes of persons who
+are to be gathered. <span class="tei tei-q">“The dead in Christ
+shall rise first,”</span> and will be <span class="tei tei-q">“caught up to
+meet the Lord in the air,”</span> before the wicked
+are gathered, 1 Thess. 4:16, 17. <span class="tei tei-q">“I will
+come again, and receive you unto myself,”</span>
+said the Saviour, John 14:5. The Lord of
+the harvest directs its gathering, but effects it
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page238">[pg 238]</span><a name="Pg238" id="Pg238" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+by the instrumentality of angels: <span class="tei tei-q">“He shall
+send his angels, and shall gather together his
+elect from the four winds, from the uttermost
+part of the earth, to the uttermost part of
+heaven,”</span> Mark 13:27. When thus gathered,
+they are caught up to meet the Lord in the air,
+where the Lord of the harvest sits. This
+is the separation of the righteous and wicked,
+who were to <span class="tei tei-q">“grow together till the harvest,”</span>
+which, says the Saviour, <span class="tei tei-q">“is the end of the
+world,”</span> Matt. 13:39.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Mr. Lord suggests, that it is inconsistent
+with the dignity of Christ, to be notified by an
+angel when to begin his work; and therefore
+dissents from the application of the symbol to
+him. It may not, however, be necessary to
+consider the cry of the angel, as one of command.
+The angel may be a messenger from
+the Ancient of days, announcing the epoch of
+the resurrection. Or he may symbolize a body
+of men, who will be ardently praying for the
+return of the nobleman to take his kingdom.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The harvest is spoken of in distinction
+from the gathering of the vine, and in contrast
+with it. Men harvest what they prize,—their
+grain and fruits. They do not harvest
+briers and thorns. They cut or reap both;
+but the act of reaping is not expressive of the
+destiny of what is reaped. This is indicated
+by the disposition made, and the terms applied;
+the one is gathered into the garner of
+the Lord; but the other is given to the consuming
+fire.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page239">[pg 239]</span><a name="Pg239" id="Pg239" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The righteous being caught up to meet the
+Lord at his coming, the destruction of the
+wicked, which must precede the regeneration
+of the earth and descent of the saints, is next
+symbolized.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Reaping of the Vine.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And another angel came out of the temple in heaven,
+he also having a sharp sickle. And another angel came out
+from the altar, who had power over the fire, and called
+with a loud shout to him who had the sharp sickle, saying,
+Thrust in thy sharp sickle, and cut off the clusters of the
+vine of the earth; for its grapes are ripe. And the angel
+cast in his sickle into the earth, and cut off the vine of the
+earth, and cast it into the great wine-press of the wrath of
+God. And the wine-press was trodden without the city,
+and blood came out of the wine-press, even to the bridles
+of the horses, for the distance of one thousand six hundred
+furlongs.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev. 14:17-20.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The wicked also are gathered by the instrumentality
+of angels: said the Saviour, <span class="tei tei-q">“As
+therefore the tares are gathered and burned in
+the fire; so shall it be in the end of this
+world. The Son of man shall send forth his
+angels, and they shall gather out of his kingdom
+all things that offend, and them which
+do iniquity; and shall cast them into a
+furnace of fire: there shall be wailing and
+gnashing of teeth,”</span> Matt. 13:40-42. In the
+parable of the tares, the Saviour said, <span class="tei tei-q">“Let
+both grow together until the harvest: and in
+the time of harvest I will say to the reapers,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page240">[pg 240]</span><a name="Pg240" id="Pg240" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Gather ye together first the tares, and bind
+them in bundles to burn them: but gather the
+wheat into my barn.”</span> Thus the tares were
+to be gathered <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">first</span></em>—not before the righteous
+are gathered, but before the wheat is placed in
+the garner: the new earth being the garner
+where the righteous are <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">finally</span></em> to be gathered,
+they cannot be placed there till the wicked
+have been gathered out. <span class="tei tei-q">“Then shall the
+righteous shine forth as the sun in the kingdom
+of their Father. Who hath ears to hear,
+let him hear,”</span> Matt. 13:30, 43.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The disposition of the vine, its being trodden
+down, and the great presence of blood
+flowing, symbolize the awful judgments to
+overtake the wicked, after the escape of the
+righteous, when they are gathered into bundles
+and burned. Thus Isaiah prophesied:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Who is this that cometh from Edom, with
+dyed garments from Bozrah? this that is glorious
+in his apparel, travelling in the greatness
+of his strength? I that speak in righteousness,
+mighty to save. Wherefore art thou red
+in thine apparel, and thy garments like him
+that treadeth in the wine-vat? I have trodden
+the wine-press alone: and of the people
+there was none with me: for I will tread them
+in mine anger, and trample them in my fury,
+and their blood shall be sprinkled upon my
+garments, and I will stain all my raiment.
+For the day of vengeance is in my heart, and
+the year of my redeemed is come,”</span> Isa. 63:1-4.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page241">[pg 241]</span><a name="Pg241" id="Pg241" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Before the destruction of the old world by
+the deluge, Noah was secure in the ark. Before
+the destruction of Sodom, Lot is removed
+to a place of safety. So before the destruction
+of the vine of the earth, the righteous are
+caught up to the Lord in the air, where they
+are symbolized, in the following chapter, as:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Victors on the Sea of Glass.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw another sign in heaven, great and wonderful,
+seven angels having the seven last plagues; for by
+these, the wrath of God is completed. And I saw as it were
+a transparent sea mingled with fire; and those who had
+obtained the victory over the wild beast, and over his
+image, and over the number of his name, standing on the
+transparent sea, having harps of God. And they sing the
+song of Moses the servant of God, and the song of the Lamb,
+saying, Great and wonderful are thy works, O Lord God
+Almighty; just and true are thy ways, king of nations!
+Who should not fear thee, O Lord, and glorify thy name?
+for thou only art holy; for all nations will come and worship
+before thee; for thy judgments are manifested.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev.
+15:1-4.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This appears to close the vision commencing
+with the sixth verse of the 14th chapter, and
+to be independent of the remaining portion of
+the 15th chapter.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These <span class="tei tei-q">“seven angels,”</span> in the subsequent
+vision, discharge the contents of the vials of
+God's wrath; but the epoch here presented is
+evidently subsequent to that fulfilment; for
+the imitation of the <span class="tei tei-q">“Song of Moses,”</span> must
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page242">[pg 242]</span><a name="Pg242" id="Pg242" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+follow the infliction of the judgments which
+call forth that song of rejoicing. They had
+here completed the wrath of God, the manner
+of which act is subsequently shown in a
+separate vision.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“sea of glass,”</span> must represent an elevation
+above the earth. For those stationed
+there had gotten the victory over the beast
+and his image, had escaped the wrath to be
+poured on those who worshipped those powers
+(14:9), had been gathered when the
+harvest of the earth was reaped (14:16),
+being then caught up to meet the Lord in the
+air (1 Thess. 4:17), and now, the clusters of
+the vine of the earth having been gathered
+and cast into the wine-press of the wrath of
+God (14:19), they rejoice above the fires
+of earth, witnesses of the manifestations of
+God's judgments. They have come out of
+all their tribulations, and evidently synchronize
+with the palm-bearing multitude (Rev.
+7:9), the hundred and forty-four thousand
+on Mount Zion (14:1), and the multitude in
+heaven who sing Alleluia over the judgment
+of the great harlot, 19:1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The song of Moses,”</span> was that sung by
+the Israelites when the Egyptians had perished
+in the waters of the Red Sea, and they
+were safely encamped on its further shore.
+The Lord had triumphed gloriously over the
+enemies of Israel, had buried the horse and
+his rider in the sea, and was about to plant
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page243">[pg 243]</span><a name="Pg243" id="Pg243" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+his people in the mountain of his inheritance,—in
+the place which he had made for them
+to dwell in,—in the sanctuary which he had
+established, Ex. 15:1-21. The analogy
+requires that when this corresponding song is
+sung, the ransomed of the Lord shall have
+correspondingly witnessed the overthrow of
+the adversaries of Jehovah, and shall themselves
+have escaped from the perils of the
+many waters which had threatened to engulf
+them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The judgments of God being manifested on
+the nations of the ungodly, there are none
+remaining, only <span class="tei tei-q">“the nations of them which
+are saved,”</span> 21:24. As these will all walk in
+the light of the new Jerusalem, those on the
+sea of glass may well sing:
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Great and marvellous are thy works, Lord God Almighty!</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Just and true are thy ways, thou King of saints!</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Who shall not fear thee, O Lord, and glorify thy name?</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">For thou only art Holy:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">For all nations shall come and worship before thee;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">For thy judgments are made manifest.”</span></div>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In accordance with the foregoing view, this
+synchronizes with the <span class="tei tei-q">“new song”</span> sung by
+those who are redeemed from every nation,
+kindred, tongue and people (5:9), who are
+afterwards seen standing with the Lamb on
+Mount Zion, 14:3.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page244">[pg 244]</span><a name="Pg244" id="Pg244" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Angels with the Seven Vials.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And after this, I looked, and the temple of the tabernacle
+of the testimony in heaven was opened; and the seven
+angels came out of the temple, having the seven plagues,
+clothed in pure white linen, and girded around the breasts
+with golden girdles. And one of the four living beings
+gave to the seven angels, seven golden bowls filled with the
+wrath of God, who liveth for ever and ever. And the temple
+was filled with smoke from the glory of God, and from
+his power, and no one was able to enter the temple till the
+seven plagues of the seven angels were completed.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev.
+15:5-8.
+</span></div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I heard a loud voice out of the temple saying,
+to the seven angels, Depart, and pour out the bowls of the
+wrath of God on the earth.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:1.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The temple of the tabernacle of the testimony
+in heaven,”</span> must symbolize heaven
+itself. It corresponds with the tabernacle
+<span class="tei tei-q">“after the second veil,”</span>—called <span class="tei tei-q">“the holiest
+of all,”</span> where the tables of the covenant were
+deposited by the command of Moses, Heb. 9:1-5.
+There, the <span class="tei tei-q">“cherubims of glory”</span> over-shadowed
+the mercy-seat,—a type of the presence-chamber
+of the Almighty. Consequently,
+when it is symbolized as being opened in
+heaven, the angels who come out are divinely
+commissioned executors of God's purposes.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“seven angels,”</span> are the ministers of
+the divine vengeance,—the rectitude of
+their character and the dignity of their office,
+being symbolized by their <span class="tei tei-q">“white robes”</span> and
+<span class="tei tei-q">“golden girdles.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page245">[pg 245]</span><a name="Pg245" id="Pg245" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The period of time symbolized by the pouring
+out of the vials, must be anterior to the
+second advent; for in the analogous instances
+of God's judgments, he visits his enemies
+with plagues previous to the deliverance of
+his children. Thus were the ancient Egyptians
+visited, before the Israelites escaped from
+their power, Ex. 5-11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The deliverance of the vials to the angels
+by one of the four <span class="tei tei-q">“living creatures,”</span> indicates
+that the intelligences in the divine presence,
+which are thus symbolized, are cognizant
+of God's design, and acquiesce in his purpose
+to visit the subjects of his wrath with these
+plagues.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+By these being called <span class="tei tei-q">“the vials of God's
+wrath,”</span> we learn that their infliction is not
+corrective, but judicial;—that they are not
+agents of mercy, but of vengeance.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The filling of the temple with the smoke of
+God's glory, to the exclusion of all persons
+during the pouring out of the vials, shows
+that during that period, there will be no intercession
+with God for him to refrain from the
+execution of the purposes thus symbolized.
+They are inevitable; and there will be no
+supplication for their suspension. When Moses
+had finished the type of the <span class="tei tei-q">“Holiest of
+all,”</span> a <span class="tei tei-q">“cloud covered the tent of the congregation,
+and the glory of the Lord filled the
+tabernacle. And Moses was not able to enter
+into the tent of the congregation, because the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page246">[pg 246]</span><a name="Pg246" id="Pg246" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+cloud abode thereon, and the glory of the
+Lord filled the tabernacle,”</span> Ex. 40:34, 35.
+It was only when Moses could enter the tabernacle,
+that he could there commune with
+God face to face, Ex. 33:9, 11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The voice from the temple to the seven
+angels, shows that the acts commanded are
+the subjects of divine appointment,—the
+angels simply designating the commencement
+of the several judgments.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The First Vial.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the first went away, and poured out his bowl on
+the earth; and there came an evil and sore ulcer on the
+men who had the mark of the beast, and on those worshipping
+his image.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:2.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“earth,”</span> in the Apocalypse, symbolizes
+a quiet and settled government (13:11),
+in distinction from one politically agitated,
+which is symbolized by waters, 13:1; 17:15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those who receive the contents of the first
+vial, being the worshippers of the <span class="tei tei-q">“beast”</span>
+and its <span class="tei tei-q">“image”</span> (13:15), it is certain that
+the governments on which it is poured, are
+subservient to the church of Rome and within
+the boundaries of the ten kingdoms.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The effect of the vial is <span class="tei tei-q">“a noisome and
+grievous sore;”</span> and the only things analogous,
+are mental maladies. Therefore the results
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page247">[pg 247]</span><a name="Pg247" id="Pg247" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+symbolized must be noxious principles and
+opinions, which fill the mind with rancor and
+hate,—producing strife, alienation and contention.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">epoch</span></em> here symbolized, in the very
+unanimous opinion of most judicious writers,
+corresponds with the commencement of the
+agitations which preceded the outbreak of the
+first French revolution, about A. D. 1785.
+Commencing in France, and extending with
+more or less virulence throughout the ten
+kingdoms, there was excited an intense uneasiness
+of the people respecting their relation
+to their rulers. They regarded themselves as
+insupportably oppressed and degraded, and
+were exasperated to madness against their
+respective governments. This, under the
+next vial, resulted in the overthrow of the
+French monarchy, and in attempted revolutions
+in other kingdoms.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Second Vial.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the second angel poured out his bowl on the sea;
+and it became like the blood of a dead person; and every
+living creature in the sea died.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:8.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The first vial having excited political agitations
+in previously quiet governments, they
+are now more fitly symbolized by the <span class="tei tei-q">“sea”</span>
+than by the <span class="tei tei-q">“earth.”</span> And on such the second
+vial is poured.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page248">[pg 248]</span><a name="Pg248" id="Pg248" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As the sea symbolizes a people agitated and
+disquieted, the living things in it, must symbolize
+those who live on and are sustained by
+the people. Consequently, the waters becoming
+blood, and the death of the things living
+in the waters, symbolize the shedding of the
+blood of the people, and the slaughter, by
+them, of their rulers and superiors.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The epoch symbolized, would therefore
+correspond with the actual outbreak of the
+French revolution, to which the agitations produced
+by the previous vial had goaded on the
+excited people. In their riots and insurrections,
+history records the destruction of large numbers
+of the populace; and these exterminated
+the members of the royal family, and all persons
+of rank and influence. A million of
+people, according to Alison, perished in the
+civil war of La Vendee alone; and thousands
+of the nobility and persons of distinction were
+ruthlessly slaughtered throughout France,
+whose rivers were discolored with the blood
+of the slain.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Third Vial.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the third poured out his bowl on the rivers and on
+the fountains of waters; and they became blood. And I
+heard the angel of the waters say, Thou art righteous, O
+Thou, who art, and wast holy, because thou hast inflicted
+these judgments; for they have poured out the blood of
+saints and prophets, and thou hast given them blood to
+drink: they are worthy! And I heard one from the altar,
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page249">[pg 249]</span><a name="Pg249" id="Pg249" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+saying, Even so, Lord God Almighty, true and righteous
+are thy judgments!</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:4-7.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Mr. Lord justly remarks that <span class="tei tei-q">“Rivers and
+fountains of waters, are to a sea, what smaller
+exterior communities and nations are to a
+great central people.”</span> As the French nation
+was the sea, the <span class="tei tei-q">“rivers and fountains”</span> symbolize
+contiguous or more remote communities
+surrounding it. These are said to have
+become blood, without its being specified that
+the living things in them perished, as in the
+sea. Accordingly, while the greater portion
+of Europe continued, with little interruption,
+for twenty years from 1792, to be deluged
+with war and bloodshed, the nobles and rulers
+of the other nations were not exterminated, as
+in France.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The nations thus overwhelmed with blood,
+were those which had sanctioned the shedding
+of the blood of the saints; consequently
+their retribution was just.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Fourth Vial.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the fourth angel poured out his vial on the sun;
+and it was given him to burn men with fire. And men
+were burned with great heat, and reviled the name of God,
+who had power over these plagues; and they repented not
+to give him glory.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:8, 9.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The influence of the sun on the earth and
+sea, is analogous to that of a government on
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page250">[pg 250]</span><a name="Pg250" id="Pg250" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the subjects of its rule. As the right degree
+of light and heat is conducive to vegetation,
+and the excessive action of the sun's rays will
+scorch and destroy; so a genial government
+is a blessing to the people, while its arbitrary
+and tyrannical acts are often insupportably
+oppressive.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With the overthrow of the French monarchy
+under the second vial, there arose new
+rulers in France, who usurped despotic powers,
+and subjected the governed to most oppressive
+exactions. The rich were impoverished,
+the nation was robbed, the business of
+the country was paralyzed, the obnoxious
+were slain, every species of misery and wickedness
+abounded, the males were subjected
+to military conscription, and hundreds of thousands
+of them were sent to subjugate surrounding
+nations. The countries they invaded
+were also devastated, and oppressed, and robbed
+by impoverishing taxations. These continued,
+though in a milder form, under the imperial
+rule, and all parts of the Roman earth
+felt the scorching effects of the devouring heat
+of French usurpation. But when Napoleon
+passed beyond the boundaries of the Roman
+empire, he was met and driven back by the
+snow and frost of the Almighty.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Notwithstanding the oppressions to which
+the people were subjected, and the exactions
+under which they groaned, they made no
+recognition of God's sovereignty. They saw
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page251">[pg 251]</span><a name="Pg251" id="Pg251" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+not that this chastisement was from Him.
+They did not deprecate his wrath, nor acknowledge
+his righteousness, but still continued
+to be infidels and apostates. They continued
+to blaspheme the name of God, who
+had power over these plagues, and repented
+not to give him glory.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Fifth Vial.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the fifth angel poured out his bowl on the throne
+of the wild beast; and his kingdom was darkened; and
+they gnawed their tongues through pain, and reviled the
+God of heaven, because of their pains and their ulcers, and
+repented not of their deeds</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:10, 11.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The beast, here spoken of, is the same seven-headed,
+ten-horned wild beast that ascended
+out of the sea (Rev. 13:1), symbolizing the
+Roman empire in its divided form. Consequently
+the seat or throne of the beast would
+be the ruling power which exercised and controlled
+the government of these kingdoms.
+Just previous to this epoch, Napoleon had
+reached the summit of his power; and the
+subversion of his throne, with the restoration
+of the Bourbon dynasty in 1814 and
+1815, is evidently here symbolized. Napoleon
+had become the idol of France, which
+worshipped at the shrine of his glory. With
+his fall, their sun was stricken from its
+firmament, and the kingdom was darkened.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page252">[pg 252]</span><a name="Pg252" id="Pg252" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The change being effected by foreign arms,
+the chagrin and mortification of his adherents
+was natural and expected. They were filled
+with pain and anguish at this termination of
+all their hopes. The re-imposition on them
+of the Bourbon line, revived all their former
+hatred towards their rulers and sense of oppression,
+symbolized by the ulcers of the first
+vial. They continued still a nation of infidels,
+performing the same works of blasphemy
+against God; and again and again have they
+risen in rebellion against their government.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Sixth Vial.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the sixth poured out his bowl on the great river,
+the Euphrates; and its water was dried up, that the way
+of the kings from the rising of the sun might be prepared.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">
+Rev. 16:12.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This symbol resembles a like prediction
+respecting ancient Babylon: <span class="tei tei-q">“A drought is
+upon her waters, and they shall be dried up,”</span>
+(Jer. 50:38); and <span class="tei tei-q">“I will dry up her sea,
+and make her springs dry,”</span> Jer. 51:36.
+Ancient Babylon was situated on the river
+Euphrates, which contributed to the wealth
+and greatness of the city, and was a means
+of its defence. The kings of Media and Persia,
+from the east of Babylon, subjugated it
+by diverting from the city the waters of the
+river, and entering by its unprotected bed.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page253">[pg 253]</span><a name="Pg253" id="Pg253" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+The turning of the waters into other channels,
+fulfilled the prediction that it should be dried
+up.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Waters, when used as a symbol, are explained
+to be <span class="tei tei-q">“peoples, nations,”</span> &amp;c., Rev.
+17:15. In the 17th chapter of the Apocalypse,
+the angel informs the revelator that he
+will show him <span class="tei tei-q">“the judgment of the great
+harlot who sitteth on many waters,”</span> (17:1);
+which implies that he had already seen a vision
+to that effect. He is then shown a woman
+on a scarlet-colored beast (v. 3), who is
+spoken of as sitting <span class="tei tei-q">“on many waters”</span> (v.
+1), and on seven mountains (v. 10), and who
+is affirmed to be the <span class="tei tei-q">“great city, which reigneth
+over the kings of the earth,”</span> v. 18. Under
+the seventh vial, the <span class="tei tei-q">“great city,”</span> which is
+<span class="tei tei-q">“great Babylon,”</span> is divided into three parts
+(16:19); and the inference is, that the harlot
+and ancient Babylon are analogous symbols
+of the same organized agency; and, that the
+city was here exhibited on the great river
+Euphrates.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As a woman clothed with sunbeams and
+crowned with stars (Rev. 12:1), and a city
+illuminated with the glory of God (Rev. 21:10),
+are each symbols of the true church, corresponding
+symbols of opposite moral characteristics
+are appropriate representatives of a
+corrupt and apostate church. As Jerusalem
+was the seat of the ancient church, so was
+Babylon the seat of her oppressors. The former
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page254">[pg 254]</span><a name="Pg254" id="Pg254" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+is addressed as a woman, and told to put
+on her <span class="tei tei-q">“beautiful garments,”</span> (Isa. 52:1); and
+Babylon is called the <span class="tei tei-q">“daughter of the Chaldeans,”</span>
+and <span class="tei tei-q">“the lady of kingdoms,”</span> (Isa.
+47:5): so that a woman, and a city of corresponding
+character, may, interchangeably,
+symbolize the same object. Consequently, the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Babylon,”</span> and the <span class="tei tei-q">“harlot”</span> of the Apocalypse,
+both symbolize the corrupt Roman hierarchy.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Ancient Babylon is described as a harlot,
+and is addressed as one who <span class="tei tei-q">“dwellest upon
+many waters, abundant in treasures,”</span> (Jer. 51:13);
+whose end was to come by her waters
+being dried up, 51:36. That city sustained
+a relation to the waters on which it was situated,
+analogous to that held by the Roman
+Catholic church to the people who support
+and defend her pretensions. Their alienation
+and withdrawal from her support, must therefore
+be symbolized by the drying up of the
+great river Euphrates, which becomes diverted
+into other channels. This is now apparently
+being fulfilled in the marked alienation of
+feeling from the church of Rome, which is
+evident throughout the ten kingdoms. During
+the last twenty years, the hold of that community
+on the affection of her supporters in
+Europe, has been constantly becoming weaker
+and weaker. Infidel principles have been extensively
+propagated. Her cathedrals have
+been comparatively deserted; and her existence
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page255">[pg 255]</span><a name="Pg255" id="Pg255" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+has been endured more as a matter of
+expediency than of affection. At the present
+moment, probably, the mass of the people
+have little confidence in her pretensions; but
+it will require a more marked withdrawal
+from her support than has yet been witnessed,
+to fulfil, in all its significance, the meaning
+conveyed in the symbol.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“kings of the east,”</span> whose way is to
+be thus prepared, are doubtless her enemies,
+who, having produced the desired alienation
+from her support, will take advantage of her
+defenceless position, and hasten her ruin; as
+the kings of Media and Persia, in like manner,
+subjugated old Babylon.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Under the operation of the sixth vial, and,
+according to the fulfilment of the preceding
+symbols, corresponding with the present time,
+are to be developed:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Unclean Spirits.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw three unclean spirits like frogs come out of
+the mouth of the dragon, and out of the mouth of the wild
+beast, and out of the mouth of the false prophet. For they
+are spirits of demons, performing signs, that go forth to the
+kings of the whole world, to gather them to the battle of
+that great day of God Almighty.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:13, 14.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“dragon,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“beast,”</span> and <span class="tei tei-q">“false prophet,”</span>
+being regarded as symbols: the first,
+of the Roman empire previous to its subversion
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page256">[pg 256]</span><a name="Pg256" id="Pg256" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+by the northern barbarians; the second
+of the ten kingdoms which subsequently
+arose; and the third, of the eastern Roman
+empire—now the Mohamedan power; the
+mouths of each, from which the frog-like
+spirits emerge, are next to be considered.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To the wild beast was given <span class="tei tei-q">“a mouth,
+speaking great things and blasphemies,”</span> the
+power of which was <span class="tei tei-q">“to continue forty and
+two months,”</span> Rev. 13:5. The agreement
+of this with the corresponding appendages of
+Daniel's <span class="tei tei-q">“little horn”</span> (Dan. 7:8), makes it
+evident that a <span class="tei tei-q">“mouth”</span> is a symbol of an
+ecclesiastical organization existing in a political
+one,—that it symbolizes the agency by
+which the people are taught, and is representative
+of ecclesiastics, who are the mouthpiece
+of the nation in all matters of faith and
+worship, p. <a href="#Pg172" class="tei tei-ref">172</a>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The religion of Rome imperial, when symbolized
+by the dragon, was Paganism; that of
+the ten kingdoms, was the Papacy; and that
+of the eastern empire, is Mohammedanism.
+From these three, then, emerge the <span class="tei tei-q">“unclean
+spirits.”</span> Diverse as their origin appears,
+they have no marked individual peculiarities.
+Being alike in their characteristics, they
+must symbolize some common agency:—a
+combination of religious teachers, whose
+views harmonize in a system of belief common
+to Paganism, Catholicism, and Mohammedanism.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page257">[pg 257]</span><a name="Pg257" id="Pg257" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The character of these teachers, is shown
+by the declaration that <span class="tei tei-q">“they are the spirits
+of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></em> working miracles.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+There are two words rendered devils in the
+New Testament, viz.: δαιμονιον (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">daimonion</span></span>) or
+δαιμων (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">daimoon</span></span>), and διαβολος (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">diabolus</span></span>).
+The latter signifies the Devil, or Satan, who
+is the same as Beelzebub the prince of the
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></em>, Matt. 12:25. He it was by whom
+Jesus was tempted in the wilderness, (Matt.
+4:1-11); who sowed the tares in the field,
+(Matt, 13:39); and for whom, with his
+angels, the final punishment for the wicked is
+prepared, Matt. 25:41.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The word here, is <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">daimoon</span></span>. It is used, in
+different forms, sixty-five times by our Lord
+and his apostles; and on no occasion do they
+hint that they use the word in a sense different
+from its then accepted signification; to
+learn which, recourse must be had to the testimony
+of the Pagan, Jewish, and Christian
+writers of those times.<a id="noteref_6" name="noteref_6" href="#note_6"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">6</span></span></a>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Hesiod</span></span> taught that, <span class="tei tei-q">“The spirits of departed
+mortals become <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></em> when separated
+from their earthly bodies;”</span> and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Plutarch</span></span>, that
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page258">[pg 258]</span><a name="Pg258" id="Pg258" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The demons of the Greeks were the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">ghosts</span></em>
+and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">genii</span></span> of departed men.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“All Pagan
+antiquity affirms,”</span> says Dr. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Campbell</span></span>, <span class="tei tei-q">“that
+from Titan and Saturn, the poetic progeny of
+Cœlus and Terra, down to Æsculapius, Proteus,
+and Minos, all their <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">divinities</span></span> were the
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">ghosts</span></span> of dead men; and were so regarded
+by the most erudite of the Pagans themselves.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Among the Pagans, the term <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demon</span></span>, as
+often represented a good as an evil spirit;
+but among the Jews, it generally, if not universally,
+denoted an unclean, malign, or
+wicked spirit. Thus <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Josephus</span></span> says: <span class="tei tei-q">“Demons
+are the spirits of wicked men.”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Philo</span></span> says
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“The souls of dead men are called
+demons.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“The notion,”</span> says Dr. <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Lardner</span></span>,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“of demons, or the souls of dead men, having
+power over living men, was universally
+prevalent among the heathen of these times
+[the first two centuries], and believed by
+many Christians.”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Justin Martyr</span></span> speaks of
+<span class="tei tei-q">“those who are seized by the souls of the
+dead, whom we call <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span> and madmen.”</span>
+Ignatius quotes the words of Christ to Peter
+thus: <span class="tei tei-q">“Handle me and see; for I am not a
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">daimoon asomaton</span></span>,—a disembodied
+demon,”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>
+a spirit without a body.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The foregoing is evidence of the New Testament
+signification of the word <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">daimoon</span></span>,
+here improperly rendered devils,—spirits of
+which, the frog-like agencies are affirmed to be.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page259">[pg 259]</span><a name="Pg259" id="Pg259" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Demon worship is a characteristic of the
+three religions referred to. As already shown,
+all Pagans regarded their gods as the ghosts
+of dead men; and the Bible speaks of them
+as devils, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span>. Moses says of them,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Even their sons and their daughters they
+have burnt in the fire to their gods,”</span> (Deut.
+12:31); while the Psalmist affirms that
+<span class="tei tei-q">“they sacrificed their sons and their daughters
+unto <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></span>,”</span> Ps. 106:37. <span class="tei tei-q">“They sacrificed
+unto <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></span>, not to God; to gods whom
+they knew not, to new gods that came newly
+up,”</span> Deut. 32:17. Jeroboam <span class="tei tei-q">“ordained him
+priests for the high places, and for the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></span>,”</span>
+2 Chron. 11:15. <span class="tei tei-q">“The things which the
+Gentiles sacrifice, they sacrifice to <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></span>, and
+not to God: and I would not that ye should
+have fellowship with <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></span>. Ye cannot
+drink the cup of the Lord and the cup of
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></span>; ye cannot be partakers of the Lord's
+table, and of the table of
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">devils</span></span>,”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> of
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Of the same kind are the gods of the
+heathen now. In the Youth's Day-Spring,
+for June, a missionary describing the alarm
+and grief of the Africans on the Gaboon river,
+at the near prospect of a death in their village,
+says: <span class="tei tei-q">“The room was filled with
+women, who were weeping in the most piteous
+manner, and calling on the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">spirits of their
+fathers and of others who were dead</span></em>, and
+upon all spirits in whom they believe, Ologo,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page260">[pg 260]</span><a name="Pg260" id="Pg260" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Njembi, Abambo, and Mbwini, to save the
+man from death. These spirits could not
+help them, but they knew of none mightier,
+and so called on them.”</span> Mr. White, a Wesleyan
+missionary, says: <span class="tei tei-q">“There is a class of
+people in New Zealand, called Eruku, or
+priests. These men pretend to have intercourse
+with departed spirits, ... by which they
+are able to kill by incantation any person on
+whom their anger may fall.”</span> The Sandwich
+Islanders, when they found that Christians
+supposed they worshipped the images of their
+gods, were much amused, and said <span class="tei tei-q">“We are
+not such fools.”</span> They used the idol as an
+aid to fix their minds on their divinity. Some
+of them supposed their divinity was a spirit
+residing in their idol.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Mohammedans, while they recognize
+God, are also <span class="tei tei-q">“taught by the Koran to
+believe the existence of an intermediate order
+of creatures, which they call Jin, or genii;”</span>
+some of which are supposed to be good and
+others bad, and capable of communicating
+with men, and rewarding or punishing them.
+The 72d chapter of the Koran consists of a
+pretended communication from the genii to
+Mohammed. They are made to say: <span class="tei tei-q">“There
+are some among us who are upright, and
+there are some among us who are otherwise;”</span>
+and speaking of men: <span class="tei tei-q">“If they tread
+in the way of truth, we will surely water
+them with abundance of rain,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> will
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page261">[pg 261]</span><a name="Pg261" id="Pg261" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+grant them plenty of good things. Thus they
+are recognized as dispensers of good. They
+bear a striking resemblance to the spirits
+which now pretend to communicate with
+men! All who are familiar with Arabian
+romances know how frequently genii, fairies,
+&amp;c., figure as agents in the execution of wonderful
+exploits.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Romanists also pretend to communicate with
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span>,—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> with departed spirits.
+They deify the Virgin Mary, and supplicate
+the intercessions of many departed saints; and
+some they supplicate, whose claim to saintship
+is somewhat equivocal. Their teachings
+in this particular, Protestants generally recognize
+as the subject of the following prediction:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Now the Spirit speaketh expressly that in
+the latter times some shall depart from the
+faith, giving heed to seducing spirits, and
+doctrines of devils,”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span>, 1 Tim. 4:1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Demon-worship being common to Paganism,
+Mohammedanism, and Popery, when the
+frog-like agency emerges from them, the conditions
+of the symbol seem to require that it
+shall originate with, but shall pass beyond
+and outside the influence of those religions.
+The agency thus symbolized, was to <span class="tei tei-q">“go forth
+unto the kings of the earth, and of the whole
+world.”</span> Its fulfilment requires a wonderful
+and an alarming increase of those who teach
+and believe these doctrines; and as they are
+to work miracles, whereby the world will be
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page262">[pg 262]</span><a name="Pg262" id="Pg262" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+deceived, their teachings are to be accompanied
+by extraordinary phenomena, which will
+be unexplainable by any of the known laws
+of science. The spirits of the departed are
+to be recognized by them as authoritative
+teachers, who are to be reverenced and
+obeyed. They will be regarded as communicating
+with mortals, as unveiling the hidden
+things of the invisible state, and as performing
+acts requiring the exercise of physical
+power. The former are evident from
+the analogy which exists between this and
+demon-worship; and the latter, from the
+ascription to them of miraculous acts.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The existence of demoniacal intelligences,
+capable of communicating with and acting
+on mortals, appears to be in accordance with
+the teachings of the Saviour and apostles.
+Demoniacal possessions are clearly distinguished
+from all diseases; and demons are
+shown, by the admissions of the New Testament,
+to be actual intelligences, capable of
+physical power. When the fame of Christ
+<span class="tei tei-q">“went throughout all Syria, they brought
+unto him all sick people that were taken with
+divers diseases and torments, and those which
+were possessed with devils, and those which
+were lunatic, and those which had the palsy;
+and he healed them,”</span> Matt. 4:24. <span class="tei tei-q">“When
+the unclean spirit is gone out of a man, he
+walketh through dry places, seeking rest, and
+findeth none. Then he saith, I will return
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page263">[pg 263]</span><a name="Pg263" id="Pg263" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+into my house from whence I came out; and
+when he is come, he findeth it empty, swept,
+and garnished. Then goeth he, and taketh
+with himself seven other spirits more wicked
+than himself, and they enter in and dwell
+there: and the last state of that man is worse
+than the first,”</span> Matt. 12:43-45. <span class="tei tei-q">“And
+as they went out, behold they brought to
+him a dumb man possessed with a devil.<a id="noteref_7" name="noteref_7" href="#note_7"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">7</span></span></a>
+And when the devil was cast out, the dumb
+spake; and the multitudes marvelled, saying,
+It was never so seen in Israel. But the Pharisees
+said, He casteth out devils,<a id="noteref_8" name="noteref_8" href="#note_8"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">8</span></span></a> through the
+prince of the devils,”</span> Matt. 9:32-34. <span class="tei tei-q">“And
+when they were come to the multitude, there
+came to him a certain man kneeling down to
+him, and saying, Lord, have mercy on my
+son; for he is lunatic, and sore vexed, for oft-times
+he falleth into the fire, and oft into the
+water. And I brought him to thy disciples,
+and they could not cure him. Then Jesus
+answered and said, O faithless and perverse
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page264">[pg 264]</span><a name="Pg264" id="Pg264" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+generation, how long shall I be with you?
+how long shall I suffer you? Bring him
+hither to me. And Jesus rebuked the devil,
+and he departed out of him; and the child
+was cured from that very hour,”</span> Matt. 17:14-18.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And there was in their synagogue
+a man with an unclean spirit: and he cried
+out, saying, Let us alone; what have we to
+do with thee, thou Jesus of Nazareth? art
+thou come to destroy us? I know thee who
+thou art, the Holy One of God. And Jesus
+rebuked him, saying, Hold thy peace, and
+come out of him. And when the unclean
+spirit had torn him, and cried with a loud
+voice, he came out of him. And they were
+all amazed, insomuch that they questioned
+among themselves, What thing is this? what
+new doctrine is this? for with what authority
+commandeth he even the unclean spirits, and
+they do obey him!”</span> Mark 1:23-27. <span class="tei tei-q">“And
+when he was come out of the ship, immediately
+there met him out of the tombs a man
+with an unclean spirit, who had his dwelling
+among the tombs; and no man could bind
+him, no, not with chains: because that he
+had been often bound with fetters and chains,
+and the chains had been plucked asunder by
+him, and the fetters broken in pieces: neither
+could any man tame him. And always,
+night and day, he was in the mountains, and
+in the tombs, crying, and cutting himself with
+stones. But when he saw Jesus afar off, he
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page265">[pg 265]</span><a name="Pg265" id="Pg265" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+ran and worshipped him, and cried with a
+loud voice, and said, What have I to do with
+thee, Jesus, thou Son of the Most High God!
+I adjure thee, by God, that thou torment me
+not. (For he said unto him, Come out of the
+man, thou unclean spirit.) And he asked
+him, What is thy name? And he answered,
+saying, My name is Legion: for we are
+many. And he besought him much that he
+would not send them away out of the country.
+Now there was nigh unto the mountains a
+great herd of swine feeding. And all the
+devils besought him, saying, Send us into the
+swine, that we may enter into them. And
+forthwith Jesus gave them leave. And the
+unclean spirits went out, and entered into the
+swine; and the herd ran violently down a
+steep place into the sea (they were about two
+thousand), and were choked in the sea,”</span>
+Mark 5:2-13.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In all these instances, the demons are
+recognized as actual intelligences, performing
+given acts. Without the admission of this,
+it will be difficult to explain the meaning of
+a large class of scriptures. It cannot for a
+moment be supposed that the inspired writers
+would be permitted to use language which
+should directly mislead the common mind.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Among the miracles which the apostles
+wrought, <span class="tei tei-q">“unclean spirits, crying with a loud
+voice, came out of many possessed with them,
+and many taken with palsies, and that were
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page266">[pg 266]</span><a name="Pg266" id="Pg266" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+lame, were healed,”</span> Acts 8:7. <span class="tei tei-q">“And God
+wrought special miracles by the hands of
+Paul: so that from his body were brought
+unto the sick handkerchiefs, or aprons, and
+the diseases departed from them, and the evil
+spirits went out of them. Then certain of
+the vagabond Jews, exorcists, took upon them
+to call over them which had evil spirits, the
+name of the Lord Jesus, saying, We adjure
+you by Jesus whom Paul preacheth. And
+there were seven sons of one Sceva, a Jew,
+and chief of the priests, who did so. And
+the evil spirit answered and said, Jesus I
+know, and Paul I know; but who are ye?
+And the man in whom the evil spirit was,
+leaped on them, and overcame them, and prevailed
+against them, so that they fled out
+of that house naked and wounded. And
+many that believed, came and confessed, and
+showed their deeds. Many of them also
+which used curious arts, brought their books
+together, and burned them before all men:
+and they counted the price of them, and
+found it fifty thousand pieces of silver,”</span> Acts
+19:11-16, 18, 19.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The necromancy, divination, and witchcraft,
+forbidden in the Old Testament and
+practised by the heathen of those times, were
+all of a similar character. A necromancer
+was one who had, or pretended to have communication
+with the dead,—who sought <span class="tei tei-q">“for
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page267">[pg 267]</span><a name="Pg267" id="Pg267" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the living to the dead,”</span><a id="noteref_9" name="noteref_9" href="#note_9"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">9</span></span></a> Isa. 8:19. They
+practised divination in divers ways, but usually
+admitted their dependence on familiar
+spirits,—the spirits of the departed,—demons.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The king of Babylon stood at the
+parting of the way, at the head of the two
+ways, to use divination; he made his arrows
+bright, he consulted with images, he looked
+in the liver. At his right hand was the
+divination for Jerusalem, to appoint captains,
+to open the mouth in the slaughter,
+to lift up the voice with shouting, to appoint
+battering-rams against the gates, to cast a
+mount, and to build a fort. And it shall be
+unto them as false divination in their sight,
+to them that have sworn oaths: but he will
+call to remembrance the iniquity, that they
+may be taken,”</span> Ezek. 21:21-23. They
+observed times, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> they regarded some as
+lucky, and others as unlucky times for the
+commencement of any work,—recognizing
+distinctions which God had not made. The
+heathen divinities were regarded as more propitious
+at some times than others. It is enumerated
+among the sins of Manasseh, that he
+<span class="tei tei-q">“made his sons pass through the fire, and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page268">[pg 268]</span><a name="Pg268" id="Pg268" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+observed times, and used enchantments, and
+dealt with familiar spirits and wizards,”</span> 2 Kings 21:6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They practised various arts, whereby they
+thought to protect themselves from evil, and
+to pry into the secrets of futurity. Because
+of these things, ancient Babylon was suddenly
+overwhelmed,—<span class="tei tei-q">“for the multitude of thy sorceries,
+and for the great abundance of thine
+enchantments.”</span> These could not save, as
+they supposed. Therefore God said to them:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Stand now with thine enchantments, and
+with the multitude of thy sorceries, wherein
+thou hast labored from thy youth; if so be
+thou shalt be able to profit, if so be thou
+mayest prevail. Thou art wearied in the
+multitude of thy counsels. Let now the astrologers,
+the star-gazers, the monthly prognosticators,
+stand up, and save thee from these
+things that shall come upon thee,”</span> Isa. 47:12, 13.
+All these practices were forbidden by
+God, who said: <span class="tei tei-q">“Neither shall ye use enchantments,
+nor observe times,”</span> Lev. 19:26.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those who consulted with familiar spirits
+were termed wizards and witches,—the practice
+of which was also expressly forbidden.
+To make witchcraft a mere pretence, is to
+impute to Jehovah the making of laws against
+pretences and nonentities. To suppose that
+he would legislate against, and inflict capital
+punishment, because of mere pretences, is incredible!
+God said to Moses, <span class="tei tei-q">“Thou shalt
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page269">[pg 269]</span><a name="Pg269" id="Pg269" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+not suffer a witch to live,”</span> Ex. 22:18. And
+to the Jews he said, <span class="tei tei-q">“Regard not them that
+have familiar spirits, neither seek after wizards,
+to be defiled by them: I am the Lord
+your God,”</span> Lev. 19:31. <span class="tei tei-q">“And the soul that
+turneth after such as have familiar spirits,
+and after wizards, to go a whoring after them,
+I will even set my face against that soul, and
+will cut him off from among his people.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“A
+man, also, or a woman, that hath a familiar
+spirit, or that is a wizard, shall surely be put
+to death: they shall stone them with stones:
+their blood shall be upon them,”</span> Lev. 20:6,27.
+When Egypt was to be destroyed, they were
+left to <span class="tei tei-q">“seek to the idols, and to charmers,
+and to them that have familiar spirits, and to
+wizards,”</span> Isa. 19:3.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The manner in which the familiar spirit
+spoke, was by <span class="tei tei-q">“peeping,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“muttering,”</span> whispering
+out of the dust, &amp;c. God said to Ariel,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And thou shalt be brought down, and shalt
+speak out of the ground, and thy speech shall
+be low out of the dust, and thy voice shall be
+as of one that hath a familiar spirit, out of the
+ground, and thy speech shall whisper out of
+the dust,”</span> Isa. 29:4. <span class="tei tei-q">“And when they shall
+say unto you, Seek unto them that have familiar
+spirits, and unto wizards that peep, and
+that mutter: (should not a people seek unto
+their God? for the living to the dead!) to the
+law and to the testimony: if they speak not
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page270">[pg 270]</span><a name="Pg270" id="Pg270" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+according to this word, it is because there is
+no light in them,”</span> Isa. 8:19, 20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Saul had put away those that had familiar
+spirits, and the wizards, out of the land; but
+when he <span class="tei tei-q">“inquired of the Lord, the Lord
+answered him not, neither by dreams, nor by
+Urim, nor by prophets. Then said Saul unto
+his servants, Seek a woman that hath a familiar
+spirit, that I may go to her, and inquire
+of her. And his servants said to him, Behold,
+there is a woman that hath a familiar
+spirit at En-dor. And Saul disguised himself,
+and put on other raiment, and he went, and
+two men with him, and they came to the
+woman by night: and he said, I pray thee
+divine unto me by the familiar spirit, and
+bring me him up whom I shall name unto
+thee. And the woman said unto him, Behold,
+thou knowest what Saul hath done, how he
+hath cut off those that have familiar spirits,
+and the wizards out of the land; wherefore,
+then, layest thou a snare for my life, to cause
+me to die? And Saul sware unto her by the
+Lord, saying, As the Lord liveth, there shall
+no punishment happen to thee for this thing.
+Then said the woman, Whom shall I bring
+up to thee? And he said, Bring me up Samuel.
+And when the woman saw Samuel she
+cried with a loud voice: and the woman
+spake to Saul, saying, Why hast thou deceived
+me? for thou art Saul. And the king
+said unto her, Be not afraid: for what sawest
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page271">[pg 271]</span><a name="Pg271" id="Pg271" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+thou? And the woman said unto Saul, I saw
+gods ascending out of the earth. And he said
+unto her, What form is he of? And she said,
+An old man cometh up; and he is covered
+with a mantle. And Saul perceived that it
+was Samuel, and he stooped with his face to
+the ground, and bowed himself. And Samuel
+said to Saul, Why hast thou disquieted me,
+to bring me up? And Saul answered, I am
+sore distressed; for the Philistines make war
+against me, and God is departed from me, and
+answereth me no more, neither by prophets,
+nor by dreams: therefore I have called thee,
+that thou mayest make known unto me what
+I shall do. Then said Samuel, Wherefore
+then dost thou ask of me, seeing the Lord
+is departed from thee, and is become thine
+enemy? And the Lord hath done to him, as
+he spake by me: for the Lord hath rent the
+kingdom out of thine hand, and given it to
+thy neighbor, even to David: because thou
+obeyedst not the voice of the Lord, nor executedest
+his fierce wrath upon Amelek, therefore
+hath the Lord done this thing unto thee this
+day. Moreover, the Lord will also deliver
+Israel with thee into the hand of the Philistines:
+and to-morrow shalt thou and thy sons
+be with me: the Lord also shall deliver the
+host of Israel into the hand of the Philistines.
+Then Saul fell straightway all along on the
+earth, and was sore afraid, because of the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page272">[pg 272]</span><a name="Pg272" id="Pg272" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+words of Samuel: and there was no strength
+in him,”</span> 1 Sam. 28:6-20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Micaiah <span class="tei tei-q">“saw the Lord sitting on his
+throne, and all the host of heaven standing by
+him on his right hand and on his left. And
+the Lord said, Who shall persuade Ahab, that
+he may go up and fall at Ramoth-gilead?
+And one said on this manner, and another
+said on that manner. And there came forth
+a spirit, and stood before the Lord, and said,
+I will persuade him. And the Lord said unto
+him, Wherewith? And he said, I will go
+forth, and I will be a lying spirit in the mouth
+of all his prophets. And he said, Thou shalt
+persuade him, and prevail also: go forth, and
+do so. Now therefore, behold, the Lord hath
+put a lying spirit in the mouth of all these thy
+prophets, and the Lord hath spoken evil concerning
+thee,”</span> 1 Kings 22:19-23.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+When Paul was in the house of Lydia, he
+says, <span class="tei tei-q">“It came to pass, as we went to prayer,
+a certain damsel possessed with a spirit of
+divination, met us, which brought her masters
+much gain by her soothsaying: the same followed
+Paul and us, and cried, saying, These
+men are the servants of the most high God,
+which show unto us the way of salvation.
+And this she did many days. But Paul,
+being grieved, turned and said to the spirit, I
+command thee in the name of Jesus Christ to
+come out of her. And he came out the same
+hour,”</span> Acts 16:16-18.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page273">[pg 273]</span><a name="Pg273" id="Pg273" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+By sorcery, enchantment, &amp;c., they performed
+wonders, or <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">miracles</span></span>, either real or
+pretended. <span class="tei tei-q">“There was a certain man called
+Simon, which beforetime in the same city
+used sorcery, and bewitched the people of
+Samaria, giving out that himself was some
+great one: to whom they all gave heed, from
+the least to the greatest, saying, This man is
+the great power of God. And to him they
+had regard, because that of long time he had
+bewitched them with sorceries,”</span> Acts 8:9-11.
+When <span class="tei tei-q">“Aaron cast down his rod before Pharaoh,
+and before his servants, and it became
+a serpent, then Pharaoh also called the wise
+men, and the sorcerers: now the magicians
+of Egypt they also did in like manner with
+their enchantments. For they cast down
+every man his rod, and they became serpents:
+but Aaron's rod swallowed up their rods,”</span>
+Ex. 7:10-12. When Aaron turned the
+water of the river to blood, <span class="tei tei-q">“the magicians
+did so with their enchantments,”</span> v. 22. In
+like manner they <span class="tei tei-q">“brought up frogs upon the
+land of Egypt,”</span> 8:7. But when Aaron
+changed the dust to lice, the magicians attempted
+the same with their enchantments,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“but they could not,”</span> Ex. 8:18. These sorcerers
+who withstood Moses, we learn by
+Paul, were <span class="tei tei-q">“Jannes and Jambres,”</span> 2 Tim.
+3:8. They belonged to an ancient profession
+in Egypt; for, when Pharaoh dreamed his
+dreams, he first <span class="tei tei-q">“sent and called for all the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page274">[pg 274]</span><a name="Pg274" id="Pg274" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+magicians of Egypt, and all the wise men
+thereof: and Pharaoh told them his dreams;
+but there was none that could interpret them
+unto Pharaoh,”</span> Gen. 41:8. In like manner
+Nebuchadnezzar <span class="tei tei-q">“commanded to call the
+magicians, and the astrologers, and the sorcerers,
+and the Chaldeans, for to show the
+king his dreams. So they came, and stood
+before the king,”</span> Dan. 2:2.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These things were practised to some extent
+in Judah, but were all put away by Josiah.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Moreover, the workers with familiar spirits,
+and the wizards, and the images, and the
+idols, and all the abominations that were spied
+in the land of Judah and in Jerusalem, did
+Josiah put away, that he might perform the
+words of the law which were written in the
+book that Hilkiah the priest found in the
+house of the Lord,”</span> 2 Kings 23:24.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The acts and influences of demoniacal
+agencies are apparent from the foregoing; and
+the symbolization under the sixth seal, seems
+to indicate a revival of those teachings and
+manifestations at the present time. Within a
+few years, the curiosity of the community has
+been excited, and large numbers of persons
+greatly interested, in various phenomena,
+known as Mesmerism, Animal-Magnetism,
+Clairvoyance, Pathetism, Neurology, Psychology,
+Biology, Electro-Biology, &amp;c. &amp;c. Similar
+manifestations have been before exhibited,
+but not in modern times to the extent now
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page275">[pg 275]</span><a name="Pg275" id="Pg275" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+witnessed. These were regarded as harmless
+phenomena and independent of any supernatural
+agency, till audible sounds were heard
+communicating intelligible responses. Then
+the claim was set up that these are caused by
+departed spirits.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These sounds were first heard near Rochester,
+New York, in 1847; and, at the present
+time (1852), they are affirmed to exist in
+hundreds of places in this country, and other
+sections of the globe. They are audible raps,
+the cause of which, aside from the hypothesis
+of spiritual agency, has never been satisfactorily
+accounted for. By these raps, unimpeached
+and credible witnesses testify that
+correct answers have been given to questions,
+the facts respecting which were known to no
+one at the time of answering. Since then,
+furniture has been seen to move about the
+room, and other <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">wonders</span></span>, or miracles, been
+performed, by invisible agency, at the command
+of mediums to attending spirits,—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>
+to <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span>. Mediums have written on paper,
+as they profess, involuntarily, lengthy communications,
+in poetry and prose, the subjects
+of which they claim to have been ignorant of,
+while the pen they held was moved independent
+of their own will. These exhibitions have
+been attested by hundreds of credible witnesses.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+By such manifestations large numbers of
+persons have given their adherence to these
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page276">[pg 276]</span><a name="Pg276" id="Pg276" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+real or pretended agencies as truthful and
+reliable intelligences; whose responses they
+receive with the same credence that we do the
+revelations of scripture. <span class="tei tei-q">“Circles”</span> are extensively
+formed, who have sittings, at stated
+times, to receive communications from the
+spirits of the departed; and these are enforced
+by miracles, audible sounds, the exercise of
+physical power, &amp;c.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The reality and the credibility of these
+agencies are separate questions. Their reality
+is shown by their identity with similar manifestations
+of former times. The Bible affirms
+the existence of such: <span class="tei tei-q">“For we wrestle not
+against flesh and blood, but against principalities,
+against powers, against the rulers of the
+darkness of this world, against spiritual wickedness
+in high places;”</span> or <span class="tei tei-q">“wicked spirits”</span>
+in <span class="tei tei-q">“heavenly places,”</span> as the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">margin</span></span> reads,
+Eph. 6:12.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+1. The familiar spirits of old responded in
+a manner similar to these. They did <span class="tei tei-q">“peep”</span>
+and <span class="tei tei-q">“mutter;”</span> their speech was low out of
+the dust; they spoke out of the ground, and
+whispered; or, as in the margin, did <span class="tei tei-q">“peep”</span>
+or <span class="tei tei-q">“chirp”</span> out of the dust. These <span class="tei tei-q">“rap”</span>
+and mutter. They respond from beneath
+chairs, tables and floors.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+2. They exercised similar physical powers.
+They threw down and tare the persons they
+possessed. They turned the swine into the
+sea, &amp;c. These claim that chairs and tables,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page277">[pg 277]</span><a name="Pg277" id="Pg277" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+are lifted and moved at will by an invisible
+agency.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+3. They made similar pretensions to credibility.
+Simon Magus gave out <span class="tei tei-q">“that himself
+was some great one;”</span> and these, that they
+utter divine truths.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+4. Similar regard was bestowed on those,
+which is claimed for these. To Simon <span class="tei tei-q">“they
+all gave heed, from the least to the greatest,
+saying, This man is the great power of God.”</span>
+Yet <span class="tei tei-q">“he had bewitched them with sorceries.”</span>
+Similar claims by, and regard for these modern
+pretenders to the same art, do not relieve
+them from the suspicion of a like agency.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For such are false apostles, deceitful workers,
+transforming themselves into the apostles
+of Christ. And no marvel; for Satan himself
+is transformed into an angel of light. Therefore,
+it is no great thing if his <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">ministers</span></span> also
+be transformed as the ministers of righteousness:
+whose end shall be according to their
+works,”</span> 2 Cor. 11:13-15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+5. Both have given utterance to some truths.
+The legion of demons who were cast out of
+the man into a herd of swine, acknowledged
+Jesus to be <span class="tei tei-q">“the Son of the Most High God;”</span>
+and the pythonic spirit which so grieved Paul,
+declared the apostles to be <span class="tei tei-q">“the servants of
+the Most High God, which show unto us the
+way of salvation.”</span> Such communications
+with the invisible world being forbidden, their
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">credibility</span></em> is disproved.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page278">[pg 278]</span><a name="Pg278" id="Pg278" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They claim that spirits of the departed
+are brought into direct and intelligent communication
+with the living, who desire to
+interrogate them. What more was claimed
+by the necromancers of old? Said Saul to
+the woman of Endor: <span class="tei tei-q">“Divine unto me by
+the familiar spirit, and bring me him up
+whom I shall name unto thee,”</span> 1 Sam. 28:8.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They claim that not all, but only those
+persons are mediums who are peculiarly susceptible
+to spiritual influences. Wherein,
+then, admitting their claims, do the <span class="tei tei-q">“mediums”</span>
+differ from those of old, who divined
+by a familiar spirit?
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their responses are frequently disproved by
+facts; and themselves admit the existence of
+unreliable spirits, which communicate like
+them. They give contradictory responses,
+and mutually criminate each other; but their
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">reality</span></em> is not disproved by any discrepancy,
+or want of truthfulness in their responses; for
+if they are spirits, none but unclean spirits
+would respond in a forbidden manner.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These spirits are to be discredited, because
+they preach a different gospel from that
+preached by Paul, who says: <span class="tei tei-q">“I marvel that
+ye are so soon removed from him that called
+you into the grace of Christ, unto another
+gospel: which is not another; but there be
+some that trouble you, and would pervert the
+gospel of Christ. But though we, or an angel
+from heaven, preach any other gospel unto
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page279">[pg 279]</span><a name="Pg279" id="Pg279" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+you than that ye have received, let him be
+accursed,”</span> Gal. 1:6-9. <span class="tei tei-q">“If any man love
+not the Lord Jesus Christ, let him be Anathema,
+Maran-atha.”</span> 1 Cor. 16:22. Said John,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Beloved, believe not every spirit, but try the
+spirits whether they are of God: because
+many false prophets are gone out into the
+world,”</span> 1 John 4:1. Also Isaiah said, <span class="tei tei-q">“And
+when they shall say unto you, Seek unto them
+that have familiar spirits, and unto wizards
+that peep, and that mutter: should not a
+people seek unto their God?
+To the law and to the testimony:
+if they speak not according to this word, it
+is because there is no light in them,”</span> Isa. 8:19, 20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Because of these practices, the nations were
+driven out from before the children of Israel.
+And with the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">miracles</span></span> to be wrought, the
+frog-like spirits are to go forth to <span class="tei tei-q">“the whole
+world to gather them to the battle of that
+great day of God Almighty.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In the time of Abraham, <span class="tei tei-q">“the iniquity of
+the Amorites was not yet full,”</span> (Gen. 15:16);
+but in four hundred years they had practised
+all the abominations for which they were to
+be destroyed, and the practice of which God
+has expressly forbidden. He said to Israel, in
+the wilderness, <span class="tei tei-q">“When thou art come into
+the land which the Lord thy God giveth thee,
+thou shalt not learn to do after the abominations
+of those nation. There shall not be
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page280">[pg 280]</span><a name="Pg280" id="Pg280" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+found among you any one that maketh his
+son or his daughter to pass through the fire,
+or that useth divination, or an observer of
+times, or an enchanter, or a witch, or a
+charmer, or a consulter with familiar spirits,
+or a wizard, or a necromancer. For all that
+do these things are an abomination unto the
+Lord: and because of these abominations the
+Lord thy God doth drive them out from before
+thee. Thou shalt be perfect with the Lord
+thy God. For these nations, which thou
+shalt possess, hearkened unto observers of
+times, and unto diviners: but as for thee, the
+Lord thy God hath not suffered thee so to do,”</span>
+Deut. 18:9-14.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Similar pernicious practices and dangerous
+heresies, are to prepare the way for the final
+destruction of the nations who reject the claims
+of Jehovah. Peter declares that <span class="tei tei-q">“there shall
+be false teachers among you, who privily shall
+bring in damnable heresies, even denying the
+Lord that bought them, and bring upon themselves
+swift destruction. And many shall follow
+their pernicious ways; by reason of whom
+the way of truth shall be evil spoken of. And
+through covetousness shall they with feigned
+words make merchandise of you: whose
+judgment now of a long time lingereth not,
+and their damnation slumbereth not,”</span> 2 Pet.
+2:1-3. And Paul says of that wicked:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Whose coming is after the working of Satan,
+with all power, and signs, and lying wonders,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page281">[pg 281]</span><a name="Pg281" id="Pg281" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and with all deceivableness of unrighteousness
+in them that perish; because they received
+not the love of the truth, that they might be
+saved. And for this cause God shall send
+them strong delusion, that they should believe
+a lie: that they might be damned who believed
+not the truth, but had pleasure in
+unrighteousness,”</span> 2 Thess. 2:9-12.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The battle of that great day of God Almighty,”</span>
+it would seem, must commence by
+a conflict of opinions. Mind will war with
+mind, and puny man will stoutly contend
+against the truths of the Almighty. In this
+revival of demon-worship, the old gods of the
+heathen are to be set up against the claims of
+Jehovah. His declarations are to be made to
+give place to <span class="tei tei-q">“doctrines of demons.”</span> The
+teachings of God and of these spirits are to be
+brought into direct conflict.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The followers of the spirits have baptized
+their new theological dogmas, <span class="tei tei-q">“The Harmonial
+Philosophy,”</span> of which <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Reason</span></em> is the
+final umpire. Revelation no longer speaks to
+them in tones of authority. From the Bible,
+it is claimed, <span class="tei tei-q">“the seal of infallibility must be
+broken away, before a new light and beauty
+can enliven and embellish the mystical disclosures
+of any seer, prophet, or evangelist.”</span>
+So writes Andrew Jackson Davis, the Poughkeepsie
+seer, one of the leaders of this new
+school, who complains that <span class="tei tei-q">“owing to the
+dogmatism of infallibility, the Bible is taught
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page282">[pg 282]</span><a name="Pg282" id="Pg282" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+now-a-days as it was nearly four centuries
+ago.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Review of Dr. Bushnell</span></span>, p. 10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Scriptures are, with those of his faith,
+only <span class="tei tei-q">“the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">paper and ink</span></em> relics of Christianity,”</span>
+(<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>, p. 21); which they regard as <span class="tei tei-q">“a
+foundation as impermanent as the changeful
+sand”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 24), and not adapted <span class="tei tei-q">“to the
+wants or requirements of the nineteenth century,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 26. They reject Him, whom they
+style <span class="tei tei-q">“the cruel and capricious God generally
+worshipped by the Bible Christians,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 47.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Jewish God,”</span> says Davis, <span class="tei tei-q">“is cruel,
+capricious and tyrannical,”</span> whose <span class="tei tei-q">“kingdom
+is more despotic, and more contracted in principle,
+than the present government of the
+Russian empire,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 61. He adds, <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+Old Testament idea of a Deity is the outgrowth
+of the despotic stage of human mental
+development,”</span> and <span class="tei tei-q">“a superannuated monotheistic
+conception,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 62. In their opinion,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the developments of republicanism, and
+of mental happiness among men, depend very
+much upon the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">absence</span></em> of these dogmatical
+compilations, or fossil relics, of an old Hebrew
+and Chaldean theology,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 70. With
+them <span class="tei tei-q">“the Bible account of creation is a very
+interesting <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">myth</span></span>,—mainly a plagiarism from
+the early traditions and cosmological doctrines
+of the ancient Persians and Chaldeans;”</span> and,
+instead of being <span class="tei tei-q">“a divine revelation of truth,”</span>
+is <span class="tei tei-q">“a pagan relic, which should no more command
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page283">[pg 283]</span><a name="Pg283" id="Pg283" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+serious respect than the ancient doctrines
+of Fetichism,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 90.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These <span class="tei tei-q">“Harmonial Philosophers”</span> are antagonistic
+to the teachings of Jehovah in
+nearly all their theological notions. They
+scout the idea that any actual evil exists in
+the universe. They deny the existence of the
+devil, and of evil spirits. <span class="tei tei-q">“Everything,”</span>
+says Davis, <span class="tei tei-q">“is forever progressing in goodness
+and perfection,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 180. The salvation
+of all men, is with them as certain as the
+operation of fixed laws. They recognize no
+Saviour and no atonement in their system of
+faith. The teachings of spirits, and <span class="tei tei-q">“a certain
+organization of labor, capital and talent,”</span> they
+fancy, <span class="tei tei-q">“will effect the desired cure”</span> for all
+actual or supposed ills, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 178. They recognize
+no responsibility in the sinner, but attribute
+his wrong-doings to ignorance and accident;
+and their laws of right, are the dictates
+of their own wisdom.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their system is essentially Pantheistic, all
+things being regarded by them as a part and
+parcel of Deity. They argue that <span class="tei tei-q">“every
+object which has an existence in the universe
+must be in its nature good and pure, on the
+principle that the effect must partake of the
+nature of the cause, and the stream must be
+the corresponding emanation of the fountain
+from which it flows.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Elements of Spiritual
+Philosophy</span></span>, p. 55. They teach that human
+spirits are <span class="tei tei-q">“formed primarily from the animating
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page284">[pg 284]</span><a name="Pg284" id="Pg284" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+essences that pervade the creation,—which
+essences,”</span> they say, <span class="tei tei-q">“are the breath
+and presence of the Divinity;”</span> and hence
+they argue, <span class="tei tei-q">“that there are no spirits which
+are intrinsically evil in their nature, and
+none which do not present in their inward
+depths the reflection of divine purity,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 56.
+Going still further, they claim that there is no
+existing <span class="tei tei-q">“source of positive evil,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“no principle
+of this nature in the human spirit,”</span> and
+that consequently <span class="tei tei-q">“there can be no evil designs
+to emanate from such a source,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 60.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These assertions are put forth authoritatively;
+for the <span class="tei tei-q">“Elements of Spiritual Philosophy”</span>
+are attested by witnesses to be <span class="tei tei-q">“written
+by Spirits of the Sixth Circle, R. P.
+Ambler, Medium.”</span> And if they are met by
+the declarations written by those who spake
+as they were moved by the Holy Ghost, they
+reply: <span class="tei tei-q">“The Christian who deifies his Bible is
+as much an idolater as the heathen who burns
+his incense before his household image. It is
+surely attributing to the book what the Pagan
+attributes to his image.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Shekinah, April
+No.</span></span>, p. 251. Christianity, they denominate,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“learned scepticism, baptized in the name of
+Jesus,”</span> &amp;c., <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>, p. 301. Thus are they warring
+against the word of God, and placing
+themselves in direct conflict with the Almighty.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This warfare is not only avowed to be
+against the God of the Bible, but is recognized
+by themselves as <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the last great conflict
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page285">[pg 285]</span><a name="Pg285" id="Pg285" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-style: italic">
+previous to the millennium</span></em>. They regard this
+subject as <span class="tei tei-q">“the great question of the age,
+which is destined to convulse and divide
+Protestantism, and around which all other
+religious controversies must necessarily revolve.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Davis'
+Review of Bushnell</span></span>, page 3.
+The millennium which is to be thus ushered
+in, they regard as a period when <span class="tei tei-q">“every one
+that desires will be able to hold direct intercourse
+and conversation with the spirit
+world.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Spiritual Tel., Vol. 1, No. 1.</span></span> Says
+Davis: <span class="tei tei-q">“The thunders of a stupendous reformation
+are soon to issue from the now open
+mouth of the Protestant church. The supernatural
+faith,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> a belief in the authenticity
+of Scripture, <span class="tei tei-q">“will be shaken, as a reed in
+the tempest. New channels will be formed
+for the inflowing of new truths, and then a
+long-promised era will steal upon the religious
+and political world.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Review of Bushnell</span></span>,
+p. 187.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In another place he says: <span class="tei tei-q">“You may be
+assured of the truth of this <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">approaching
+crisis</span></em>. The world must recognize it, because
+it will be accompanied with <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">war</span></em>; for politics
+are inseparably connected, all over the world,
+with religious systems. Religion will develop
+reason; but politics will impel the masses to
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">unsheath the sword, and to stain the bosom of
+Nature with blood</span></em>! Friends of progress! be
+not discouraged; for the FINAL CRISIS
+must come; <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">then the strange interregnum</span></em>,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page286">[pg 286]</span><a name="Pg286" id="Pg286" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 217. <span class="tei tei-q">“Protestantism as now constructed
+will first decay; because it is to be divided
+into two,—the smallest party will go back
+into Catholicism; the other will go forward
+into Rationalism. And then, after a succession
+of eventful years, a political revolution
+will hurl the Catholic superstructure to the
+earth, and the prismatic bow of promise will
+span the heavens. The children of earth will
+then be comparatively free and happy! for the
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">millennial</span></em> epoch will have arrived; and there
+will be something like a realization of peace on
+earth, and good will toward all men!”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> p. 221.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Such are their delusive hopes, while setting
+themselves against the Lord, and against his
+Anointed. The Bible teaches that multitudes
+will be deceived by them, and, if it were possible,
+some of the elect; and hence:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Admonition.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Behold, I come like a thief. Happy is he who watcheth,
+and keepeth his garments, lest he walk naked, and
+they see his shame.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:15.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The day of the Lord will come as a thief
+in the night; in which the heavens shall pass
+away with a great noise, and the elements
+shall melt with fervent heat,”</span> 2 Pet. 3:10.
+The Saviour said to his disciples: <span class="tei tei-q">“Watch,
+therefore; for ye know not what hour your
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page287">[pg 287]</span><a name="Pg287" id="Pg287" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Lord doth come,”</span> Matt. 24:42. Says Paul:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Yourselves know perfectly that the day of
+the Lord so cometh as a thief in the night;
+for when they shall say, peace and safety,
+then sudden destruction cometh, ... and they
+shall not escape; but ye, brethren, are not in
+darkness that that day should overtake you
+as a thief,”</span> 1 Thess. 5:1-6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Thus will the day of the Lord come, as a
+thief, on those who are careless and indifferent
+to its approach; but it will not thus overtake
+those who watch, and keep their garments.
+Because so many will be deceived by the
+strange performances of the spirits of demons,
+and their miracles so delude the multitude,
+Christ's coming will be to them sudden and
+unexpected. Therefore the greater necessity
+for watchfulness. While this is a predicted
+means for lulling the world to sleep, it is
+given to the Christian as an indication of the
+near coming of Christ, whose advent synchronizes
+with the outpouring of the seventh
+vial. The blessing pronounced on those who
+watch, is an intimation that the people of
+God will be expecting Christ's advent, while
+others will be taken by surprise: <span class="tei tei-q">“unto them
+that look for him shall he appear the second
+time without sin unto salvation,”</span> Heb. 9:28.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For the grace of God that bringeth salvation
+hath appeared to all men, teaching us,
+that denying ungodliness, and worldly lusts,
+we should live soberly, righteously, and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page288">[pg 288]</span><a name="Pg288" id="Pg288" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+godly, in this present world; looking for that
+blessed hope, and the glorious appearing of
+the great God, and our Saviour Jesus Christ,”</span>
+Titus 2:11-13.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those who keep their garments, are those
+who have not <span class="tei tei-q">“defiled”</span> them with sin, (3:4);
+they will walk with Christ in white, being
+worthy; <span class="tei tei-q">“for the fine linen”</span> in which they
+are to be arrayed <span class="tei tei-q">“is the righteousness of
+saints,”</span> 19:8. To be destitute of this, is to
+be unclothed; and hence the Saviour says: <span class="tei tei-q">“I
+counsel thee to buy of me ... white raiment,
+that thou mayest be clothed, and that the
+shame of thy nakedness do not appear,”</span> 3:18.
+The intimation is clear, that to be deceived
+by the unclean spirits, is to lose those
+robes of righteousness, and to be found naked
+at Christ's appearing.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Success of the Spirits.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And they gathered them into a place called in Hebrew
+Armageddon.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:16.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Before the coming of the Lord, and as a
+preparation for that event, the nations are to
+be thus gathered. Armageddon is the name
+of a valley at the foot of Mount Megiddo,
+famous for its bloody slaughters. It fitly
+symbolizes the final gathering of the nations.
+The enemies of God will marshal for the final
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page289">[pg 289]</span><a name="Pg289" id="Pg289" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+conflict. The powers of darkness will fancy
+themselves on the verge of victory; and then
+will be poured out:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Seventh Vial.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the seventh poured out his bowl on the air; and
+there came a loud voice from the temple [of heaven], from
+the throne, saying, It is done! And there were lightnings,
+and voices, and thunders; and there was a great earthquake,
+such as was not since men were on the earth, so
+mighty and so great an earthquake. And the great city
+became three parts, and the cities of the nations fell: and
+great Babylon was remembered before God, to give to her
+the cup of the wine of his furious wrath. And every island
+fled, and the mountains were no more. And vast hail,
+weighing a talent, fell from heaven on men; and men
+reviled God because of the plague of the hail; for the plague
+thereof was exceedingly great.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 16:17-21.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The atmosphere is not limited, like a river,
+or portion of the earth, to a given locality, but
+encircles the globe. Consequently the effect
+of the vial poured out on the air, would be
+universal, and not local like the effects of the
+previous vials. The air is the region of
+storms. These symbolize the expression of
+conflicting opinions, and violent outbursts
+of passion; which may be the commencement
+of that <span class="tei tei-q">“great battle,”</span> for the preparation of
+which the unclean spirits went forth under
+the sixth vial, to gather the people, and which
+terminates by the slaying of the remnant with
+the sword of the Lord, 19:21.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page290">[pg 290]</span><a name="Pg290" id="Pg290" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+An earthquake is a symbol of a political
+revolution. As this is to be greater than all
+preceding ones, it must extend to all nations.
+It is during the earthquake, that the cities fall
+and the mountains and islands flee away.
+This commotion evidently synchronizes with
+the <span class="tei tei-q">“time of trouble, such as never was since
+there was a nation even to that same time,”</span>
+when God's <span class="tei tei-q">“people shall be delivered, every
+one that shall be found written in the book,”</span>
+Dan. 12:1.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“It is done,”</span> is a declaration indicating the
+completion of the work symbolized. It marks
+the termination of the events of the seventh
+vial, which are described in the verses following:
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The great city”</span> is <span class="tei tei-q">“Babylon,”</span> (14:8);
+which <span class="tei tei-q">“reigneth over the kings of the earth,”</span>
+(17:8); and which John had seen sitting
+<span class="tei tei-q">“upon many waters,”</span> 17:1. This was
+doubtless seen when he saw the waters of the
+symbolic Euphrates being dried up, 16:12.
+Babylon, being a symbol of the Roman hierarchy,
+its triple division indicates a like
+division of the church of Rome, not geographical,
+but under different leaders, previous to
+its destruction.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The cities of the nations,”</span> must symbolize
+other hierarchies, analogous to that of
+Rome, of which there are the Greek church,
+in Russia and Greece, the Arminian and
+Syrian churches, and other corrupt nationalized
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page291">[pg 291]</span><a name="Pg291" id="Pg291" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+establishments. All such will become
+disconnected, like Babylon, with the governments
+by which they are sustained.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Great Babylon”</span> then comes into remembrance
+to drink the cup of the wine of the
+fierceness of God's wrath. Because her sins
+have reached unto heaven, <span class="tei tei-q">“God hath remembered
+her iniquities,”</span> 18:5. This synchronizes
+with her destruction, symbolized in Rev.
+18:8-23. As the Papacy continues till
+Christ's coming (Dan. 7:21, and 2 Thess.
+2:3-8), this epoch must synchronize with
+that event, when he comes to receive his
+chosen ones.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With the destruction of Babylon, occurs
+the subversion of all national authority. As
+ecclesiastical hierarchies are symbolized by
+cities, the <span class="tei tei-q">“mountains”</span> and <span class="tei tei-q">“islands”</span> on
+which they are situated must symbolize the
+larger and smaller governments; and their
+removal from their places, their subversion in
+the great moral <span class="tei tei-q">“earthquake”</span> which is to
+overwhelm them. This synchronizes with
+the sixth seal, when they are all <span class="tei tei-q">“removed
+out of their places,”</span> (6:14); and it leaves
+the inhabitants of earth in a state of anarchy.
+It is at this time that the kings and great men
+of the earth become aware that the great day
+of God's wrath is come, 6:15-17. With
+this time of trouble, comes the deliverance of
+God's people, (Dan. 12:1); who shall be
+caught up together <span class="tei tei-q">“to meet the Lord in the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page292">[pg 292]</span><a name="Pg292" id="Pg292" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+air,”</span> 1 Thess. 4:17. To them the Lord has
+said, <span class="tei tei-q">“Thou shalt not be afraid for the terror
+by night; nor for the arrow that flieth by
+day; nor for the pestilence that walketh in
+darkness; nor for the destruction that wasteth
+at noon-day. A thousand shall fall at thy
+side, and ten thousand at thy right hand; but
+it shall not come nigh thee. Only with thine
+eyes shalt thou behold and see the reward of
+the wicked. Because thou hast made the
+Lord which is my refuge, even the Most High,
+thy habitation,”</span> Ps. 91:5-9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The removal of the saints leaves the
+wicked exposed to the vengeance of God's
+wrath, of which a terrific hail-storm on their
+defenceless heads, is an expressive symbol.
+The Lord said, by Isaiah: <span class="tei tei-q">“Judgment also
+will I lay to the line, and righteousness to the
+plummet: and the hail shall sweep away the
+refuge of lies, and the waters shall overflow
+the hiding-place. And your covenant with
+death shall be disannulled, and your agreement
+with hell shall not stand; when the
+overflowing scourge shall pass through, then
+ye shall be trodden down by it. From the
+time that it goeth forth it shall take you: for
+morning by morning shall it pass over, by day
+and by night: and it shall be a vexation only
+to understand the report. For the bed is
+shorter than that a man can stretch himself
+on it: and the covering narrower than that
+he can wrap himself in it. For the Lord
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page293">[pg 293]</span><a name="Pg293" id="Pg293" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+shall rise up as in Mount Perazim, he shall be
+wroth as in the valley of Gibeon, that he may
+do his work, his strange work; and bring to
+pass his act, his strange act. Now therefore
+be ye not mockers, lest your bands be made
+strong: for I have heard from the Lord God
+of hosts a consumption even determined upon
+the whole earth,”</span> Isa. 28:17-22.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This must synchronize with the final conflict,
+(symbolized in Rev. 19:19-21): also
+with the casting of the vine of the earth into
+the wine-press of God's wrath (14:19),
+and terminates the battle of <span class="tei tei-q">“Armageddon,”</span>—the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“battle of that great day of God
+Almighty,”</span> 16:14.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Judgment of the Harlot.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And one of the seven angels, who had the seven bowls,
+came and talked with me, saying, Come here; I will show
+thee the judgment of the great harlot who sitteth on many
+waters; with whom the kings of the earth have committed
+fornication, and the inhabitants of the earth have been
+made drunk with the wine of her fornication.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 17:1,
+2.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Roman hierarchy had been frequently
+referred to in the preceding visions; but an
+institution, so interwoven with the history of
+the nations, required a more full and minute
+symbolization.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page294">[pg 294]</span><a name="Pg294" id="Pg294" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The subject of this vision is announced to
+the revelator, by one of the angels who had
+the seven vials;—very probably, the seventh.
+The harlot is identified as one <span class="tei tei-q">“that sitteth
+upon many waters.”</span> Ancient Babylon was
+thus addressed: <span class="tei tei-q">“O thou that dwellest upon
+many waters, abundant in treasures, thine
+end is come, and the measure of thy covetousness,”</span>
+Jer. 51:13. She is also described
+as <span class="tei tei-q">“The well-favored <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">harlot</span></em>, the mistress
+of witchcrafts, that selleth nations through
+her whoredoms, and families through her
+witchcrafts,”</span> Nahum 3:4. Therefore the
+harlot whose judgment is to be more minutely
+shown, is the city of the previous vision,
+which received the cup of the wine of God's
+wrath (16:19), and which probably was
+shown to John on the waters of the Euphrates,
+(16:12); for the reference indicates that
+she had been thus previously exhibited,—the
+waters on which she was seated, being the
+people, nations, &amp;c., which sustained and
+defended her idolatries, 17:15. In the vision
+now to be shown John, the Roman hierarchy
+is symbolized by Babylon; but it is first
+exhibited as:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">A Woman on a Scarlet-Colored Beast.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And he carried me away in spirit into a desert: and I
+saw a woman seated on a crimson-colored wild beast, full
+of names of reviling, having seven heads and ten horns.
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page295">[pg 295]</span><a name="Pg295" id="Pg295" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+And the woman was arrayed in purple and crimson, and
+decked with gold and precious stones and pearls, having a
+golden cup in her hand full of abominations and the impurities
+of her fornication; and on her forehead a name was
+written, A SECRET: BABYLON, THE GREAT, THE
+MOTHER OF THE HARLOTS AND THE ABOMINATIONS
+OF THE EARTH. And I saw the woman drunken
+with the blood of the saints, and with the blood of the witnesses
+of Jesus; and when I saw her I wondered greatly.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">
+Rev. 17:3-6.
+</span></div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the angel said to me, Why dost thou wonder? I
+will tell thee the secret of the woman, and of the wild beast
+that carrieth her, which hath the seven heads and the ten
+horns. The wild beast which thou didst see, was, and is
+not, and will ascend out of the abyss, and go into destruction;
+and those who dwell on the earth will wonder, (whose
+names were not written in the book of life from the foundation
+of the world,) as they behold the wild beast that was
+and is not, and will be. And here is the mind having wisdom.
+The seven heads are seven mountains, on which the woman
+sitteth, and they are seven kings: five are fallen, and one
+is and the other is not yet come; and when he cometh he
+must remain a little while. And the wild beast that was,
+and is not, even he is the eighth, and is of the seven, and
+goeth into destruction. And the ten horns which thou
+didst see are ten kings, who have not yet received a kingdom;
+but they receive power as kings, one hour, with the
+wild beast. These have one mind, and will give their power
+and strength to the wild beast. These will make war with
+the Lamb, and the Lamb will overcome them; for he is
+Lord of lords, and King of kings; and those with him are
+called, and chosen, and faithful.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 17:7-14.
+</span></div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And he saith to me, The waters which thou didst see,
+where the harlot sitteth, are peoples, and crowds, and
+nations, and tongues. And the ten horns which thou didst
+see, and the wild beast, these will hate the harlot, and will
+make her desolate and naked, and will eat her flesh, and
+burn her up with fire. For God hath put it into their
+hearts to perform his purpose, and to agree, and give their
+kingdom to the wild beast, until the words of God shall be
+fulfilled. And the woman whom thou didst see is the great
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page296">[pg 296]</span><a name="Pg296" id="Pg296" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+city, which reigneth over the kings of the earth.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 17:15-18.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+That the woman and city symbolize the
+same, is shown by the declaration that she is
+that great city, which reigneth over the kings
+of the earth, v. 18. She is also thus indicated
+by the name of <span class="tei tei-q">“Babylon,”</span> on her forehead,
+and the golden cup in her hand: <span class="tei tei-q">“Babylon
+hath been a golden cup in the Lord's hand,
+that made all the earth drunken: the nations
+have drunken of her wine; therefore are the
+nations mad,”</span> Jer. 51:7. In like manner has
+the church of Rome intoxicated the nations.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The scarlet-colored beast”</span> on which the
+woman is seated, is evidently the same beast
+that John saw <span class="tei tei-q">“rise out of the sea, having
+seven heads, and ten horns,”</span> 13:1. The
+Roman empire had been symbolized by <span class="tei tei-q">“a
+great red dragon,”</span> which also had seven
+heads and ten horns. In that vision, crowns
+were on the heads of the beast, (12:3);
+which indicated that Rome, during the period
+thus represented, existed under the forms of
+government symbolized by the heads. These
+heads, the angel affirms, are the seven mountains
+on which the woman sitteth, (v. 9); and
+also that they are seven kings (v. 10), or
+forms of government. Mountains also symbolize
+governments, (16:20); and as the
+heads and mountains are the same, they must
+alike symbolize the seven forms of government
+under which Rome existed previous to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page297">[pg 297]</span><a name="Pg297" id="Pg297" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+its subversion by the northern barbarians,—viz.:
+1, the kingly; 2, consular; 3, dictatorial;
+4, decemviral; 5, tribunitial; 6, pagan-imperial;
+and 7, Christian-imperial. At the time
+of the explanation of this vision to John, the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“five”</span> first-named forms had passed away;
+or, as the angel says, had <span class="tei tei-q">“fallen,”</span> v. 10.
+One then was:—Rome then existed under its
+pagan-imperial, or sixth head. The other,
+the Christian-imperial, had not then come;
+but after it came, and had continued for a
+time, the Roman empire was subverted by
+the irruptions of northern barbarians. Thus
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the beast was;”</span> and then, was not for a
+season. But afterwards it emerged again
+from the sea (13:1), under an <span class="tei tei-q">“eight”</span> form,
+which was of the previous seven, 17:11.
+When it reäppears, its crowns are not upon
+its heads, but encircle its horns, (13:1); indicating
+that those governments have the ascendency,
+which are symbolized by the <span class="tei tei-q">“ten
+horns;”</span> and which, according to the angel,
+are <span class="tei tei-q">“ten kings,”</span> which had not received their
+kingdom at the time of the vision, v. 12.
+These were to be kings in <span class="tei tei-q">“one,”</span> or the same
+hour with the beast, and must therefore be
+contemporary kingdoms, while the forms symbolized
+by the heads, are evidently successive.
+They constitute the government of Rome, in
+its eighth, or decem-regal form; and symbolize
+the ten kingdoms which arose after and out
+of the subversion of imperial Rome. Under
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page298">[pg 298]</span><a name="Pg298" id="Pg298" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+this form, the beast goes into perdition, (v.
+11):—they continue under various combinations,
+till the end of the world, when they
+will war with and be overcome by the Lamb
+(v. 14), in the great battle of Armageddon,
+19:19-21.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The ten contemporary kingdoms have one
+mind, (v. 13): they perpetuate the kingdom
+of the beast, by adopting similar laws, pursuing
+the same line of policy, and assuming
+the same powers that the empire exercised.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“names of blasphemy”</span> which cover
+the beast, symbolize its arrogating the right
+to dictate in matters of faith and religious
+worship, and to punish those who dissent
+from its creed. The Roman hierarchy was
+supported by legal enactments against heretics
+in all of the ten kingdoms. Those who
+dissented from the church were delivered over
+to the power of the civil arm, which punished
+by imprisonment, confiscation of goods, bodily
+torture, and death. The exercise of such
+power, was a blasphemous usurpation of the
+prerogatives of Christ, and an assumption of
+authority over the legislation of God.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+On this beast the woman is seated. As its
+rider, she guides it, and is sustained by it.
+She is its directing power; and while she is
+thus seated, there is no reference to crowns
+encircling either heads or horns. All rule for
+a time is subservient to her control. Thus
+were the ten kingdoms obedient to the Roman
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page299">[pg 299]</span><a name="Pg299" id="Pg299" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+hierarchy,—sustaining, and being controlled
+by it. She crowned their kings, and dethroned
+them at her pleasure. The religion of the
+church was enforced by the sword of the
+state; and thus did the kings of the earth
+commit fornication with her,—the idolatries
+of the church being sanctioned by them.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The superb attire of the woman, and the
+costly gems with which she is decked, denote
+the wealth, luxury, and regal splendor of the
+hierarchy which she symbolizes. The cup,
+and its abominations in her hand, denote the
+false doctrines with which she would seduce
+the nations. Her names describe her nature,
+and identify her with Babylon; and her intoxication
+with blood, indicates her blood-thirsty,
+persecuting character, and the delight
+with which she would exult over the slaughter
+of the saints.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Roman hierarchy was not, however,
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">always</span></em> to retain her supremacy over the
+nations. She was in due time to <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">fall</span></em> from
+the position symbolized by the woman seated
+on the beast; and the kings of the earth were
+to hate and burn with fire, her whom they
+had recognized as their mistress, and to whose
+control they had submitted. The governments
+which have sustained her pretensions,
+were to cast her off contemptuously. This
+has been in progress of fulfilment from the
+days of Martin Luther, since which her control
+of the ten kingdoms has been only limited
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page300">[pg 300]</span><a name="Pg300" id="Pg300" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and partial. Many of her ecclesiastical estates
+have been confiscated, and she has been deprived
+of her prerogatives in many countries.
+There may, perhaps, be hereafter a more complete
+fulfilment of this prediction. It is symbolized
+in the following chapter, by:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Fall of Babylon.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And after this, I saw another angel descending from
+heaven, having great power; and the earth was enlightened
+by his glory. And he cried with a mighty voice, saying,
+She is fallen: Babylon the great is fallen, and is
+become a dwelling of demons, and a prison of every unclean
+spirit, and a prison of every unclean and hateful bird, for
+all the nations have drunk of the wine of the fury of her
+fornication, and the kings of the earth have committed fornication
+with her, and the merchants of the earth have
+become rich through the abundance of her luxury.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev.
+18:1-3.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This announcement of the fall of the city,
+synchronizes with the same symbolization
+in the 14th chapter: <span class="tei tei-q">“And there followed
+another angel, saying, Babylon is fallen, is
+fallen, that great city, because she made all
+nations drink of the wine of the wrath of her
+fornication,”</span> 14:8. The angel, proclaiming
+her fall, doubtless symbolizes a body of men,
+who shall give utterance to corresponding
+declarations.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">epoch</span></em> of this utterance is shown by
+the identity of this angel with that of Rev.
+10:1-3. They thus correspond: They both
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page301">[pg 301]</span><a name="Pg301" id="Pg301" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+descend from heaven: the one is a mighty
+angel, and the other has great power; the one
+is enveloped with a robe of cloud, his head is
+arched with the rainbow, his face is like the
+sun, and his feet like fire, and he stands on
+both earth and sea; the other is so glorified,
+and occupies a position so conspicuous, that
+the earth is enlightened with his glory; and
+the one cries <span class="tei tei-q">“with a loud voice as when a
+lion roareth,”</span> while the other cries <span class="tei tei-q">“mighty
+with a strong voice.”</span> Thus their position,
+manner and conspicuousness, are alike. What
+was uttered by the angel of the tenth chapter,
+is not revealed; but the fall of Babylon being
+announced in the eighteenth, it follows that it
+was the subject of the angel's utterance in the
+tenth.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As the messenger of the tenth chapter appears
+subsequent to the sixth, and before the
+seventh trumpet; and as, after this epoch,
+there were to be prophesyings <span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">again</span></em>, before
+many peoples, and nations, and tongues, and
+kings”</span> (10:11), it follows that the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">time</span></em> then
+symbolized must be at an epoch <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">anterior</span></em> to
+the end of the world. A corresponding reason—namely,
+the command to come out of Babylon,
+and the fulfilment of her plagues and
+sorrows, which are to intervene between the
+cry of the angel announcing her fall and the
+time of her actual destruction—proves that
+the mighty angel of the 18th of Revelation
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page302">[pg 302]</span><a name="Pg302" id="Pg302" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+must also be at an <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">epoch</span></em> having a considerable
+period between it and the end.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It follows, that when John saw the angel
+of the eighteenth chapter, and <span class="tei tei-q">“the earth was
+lightened with his glory,”</span> it did not symbolize
+a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">literal</span></em> but a <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">moral</span></em> light,—<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the light of
+truth</span></em>. And as the enlightening of the earth
+by its promulgation, pre-supposes a previous
+state of corresponding moral <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">darkness</span></em>, it must,
+as in the tenth chapter, symbolize an <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">epoch</span></em>,
+prominent in the history of the world, as a
+time when the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">darkness</span></em> of ignorance, error
+and superstition, began rapidly to disappear
+before the spread of the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">light</span></em> of truth and
+knowledge.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These considerations point to the epoch of
+the REFORMATION, when the midnight
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">darkness</span></em> of the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">dark ages</span></em> began to be scattered
+before the uprising and onward progress
+of truth and knowledge. Then appeared a
+body of religious teachers, aided by the newly
+discovered art of printing, who so brought the
+Scriptures out from their obscurity, opposed
+the pretensions of the Papal hierarchy, and,
+by the clear teachings of the word, so secured
+the spread of gospel light and liberty, that
+they might appropriately be symbolized by an
+angel coming down from heaven, and enlightening
+the earth with his glory. The descent
+from heaven would symbolize the heavenly
+origin of the doctrines promulgated. His
+mighty power, and the strong voice with
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page303">[pg 303]</span><a name="Pg303" id="Pg303" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+which he proclaimed his cry, would symbolize
+the greatness and earnestness of the movement,
+and the mighty results to be effected by
+it. This symbolization, twice given, could
+only be fulfilled by some great and mighty
+movement, like the Reformation.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The fall of Babylon is distinct from and
+anterior to its destruction, and must correspond
+with the fall of the woman from her
+position on the beast;—she is no longer to be
+the director of, and to be sustained by, the
+civil power. The cry of the angel, announcing
+her fall, as Mr. Elliot remarks, seems to
+be anticipative, and not retrospective. The
+denunciations of the Papacy by the reformers
+were of a character to fulfil this symbolization.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The year 1300, during the pontificate of
+Boniface VIII., may be regarded as marking
+the highest eminence to which the Papal power
+ever attained. From this period the dominion
+of the Roman Pontiffs appeared to be gradually
+undermined. Twenty-four years after this
+date, John Wickliffe was born, who, together
+with his followers, made more vigorous attacks
+upon Babylon itself. Some of these declared
+Rome to be mystical Babylon, and the Pope
+and church there to be Antichrist. These
+heralds announced the fall of mystical Babylon,
+as the ancient prophets had done that of
+literal Babylon, long before the event.—Jer.
+51:7, 8. Antichrist and Babylon are identified
+in prophecy. In 1518, Luther first suspected
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page304">[pg 304]</span><a name="Pg304" id="Pg304" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+their application to the Papacy; and,
+writing to his friend Link, on sending him a
+copy of the acts just published of the conference
+at Augsburg, he says: <span class="tei tei-q">“My pen is ready
+to give birth to things much greater. <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">I know
+not myself whence these thoughts come to me.</span></em>
+I will send you what I write, that you may
+see if I have well conjectured in believing that
+the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Antichrist</span></em> of whom St. Paul speaks now
+reigns in the court of Rome.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+At first, Luther and his companions sought
+only the reformation of that church. They
+had no idea of dissolving their own connection
+with it. But when the thunders of the Vatican
+were hurled at them, and they found
+themselves excommunicated as heretics, they
+came to the conclusion that the church of
+Rome was <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the Babylon of the Apocalypse</span></em>.
+Immediately upon this conviction, they began
+to cry, <span class="tei tei-q">“Babylon is fallen!”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In 1520 appeared a famous book, by Luther,
+on the <span class="tei tei-q">“<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Babylonish Captivity of the
+Church</span></em>,”</span> in which he attacked Rome with
+great skill and courage. In Switzerland and
+England the reformers considered themselves
+as fulfilling this message of the Apocalyptic
+angel. Elliot says, <span class="tei tei-q">“They <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">seized on this very
+prophecy for application; and, for the first
+time</span></em>, upon grounds of evidence sound and
+tenable, concluded on the fact of progress
+having been made up to it, in the evolution
+of the great mundane drama, and on their
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page305">[pg 305]</span><a name="Pg305" id="Pg305" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+own chronological place being already far
+advanced under the sixth trumpet, and in
+near expectancy of the seventh trumpet, of
+the Apocalyptic prophecy.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+These denunciations against Mystic Babylon,
+and protestations against all her idolatrous
+ceremonies and superstitious appendages, were
+given, by the great body of the reformers,
+within the very bounds of her empire. They
+resulted in her loss of power, and of control
+over the princes of Europe. In 1526, the
+other monarchs becoming jealous of the power
+of Charles V., Emperor of Germany, <span class="tei tei-q">“Pope
+Clement VII. placed himself at the head of a
+league of the principal states of Italy against
+him; but their ill-directed efforts were productive
+of new misfortunes. Rome was taken
+by storm, by the troops of the constable,
+sacked, and the Pope himself made prisoner.
+Charles V. publicly disavowed the proceedings
+of the constable, went into mourning with his
+court, and carried his hypocrisy so far as to
+order prayers for the deliverance of the Pope.
+On restoring the holy father to liberty, he
+demanded a ransom of four hundred thousand
+crowns of gold, but was satisfied with a
+quarter of that sum.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ency. Am.</span></span>, v. 3. p. 76.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+All the Protestant princes of Germany denied
+the assumptions of the Pope; and the
+powers of western and northern Europe, one
+after another, denied their allegiance to him.
+In 1798, Pius VI. was taken prisoner by the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page306">[pg 306]</span><a name="Pg306" id="Pg306" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+French, under Gen. Berthier, and died in
+exile. When Berthier entered Rome, many
+of the cardinals <span class="tei tei-q">“fled from the city on the
+wings of terror;”</span> but those who remained
+<span class="tei tei-q">“were disposed still to uphold the authority
+of the Pontiff.”</span> Finally, however, <span class="tei tei-q">“with
+melancholy voice, they pronounced their absolute
+renunciation of the temporal government.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Life
+of Pius VI.</span></span> His successor
+resumed his position. But in 1848 Pius IX.
+fled from his own subjects, and was only
+restored by French arms. Thus gradually
+the Babylonish <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">woman</span></em> became unseated, and
+fell from her position on the beast; and,
+instead of guiding and directing the civil
+power, now only exists by sufferance. As a
+city, also, her supremacy was gone. Being
+no longer the mistress of the nations, or the
+ruling city, the Papal See is in the condition
+of ancient Babylon when becoming a dependency
+of the Medes and Persians.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+After the fall of ancient Babylon, it became
+gradually more and more deserted, until
+there was a literal fulfilment of the words of
+Isaiah: <span class="tei tei-q">“Wild beasts of the desert shall lie
+there; and their houses shall be full of doleful
+creatures; and owls shall dwell there, and
+satyrs shall dance there. And the wild beasts
+of the islands shall cry in their desolate houses,
+and dragons in their pleasant palaces,”</span> Isa.
+13:21, 22. In like manner the apocalyptic
+Babylon, after her fall, and the withdrawal
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page307">[pg 307]</span><a name="Pg307" id="Pg307" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of Protestants from her communion, was to
+become the receptacle of corresponding spirits.
+Her members were to be more impious than
+before, and were to adhere more closely than
+ever to her idolatrous practices. The contrast
+between these and true Christians would also
+be more apparent from the separation which
+succeeds her fall, in obedience to:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Voice From Heaven.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I heard another voice from heaven, saying, Come
+out of her, my people, that ye partake not of her sins, and
+that ye receive not of her plagues, for her sins have reached
+to heaven, and God hath remembered her iniquities! Reward
+her even as she rendered to you, and double to her
+according to her works, in the cup which she hath poured
+out, pour out double to her. By as much as she hath
+glorified herself, and lived luxuriously, so much torment
+and mourning give her; for she saith in her heart, I sit a
+queen, and am not a widow, and shall see no mourning.
+On this account, her plagues will come in one day, death,
+and mourning, and famine; and she will be burned up with
+fire; for strong is the Lord God, who judgeth her.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%">—Rev.
+18:4-8.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+So long as the true character of the apostate
+church was unperceived, she would contain
+many good, as well as a multitude of
+bad members. The voice from heaven, indicates
+an epoch when there should be a widely
+extended and marked separation between
+these two classes. Till the time of that separation
+should be indicated, the children of
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page308">[pg 308]</span><a name="Pg308" id="Pg308" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+God would be justified in continuing members
+of her communion; but not subsequently.
+The condition of Babylon, at the time of her
+fall, indicates that the separation must take
+place in near connection with that event; and
+the cry must synchronize with that of the third
+angel in Rev. 14:9,—which symbolized a
+body of men who should insist on such a
+separation from the Papacy as that here symbolized.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+After the discovery that the church of Rome
+was the Babylon of the Apocalypse, the reformers
+began to call on the people of God to
+desert her communion; and the formation of
+the reformed churches was the consequence.
+This was preached wherever the Reformation
+extended, and has been continued to the
+present time. The Protestant churches have
+proclaimed connection with Romanism, an
+obstacle to salvation; and have called on its
+Christian members to come out from her
+abominations. Even the name <span class="tei tei-q">“Protestant,”</span>
+was given because of their protestation against
+the corruptions of the Papal See.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+After the fall of ancient Babylon, and before
+her destruction, the people were, in like manner,
+commanded to forsake her. Said Jeremiah:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Flee out of the midst of Babylon, and
+deliver every man his soul: be not cut off in
+her iniquity; for this is the time of the Lord's
+vengeance; he will render unto her a recompense.
+Babylon is suddenly fallen and destroyed:
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page309">[pg 309]</span><a name="Pg309" id="Pg309" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+howl for her; take balm for her
+pain, if so be she may be healed. We would
+have healed Babylon, but she is not healed:
+forsake her, and let us go every one into his
+own country: for her judgment reacheth unto
+heaven, and is lifted up even to the skies,”</span>
+Jer. 51:6, 8, 9. And Isaiah said: <span class="tei tei-q">“Go ye
+forth of Babylon, flee ye from the Chaldeans,
+with a voice of singing declare ye, tell this,
+utter it even to the end of the earth; say ye,
+The Lord hath redeemed his servant Jacob,”</span>
+Isa. 48:20. <span class="tei tei-q">“Depart ye, depart ye, go ye
+out from thence, touch no unclean thing; go
+ye out of the midst of her; be ye clean, that
+bear the vessels of the Lord,”</span> Isa. 52:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Sins reaching to heaven, indicate great
+wickedness. Thus God said to Jonah: <span class="tei tei-q">“Go
+to Nineveh, that great city, and cry against
+it; for their wickedness is come up before
+me,”</span> Jonah 1:2. And he said of old Babylon:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Her judgment reacheth unto heaven,
+and is lifted up even to the skies,”</span> Jer. 51:9.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Destruction of Babylon.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And the kings of the earth, who have committed fornication
+and lived luxuriously with her, will weep and wail
+for her, when they see the smoke of her burning, standing
+afar off through the fear of her torment, saying, Woe!
+woe! that great city, Babylon, that mighty city! for in one
+hour is thy judgment come! And the merchants of the
+earth will weep and mourn over her; for no one buyeth
+their merchandise any more; the merchandise of gold, and
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page310">[pg 310]</span><a name="Pg310" id="Pg310" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+silver, and precious stones, and pearls, and fine linen, and
+purple, and silk, and crimson, and all thine wood, and all
+kinds of vessels of ivory, and all kinds of vessels of most
+precious wood, and of brass, and iron, and marble, and
+cinnamon, and fragrant ointment, and incense, and myrrh,
+and frankincense, and wine, and oil, and fine flour, and
+wheat, and beasts, and sheep, and horses, and chariots, and
+bodies, and souls of men. And the autumnal fruit of thine
+appetite's desire is departed from thee, and all things dainty
+and sumptuous are destroyed from thee, and thou wilt find
+them no more at all. The merchants of these things, who
+were enriched by her, will stand afar off, through the fear
+of her torment, weeping and mourning, saying, Woe! woe!
+that great city, that was clothed in fine linen, and purple,
+and crimson, and adorned with gold, and precious stones,
+and pearls! for in one hour such great wealth is destroyed.
+And every pilot, and every one sailing to any place, and
+sailors, and as many as trade by sea, stood afar off, and
+cried, when they saw the smoke of her burning, saying,
+What city is like the great city? And they cast dust on
+their heads, and cried out, weeping and mourning, saying,
+Woe! woe! the great city by which all who had ships on
+the sea, were made rich through her precious merchandise!
+for in one hour she is desolated.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 18:9-20.
+</span></div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">Rejoice over her, O heaven, and ye saints and apostles
+and prophets; for God hath avenged you on her!</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev.
+18:20.
+</span></div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And a strong angel took up a stone like a great mill-stone,
+and cast it into the sea, saying, Thus violently, will
+Babylon, the great city, be cast down, and be no more at
+all. And the voice of harpers, and musicians, and pipers,
+and trumpeters, will be heard no more at all in thee; and
+no craftsman, of any art, will be found any more in thee;
+and the sound of a mill-stone will be heard no more at all
+in thee; and the light of a lamp will shine no more at all
+in thee; and the voice of the bridegroom and the bride will
+be heard no more at all in thee; for thy merchants were
+the nobles of the earth; for by thy sorcery all nations were
+deceived. And in her was found the blood of prophets, and
+of saints, and of all those slain on the earth.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 18:21-24.
+</span></div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page311">[pg 311]</span><a name="Pg311" id="Pg311" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The punishment of Babylon is proportioned
+to her wickedness, and is to be inflicted partially
+by the kings of the earth, and partially
+by other agencies. The kings were to hate,
+and burn her with fire, (17:16); and were
+also, when they should see the smoke of her
+burnings, to bewail and lament for her, 18:9.
+The former passage indicates their agency in
+her impoverishment, and has been fulfilled in
+the confiscation of her property in France and
+England, the spoliation of churches and religious
+houses, wherever the arms of Napoleon
+extended; the dethronement of the Pope, by
+Gen. Berthier, in 1798; the refusal of some
+of the powers to permit her to nominate, within
+their limits, the candidates for ecclesiastical
+preferment, &amp;c. She is thus made to feel her
+widowhood,—her divorce from the secular
+arm,—and has mourned the loss of her most
+devoted children, who have forsaken her communion.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Her final destruction is, however, to be
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">entire</span></em>. She is totally to disappear, like the
+sinking of a millstone in the sea. She is to
+be <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">utterly</span></em> burned with fire; but the lamentation
+of the kings over her burning, indicates
+that her destruction is to be completed by
+other instrumentality than theirs. Probably
+the multitude are to be incensed against her,
+and will so manifest their hatred that the governments
+will neither join in it, nor attempt to
+resist it, for fear that the same torment will be
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page312">[pg 312]</span><a name="Pg312" id="Pg312" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+inflicted on them, 18:10. But her existence
+is terminated by the brightness of Christ's
+coming, 2 Thess. 2:8. Her destruction precedes
+that of the kings of the earth, who
+mourn her end. The merchants of the earth,
+the captains, sailors, &amp;c., symbolize those
+who bear a relation to the hierarchy, analogous
+to that sustained by such to a great
+commercial emporium. They are those who
+have the control of her preferments, benefices
+and revenues,—who traffic in her indulgences,
+and thereby become themselves enriched.
+And these articles of traffic are symbolized by
+the merchandise which, after her destruction,
+no man would buy.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The commerce of this ecclesiastical city, has
+been immense,—particularly in indulgences.
+The sale of these was reduced to a system,
+says D'Aubigné, by <span class="tei tei-q">“the celebrated and scandalous
+Tariff of Indulgences,”</span> which went
+through more than forty editions. The least
+delicate ears would be offended by an enumeration
+of all the horrors it contains. Incest,
+if not detected, was to cost five groats; and
+six, if it was known. There was a stated
+price for murder, infanticide, adultery, perjury,
+burglary, &amp;c. Polygamy cost six
+ducats; sacrilege and perjury, nine; murder,
+eight; and witchcraft, two ducats.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The penances of various kinds which were
+imposed as a punishment for sin, might also
+be compounded for money.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page313">[pg 313]</span><a name="Pg313" id="Pg313" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Tetzel, one of Rome's travelling merchants,
+told the people of Germany that for <span class="tei tei-q">“a quarter
+of a florin”</span> they might <span class="tei tei-q">“receive letters of indulgence,”</span>
+by means of which they might
+<span class="tei tei-q">“introduce into paradise a divine and immortal
+soul, without its running any risk.”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Hist.
+Ref.</span></span>, pp. 56, 242.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+He also said <span class="tei tei-q">“Indulgences avail not only for
+the living but for the dead. With twelve groats
+you can deliver your father from purgatory.”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“At the very instant,”</span> said he, <span class="tei tei-q">“that the
+money rattles at the bottom of the chest, the
+soul escapes from purgatory, and flies, liberated
+to heaven.”</span> This is but a specimen of
+her vile traffic.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Responding to the command, are heard the
+voices of much people in heaven,
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Rejoicing Over Babylon's Destruction.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And after this, I heard a loud voice of a mighty crowd
+in heaven, saying, Praise ye Jehovah! The salvation, and
+the glory, and the power of our God! For true and righteous
+are his judgments; for he hath judged the great harlot,
+who corrupted the earth with her fornication, and hath
+avenged the blood of his servants at her hand! And again
+they said, Praise ye Jehovah! And her smoke ascendeth
+for ever and ever. And the twenty-four elders and the
+four living beings fell down and worshipped God, who sat
+on the throne, saying, So be it! Praise ye Jehovah!</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev.
+19:1-4.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Daniel, in vision, saw the same persecuting
+power symbolized by a <span class="tei tei-q">“Little Horn,”</span> having
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page314">[pg 314]</span><a name="Pg314" id="Pg314" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“eyes like the eyes of a man and a mouth
+speaking great things;”</span> and he beheld, <span class="tei tei-q">“and
+the same Horn made war with the saints,
+and prevailed against them, until the Ancient
+of days came, and judgment was given to the
+saints of the Most High, and the time came
+that the saints possessed the kingdom,”</span> Dan.
+7:8, 21, 22. And Paul testified of <span class="tei tei-q">“that
+Wicked”</span> who was to be revealed, that he
+was the <span class="tei tei-q">“Man of Sin,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“whom the Lord
+shall consume with the spirit of his mouth,
+and shall destroy with the brightness of his
+coming,”</span> 2 Thess. 2:3-8. The destruction
+of that which was thus symbolized and
+predicted, must, consequently, be at the epoch
+of Christ's second coming and of the establishment
+of the kingdom of God.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It is also at the epoch anticipated by <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+souls of them that were slain for the word of
+God and for the testimony which they held,”</span>
+who, from under the altar, on the opening of
+the <span class="tei tei-q">“fifth seal,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“cried with a loud voice,
+saying, How long, O Lord, holy and true,
+dost thou not judge and avenge our blood on
+them that dwell on the earth?”</span> 6:9, 10.
+The epoch which they anticipated not having
+then arrived, <span class="tei tei-q">“white robes were given unto
+every one of them; and it was said unto
+them, that they should rest yet for a little
+season, until their fellow servants also, and
+their brethren that should be killed as they
+were, should be fulfilled”</span> (6:11),—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, till
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page315">[pg 315]</span><a name="Pg315" id="Pg315" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+their number should be filled up. As the
+destruction of that hierarchy, in which <span class="tei tei-q">“was
+found the blood of prophets and of saints
+and of all that were slain upon the earth”</span>
+(18:24), had just been symbolized (in the
+18th chap.), and as these rejoicings are because
+God <span class="tei tei-q">“hath judged the great whore which did
+corrupt the earth with her fornication, and
+hath avenged the blood of his servants at her
+hand”</span> (19:2), it follows that the epoch here
+symbolized is that to which the saints were
+to wait, and that they are now to be crowned
+with their reward.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As the destruction of Babylon is a little
+anterior to that of the beast and false prophet
+(19:20), and is to be destroyed by the brightness
+of Christ's coming (2 Thess. 2:8), at a
+time when the kingdom is to be given to the
+saints of the Most High (Dan. 7:22), it
+explains how it is that the kingdom is set up
+in the days of the kings symbolized by the
+divided toes of Nebuchadnezzar's image: symbolic
+of the same as the horns of the beast in
+Dan. 7:7, 24, and Rev. 17:3, 12, 16; for
+<span class="tei tei-q">“in the days of these kings shall the God of
+heaven set up a kingdom which shall never
+be destroyed, and the kingdom shall not be
+left to other people, but it shall break in
+pieces and consume all these kingdoms, and
+it shall stand forever,”</span> Dan. 2:44.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The kingdom is therefore commenced previous
+to the descent of the Lord to the earth,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page316">[pg 316]</span><a name="Pg316" id="Pg316" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+by the saints being caught up to meet him in
+the air. <span class="tei tei-q">“For the Lord himself shall descend
+from heaven with a shout, with the voice of
+the archangel and the trump of God; and
+the dead in Christ shall rise first; then we
+which are alive and remain shall be caught
+up together with them in the clouds, to meet
+the Lord in the air: and so shall we ever be
+with the Lord,”</span> 1 Thess. 4:16, 17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This epoch, then, is that of the sounding
+of the seventh trumpet; for <span class="tei tei-q">“in the days of
+the voice of the seventh angel, when he shall
+begin to sound, the mystery of God shall be
+finished, as he hath declared to his servants
+the prophets,”</span> 10:7. This mystery Paul
+thus explains: <span class="tei tei-q">“Now this I say, brethren,
+that flesh and blood cannot inherit the kingdom
+of God, neither doth corruption inherit
+incorruption. Behold, I show you a mystery:
+We shall not all sleep, but we shall all be
+changed, in a moment, in the twinkling of an
+eye, <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">at the last trump</span></em>: for the trumpet shall
+sound, and the dead shall be raised incorruptible,
+and we shall be changed,”</span> 1 Cor.
+15:50-54. This <span class="tei tei-q">“saying”</span> was thus written
+by Isaiah,—<span class="tei tei-q">“He will swallow up death
+in victory; and the Lord God will wipe away
+tears from off all faces; and the rebuke of his
+people shall he take away from off all the
+earth; for the Lord hath spoken it. And it
+shall be said in that day, Lo, this is our God;
+we have waited for him, and he will save
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page317">[pg 317]</span><a name="Pg317" id="Pg317" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+us: this is the Lord; we have waited for
+him, we will be glad and rejoice in his salvation,”</span>
+Isa. 25:8, 9. It follows, then, that
+the voices heard in heaven, shouting <span class="tei tei-q">“Alleluia,”</span>
+and ascribing <span class="tei tei-q">“salvation, and glory, and
+honor, and power, unto the Lord our God”</span>
+(v. 1), synchronize with those heard when
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the seventh angel sounded: and there were
+great voices in heaven, saying, The kingdoms
+of this world are become the kingdoms
+of our Lord, and of his Christ; and he shall
+reign for ever and ever.—And the four and
+twenty elders, which sat before God on their
+seats, fell upon their faces and worshipped
+God, saying, We give thee thanks, O Lord
+God Almighty, which art, and wast, and art
+to come; because thou hast taken to thee thy
+great power, and hast reigned: And the nations
+were angry, and thy wrath is come,
+and the time of the dead, that they should be
+judged, and that thou shouldest give reward
+unto thy servants the prophets, and to the
+saints, and them that fear thy name, small
+and great; and shouldest destroy them which
+destroy the earth,”</span> Rev. 11:15-18.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The time of the dead being come that they
+should be judged, and the saints rewarded, is
+another evidence that this epoch is that of the
+second advent and kingdom of Christ, <span class="tei tei-q">“who
+shall judge the quick and the dead at his
+appearing and kingdom,”</span> 2 Tim. 4:1. Consequently
+it must synchronize with that of:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page318">[pg 318]</span><a name="Pg318" id="Pg318" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Marriage of the Lamb.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And a voice came from the throne saying, Praise our
+God, all ye his servants, and ye that fear him, both the
+small and the great! And I heard a voice like that of a
+great crowd, and like the voice of many waters, and like
+the voice of mighty thunders, saying, Praise ye Jehovah!
+for the Lord God Almighty reigneth. Let us rejoice and
+exult, and give glory up him: for the marriage of the
+Lamb hath come, and his wife hath prepared herself! And
+it was granted to her to be arrayed in fine linen, clean and
+white: (for the fine linen is the righteousness of the
+saints.) And he saith to me, Write, Happy are those called
+to the marriage-supper of the Lamb. And he saith to me,
+These are the true words of God. And I fell before his feet
+to worship him. And he saith to me, See thou do it not: I
+am thy fellow-servant and one of thy brethren, who have
+the testimony of Jesus: worship God: for the testimony of
+Jesus is the spirit of prophecy.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 19:5-10.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The marriage of the Lamb is at the epoch
+when <span class="tei tei-q">“the kingdoms of this world are to
+become our Lord's and his Christ's”</span>—when
+the Lord God Almighty takes to himself his
+great power and reigns, 11:15, 17. Therefore,
+in connection, are heard the mighty
+thunderings, saying, <span class="tei tei-q">“Alleluia; for the Lord
+God Omnipotent reigneth,”</span> 9:16. This
+scripture, then, corresponds with that in
+Matt. 24:30, 31, when <span class="tei tei-q">“they shall see the
+Son of Man coming in the clouds of heaven
+with power and great glory; and he shall
+send his angels with a great sound of a
+trumpet, and they shall gather together his
+elect from the four winds, from one end of
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page319">[pg 319]</span><a name="Pg319" id="Pg319" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+heaven to the other.”</span> For, <span class="tei tei-q">“when the Son
+of Man shall come in his glory, and all the
+holy angels with him, then shall he sit upon
+the throne of his glory: and before him shall
+be gathered all nations: and he shall separate
+them one from another as a shepherd divideth
+his sheep from the goats—the one on his
+right hand and the other on his left,”</span> Matt. 25:31, 32.
+Those on his right, we learn
+from 1 Cor. 15:51, and 1 Thess. 4:16, 17,
+are the elect, gathered by the angels from all
+parts under heaven, who are caught up to
+meet the Lord in the air—and those on the
+left are consequently the living wicked, who
+are to be slain by the sword which proceedeth
+out of the mouth of the Lamb, 19:21.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">The wife</span></span> who <span class="tei tei-q">“hath made herself ready,”</span>
+is shown by the foregoing scriptures to be,
+undoubtedly, the church triumphant—the
+redeemed, who have been raised out from
+among the dead, and the living saints, caught
+up together to meet the Lord in the air;
+to welcome him in his coming to reign.
+These constitute the bride, the Lamb's wife;
+for as <span class="tei tei-q">“the husband is the head of the wife,”</span>
+even so <span class="tei tei-q">“Christ is the head of the church,”</span>
+Eph. 5:23. He <span class="tei tei-q">“loved the church, and gave
+himself for it, that he might sanctify and
+cleanse it with the washing of water by the
+word, that he might present it to himself a
+glorious church, not having spot or wrinkle,
+or any such thing; but that it should be holy
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page320">[pg 320]</span><a name="Pg320" id="Pg320" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and without blemish,”</span> Eph. 5:25-27. This
+accords with God's ancient promises to his
+people. Thus Isaiah saith: <span class="tei tei-q">“Thy Maker is
+thy husband; the Lord of hosts is his name,
+and thy Redeemer the Holy One of Israel:
+the Lord of the whole earth shall he be
+called,”</span> Isa. 54:5. Also Hosea: <span class="tei tei-q">“And it
+shall be at that day, saith the Lord, that thou
+shalt call me Ishi,”</span> my husband; <span class="tei tei-q">“and
+shalt call me no more Baali,”</span> my Lord.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And I will betroth thee unto me in righteousness,
+and in judgment, and in loving
+kindness, and in mercies. I will even betroth
+thee unto me in faithfulness; and thou shalt
+know the Lord,”</span> Hos. 2:16, 19. Thus is
+the church <span class="tei tei-q">“espoused to one husband,”</span> to be
+presented <span class="tei tei-q">“as a chaste virgin to Christ,”</span> 2
+Cor. 11:2.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The epoch of this presentation being here
+symbolized, it synchronizes with that part of
+the parable of the <span class="tei tei-q">“ten virgins which took
+their lamps and went forth to meet the Bridegroom,”</span>
+when, the Bridegroom having come,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“they that were ready went in with him to
+the marriage, and the door was shut”</span>—those
+left without, afterwards crying in vain for
+admittance, Matt. 25:10. The wife had
+been made ready by its having been <span class="tei tei-q">“granted
+that she should be arrayed in fine linen, clean
+and white—[<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">mar.</span></span> <span class="tei tei-q">‘bright’</span>]; for the fine
+linen is the righteousness of the saints,”</span> 19:8.
+Such were the <span class="tei tei-q">“white robes”</span> given to
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page321">[pg 321]</span><a name="Pg321" id="Pg321" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+those who cried from under the altar (6:11),
+and who afterwards, at an epoch synchronizing
+with the marriage of the Lamb,
+appeared, <span class="tei tei-q">“a great multitude which no man
+could number, of all nations, and kindreds,
+and people, and tongues,”</span> who <span class="tei tei-q">“stood before
+the throne, and before the Lamb, clothed with
+white robes, and palms in their hands, and
+cried with a loud voice, saying, Salvation to
+our God which sitteth upon the throne, and
+unto the Lamb,”</span> 7:9, 10. These were
+they of whom one of the elders asked, saying,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“What are these which are arrayed in white
+robes? and whence came they?”</span> and who
+was answered: <span class="tei tei-q">“These are they which came
+out of great tribulation, and have washed
+their robes and made them white in the blood
+of the Lamb. Therefore are they before the
+throne of God, and serve him day and night
+in his temple: and he that sitteth on the
+throne shall dwell among them. They shall
+hunger no more, neither thirst any more;
+neither shall the sun light on them, nor any
+heat. For the Lamb which is in the midst of
+the throne shall feed them, and shall lead
+them unto living fountains of waters; and
+God shall wipe away all tears from their
+eyes,”</span> 7:13-17. These had complied
+with the condition to the promise: <span class="tei tei-q">“He that
+overcometh, the same shall be clothed in
+white raiment; and I will not blot out his
+name out of the book of life, but I will confess
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page322">[pg 322]</span><a name="Pg322" id="Pg322" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+his name before the Father and before
+his holy angels,”</span> 3:5. <span class="tei tei-q">“These are they
+which follow the Lamb whithersoever he
+goeth. These were redeemed from among
+men, being the first fruits unto God and to
+the Lamb,”</span> 14:4.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed are they which are called unto
+the marriage supper of the Lamb,”</span> 19:9.
+Truly are they blessed; for <span class="tei tei-q">“they shall hunger
+no more, neither thirst any more; neither
+shall the sun light on them, nor any heat,”</span>
+7:16. They attain the promised blessing:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed and holy is he that hath part in the
+first resurrection,”</span> 20:6. <span class="tei tei-q">“And God shall
+wipe away all tears from their eyes; and
+there shall be no more death, neither sorrow,
+nor crying, neither shall there be any more
+pain: for the former things are passed away,”</span>
+21:4. So entranced was the apocalyptic
+seer at these symbols of the glorified redeemed,
+that he fell at his feet to worship the
+angel who showed him these things. But
+his fellow servant shrank back from the
+reception of homage, and pointed to God as
+the only object of adoration.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The union of the saints to Christ in the
+clouds of heaven being symbolized, they
+receive the gracious welcome: <span class="tei tei-q">“Come, ye
+blessed of my Father, inherit the kingdom
+prepared for you from the foundation of the
+world,”</span> Matt. 25:34. But first it is necessary
+to redeem the <span class="tei tei-q">“purchased possession”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page323">[pg 323]</span><a name="Pg323" id="Pg323" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+(Eph. 1:14), to reconquer the revolted province,
+which, since the fall, has been subject to
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the god of this world”</span> (2 Cor. 4:4), the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“prince of the power of the air”</span> (Eph. 2:2),
+to rescue it from the dominion of the
+usurper, and deliver it from its present mis-rule
+<span class="tei tei-q">“up to God the Father”</span> (1 Cor. 15:24),
+who will bestow it on One who is worthy
+to wear its crown. For when Daniel saw
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“the judgment was set and the books
+were opened,”</span> he also <span class="tei tei-q">“saw in the night
+visions, and, behold, one like the Son of
+man came in the clouds of heaven, and
+came to the Ancient of days, and they
+brought him near before him; and there was
+given him dominion, and glory, and a kingdom,
+that all people, nations and languages,
+should serve him: his dominion is an everlasting
+dominion, which shall not pass away,
+and his kingdom that which shall not be
+destroyed,”</span> Dan. 7:10, 13, 14. He comes,
+then, to dispossess the usurper, and to take
+possession of his kingdom. The next representation,
+then, symbolizes the coming of:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The King and his Armies.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw heaven opened, and behold, a white horse: and
+he who sat on him was called Faithful and True, and in righteousness
+he judgeth and maketh war. His eyes were like
+a flame of fire, and on his head were many diadems; and
+he had a name written which no one knew except himself.
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page324">[pg 324]</span><a name="Pg324" id="Pg324" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+And he was clothed with a garment dipped in blood: and
+his name is called The Word of God. And the armies in
+heaven followed him on white horses, clothed in fine linen,
+white and clean. And from his mouth goeth forth a sharp
+sword, that he may smite the nations with it: and he will
+rule them with a rod of iron: and he treadeth the wine-press
+of the furious wrath of God, the Almighty. And he
+hath on his garment and on his thigh a name written,
+KING OF KINGS AND LORD OF LORDS.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 19:11-16.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+According to the significance of symbolic
+language, Christ is here represented as coming
+personally. The heavens open and he appears
+in resplendent majesty, in accordance with
+the predictions respecting his second advent.
+When the clouds of heaven had received the
+ascending Saviour, the shining ones who stood
+by said to the gazing disciples, <span class="tei tei-q">“This same
+Jesus which is taken up from you into heaven,
+shall so come in like manner as ye have seen
+him go into heaven,”</span> Acts 1:11. <span class="tei tei-q">“And they
+shall see the Son of man coming in the clouds
+of heaven with power and great glory,”</span> Matt.
+24:30. <span class="tei tei-q">“Behold, he cometh with clouds;
+and every eye shall see him, and they also
+which pierced him: and all kindreds of the
+earth shall wail because of him,”</span> Rev. 1:7.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The white horse of the King, and those of
+his armies, are symbols of the pomp and
+grandeur of their descent, and show that they
+will triumph in victory.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The names ascribed to the descending
+Monarch are applicable only to Christ. He
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page325">[pg 325]</span><a name="Pg325" id="Pg325" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+was <span class="tei tei-q">“the Faithful and True Witness”</span> who
+commanded John to write <span class="tei tei-q">“to the angel of
+the church of the Laodiceans,”</span> (3:14); for
+he who commanded John to <span class="tei tei-q">“write in a book
+and send it unto the seven churches”</span> of Asia
+(1:11), was the One whom John saw <span class="tei tei-q">“in
+the midst of the seven candlesticks, like unto
+the Son of man”</span> (1:13), and who announced
+himself as <span class="tei tei-q">“the Alpha and Omega,
+the beginning and the ending, saith the Lord,
+which is, and which was, and which is to
+come—the Almighty,”</span> 1:8. <span class="tei tei-q">“The Word
+of God,”</span> was the <span class="tei tei-q">“Word”</span> that was <span class="tei tei-q">“in the
+beginning,”</span> that <span class="tei tei-q">“was with God,”</span> and that
+<span class="tei tei-q">“was God,”</span> the same that was <span class="tei tei-q">“in the beginning
+with God,”</span> and which <span class="tei tei-q">“was made
+flesh and dwelt among us, and we beheld his
+glory, the glory as of the only begotten of the
+Father, full of grace and truth,”</span> John 1:1-14.
+Jesus is <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lamb of God which
+taketh away the sin of the world,”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>,
+29); and <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lamb”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“is Lord of lords and
+King of kings,”</span> 17:14. It is <span class="tei tei-q">“Jesus Christ,
+who is the faithful witness, and the first
+begotten of the dead, and the Prince of the
+kings of the earth,”</span> (1:5); and he alone is
+possessed of that incomprehensible <span class="tei tei-q">“Name”</span>
+which no man knoweth, and which he hath
+promised to write on <span class="tei tei-q">“him that overcometh,”</span>
+3:12.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+That the visible and personal coming of
+Christ, and not any providential interposition,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page326">[pg 326]</span><a name="Pg326" id="Pg326" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+is here symbolized, is self-evident. For,
+while no created object can adequately symbolize
+Him, it would derogate from the dignity
+of his character and position to be a
+symbol of some inferior object. In all mere
+providential interpositions, foreshown by symbolic
+imagery, the predicted events are represented
+by corresponding acts of symbolic
+agents. War between nations is symbolized
+by beasts, representatives of the nations, contending
+with each other. (See Dan. 8th chap.)
+Pestilence and famine are symbolized by analogous
+results, and not by Christ's appearing.
+When, therefore, he is seen coming in person,
+it must symbolize his personal advent.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His eyes <span class="tei tei-q">“as a flame of fire,”</span> show his
+identity with the one <span class="tei tei-q">“like unto the Son
+of man”</span> in the <span class="tei tei-q">“midst of the seven candlesticks”</span>
+(1:13), the author of the message
+to <span class="tei tei-q">“the church in Thyatira;”</span> which
+<span class="tei tei-q">“things saith the Son of God, who hath his
+eyes like unto a flame of fire, and his feet
+like unto fine brass,”</span> 2:18.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His <span class="tei tei-q">“many crowns”</span> are symbols of his
+sovereignty. Rome undivided and mistress of
+the world, when symbolized by the seven-headed
+and ten-horned dragon, is represented
+with the crowns on the heads, which were
+the seven successive kinds of government by
+which its sovereignty was enforced, 12:3,
+and 17:9, 10. But when its imperial had
+given place to its decem-regal form, and it is
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page327">[pg 327]</span><a name="Pg327" id="Pg327" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+to be shown under the government of ten
+contemporaneous kingdoms, <span class="tei tei-q">“the crowns,”</span>
+the symbols of sovereignty, are represented
+as encircling the <span class="tei tei-q">“horns”</span> of the beast, 13:1.
+So, when <span class="tei tei-q">“the King of kings”</span> cometh,
+to take to himself his great power, and to
+reign, and <span class="tei tei-q">“the kingdoms of this world are
+become those of our Lord and of his Christ”</span>
+(11:15, 17), He, <span class="tei tei-q">“the head of all principality
+and power”</span> (Col. 2:10), at whose
+name <span class="tei tei-q">“every knee should bow”</span> (Phil. 2:9),
+is shown the wearer of <span class="tei tei-q">“many crowns.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Come, then, and, added to thy many crowns,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Receive yet one, the crown of all the Earth,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Thou who alone art worthy! It was thine</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">By ancient covenant, ere nature's birth;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And thou hast made it thine by purchase since,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">And overpaid its value with thy blood.”</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 10.00em"><span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Cowper's Task.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His <span class="tei tei-q">“vesture dipped in blood”</span> is symbolic
+of his coming to tread <span class="tei tei-q">“the wine-press of the
+fierceness and wrath of Almighty God”</span> (19:15),
+when he shall <span class="tei tei-q">“smite the nations,”</span> and
+<span class="tei tei-q">“rule them with a rod of iron,”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>) Thus
+Isaiah prophesied: <span class="tei tei-q">“Who is this that cometh
+from Edom, with dyed garments from Bozrah?
+this that is glorious in his apparel,
+travelling in the greatness of his strength? I
+that speak in righteousness, mighty to save.
+Wherefore art thou red in thine apparel, and
+thy garments like him that treadeth in the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page328">[pg 328]</span><a name="Pg328" id="Pg328" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+wine-fat? I have trodden the wine-press
+alone; and of the people there was none with
+me: for I will tread them in mine anger, and
+trample them in my fury; and their blood
+shall be sprinkled upon my garments, and I
+will stain all my raiment. For the day of
+vengeance is in my heart, and the year of
+my redeemed is come. And I looked, and
+there was none to help; and I wondered that
+there was none to uphold: therefore mine
+own arm brought salvation unto me; and my
+fury, it upheld me. And I will tread down
+the people in mine anger, and make them
+drunk in my fury, and I will bring down their
+strength to the earth,”</span> Isa. 63:1-6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“armies”</span> which follow him, symbolize
+the attending saints and angels who
+will accompany his advent. They are all
+<span class="tei tei-q">“clothed in fine linen, white and clean,”</span>
+which constituted the wedding garments of
+those who were called to the marriage-supper
+of the Lamb, and which was worn by those
+who had washed their robes, and made them
+white in his blood, (7:14); <span class="tei tei-q">“for the fine
+linen is the righteousness of saints,”</span> 19:8.
+The righteous being caught up in the clouds
+to meet the Lord in the air (1 Thess. 4:17),
+<span class="tei tei-q">“when Christ, who is our life shall appear,”</span>
+they will <span class="tei tei-q">“appear with him in glory,”</span> (Col.
+3:4); so that <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lord my God shall come
+and all the saints with thee,”</span> Zech. 14:5.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Enoch also, the seventh from Adam, prophesied
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page329">[pg 329]</span><a name="Pg329" id="Pg329" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of these, saying, Behold, the Lord
+cometh with ten thousand of his saints, to
+execute judgment upon all, and to convince
+all that are ungodly among them of all their
+ungodly deeds which they have ungodly
+committed, and of all their hard speeches
+which ungodly sinners have spoken against
+him,”</span> Jude 14, 15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Not only saints, but angels also, will attend
+his coming. For <span class="tei tei-q">“when the Son of man
+shall come in his glory,”</span> there will be <span class="tei tei-q">“all
+the holy angels with him,”</span> Matt. 25:31.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“He cometh in the glory of his Father, with
+the holy angels,”</span> Mark 8:38. <span class="tei tei-q">“The Lord
+Jesus shall be revealed from heaven with his
+mighty angels,”</span> 2 Thess. 1:7.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“sharp sword,”</span> going out of his
+mouth, must be a symbol of his word. He
+speaks, and it is done, Psa. 33:9. <span class="tei tei-q">“For
+the word of God is quick and powerful, and
+sharper than any two-edged sword, piercing
+even to the dividing asunder of soul and
+spirit, and of the joints and marrow, and is a
+discerner of the thoughts and intents of the
+heart,”</span> Heb. 4:12. As <span class="tei tei-q">“he shall smite the
+earth with the rod of his mouth, and with
+the breath of his lips shall he slay the
+wicked,”</span> (Isa. 11:4); and as <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lord shall
+consume”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“that Wicked”</span> one <span class="tei tei-q">“with the spirit
+of his mouth”</span> (2 Thess. 2:8), it follows
+that the sword proceeding out of his mouth
+is a symbol of the words he shall speak for
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page330">[pg 330]</span><a name="Pg330" id="Pg330" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+their destruction; for with it he smites the
+nations, 19:15. And this he does when he
+comes to <span class="tei tei-q">“rule them with a rod of iron”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>)
+and tread them in <span class="tei tei-q">“the wine-press”</span> of the
+wrath of God. This brings us to the object
+of his coming, which is to <span class="tei tei-q">“judge and make
+war,”</span> 19:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+And first, <span class="tei tei-q">“To judge.”</span> This proves, that
+Christ's second advent is here symbolized;
+for, as before quoted, he is to <span class="tei tei-q">“judge the
+quick and the dead at his appearing and
+kingdom,”</span> 2 Tim. 4:1. This is at the
+sounding of the seventh trumpet, for then is
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the time of the dead that they should be
+judged,”</span> 11:18. <span class="tei tei-q">“With righteousness shall
+he judge the poor, and reprove with equity
+for the meek of the earth,”</span> when he <span class="tei tei-q">“shall
+smite the earth with the rod of his mouth,
+and with the breath of his lips shall he slay
+the wicked,”</span> Isa. 11:4. <span class="tei tei-q">“Let the heavens
+rejoice, and let the earth be glad; let the sea
+roar, and the fulness thereof. Let the field
+be joyful, and all that is therein: then shall
+all the trees of the wood rejoice before the
+Lord: for he cometh to judge the earth: he
+shall judge the world with righteousness, and
+the people with truth,”</span> Psa. 96:11-13. He
+cometh <span class="tei tei-q">“to execute judgment upon all,”</span>
+Jude 15.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+To <span class="tei tei-q">“make war.”</span> That this is another
+object of his coming, is shown by:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page331">[pg 331]</span><a name="Pg331" id="Pg331" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Final Conflict.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw an angel standing in the sun; and he cried
+with a loud voice, saying to all the birds flying in the midst
+of heaven, Come! gather yourselves to the great supper of
+God; that ye may eat the flesh of kings, and the flesh of
+commanders, and the flesh of the mighty, and the flesh of
+the horses, and of those who sit on them, and the flesh of
+all, both free and bond, both small and great. And I saw
+the wild beast, and the kings of the earth, and their armies,
+gathered to make war with him, who sat on the horse, and
+with his army. And the wild beast was taken, and with
+him the false prophet, who wrought signs in his sight, with
+which he had deceived those who received the mark of the
+wild beast, and those who worshipped his image. These
+two were cast alive into the lake of fire burning with brimstone.
+And the rest were slain with the sword of him who
+sat on the horse, which sword goeth forth from his mouth;
+and all the birds were filled with their flesh.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 19:17-21.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The contest being between the Lord and his
+armies on the one part, and the wicked nations
+on the other, the angel seen standing in the sun
+and performing an important act in connection
+with the Lord's army, must represent one
+of his attending angels; for the acts to be performed
+are to be by their instrumentality:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In the end of this world, the Son of man
+shall send forth his angels, and they shall
+gather out of his kingdom all things that
+offend, and them which do iniquity; and
+shall cast them into a furnace of fire,”</span> Matt.
+13:40-42.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His crying to the fowls of heaven to come
+and sup on the bodies of the slain, is indicative
+of the certainty of victory and of the entire
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page332">[pg 332]</span><a name="Pg332" id="Pg332" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+overthrow of those who war against the Lamb.
+As birds gather on fields of slaughter to feast
+on the slain, so a cry to <span class="tei tei-q">“all the fowls of
+heaven”</span> is expressive of the extent and
+thoroughness of the destruction to be inflicted.
+It is the same cry which is made in Ezekiel,
+39:17, when the armies of Gog are slain on
+the mountains of Israel. The beast and the
+kings of the earth symbolize the various governments
+in the world. The <span class="tei tei-q">“beast”</span> is that
+which had seven heads and ten horns (13:1,
+and 17:3), and was a symbol of Rome in its
+decem-regal form. It was said of this beast,
+it shall <span class="tei tei-q">“go into perdition,”</span> (17:8); so that
+under some manifestation, it must continue
+till the end of the world: the earth being
+<span class="tei tei-q">“reserved unto fire against the day of judgement,
+and perdition of ungodly men,”</span> 2 Pet.
+3:7. As only in its divided form, the Roman
+empire continues till then, the beast is here significant
+of the divisions represented by its ten
+horns—the governments of modern Europe.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“These shall war with the Lamb, and the
+Lamb shall overcome them: for he is Lord of
+lords and King of kings; and they that are
+with him are called and chosen and faithful,”</span>
+17:14.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The false prophet,”</span> which is taken with
+the beast, is described as the one <span class="tei tei-q">“that wrought
+miracles before him, with which he deceived
+them that had received the mark of the beast
+and them that worshipped his image,”</span> v. 20.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page333">[pg 333]</span><a name="Pg333" id="Pg333" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+This identifies him as the two-horned beast
+of Rev. 13. (13:11-17). The two-horned
+beast being a representative of the Eastern Roman
+empire, when that was subverted by the
+Turks it became the seat of the false prophet,—the
+Mahometan hierarchy.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The kings of the earth must be the remaining
+governments which are not represented by
+those two. By their subsequently warring
+with the Lamb, it follows that the previous
+resurrection and translation of the saints does
+not produce a cessation of all government.
+Those events may not be apparent to all eyes;
+or they may serve only to madden the unbelieving,
+and to make them more desperate in
+their infidelity.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They gather their armies to war against
+the Lamb. They resist his authority. They
+will not have Him to reign over them. They
+are instigated to oppose him by <span class="tei tei-q">“unclean
+spirits like frogs”</span> (16:13), which are the
+spirits of devils [<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span>, understood by the
+Jews to be spirits of the wicked dead] working
+miracles, which go forth unto the kings
+of the earth and of the whole world, to gather
+them to the battle of that great day of God
+Almighty, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> v. 14. This is when Christ is
+to <span class="tei tei-q">“come as a thief;”</span> and they are to be
+gathered <span class="tei tei-q">“into a place called in the Hebrew
+tongue Armageddon,”</span> 16:15, 16. This was
+the name of the valley at the foot of Mount
+Megiddo (Judg. 5:19), which was famous as
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page334">[pg 334]</span><a name="Pg334" id="Pg334" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a valley of slaughter. In it Jehu fought
+against Ahaziah and Joram, and slew both
+the kings of Israel and Judah, 2 Kings 9:27.
+It was afterwards memorable for the death of
+king Josiah, when Pharaoh-necho fought
+against him, (2 Kings 23:29); so that the
+mourning as <span class="tei tei-q">“in the valley of Megiddon,”</span> became
+a proverbial expression in Israel for
+great mourning, Zech. 12:11,12. It is therefore
+significantly applied to the final battle.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Thus do <span class="tei tei-q">“the kings of the earth set themselves,
+and the rulers take counsel together
+against the Lord, and against his Anointed;”</span>
+but <span class="tei tei-q">“He that sitteth in the heavens shall
+laugh; the Lord shall have them in derision.”</span>
+For the decree has gone forth: <span class="tei tei-q">“I
+shall give thee the heathen for thine inheritance,
+and the uttermost parts of the earth for
+thy possession. Thou shalt break them with
+a rod of iron; thou shalt dash them in pieces
+like a potter's vessel,”</span> Ps. 2:2-9. In this
+victory the saints, also, have a part; for it is
+written: <span class="tei tei-q">“He that overcometh, and keepeth
+my works unto the end, to him will I give
+power over the nations, and he shall rule
+them with a rod of iron; as the vessels of a
+potter shall they be broken to shivers: even
+as I received of my Father,”</span> 2:26, 27.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As thus predicted, in this final conflict
+the nations are smitten, 19:15. Those symbolized
+by the beast and false prophet are
+cast alive into the burning flame; <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page335">[pg 335]</span><a name="Pg335" id="Pg335" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+individuals constituting the bodies of those
+beasts are cast therein: their governments
+cease when taken by the Lamb and his
+armies. This is in accordance with what
+Daniel saw, who <span class="tei tei-q">“beheld, even till the beast
+was slain, and his body destroyed and given
+to the burning flame,”</span> Dan. 7:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The remnant”</span> also are slain; so that there
+are none left alive on the earth of all the
+wicked. Thus Daniel interpreted to king
+Nebuchadnezzar his dream: <span class="tei tei-q">“Thou sawest
+till that a stone was cut out without hands,
+which smote the image [representing the governments
+of earth] upon his feet, that were
+of iron and clay, and brake them to pieces.
+Then was the iron, the clay, the brass, the silver,
+and the gold broken to pieces together, and
+became like the chaff of the summer threshing-floors;
+and the wind carried them away,
+that no place was found for them,”</span> Dan.
+2:34, 35. It will <span class="tei tei-q">“break in pieces, and
+consume all these kingdoms”</span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>), according
+to the prediction: <span class="tei tei-q">“The nation and kingdom
+that will not serve thee shall perish;
+yea, those nations shall be utterly wasted,”</span>
+Isa. 60:12. <span class="tei tei-q">“And this shall be the plague
+wherewith the Lord will smite all the people
+which have fought against Jerusalem:
+Their flesh shall consume away while they
+stand upon their feet, and their eyes shall consume
+away in their holes, and their tongues
+shall consume away in their mouth,”</span> Zech. 14:12.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page336">[pg 336]</span><a name="Pg336" id="Pg336" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For, behold, the day cometh, that shall
+burn as an oven; and all the proud, yea, and
+all that do wickedly shall be stubble, and the
+day that cometh shall burn them up, saith
+the Lord of hosts, that it shall leave them
+neither root nor branch,”</span> Mal. 4:1. <span class="tei tei-q">“Behold,
+the day of the Lord cometh, cruel both with
+wrath and fierce anger, to lay the land desolate:
+and he shall destroy the sinners thereof
+out of it,”</span> Isa. 13:9. Thus will the Saviour
+come <span class="tei tei-q">“in flaming fire, taking vengeance
+on them that know not God, and obey not the
+gospel of our Lord Jesus Christ; who shall be
+punished with everlasting destruction, from
+the presence of the Lord, and from the glory
+of his power, when he comes to be glorified in
+his saints, and to be admired in all them that
+believe in that day,”</span> (2 Thess. 1:8-10): saying
+to the nations on his left, <span class="tei tei-q">“Depart from
+me ye cursed, into everlasting fire, prepared
+for the devil and his angels,”</span> Matt. 25:41.
+Thus will he <span class="tei tei-q">“gather out of his kingdom all
+things that offend, and them which do iniquity,
+and shall cast them into a furnace of
+fire: there shall be wailing and gnashing of
+teeth,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span>, 13:41, 42. The destruction of
+all the wicked from the earth is followed by:
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Binding of Satan.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw an angel descending from heaven, having
+the key of the abyss and a great chain in his hand. And
+he seized the dragon, the old serpent, who is the Devil, and
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page337">[pg 337]</span><a name="Pg337" id="Pg337" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+Satan, and bound him a thousand years, and cast him into
+the abyss, and shut him up, and set a seal over him, that
+he should deceive the nations no more, till the thousand
+years were completed; and after that, he must be loosed a
+short time.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 20:1-3.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The angel descending from heaven, must
+be a representative of his own order; for at
+this epoch there are no other orders of beings
+for him to be a representative of. He therefore
+symbolizes the angels who are commissioned
+to <span class="tei tei-q">“gather out of his kingdom all
+things that offend,”</span> Matt. 13:41.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“key,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“pit,”</span> and <span class="tei tei-q">“chain,”</span> symbolize
+the instruments of restraint and confinement to
+which Satan is to be subjected; and his being
+bound and confined symbolize his restraint.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“Dragon”</span> is expressly called <span class="tei tei-q">“that
+old serpent, which is the Devil and Satan.”</span>
+With the appendages of heads and horns—symbols
+of political sovereignty—he is used
+in Rev. 12:3, as a symbol of the Roman
+civil power, under Pagan rule; and in verse
+7, when divested of political insignia, of the
+pagan hierarchy. But now, as the beast,
+another symbol of Roman civil rule, has been
+cast into <span class="tei tei-q">“the lake of fire and brimstone,”</span> and
+the <span class="tei tei-q">“remnant”</span> are <span class="tei tei-q">“slain with the sword”</span>
+(19:21), there are no analogous powers
+remaining on earth for him to be a representative
+of, and consequently he is here represented
+as a symbol of himself.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Of his identity there can be no question:
+He is <span class="tei tei-q">“that Old Serpent,”</span> who, being
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page338">[pg 338]</span><a name="Pg338" id="Pg338" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“more subtle than any beast of the field
+which the Lord God had made”</span> (Gen. 3:1),
+<span class="tei tei-q">“beguiled Eve through his subtlety,”</span> 2 Cor.
+11:3. He is also the Devil, by whom our
+Saviour was tempted in the wilderness,
+(Matt. 4:1-12); and the Satan, whose working
+is <span class="tei tei-q">“with all power and signs and lying
+wonders,”</span> 2 Thess. 2:9. He is our adversary
+the devil, who, <span class="tei tei-q">“as a roaring lion, walketh
+about seeking whom he may devour,”</span>
+(1 Pet. 5:8); and against whom we are to
+guard continually, <span class="tei tei-q">“lest Satan should get an
+advantage of us,”</span> 2 Cor. 2:11.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Coëval with the fall, the promise was
+given that his head should in due time be
+bruised, and he is not ignorant of his doom;
+for when the legion saw the Saviour about to
+dispossess them of the two men among the
+tombs, they recognized him as <span class="tei tei-q">“the Son of
+God,”</span> and cried, <span class="tei tei-q">“Art thou come hither to
+torment us before <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">the time</span></em>?”</span> (Matt. 8:29);
+<span class="tei tei-q">“and they besought him, that he would not
+command them to go out into the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">deep</span></em>,”</span>—the
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">pit</span></em>, or <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">abyss</span></em>, Luke 8:31. The epoch when
+he should be there confined, is also shown by
+Isaiah to be when <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lord cometh out of
+his place to punish the inhabitants of the
+earth for their iniquity,”</span> when <span class="tei tei-q">“the earth
+also shall disclose her blood, and no more
+cover her slain,”</span> Isa. 26:21. For <span class="tei tei-q">“in that
+day the Lord with his sore and great and
+strong sword shall punish leviathan [the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page339">[pg 339]</span><a name="Pg339" id="Pg339" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+dragon], the piercing serpent, even leviathan
+that crooked serpent,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> 27:1. This synchronizes
+with the slaying of the remnant
+with the sword, when Satan is bound and
+cast into the <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">abyss</span></em>, to continue there a thousand
+years.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+His being bound and confined must symbolize
+his dejection to a position where he can
+have no possible influence over the nations
+during the time he is bound. It can be no
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">partial</span></em> restraint, as some theologians hold;
+for that is contrary to the conditions of the
+symbolic representation. His restraint is
+full, complete, and entire. Consequently his
+influence, for the time being, will have entirely
+ceased. The period of his confinement,
+therefore, cannot be one of partial exemption
+from sin; but the living will be perfectly free
+from all its contagious influences. He is to
+deceive the nations <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">no more</span></em>, till the thousand
+years shall be fulfilled.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The nations”</span> who are freed from his
+influences, and also those whom he is subsequently
+to deceive, are not, necessarily, organized
+political bodies, under civil rulers, as
+they now exist. The original term, εθνος, is
+defined by Robinson to be <span class="tei tei-q">“a multitude,
+people, race, belonging and living together.”</span>
+At this epoch, the national organizations having
+disappeared, and the people constituting
+them being translated or slain, the only
+nations remaining will be <span class="tei tei-q">“the nations of
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page340">[pg 340]</span><a name="Pg340" id="Pg340" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+them which are saved”</span> (21:24), over whom
+the influence of Satan will have ceased forever;
+and those constituting <span class="tei tei-q">“the rest of
+the dead”</span> (20:5), who will not live again
+till the end of the thousand years—at the very
+time when Satan is to be loosed from his
+prison to go out to deceive them, 20:7, 8.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Cleansing of the Earth.</span></h2>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+There is, in the Apocalypse, no symbolic
+representation of the act of the cleansing of
+the earth, yet various scriptures show that it
+is at the epoch of the second advent, and of
+the establishment of the kingdom of God. If
+so, it follows the destruction of the wicked
+and the binding of Satan, while the raised and
+transfigured saints—constituting <span class="tei tei-q">“the bride”</span>—are
+still with the Lord in the clouds of
+heaven (19:7-9), where they were caught
+up to meet him in the air, 1 Thess. 4:17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+A restoration of the earth, in connection
+with the first resurrection, is in accordance
+with the testimony of scripture, and was the
+opinion of the ancients. We read in Isaiah:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Behold, I create new heavens and a new
+earth: and the former shall not be remembered,
+nor come into mind,”</span> Isa. 65:17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“As for my opinion,”</span> saith R. Menasse, a
+Jewish Rabbi, <span class="tei tei-q">“I think that after six thousand
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page341">[pg 341]</span><a name="Pg341" id="Pg341" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+years, the world shall be destroyed, upon one
+certain day, or in one hour; that the arches
+of heaven shall make a stand as immovable;
+that there will be no more generation or corruption;
+and that all things by the resurrection
+shall be renovated, and return to a better
+condition.”</span> He also assures us that <span class="tei tei-q">“this,
+without doubt, is the opinion of the most
+learned Aben Ezra,”</span> who looked for it in the
+new earth of Isa. 65:17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Man shall be restored in that time,
+namely, in the days of the Messiah, to that
+state in which he was before the first man
+sinned.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">R. Moses Nachmanides in Duet.
+§ 45.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Although all things were created perfect,
+yet when the first man sinned, they were
+corrupted, and will not again return to their
+congruous state till <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Pherez</span></span> (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>,
+the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Messiah</span></span>)
+comes.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“There are six things which
+shall be restored to their primitive state, viz.:
+the splendor of man, his life, the height of his
+stature, the fruits of the earth, the fruits of
+the trees, and the luminaries, (the sun, moon, and
+stars.)”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">R. Berakyah</span></span>, in the <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">name of
+R. Samuel—Bereshith Rabba, Fol. 11, Col. 3</span></span>.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In that time (<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, of the Messiah) the
+whole work of creation shall be changed for
+the better, and shall return into its perfect
+and pure state, as it was in the time of the
+first man, before he had sinned.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">R. Becai,
+in Shilcan Orba, Fol. 9, Col. 4, p. 360.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page342">[pg 342]</span><a name="Pg342" id="Pg342" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Theopompus, who flourished three hundred
+and forty years B. C., relates that the
+Persian Magi taught that the present state of
+things would continue 6000 years; after which
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">hades</span></span>, or death, would be destroyed, and men
+would live happy,”</span> &amp;c. <span class="tei tei-q">“The opinion of the
+ancient Jews, on this head, may be gathered
+from the statement of one of their Rabbins,
+who said, <span class="tei tei-q">‘The world endures 6000 years,
+and in the thousand, or millennium that follows,
+the enemies of God would be destroyed.’</span>
+It was in like manner a tradition of the house
+of Elias, a holy man, who lived about B. C.
+200, that the world was to endure 6000 years,
+and that the righteous, whom God should
+raise up, would not be turned again into dust.
+That, by this resurrection, he meant a resurrection
+prior to the millennium, is manifest
+from what follows.... It is worthy of remark,
+that the two ancient authors, whose
+words have just been quoted, speak of the
+seventh millennium as <span class="tei tei-q">‘that day’</span>—the day
+in which God will renew the world, and in
+which he alone shall be exalted.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Dis. on
+Mill. by Bishop Russell, Prof. Eccl. Hist. in
+the Scottish Epis. Ch.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The Divine institution of a sabbatical,
+or seventh year's solemnity among the Jews,
+has a plain typical reference to the seventh
+chiliad, or millenary of the world, according
+to the well known tradition among the Jewish
+doctors, adopted by many in every age of
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page343">[pg 343]</span><a name="Pg343" id="Pg343" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+the Christian Church, that this world will
+attain to its limit at the end of 6000 years.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Mede.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The observance of the Sabbath is essential
+to the faith; for such only as observe the
+Sabbath confess that the earth will be renewed:
+because He who created it out of
+nothing will renew it.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">David Kimchi, on
+Isa. 55:5, quoted by Mede.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In as many days as this world was made,
+in so many thousand years it is perfected;
+for if the day of the Lord be as it were a
+1000 years, and in six days those things that
+are made were finished, it is manifest that
+the perfecting of those things is in the 6000th
+year, when anti-Christ, reigning 1260 years,
+shall have wasted all things in the world, ... then
+shall the Lord come from heaven in the
+clouds, with the glory of his Father.”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Irenæus,
+Bish. of Lyons, A. D. 178.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In six thousand years, the Lord will
+bring all things to an end, ... when iniquity
+shall be no more, all things being renewed by
+the Lord.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Epst. of Barnabas, sec. 14, 15.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Let philosophers know, who number
+thousands of years, ages since the beginning
+of the world, that the 6000th year is not yet
+concluded or ended. But that number being
+fulfilled, of necessity there must be an end,
+and the state of human things must be transformed
+into that which is better.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Lactantius,
+B. of Divine Inst., A. D. 310.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page344">[pg 344]</span><a name="Pg344" id="Pg344" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Thomas Burnet (Theory of Earth, Lon.
+1697) states <span class="tei tei-q">“that it was the received opinion
+of the primitive church from the days of the
+apostles to the council of Nice, that this earth
+would continue 6000 years, when the resurrection
+of the just, and conflagration of the
+earth, would usher in the millennium and
+reign of Christ on earth.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“God's blessing the Sabbath day, and resting
+on it from all his works, was a type of that
+glorious rest that the saints shall have when
+the six days of this world are fully ended....
+He will finish the toil and travail of his
+saints, with the burden of the beasts and the
+curse of the ground, and bring all into rest
+for a thousand years.... None ever saw
+this world as it was in its first creation but
+Adam and his wife, neither will any see it
+until the manifestation of the children of
+God; <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, until the redemption or resurrection
+of the saints.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">John Bunyan's Works,
+vol. 6, pp. 301, 329.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“I expect with Paul a reparation of <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">all</span></em> the
+evils caused by sin, for which he represents
+the creatures as groaning and travailing.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">John
+Calvin, in his </span><span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-style: italic">“</span><span style="font-style: italic">Institutes.</span><span style="font-style: italic">”</span></span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The reformation of the earth <span class="tei tei-q">“never was,
+nor yet shall be, till the righteous King and
+Judge appear for the restoration of all things.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">John
+Knox.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“The groans of nature in this nether world,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Which heaven has heard for ages, have an end.</div>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page345">[pg 345]</span><a name="Pg345" id="Pg345" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Foretold by prophets, and by poets sung,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Whose fire was kindled at the prophet's lamp,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The time of rest, the promised Sabbath, comes:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Six thousand years of sorrow have well nigh</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Fulfilled their tardy and disastrous course</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Over a sinful world; and what remains</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Of this tempestuous state of human things,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Is merely as the working of a sea</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Before a calm, that rocks itself to rest;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">For <span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">He</span></span>, whose car the winds are, and the clouds</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The dust that waits upon his sultry march,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">When sin hath moved him, and his wrath is hot,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Shall visit earth in mercy; shall descend,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Propitious, in his chariot paved with love;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And what his storms have blasted and defaced</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">For man's <em class="tei tei-emph" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">revolt</span></em>, shall with a smile
+<em class="tei tei-emph" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">repair</span></em>.”</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 6.00em"><span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Cowper's Task.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The above are only a few of many extracts
+which might be made, showing the faith of
+the church in past ages; but which are of
+no weight, only as they are in accordance
+with the harmony of scriptural testimony.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+When man sinned, this earth was cursed
+for his sake. The Lord said to him, <span class="tei tei-q">“Cursed
+is the ground for thy sake; in sorrow shalt
+thou eat of it all the days of thy life; thorns
+also and thistles shall it bring forth unto thee,
+and thou shalt eat the herb of the field; in
+the sweat of thy face shalt thou eat bread,
+till thou return unto the ground; for out of it
+wast thou taken: for dust thou art, and unto
+dust shalt thou return,”</span> Gen. 3:17-19.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Such was the curse to which the whole
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page346">[pg 346]</span><a name="Pg346" id="Pg346" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+creation was subjected because man sinned.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For the creature was made subject to vanity,
+not willingly, but by reason of him who
+hath subjected the same in hope,”</span> Rom. 8:20.
+And this hope is for a removal of the
+curse thus inflicted, and a restoration of all
+things to their original condition.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As the earth was subjected to the curse at
+the time when man was made subject to
+death, the removal of the former would naturally
+be expected at the epoch of the fulfillment
+of the promise to the just: <span class="tei tei-q">“I will ransom
+them from the power of the grave; I will
+redeem them from death: O death I will be
+thy plagues; O grave I will be thy destruction,”</span>
+Hos. 13:14. And thus Paul testifies:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For the earnest expectation of the creature
+waiteth for the manifestation of the sons of
+God, ... Because the creature itself, also,
+shall be delivered from the bondage of corruption
+into the glorious liberty of the children
+of God. For we know that the whole creation
+groaneth and travaileth in pain together
+until now. And not only they, but ourselves
+also, which have the first fruits of the Spirit,
+even we ourselves groan within ourselves,
+waiting for the adoption, to wit, the redemption
+of our body,”</span> Rom. 8:19, 21-23.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The removal of the curse removes also its
+consequences. Thus it is promised: <span class="tei tei-q">“Instead
+of the thorn shall come up the fir tree, and
+instead of the briar shall come up the myrtle
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page347">[pg 347]</span><a name="Pg347" id="Pg347" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+tree,”</span> Isa. 55:13. <span class="tei tei-q">“The inhabitant shall
+not say I am sick: the people that dwell
+therein shall be forgiven their iniquity,”</span> Isa.
+33:24. <span class="tei tei-q">“He will swallow up death in victory;
+and the Lord God will wipe away
+tears from off all faces; and the rebuke of
+his people will he take away from off all the
+earth; for the Lord hath spoken it,”</span> Isa. 25:8.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“For behold, I create new heavens and a
+new earth,”</span> Isa. 65:17. <span class="tei tei-q">“And there shall
+be no more curse,”</span> Rev. 22:3. <span class="tei tei-q">“For the
+Lord shall comfort Zion: he will comfort all
+her waste places; and he will make her
+wilderness like Eden, and her desert like the
+garden of the Lord; joy and gladness shall
+be found therein, thanksgiving, and the voice
+of melody,”</span> Isa. 51:3.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The removal of the curse is called <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+regeneration”</span> (Matt. 19:28), <span class="tei tei-q">“the times of
+refreshing,”</span> and of <span class="tei tei-q">“restitution;”</span> which Peter
+places at the advent of Christ: <span class="tei tei-q">“whom
+the heavens must receive until the times of
+restitution<a id="noteref_10" name="noteref_10" href="#note_10"><span class="tei tei-noteref"><span style="font-size: 60%; vertical-align: super">10</span></span></a> of all things, which God hath
+spoken by the mouth of all his holy prophets
+since the world began,”</span> Acts 3:21. He
+also places it at <span class="tei tei-q">“the perdition of ungodly
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page348">[pg 348]</span><a name="Pg348" id="Pg348" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+men,”</span> which must synchronize with the epoch
+when the beast <span class="tei tei-q">“goeth into perdition”</span> (17:11),
+and <span class="tei tei-q">“the remnant”</span> are <span class="tei tei-q">“slain with the
+sword,”</span> (19:21); <span class="tei tei-q">“when the Lord Jesus
+shall be revealed from heaven, with his
+mighty angels, in flaming fire taking vengeance
+on them that know not God, and
+that obey not the gospel of our Lord Jesus
+Christ,”</span> 2 Thess. 1:7, 8. Says Peter: <span class="tei tei-q">“The
+heavens and the earth, which are now, by
+the same word [<span class="tei tei-q">‘whereby the world that
+then was, being overflowed with water, perished’</span>
+v.6] are kept in store, reserved unto
+fire, against the day of judgment, and perdition
+of ungodly men.... But the day of the
+Lord will come, as a thief in the night; in
+the which the heavens shall pass away with
+a great noise, and the elements shall melt
+with fervent heat, the earth also; and the
+works that are therein shall be burned up....
+Nevertheless, we, according to his promise,
+look for new heavens and a new earth,
+wherein dwelleth righteousness,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, <span class="tei tei-q">“righteous
+persons”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Horsely</span></span>, 2 Pet. 3:7-13.
+This harmonizes with the day that <span class="tei tei-q">“cometh
+that shall burn as an oven,”</span> when <span class="tei tei-q">“all the
+proud, yea, and all that do wickedly”</span> shall be
+burned up, and become <span class="tei tei-q">“ashes under the
+soles”</span> of those on whom <span class="tei tei-q">“shall the Sun of
+righteousness arise,”</span> (Mal. 4:1-3); which
+must be the time intervening between the
+resurrection of the righteous and that of the
+wicked. This also harmonizes with the testimony
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page349">[pg 349]</span><a name="Pg349" id="Pg349" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of our Saviour, that when, <span class="tei tei-q">“in the
+end of this world,”</span> He <span class="tei tei-q">“shall send forth his
+angels and gather out of his kingdom all
+things that offend, and them which do iniquity,
+and shall cast them into a furnace of
+fire; ... <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">then</span></em> shall the righteous shine forth
+as the sun in the kingdom of their Father,”</span>
+Matt. 13:40-43.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The earth being cleansed, and all things
+made new, it will have been prepared for the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“dwelling”</span> of <span class="tei tei-q">“righteous persons”</span> (2 Pet. 3:13),
+who,—having <span class="tei tei-q">“put on incorruption”</span>
+(1 Cor. 15:53), and been <span class="tei tei-q">“caught up ... in
+the clouds to meet the Lord in the air”</span> (1 Thess. 4:17),
+where, constituting <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+bride,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lamb's wife,”</span> they were <span class="tei tei-q">“called
+unto the marriage supper of the Lamb”</span>
+(19:7-9),—will descend from heaven to
+take possession. Thus John writes, that one
+of the angels said to him: <span class="tei tei-q">“Come hither, I
+will show thee the bride, the Lamb's wife.
+And he carried me away in the spirit to a
+great and high mountain, and he showed me
+that great city, the holy Jerusalem, descending
+out of heaven from God,”</span> 21:9, 10.
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Lo, what a glorious sight appears</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">To our believing eyes:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The earth and seas are passed away,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And the old rolling skies!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">From the third heaven where God resides,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">That holy, happy place,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The New Jerusalem comes down</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Adorned with shining grace.</div>
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page350">[pg 350]</span><a name="Pg350" id="Pg350" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Attending angels shout for joy,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And the bright armies sing,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Mortals, behold the sacred seat</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">Of your descending
+King.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Watts.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Kingdom given to the Saints at the resurrection of the just.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw thrones, and they sat on them, and judgment
+was given for them: and I saw the persons of those
+beheaded for the testimony of Jesus, and for the word of
+God, and those, who had not worshipped the wild beast,
+nor his image, nor had received the mark on their forehead,
+or on their hand; and they lived and reigned with Christ
+the thousand years. But the rest of the dead lived not
+until the thousand years were completed. This is the first
+resurrection. Happy and holy is he, who bath part in the
+first resurrection: on such, the second death hath no power,
+but they will be priests of God and of Christ, and will reign
+with him a thousand years!</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 20:4-6.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Thrones”</span> are symbols of power. As the
+saints are to reign with Christ on the renewed
+earth, in obedience to the invitation: <span class="tei tei-q">“Come
+ye blessed of my Father, inherit the kingdom
+prepared for you from the foundation of the
+world,”</span> (Matt. 25:34); their being inducted
+into the kingdom is symbolized by their being
+seated on thrones. Thus they sing in the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“new song,”</span> addressed to Christ: <span class="tei tei-q">“Thou
+wast slain, and hast redeemed us to God by
+thy blood, out of every kindred, and tongue,
+and people, and nation, and hast made us
+unto our God kings and priests: and we shall
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page351">[pg 351]</span><a name="Pg351" id="Pg351" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+reign on the earth,”</span> 5:9, 10. In the first
+chapter, also, all who ascribe praises to <span class="tei tei-q">“Him
+that loved us, and washed us from our sins in
+his own blood,”</span> also add: <span class="tei tei-q">“and hath made
+us kings and priests unto God, and his Father,”</span>
+1:5, 6.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+All the saints being thus exalted to kingly
+and priestly dignity, symbolizes the exalted
+rank they are to hold in the new creation—the
+symbols of their station being taken from
+the most exalted offices known on earth.
+Thus God said to ancient Israel: <span class="tei tei-q">“Ye shall
+be unto me a kingdom of priests, and a holy
+nation,”</span> (Ex. 19:6); and the Christian church
+is addressed as <span class="tei tei-q">“a chosen generation, a royal
+priesthood, a holy nation, a peculiar people,”</span>
+1 Pet. 2:9.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The time when the saints shall reign on the
+earth is in connection with the destruction of
+the <span class="tei tei-q">“little horn”</span> of Daniel's <span class="tei tei-q">“fourth beast,”</span>
+which, as he saw, <span class="tei tei-q">“made war with the saints
+and prevailed against them, until the Ancient
+of days came, and judgment was given to the
+saints of the Most High, and the time came
+that the saints possessed the kingdom,”</span> Dan. 7:21, 22.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The saints of the Most High
+shall take the kingdom, and possess the kingdom
+forever, even forever and ever,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> v. 18.
+<span class="tei tei-q">“And the kingdom and dominion and the
+greatness of the kingdom under the whole
+heaven, shall be given to the people of the
+saints of the Most High, whose kingdom is
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page352">[pg 352]</span><a name="Pg352" id="Pg352" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+an everlasting kingdom, and all dominions
+shall serve and obey him,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ib.</span></span> v. 27. <span class="tei tei-q">“And
+they shall reign forever and ever,”</span> 22:5.
+Thus the Saviour said: <span class="tei tei-q">“Fear not, little
+flock; for it is your Father's good pleasure
+to give you the kingdom,”</span> Luke 12:32.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Those who receive the kingdom are symbolized
+by the souls of martyrs, &amp;c., living
+again and reigning with Christ. The symbol
+includes, with the martyred saints, those
+who had stood aloof from the worship of the
+beast and his image, and those who had not
+received his mark; who are shown by a parallel
+scripture to represent all who are redeemed
+to God <span class="tei tei-q">“out of every kindred, and tongue,
+and people, and nation,”</span> 5:9, 10. Some of
+these were symbolized, under the fifth seal, as
+crying from under the altar in anticipation
+of this day, 6:9. Now, with <span class="tei tei-q">“their fellow
+servants,”</span> they receive their reward.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The souls of the departed living again, can
+only symbolize those who have been subjected
+to death, and are again raised. Consequently
+they are the subjects of a real resurrection.
+And this is shown by the explanation of the
+symbol, which affirms that, <span class="tei tei-q">“This is the first
+resurrection.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+It is denied by many that a literal resurrection
+is here taught; but in so doing they
+deny the faith of the church in its best and
+purest ages. In the first two centuries after
+Christ, there was not an individual, who believed
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page353">[pg 353]</span><a name="Pg353" id="Pg353" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+in any resurrection of the dead whose
+name or memory has survived to the present
+time, who denied that the resurrection of the
+just is here taught.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Eusebius, who opposed this view, quotes
+Papias, who he admits was a disciple of St.
+John and a companion of Polycarp, as saying
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“after the resurrection of the dead the
+kingdom of Christ shall be established corporeally
+on this earth.”</span> And Jerome, another
+opposer, quotes from him that <span class="tei tei-q">“he had the
+apostles for his authors; and that he considered
+what Andrew, what Peter said, what
+Philip, what Thomas said, and other disciples
+of the Lord.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Polycarp was another of John's disciples;
+and Irenæus testifies in an epistle to Florinus,
+that he had seen Polycarp, <span class="tei tei-q">“who related his
+conversation with John and others who had
+seen the Lord, and how he related their sayings,
+and the things he had heard of them
+concerning the Lord, both concerning his
+miracles and doctrine, as he had received
+them from the Lord of life; all of which
+Polycarp related agreeable to the scriptures.”</span>
+Following such a teacher, Irenæus taught that
+at the resurrection of the just, the meek should
+inherit the earth; and that then would be fulfilled
+the promise which God made to Abraham.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Justin Martyr, born A. D. 89, says that,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“A certain man <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">among us</span></em>, whose name is
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page354">[pg 354]</span><a name="Pg354" id="Pg354" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+John, being one of the twelve apostles of
+Christ, in that Revelation which was shown
+him, prophesied that those who believe in our
+Christ shall fulfil a thousand years at Jerusalem.”</span>
+He affirms that himself <span class="tei tei-q">“and many
+others are of this mind”</span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“that Christ shall
+reign personally on earth;”</span> and that <span class="tei tei-q">“all
+who were accounted orthodox so believed.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Tertullian, about A. D. 180, says it was a
+custom for Christians to pray that they might
+have part in the first resurrection. And
+Cyprian, about 220, says that Christians <span class="tei tei-q">“had
+a thirst for martyrdom that they might obtain
+a better resurrection.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Mosheim assures us that the opinion <span class="tei tei-q">“that
+Christ was to come and reign 1000 years
+among men,”</span> had, before the time of Origen,
+about the middle of the 3d century, <span class="tei tei-q">“met
+with no opposition.”</span> And it is the testimony
+of ecclesiastical historians, that the first who
+opposed it, seeing no way of avoiding the
+meaning of the words in Rev. 20th, denied
+the authenticity of the Apocalypse, and claimed
+that it was written by one Cerenthus, a
+heretic, for the very purpose of sustaining
+what they called <span class="tei tei-q">“his fiction of the reign of
+Christ on earth.”</span> This doctrine is not <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">now</span></em>
+evaded in this way, but by spiritualizing the
+language of the Apocalypse, and thus finding
+a meaning in it which is not expressed
+by any of the admitted laws of language.
+Theologians who thus reason make the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page355">[pg 355]</span><a name="Pg355" id="Pg355" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+first resurrection the conversion of the world.
+But those who are affirmed to be raised, are
+persons who have lived and are dead. If
+the resurrection is a mere metaphor, then the
+martyrs must have metaphorically died, and
+must have comprised only those who had been
+previously converted and were fallen away.
+The rest of the dead must then be understood
+as persons morally dead, which would be inconsistent
+with the idea of a converted world.
+Those who were raised being those who were
+previously converted, they must have been
+literally dead, and the only resurrection predicable
+of such is a literal resurrection.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Bible teaches such a resurrection of
+the righteous prior to that of the wicked.
+Thus the Psalmist says of them: <span class="tei tei-q">“Like
+sheep they are laid in the grave; death shall
+feed on them, and the upright shall have dominion
+over them in the morning.”</span> But of
+himself he says: <span class="tei tei-q">“But God will redeem my
+soul from the power of the grave,”</span> Psa. 49:14,
+15. Of the wicked Isaiah testifies: <span class="tei tei-q">“They
+are dead, they shall not live; they are deceased,
+they shall not rise,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span> with the
+righteous; but to Zion he says: <span class="tei tei-q">“Thy dead
+men shall live, together with my dead body
+shall they arise. Awake and sing, ye that
+dwell in the dust: for thy dew is as the dew
+of herbs, and the earth shall cast out her
+dead,”</span> Isa. 26:14, 19. To the same import
+is the prophecy of Daniel, respecting the time
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page356">[pg 356]</span><a name="Pg356" id="Pg356" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+when Michael shall stand up, and <span class="tei tei-q">“thy people
+shall be delivered, every one that shall be
+found written in the book. And many of
+them that sleep in the dust of the earth shall
+awake, some, [the awakened, shall be] to everlasting
+life, and some, [the unawakened, shall
+be] to shame and everlasting contempt,”</span> Dan.
+12:1, 2. Such, according to Prof. Bush, is the
+precise rendering of the original.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The New Testament also teaches a resurrection
+of the just, in distinction from that of the
+wicked. Paul says, while all are to be made
+alive, that it will be <span class="tei tei-q">“every man in his own
+order,”</span> or band—<span class="tei tei-q">“Christ the first fruits;
+afterwards they that are Christ's at his coming,”</span>
+1 Cor. 15:23. None others are spoken
+of as being raised at that epoch. When the
+Lord descends from heaven with a shout, at
+the trump of God, not the entire mass of the
+dead, but <span class="tei tei-q">“the dead in Christ shall rise first,”</span>
+before the righteous living are changed, 1
+Thess. 4:16. In accordance with this priority
+in the resurrection of the righteous, Paul
+teaches that the worthies who died in faith
+<span class="tei tei-q">“accepted not deliverance, that they might
+obtain <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">a better</span></em> resurrection,”</span> (Heb. 11:13);
+and himself, he says, counted all things loss
+for Christ, <span class="tei tei-q">“if by any means I might attain
+unto the resurrection of the dead,”</span> (Phil. 3:11);
+which is <span class="tei tei-q">“the resurrection from among
+the dead”</span>—it being a resurrection to which
+some will not attain. Thus also the Saviour
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page357">[pg 357]</span><a name="Pg357" id="Pg357" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+taught: while <span class="tei tei-q">“they that have done good
+shall come forth <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">at</span></em> [as it is literally] the resurrection
+of life, and they that have done evil
+at the resurrection of damnation”</span> (John 5:29),
+the two are not co-etaneous; for the
+righteous shall be <span class="tei tei-q">“recompensed at the resurrection
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">of the just</span></em>,”</span> Lu. 14:14. That must
+be the resurrection of which those are the subjects
+who receive the kingdom; for <span class="tei tei-q">“flesh and
+blood cannot inherit the kingdom of God,”</span> 1
+Cor. 15:50. While <span class="tei tei-q">“the children of this
+world marry and are given in marriage,”</span>
+<span class="tei tei-q">“they which shall be accounted worthy to
+obtain that world, and the resurrection <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">from</span></em>
+the dead, neither marry, nor are given in
+marriage; neither can they die any more: for
+they are equal unto the angels, and are the
+children of God, being the children of the
+resurrection,”</span> Lu. 20:34-36.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The children of the resurrection thus include
+all who attain unto that world, which,
+consequently, the wicked do not obtain, and
+of which the righteous dead and the living
+saints are made equal subjects, according
+to Paul's <span class="tei tei-q">“mystery:”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“We shall not all
+sleep, but we shall all be changed, in a
+moment, in the twinkling of an eye, at the
+last trump: for the trumpet shall sound, and
+the dead shall be raised incorruptible, and
+we shall be changed,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, to the same
+incorruptible state to which the dead are
+raised, (1 Cor. 15:50-54); so that all the
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page358">[pg 358]</span><a name="Pg358" id="Pg358" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+righteous will alike <span class="tei tei-q">“bear the image of the
+heavenly”</span> (v. 49) when they <span class="tei tei-q">“shall be caught
+up together”</span> (1 Thess. 4:16) <span class="tei tei-q">“to meet the
+Lord in the air.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The resurrection state is that to which the
+ancients looked for the restoration of Israel.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Rabbi Eliezer the great, supposed to have
+lived just after the second temple was built,
+applied Hosea 14:8 to the pious Jews, who
+seemed likely to die without seeing the glory
+of Israel, saying: <span class="tei tei-q">“As I live, saith Jehovah,
+I will raise you up, in the resurrection of the
+dead; and I will gather you with all Israel.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The Sadducees are reported to have asked
+Rabbi Gamaliel, the preceptor of Paul,
+whence he would prove that God would
+raise the dead, who quoted Deut. 9:21:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Which land the Lord sware that he would
+give to your <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">fathers</span></em>.”</span> He argued, as Abraham,
+Isaac and Jacob had it not, and as God
+cannot lie, that they must be raised from the
+dead to inherit it.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Rabbi Simai, though of later date, argues
+the same from Ex. 6:4, insisting that the law
+asserts in this place the resurrection from the
+dead, when it said: <span class="tei tei-q">“And also I have established
+my covenant with them, to give them
+the Canaan;”</span> for, he adds, <span class="tei tei-q">“it is not said to
+<em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">you</span></em>, but to them.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Mennasseh Ben Israel says: <span class="tei tei-q">“It is plain
+that Abraham and the rest of the patriarchs
+did not possess that land; it follows, therefore,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page359">[pg 359]</span><a name="Pg359" id="Pg359" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+that they must be raised in order to
+enjoy the promised good, as otherwise the
+promises of God would be vain and false.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">De
+Resurrec. Mort., L. i., c. 1. § 4.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Rabbi Saahias Gaion, commenting on Dan.
+12:2, says: <span class="tei tei-q">“This is the resuscitation of the
+dead Israel, whose lot is eternal life, and those
+who shall not awake are the forsakers of
+Jehovah.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“In the world to come,”</span> says the Sahar,
+fol. 81, <span class="tei tei-q">“the blessed God will vivify the dead
+and raise them from their dust, so that they
+shall be no more an earthly structure.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Thus <span class="tei tei-q">“Abraham, when he was called to
+go out into a place which he should after
+receive for an inheritance ... sojourned in
+the land of promise, as in a strange country,
+dwelling in tabernacles, with Isaac and Jacob,
+the heirs with him of the same promise; for
+he looked for a city which hath foundations,
+whose builder and maker is God,”</span> Heb. 11:8-10.
+While he dwelt in that land, God
+<span class="tei tei-q">“gave him none inheritance in it, no, not so
+much as to set his foot on; yet he promised
+that he would give it to <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">him</span></em> for a possession,
+and to his seed after him,”</span> Acts 7:5. This
+was also true of all those <span class="tei tei-q">“who died in faith,
+not having received the promises, but having
+seen them afar off, and were persuaded of
+them, and embraced them, and confessed that
+they were strangers and pilgrims on the
+earth,”</span>—desiring <span class="tei tei-q">“a better country, that is,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page360">[pg 360]</span><a name="Pg360" id="Pg360" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a heavenly”</span> (Heb. 11:13-16), <span class="tei tei-q">“not accepting
+deliverance, that they might obtain a better
+resurrection”</span> (v. 35), <span class="tei tei-q">“God having provided
+some better thing for us, that they
+without us should not be made perfect,”</span> v. 40.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+When the promises are thus made good to
+Israel, all who are of the faith of Abraham
+will participate in the same promises. For
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Christ hath redeemed us from the curse of
+the law ... that the blessing of Abraham
+might come on the Gentiles through Jesus
+Christ.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“And if ye be Christ's, then are ye
+Abraham's seed, and heirs according to the
+promise,”</span> Gal. 3:13, 14, 29. So the Saviour
+said to the Jews: <span class="tei tei-q">“Many shall come from the
+east and west, and shall sit down with Abraham,
+and Isaac, and Jacob, in the kingdom of
+heaven; but the children of the kingdom [unregenerate
+Jews] shall be cast into outer darkness,”</span>
+Matt. 8:11, 12. And then, as the
+Saviour said to the twelve: <span class="tei tei-q">“Ye which have
+followed me, in the regeneration when the
+Son of man shall sit in the throne of his
+glory, ye also shall sit upon twelve thrones,
+judging the twelve tribes of Israel,”</span> Matt. 19:28.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The rest of the dead,”</span> who live not
+again till the thousand years are ended, must
+be the wicked dead; for, the righteous being
+raised, no other dead ones remain. They
+include all the wicked, who have died in all
+ages, and <span class="tei tei-q">“the remnant”</span> who <span class="tei tei-q">“are slain
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page361">[pg 361]</span><a name="Pg361" id="Pg361" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+with the sword”</span> (19:21), when the kingdom
+is cleansed from all things that offend.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The thousand years”</span> to intervene between
+the two resurrections, are regarded by some
+as a symbol of 360,000 years. There seems
+to be no necessity for such an interpretation.
+When time is symbolized, it is always proportioned
+to the duration of the other symbols
+used. Thus, in Dan. 8th, when beasts symbolize
+kingdoms, it would have been incongruous
+to have specified the duration of the
+vision in literal years; for beasts do not continue
+during centuries, as the kingdoms symbolized
+by them have done. But days are
+proportioned to years, as beasts are to kingdoms;
+so that there is a fitness in symbolizing
+the years foreshadowed in that vision, by
+2300 days; between which measure of time
+and the duration of the existence of beasts,
+there is a perfect congruity.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In the 4th of Daniel, where the cutting
+down of a tree is used to symbolize the loss
+of the king's reason, there is no such disproportion
+between the duration of man's existence
+and that of a tree, as there is between
+the life of a beast and that of an empire.
+And therefore there is no incongruity if the
+time specified is a symbol of literal time, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>,
+if a time is used to symbolize a year. In this
+case, the seven years could not have been
+symbolized by seven days; for there is no
+marked disproportion between the duration
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page362">[pg 362]</span><a name="Pg362" id="Pg362" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+of the other symbols in connection, and the
+things symbolized; and had days been used,
+days must have been understood in the fulfilment.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+There might be either 1000 years, or 360,000,
+between the first and second resurrections,
+without conflicting with any other Scripture.
+But there is no disproportion between the
+other symbols and the things symbolized,—the
+living again of the martyrs in vision, and
+their actual resurrection; and therefore the
+1000 years need not, by any parallel usage
+or law of language, be understood, to be other
+than a literal thousand.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Wicked Raised, and Satan Loosed</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And when the thousand years are completed, Satan
+will be loosed out of his prison, and will go out to deceive
+the nations in the four corners of the earth, Gog and Magog,
+to gather them to battle: the number of whom is like
+the sand of the sea. And they ascended on the breadth of
+the earth, and encompassed the camp of the saints, and the
+beloved city: and fire descended from God out of heaven,
+and devoured them. And the devil, who deceived them,
+was cast into the lake of fire and brimstone, where both the
+wild beast and the false prophet are, and will be tormented
+day and night for ever and ever. And I saw a great white
+throne, and him who sat on it; from whose face the earth
+and the heaven fled away, and a place was not for them.
+And I saw the dead, the small and the great, standing
+before God; and the books were opened: and another book
+was opened, which is the book of life: and the dead were
+judged from the things written in the books, according to
+their works. And the sea gave up the dead in it; and
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page363">[pg 363]</span><a name="Pg363" id="Pg363" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+death and the pit gave up the dead in them: and they were
+judged every one according to their works. And death and
+the pit were cast into the lake of fire. This is the second
+death, the lake of fire. And whoever was not found written
+in the book of life, was cast into the lake of fire.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 20:7-15.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Verses 11-15 contain the record of the
+symbolization John saw, of what was to
+transpire at the end of the thousand years;
+while verses 7-10 appear to be explanatory
+of events which would then be fulfilled.
+This explanation, previous to the exhibition
+of the symbolization, is appropriate in the
+connection, and makes more forcible the fact
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“the rest of the dead lived not again
+until the thousand years were finished.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As the rest of the dead live not till the end
+of the thousand years, they come forth at
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the resurrection of damnation,”</span> at the end
+of a thousand years of the reign of the saints
+on the earth, and at the epoch when Satan
+was to be loosed from his prison. As all who
+had part in the first resurrection were to be
+exempted from the power of the second death,
+the nations who are then deceived by Satan,
+must be the nations composing the rest of the
+dead, who live again at that epoch.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their number <span class="tei tei-q">“as the sand of the sea,”</span>
+and their coming from <span class="tei tei-q">“the four quarters of
+the earth,”</span> show that they are no obscure
+people, living unknown to the saints; and
+their existence can only be accounted for by
+the event of a resurrection of the wicked.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page364">[pg 364]</span><a name="Pg364" id="Pg364" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Their names, <span class="tei tei-q">“Gog and Magog,”</span>—those
+applied to the ancient enemies of Israel,
+(Ezek. 38:38),—are appropriate titles to
+designate the subjects of the second resurrection.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+They encompass the camp of the saints,
+and the beloved city—showing that the city
+descends at the commencement of the thousand
+years—but there is no battle: before they
+are permitted to harm the saints, fire from
+heaven devours them; and the devil that
+thought to lead them against the holy city, is
+cast into the lake of fire, where the beast and
+false prophet were cast at the commencement
+of the millennium.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In connection with the resurrection of the
+wicked, is their judgment—not following
+necessarily in the precise order of the record.
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“small and great”</span> who stand before
+God, are not small and large persons, but
+those from all stations and ranks in society.
+The king and the beggar equally receive
+according to their deserts: They are the
+bond and the free, the high and the low, the
+rich and the poor, including those who fought
+against the Lamb, and were overcome by
+Him, 19:18.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The open books symbolize the record of
+their evil deeds, for which they are to be
+judged. And the <span class="tei tei-q">“book of Life”</span> is opened
+to symbolize that the names of those who are
+judged are not there recorded, and that consequently
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page365">[pg 365]</span><a name="Pg365" id="Pg365" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+they are justly condemned. To
+<span class="tei tei-q">“him that overcometh,”</span> the Saviour promised
+<span class="tei tei-q">“I will not blot his name out of this book of
+life,”</span> 3:3.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sea, death, and hell giving up their dead,
+indicates that all of the <span class="tei tei-q">“rest of the dead”</span>
+are here resurrected, and that none are left
+out from among whom these are raised, as
+these were, from whom came forth the subjects
+of the first resurrection.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The casting of death and hell into the lake
+of fire, symbolizes the casting in of those who
+were within their domains; and <span class="tei tei-q">“the lake of
+fire,”</span> symbolizes the place into which—the
+impenitent are consigned—which is the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“second death.”</span>
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The New Creation.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I saw a new heaven and a new earth: for the first
+heaven and the first earth were passed away; and the sea
+was no more. And I saw the holy city, new Jerusalem,
+descending out of heaven, from God, prepared like a bride
+adorned for her husband.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 21:1, 2.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The new heaven and new earth are symbols
+of the new order of things. The old
+heavens and earth having been dissolved,
+their elements melting with fervent heat
+(2 Pet. 3:12), the <span class="tei tei-q">“new heavens and the
+new earth, wherein dwelleth righteousness,”</span>
+for which Peter looked, succeed to their place.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page366">[pg 366]</span><a name="Pg366" id="Pg366" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+So much more resplendent are these than the
+former, that those <span class="tei tei-q">“shall not be remembered,
+nor come into mind,”</span> <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">i.e.</span></span>, to be desired, Isa.
+65:17. This is the eternal state in which
+we are commanded to be <span class="tei tei-q">“glad and rejoice
+forever,”</span> when God shall <span class="tei tei-q">“create Jerusalem
+a rejoicing, and her people a joy.”</span> Then
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the voice of weeping shall be no more heard
+in her, nor the voice of crying.”</span> There <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+elect shall long enjoy the work of their
+hands;”</span> for <span class="tei tei-q">“as the days of a tree, are the
+days of my people,”</span> saith the Lord; who
+has also declared that, <span class="tei tei-q">“as the new heavens
+and the new earth, which I will make, shall
+remain before me, so shall your seed and
+your name remain,”</span> Isa. 66:22.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The sea is now <span class="tei tei-q">“no more,”</span> in the same
+sense that the first heavens and earth are
+passed away—all having disappeared in the
+conflagration, and given place to the <span class="tei tei-q">“restitution
+of all things spoken of by the mouth of
+all the holy prophets,”</span> Acts 3:21. Whether
+the new creation will comprise both sea and
+dry land, as was first created (Gen. 1:10), is
+not here decided; but there is no reason to
+suppose that this characteristic of the original
+creation will be forever obliterated.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The new Jerusalem descends, adorned as a
+bride for her husband. She is shown in the
+19th chapter to be <span class="tei tei-q">“arrayed in fine linen,
+clean and white”</span>—a symbol of <span class="tei tei-q">“the righteousness
+of the saints.”</span> As the corrupt
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page367">[pg 367]</span><a name="Pg367" id="Pg367" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+Roman hierarchy was symbolized by an
+adulterous woman (17:3), and also by the
+corrupt city of Babylon (18:2), so symbols
+of an opposite character—a chaste bride,
+and the new Jerusalem—are chosen representatives
+of the church triumphant, whose
+Maker is her husband.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Mr. Lord very justly remarks: <span class="tei tei-q">“The descent
+of the city is to take place at the commencement
+of the millennium, manifestly from the
+representation that the marriage of the Lamb
+was come, and that his wife had prepared
+herself, immediately after the destruction of
+great Babylon, (19:7, 8); from the exhibition
+of the risen and glorified saints, as seated
+on thrones, and reigning with Christ during
+the thousand years; and from the representation
+of the beloved city as on earth at the
+revolt of Gog and Magog, after the close of
+the thousand years.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-q">“<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Ex. Apoc.</span></span>”</span> p. 529.
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Jerusalem, my happy home,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">O how I long for thee;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">When shall my sorrows have an end?</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Thy joys when shall I see?</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“When shall these eyes thy heaven-built walls</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And pearly gates behold!</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Thy bulwarks with salvation strong,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And streets of shining gold?</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“O when, thou city of my God,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Shall I thy courts ascend,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Where congregations ne'er break up,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">And Sabbaths have no end?”</span></div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page368">[pg 368]</span><a name="Pg368" id="Pg368" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The Tabernacle of God with Men.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And I heard a loud voice out of heaven, saying, Behold,
+the tabernacle of God is with men, and he will dwell
+with them, and they will be his people, and God himself
+will be with them, even their God. And God will wipe
+away every tear from their eyes; and there will be no more
+death, nor mourning, nor crying out, nor will there be
+any more pain: for the former things are passed away.
+And he who sat on the throne said, Behold, I make all
+things new. And he said, Write, for these words are
+faithful and true. And he said to me, It is done. I am
+the Alpha and the Omega, the beginning and the end. I
+will give to him, who thirsteth, from the fountain of the
+water of life freely. He, who overcometh, will inherit these
+things; and I will be his God, and he will be my son. But
+the cowardly, and unbelieving, and abominable, and murderers,
+and fornicators, and sorcerers, and idolaters, and
+all liars, will have their part in the lake burning with fire
+and brimstone, which is the second death.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 21:3-8.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The utterances of the <span class="tei tei-q">“great voice out of
+heaven”</span> are not what John saw, but are what
+he heard; and are therefore to be interpreted,
+not by the laws of symbols, but by those of
+tropes and literal language.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The <span class="tei tei-q">“tabernacle of God with men”</span> is explained
+in the same connection to be his
+<span class="tei tei-q">“dwelling with them.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“When our Saviour was incarnate, and
+vouchsafed to dwell amongst the children of
+men, the same phrase is used by this same
+author, <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Eskeenoose</span></span> (John 1:14), <span class="tei tei-q">‘The Word
+was made flesh, and tabernacled amongst us:
+and we beheld his glory,’</span> etc. We read it,
+he dwelt amongst us: but rendered more
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page369">[pg 369]</span><a name="Pg369" id="Pg369" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+closely, it is, he set his tabernacle amongst
+us. And that which the Hebrews call the
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Shekinah</span></span>, or divine presence (Maimon, Mor.
+Nev. par. 1, chap. 25), comes from a word of
+the like signification, and found with the
+Greek word here used. Therefore there will
+be a <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Shekinah</span></span> in that kingdom of
+Christ.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Tho.
+Burnett.</span></span>
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+When Israel first entered the wilderness,
+God entered into a <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">covenant</span></span> with them (Ex. 19:3-8),
+in consequence of which he said
+to Moses, <span class="tei tei-q">“Let them make me a sanctuary,
+that I may dwell among them,”</span> (Ex. 25:8)—the
+pattern of which was shown Moses in
+the mount; and when completed <span class="tei tei-q">“the glory of
+the Lord filled the tabernacle”</span> (Ex. 40:34),
+and there <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lord talked with Moses,”</span> Ex. 33:9.
+Thus did God dwell among them
+while they were in a probationary state; but
+he indicated a more intimate connection
+with them, by promising, if they were obedient
+to his statutes in all things, that <span class="tei tei-q">“I will
+set my tabernacle among you: and my soul
+shall not abhor you. And I will walk among
+you, and will be your God, and ye shall be
+my people,”</span> Lev. 26:11, 12. This promise
+was not fulfilled to the Jews, because of their
+sins; but Paul quotes it (2 Cor. 6:16), and
+applies it as a promise still to be made good
+to the church of Christ. Thus, the <span class="tei tei-q">“Word”</span>
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“was God,”</span> who was made flesh and
+tabernacled among us at his incarnation, is
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page370">[pg 370]</span><a name="Pg370" id="Pg370" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+again to come and dwell with us in his
+human tabernacle, as at his first advent.
+Then will God enter into a new covenant
+with his people, as he has said: <span class="tei tei-q">“Behold, the
+days come, saith the Lord, that I will make
+a new covenant with the house of Israel, and
+with the house of Judah; not according to
+the covenant that I made with their fathers,
+in the day that I took them by the hand, to
+bring them out of the land of Egypt, which
+my covenant they brake, although I was a
+husband unto them, saith the Lord; but this
+shall be the covenant that I will make with
+the house of Israel; After those days, saith
+the Lord, I will put my law in their inward
+parts, and write it in their hearts; and will
+be their God, and they shall be my people.
+And they shall teach no more every man his
+neighbor, and every man his brother, saying,
+Know the Lord: for they shall all know me,
+from the least of them unto the greatest of
+them, saith the Lord: for I will forgive their
+iniquity, and I will remember their sin no
+more,”</span> Jer. 31:31-34.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+As the saints, before the resurrection of
+<span class="tei tei-q">“the rest of the dead,”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“reign with Christ
+1000 years,”</span> (20:4); it follows that during
+that period the tabernacle of God is with
+men, when he dwells among them, which is
+an additional evidence that <span class="tei tei-q">“the restitution
+of all things”</span> (Acts 3:21) is at the commencement
+of the millennium.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page371">[pg 371]</span><a name="Pg371" id="Pg371" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+This is a tearless state—all tears being
+then wiped from every eye. Isaiah predicted,
+when <span class="tei tei-q">“He will swallow up death in victory,”</span>
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lord God will wipe away tears
+from off all faces: and the rebuke of his
+people shall he take away from off all the
+earth: for the Lord hath spoken it. And it
+shall be said in that day, Lo, this is our God;
+we have waited for him, and he will save us:
+this is the Lord; we have waited for him, we
+will be glad and rejoice in his salvation,”</span> Isa.
+25:8, 9. The commencement of the tearless
+state is thus placed by Isaiah at the resurrection,
+and at the appearance of Christ; which
+is confirmed by Paul, in his inspired commentary
+on the same, who affirms that at the
+last trump, <span class="tei tei-q">“when this corruptible shall have
+put on incorruption, and this mortal shall have
+put on immortality, then shall be brought to
+pass the saying that is written, Death is swallowed
+up in victory,”</span> 1 Cor. 15:54. This
+state was also promised to the entire company
+<span class="tei tei-q">“which came out of great tribulation, and
+have washed their robes, and made them
+white in the blood of the Lamb. Therefore
+are they before the throne of God, and serve
+him day and night in his temple: and he that
+sitteth on the throne shall dwell among them.
+They shall hunger no more, neither thirst
+any more; neither shall the sun light on
+them, nor any heat. For the Lamb, which is
+in the midst of the throne, shall feed them,
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page372">[pg 372]</span><a name="Pg372" id="Pg372" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+and shall lead them unto living fountains of
+waters: and God shall wipe away all tears
+from their eyes,”</span> Rev. 7:14-17.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+There shall then <span class="tei tei-q">“be no more death”</span>—for
+that <span class="tei tei-q">“last enemy shall be destroyed”</span> (1 Cor. 15:26),
+and there shall be nothing to
+<span class="tei tei-q">“hurt nor destroy, in all my holy mountain,
+saith the Lord.”</span> Death will have been swallowed
+up in victory, (Isa. 25:8)—the redeemed
+having been ransomed <span class="tei tei-q">“from the
+power of the grave,”</span> Hos. 13:14. <span class="tei tei-q">“Neither
+can they die any more: for they are equal
+unto the angels; and are the children of God,
+being the children of the resurrection,”</span> Luke
+20:36.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+After the destruction of death, there shall
+be <span class="tei tei-q">“neither sorrow, nor crying, neither shall
+there be any more pain.”</span> This was to be
+when <span class="tei tei-q">“the ransomed of the Lord shall return,
+and come to Zion with songs and everlasting
+joy upon their heads: they shall obtain joy
+and gladness, and sorrow and sighing shall
+flee away,”</span> Isa. 35:10. And one of these
+songs was to be: <span class="tei tei-q">“Thou wast slain, and hast
+redeemed us to God by thy blood out of every
+kindred and tongue, and people and nation;
+and hast made us unto our God kings and
+priests: and we shall reign on the earth,”</span>
+Rev. 5:9,10.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Then, everything which distinguishes the
+present world from that, will have passed
+away; for all things will be created anew.
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page373">[pg 373]</span><a name="Pg373" id="Pg373" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+These words, uttered by Him who is the
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Alpha and Omega,”</span> are no rhetorical flourishes,
+nor mere figures of speech, but contain
+the exact and literal truth, and are not to be
+set aside as unmeaning figures. For He
+who sat upon the throne has declared:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“These words are true and faithful.”</span> Faithful
+is He who hath promised, and he will
+surely make good his words—bestowing on
+the righteous the inheritance of all things;
+and on the wicked, their fearful doom.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">The New Jerusalem.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And there came to me one of the seven angels, who had
+the seven bowls full of the seven last plagues, and talked
+with me, saying, Come, I will shew thee the bride, the wife
+of the Lamb. And he carried me away in spirit to a vast
+and high mountain, and shewed me the holy city Jerusalem,
+descending out of heaven from God, having the glory of
+God. Her light was like a most precious stone, like a jasper
+stone, clear as crystal; having a wall vast and high,
+and having twelve gates, and at the gates twelve angels,
+and names written on the gates, which are the names of the
+twelve tribes of the sons of Israel. On the east, three gates;
+on the north, three gates; on the south, three gates; and on
+the west, three gates. And the wall of the city had twelve
+foundations, and on them, the twelve names of the twelve
+apostles of the Lamb. And he, who talked with me, had a
+golden measuring-reed to measure the city, and its gates,
+and its wall. And the city lieth square, and the length is as
+much as the breadth: and he measured the city with the
+measuring-reed, twelve thousand furlongs. The length,
+and the breadth, and the height of it are equal. And he
+measured its wall, a hundred and forty-four cubits, according
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page374">[pg 374]</span><a name="Pg374" id="Pg374" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+to the measure of a man, that is, of the angel. And
+the structure of its wall was jasper: and the city was pure
+gold, like clear glass. And the foundations of the wall of
+the city were adorned with every kind of precious stone.
+The first foundation was a jasper; the second, a sapphire;
+the third, a chalcedony; the fourth, an emerald; the fifth,
+a sardonyx; the sixth, a sardius; the seventh, a chrysolite;
+the eighth, a beryl; the ninth, a topaz; the tenth, a
+chrysoprasus; the eleventh, a jacinth; the twelfth, an
+amethyst. And the twelve gates were twelve pearls; each
+one of the gates was of one pearl; and the wide street of
+the city was pure gold, like transparent glass.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 21:9-21.
+</span></div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And he shewed me a pure river of water of life, clear
+as crystal, proceeding out of the throne of God and the
+Lamb. In the midst of its wide street, and on each side of
+the river, was the tree of life, bearing twelve kinds of fruit,
+yielding its fruit monthly, and the leaves of the tree were
+for the healing of the nations. And there will be no more
+curse: but the throne of God and of the Lamb will be in it;
+and his servants will serve him: and they will see his face;
+and his name will be on their foreheads. And there will be
+no night there; and they have no need of the light of a
+lamp, nor of the light of the sun; for the Lord God giveth
+them light: and they will reign forever and ever.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev.
+22:1-5.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Objects of great interest, of which only a
+passing glance was permitted in previous visions,
+are again and again presented, until their
+relative glory is sufficiently manifested. Thus
+the new earth was considered worthy of being
+the subject of a special vision; and now
+the Bride, the Lamb's wife, although before
+referred to, is again made the subject of a
+special vision, under the symbol of a city,
+explained to be the bride.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The descent of the city, to harmonize with
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page375">[pg 375]</span><a name="Pg375" id="Pg375" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+corresponding scriptures, has been shown to
+be at the commencement of the millennium,
+when those who are called to the marriage
+supper of the Lamb descend from the clouds
+of heaven, to receive <span class="tei tei-q">“an inheritance incorruptible,
+and undefiled, and that fadeth not
+away, reserved in heaven for you ... ready
+to be revealed in the last time,”</span> 1 Pet. 4:5.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The glory of the Lord,”</span> which is the light
+of the city, is explained to be <span class="tei tei-q">“the Lamb”</span>
+(21:23), which <span class="tei tei-q">“is the light thereof.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“In
+him was life, and the life was the light of
+men.”</span> <span class="tei tei-q">“That was the true light which
+lighteth every man that cometh into the
+world,”</span> John 1:4, 9. In Him dwelleth all
+the fulness of the Godhead bodily (Col. 2:9),
+so that as the Holy Shekineh illumined
+the pathway of ancient Israel, the nations of
+the redeemed will walk in the light of His
+glory.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The gates of the city correspond with the
+number of the tribes of Israel; and the <span class="tei tei-q">“names
+of the apostles”</span> are in its foundations. Thus
+Paul affirms that the <span class="tei tei-q">“fellow citizens”</span> of <span class="tei tei-q">“the
+household of God”</span> are built upon the foundation
+of the apostles and prophets, Jesus
+Christ himself being the chief corner-stone,
+Eph. 2:20.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The dimensions of the city are in length
+equal to the breadth—and 1500 miles in circumference,
+or 375 miles square. The length
+is in all parts equal; and so is the breadth,
+and the height,—the latter being 216 feet.
+</p>
+
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page376">[pg 376]</span><a name="Pg376" id="Pg376" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+Its splendor is fully equal to all that inspiration
+has recorded respecting those on whom
+the Lord will have <span class="tei tei-q">“everlasting kindness;”</span>
+and to whom he saith: <span class="tei tei-q">“O thou afflicted,
+tossed with the tempest, and not comforted!
+behold, I will lay thy stones with fair colors,
+and lay thy foundations with sapphires. And
+I will make thy windows of agates, and thy
+gates of carbuncles, and all thy borders of
+pleasant stones. And all thy children shall
+be taught of the Lord; and great shall be the
+peace of thy children. In righteousness shalt
+thou be established: thou shalt be far from
+oppression; for thou shalt not fear: and from
+terror; for it shall not come near thee,”</span> Isa.
+54:11-14. <span class="tei tei-q">“Therefore thy gates shall be
+open continually; they shall not be shut day
+nor night; that men may bring unto thee the
+forces of the Gentiles, and that their kings
+may be brought. For the nation and kingdom
+that will not serve thee shall perish; yea,
+those nations shall be utterly wasted. The
+glory of Lebanon shall come unto thee, the
+fir-tree, the pine-tree, and the box together, to
+beautify the place of my sanctuary; and I
+will make the place of my feet glorious. The
+sons also of them that afflicted thee shall come
+bending unto thee; and all they that despised
+thee shall bow themselves down at the soles
+of thy feet; and they shall call thee, The city
+of the Lord, The Zion of the Holy One of
+Israel. Whereas thou hast been forsaken and
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page377">[pg 377]</span><a name="Pg377" id="Pg377" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+hated, so that no man went through thee,
+I will make thee an eternal excellency, a joy
+of many generations. Thou shalt also suck
+the milk of the Gentiles, and shalt suck the
+breast of kings: and thou shalt know that I
+the Lord am thy Saviour and thy Redeemer,
+the mighty One of Jacob. For brass I will
+bring gold, and for iron I will bring silver,
+and for wood brass, and for stones iron: I
+will also make thy officers peace, and thine
+exactors righteousness. Violence shall no
+more be heard in thy land, wasting nor destruction
+within thy borders; but thou shalt
+call thy walls Salvation, and thy gates Praise.
+The sun shall be no more thy light by day;
+neither for brightness shall the moon give
+light unto thee: but the Lord shall be unto
+thee an everlasting light, and thy God thy
+glory. Thy sun shall no more go down;
+neither shall thy moon withdraw itself: for
+the Lord shall be thine everlasting light, and
+the days of thy mourning shall be ended.
+Thy people also shall be all righteous: they
+shall inherit the land forever, the branch of
+my planting, the work of my hands, that I
+may be glorified. A little one shall become a
+thousand, and a small one a strong nation; I
+the Lord will hasten it in his time,”</span> Isa. 60:11-22.
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">O scenes surpassing fable, and yet true,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Scenes of accomplish'd bliss! which who can see,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Though but in distant prospect, and not feel</div>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page378">[pg 378]</span><a name="Pg378" id="Pg378" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">His soul refresh'd with foretaste of the joy?</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Rivers of gladness water all the Earth,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And clothe all climes with beauty. The reproach</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Of barrenness is past. The fruitful field</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Laughs with abundance; and the land, once lean,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Or fertile only in its own disgrace,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Exults to see its thistly curse repeal'd.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The various seasons woven into one,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And that one season an eternal spring,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The garden fears no blight, and needs no fence;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">For there is none to covet: all are full.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The lion, and the libbard, and the bear,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Graze with the fearless flocks; all bask at noon</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Together, or all gambol in the shade</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Of the same grove, and drink one common stream.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Antipathies are none. No foe to man</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Lurks in the serpent now: the mother sees,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And smiles to see, her infant's playful hand</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Stretch'd forth to dally with the crested worm,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">To stroke his azure neck, or to receive</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The lambent homage of his arrowy tongue.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">All creatures worship man, and all mankind</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">One Lord, one Father. Error has no place;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">That creeping pestilence is driv'n away:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The breath of Heav'n has chas'd it. In the heart</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">No passion touches a discordant string,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">But all is harmony and love. Disease</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Is not: the pure and uncontaminate blood</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Holds its due course, nor fears the frost of age.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">One song employs all nations; and all cry,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“Worthy the Lamb, for he was slain for us!”</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The dwellers in the vales and on the rocks</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Shout to each other, and the mountain-tops</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">From distant mountains catch the flying joy;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Till, nation after nation taught the strain,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Earth rolls the rapturous Hosanna round.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Behold the measure of the promise fill'd!</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">See Salem built, the labor of a God!</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Bright as a sun the sacred city shines:</div>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page379">[pg 379]</span><a name="Pg379" id="Pg379" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">All kingdoms and all princes of the Earth</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Flock to that light; the glory of all lands</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Flows into her; unbounded is her joy,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And endless her increase. Thy rams are there,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Nebaioth, and the flocks of Kedar there:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The looms of Ormus, and the mines of Ind,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And Saba's spicy groves, pay tribute there.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Praise is in all her gates; upon her walls,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And in her streets, and in her spacious courts,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Is heard salvation. Eastern Java there</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Kneels with the native of the farthest west;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And Æthiopia spreads abroad the hand,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And worships. Her report has travel'd forth</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Into all lands. From ev'ry clime they come</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">To see thy beauty, and to share thy joy,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">O Sion! an assembly such as Earth</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Saw never, such as Heav'n stoops down to see.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Thus Heav'nward all things tend. For all were once</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Perfect, and all must be at length restor'd,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">So God has greatly purpos'd: who would else</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">In his dishonor'd works himself endure</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Dishonor, and be wrong'd without redress.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Haste then, and wheel away a shatter'd world,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Ye slow-revolving seasons! we would see</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">(A sight to which our eyes are strangers yet)</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">A world that does not dread and hate his laws,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And suffer for its crime; would learn how fair</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The creature is, that God pronounces good,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">How pleasant in itself what pleases him.—<span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Cowper.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Final Admonitions.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">And he said to me, These words are faithful and true.
+And the Lord, the God of the spirits of the prophets, sent
+his angel to shew his servants the things, which must
+shortly take place. And behold, I come quickly: happy is
+he, who keepeth the words of the prophecy of this book.
+</span><span class="tei tei-pb" id="page380">[pg 380]</span><a name="Pg380" id="Pg380" class="tei tei-anchor"></a><span style="font-size: 90%">
+And I John saw and heard these things. And when I had
+heard and seen, I fell down to worship before the feet of the
+angel who shewed me these things. And he saith to me,
+See thou do it not: I am thy fellow-servant, and one of thy
+brethren the prophets, and one of those, who keep the
+words of this book: worship God. And he saith to me,
+Seal not up the words of the prophecy of this book: for the
+season is near. He, who is unjust, let him be unjust still:
+and he, who is filthy, let him be filthy still: and he, who is
+righteous, let him perform righteousness still: and he, who
+is holy, let him be holy still. Behold, I come quickly; and
+my reward is with me, to give each one as his work shall
+be. I am the Alpha and the Omega, the first and the last,
+the beginning and the end. Happy are those, who do his
+commandments, that they may have the privilege of the
+tree of life, and may enter through the gates into the city.
+For without are the Sodomites, and the sorcerers, and the
+fornicators, and the murderers, and the idolaters, and whoever
+loveth and practiseth falsehood. I Jesus have sent
+mine angel to testify to you these things in the congregations.
+I am the root and the offspring of David, the bright
+morning-star. And the Spirit and the bride say, Come!
+And let him, who heareth, say, Come! And let him, who
+thirsteth, come. And whoever will, let him take the water
+of life freely.</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">I testify to every one, who heareth the words of the
+prophecy of this book, If any one shall add to these things,
+God will add to him the plagues written in this book: and
+if any one shall take away from the words of the book of
+this prophecy, God will take away his part from the tree of
+life, and out of the holy city, and from the things written
+in this book. He, who testifieth these things, saith, Surely
+I come quickly. So be it, come, O Lord Jesus!</span></span>
+</div>
+
+<div class="block tei tei-quote" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em">
+<span class="tei tei-q"><span style="font-size: 90%">“</span><span style="font-size: 90%">The grace of our Lord Jesus Christ be with all the
+saints.</span><span style="font-size: 90%">”</span></span><span style="font-size: 90%"> Rev. 22:6-21.
+</span></div>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+With the representation of the city, the
+symbols of the Apocalypse are terminated.
+What follows are the words of Christ. The
+import of these is guarded by his declaration
+that they are <span class="tei tei-q">“true and faithful.”</span> There is
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page381">[pg 381]</span><a name="Pg381" id="Pg381" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+a reality and definiteness in them, which will
+not admit of their being added to, or taken
+from. So that any attempt to fritter away
+their meaning, will be followed by the curses
+written in the book, and a loss of the blessings
+therein promised.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The command not to seal this prophecy,
+is in contrast with the close of Daniel's
+prophecy, which was <span class="tei tei-q">“closed up and sealed
+till the time of the end,”</span> Dan. 12:9. The
+Apocalypse, as its name imports, being an
+<span class="tei tei-q">“unveiling”</span> of the obscurities of Daniel, the
+seal from the former was removed—the time
+of the end, in that sense, being equivalent to
+the last days, or the gospel dispensation.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The time was <span class="tei tei-q">“at hand,”</span> when the great
+series of predicted events was to commence.
+As he that was unjust was to be unjust still,
+and he that was righteous was thus to remain,
+it follows that the visions therein recorded,
+continue down to the close of probation; and
+that the new earth is one of everlasting reward,
+wherein is to be fulfilled the promise:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Blessed are the meek; for they shall inherit
+the earth,”</span> Matt. 5:3.
+</p>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+In this connection the Saviour answers the
+question, which so perplexed the Pharisees:
+If David then call him Lord, how is he his
+son? Matt. 22:45. Being the Root from
+whence David sprang, and in his humanity
+David's offspring, he was both his Lord and
+son.
+</p>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page382">[pg 382]</span><a name="Pg382" id="Pg382" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+The invitation appended is one of the most
+endearing that it is possible to conceive of,
+and the threats are the most terrific. These
+are given for the admonition of all; and yet
+how many will turn away from the study of
+the book, which commences with a blessing
+on him <span class="tei tei-q">“that readeth, and they that hear the
+words of this prophecy, and keep those things
+which are written therein,”</span> (1:3); and
+closes with an invitation for all to come
+and <span class="tei tei-q">“take of the water of life freely.”</span> It is
+no mystical record, and there is nothing equivocal
+in its predictions. Neither is it to be fulfilled
+in the distant future; for <span class="tei tei-q">“He which
+testifieth these things saith: Surely I come
+quickly.”</span> And shall not every one who loves
+his Lord respond, <span class="tei tei-q">“Even so; come, Lord
+Jesus.”</span>
+</p>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“The Church has waited long</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Her absent Lord to see;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And still in loneliness she waits,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">A friendless stranger she.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Age after age has gone,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Sun after sun has set,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And still, in weeds of widowhood,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">She weeps, a mourner yet.”</span></div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“The whole creation groans,</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And waits to hear that voice</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">That shall restore her comeliness,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And make her wastes rejoice.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Come, Lord, and wipe away</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">The curse, the sin, the stain,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And make this blighted world of ours</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Thine own fair world again.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">Come, then, Lord Jesus, come!”</span></div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Rev. H. A. Bonar</span></span>, (<span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-style: italic">Eng.</span></span>)</div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page383">[pg 383]</span><a name="Pg383" id="Pg383" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+
+<div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em">
+<h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">THE OLD EARTH.</span></h2>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Old Mother <span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Earth</span></span> is wan and pale,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Her face is wrinkled sore;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Her locks are blanched, her heart is cold,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Her garments stiff with gore;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">With furrowed brow and dim sad eyes,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">With trembling steps and slow,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">She marks the course that first she trod</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The Earth is old, the Earth is cold,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">She shivers and complains;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">How many Winters fierce and chill</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Have racked her limbs with pains!</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Drear tempests, lightning, flood and flame</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Have scarred her visage so,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">That scarce we deem she shone so fair,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Yet comely was the youthful Earth,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And lightly tripped along</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">To music from a starry choir,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Whose sweet celestial song</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Through Nature's temple echoed wild,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And soft as streamlets flow,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Where sister spheres replied with her,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And many happy children there</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Upon her breast reclined,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The young Earth smiled with aspect fair,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">The heavens were bright and kind;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The azure cope above her head</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">In love seemed bending low,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">O happy was the youthful Earth,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Alas! those children of the Earth</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">With hate began to burn,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And Murder stained her beauteous robe,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And bade the young Earth mourn.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">And ages, heavy ages, still</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Have bowed with gathering woe</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The form of her whose life was joy,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Old Earth! drear Earth! thy tender heart</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Bewails thy chosen ones;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Thou look'st upon the myriad graves</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">That hide their gathered bones;</div>
+<span class="tei tei-pb" id="page384">[pg 384]</span><a name="Pg384" id="Pg384" class="tei tei-anchor"></a>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">For them, by day and night, thy tears</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Unceasingly must flow;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Death chilled the fountain-head of life</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Old Earth! old Earth! above thy head</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">The heavens are dark and chill,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The sun looks coldly on thee now,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">The stars shine pale and still;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">No more the heavenly symphonies</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Through listening ether flow,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Which swelled upon creation's ear,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Weep not in bitter grief, O Earth!</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Weep not in hopelessness!</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">From out the heavens <span class="tei tei-q" style="text-align: left">“a still small voice”</span></div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Whispers returning peace.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Thy tears are precious in the sight</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Of <span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">One</span></span> who marks their flow,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Who purposes of mercy formed,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Thy days of grief are numbered all,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Their sum will soon be told:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">The joy of youth, the smile of God,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Shall bless thee as of old;</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Shall shed a purer, holier light</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Upon thy peaceful brow,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Than beamed upon thy morning hour</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Thy chosen ones shall live again,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">A countless, tearless throng,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">To wake creation's voice anew,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">And swell the choral song.</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Go, Earth! go wipe thy falling tears,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Forget thy heavy woe:</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left">Hope died not with thy first-born sons,</div>
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left; margin-left: 2.00em">Six thousand years ago!</div>
+</div>
+
+<div class="tei tei-lg" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em">
+<div class="tei tei-l" style="text-align: left"><span class="tei tei-hi" style="text-align: left"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">Knickerbocker.</span></span></div>
+</div>
+
+</div>
+</div>
+</div>
+<hr class="doublepage" /><div class="tei tei-back" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 6.00em">
+ <div id="footnotes" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+ <a name="toc7" id="toc7"></a>
+ <a name="pdf8" id="pdf8"></a>
+ <h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">Footnotes</span></h1>
+ <dl class="tei tei-list-footnotes"><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_1" name="note_1" href="#noteref_1">1.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">The first Advent was,
+according to the best-settled chronological
+data, about four thousand one hundred and twenty years
+from creation.</dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_2" name="note_2" href="#noteref_2">2.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">See margin
+of Whiting's Testament. Lord has it, <span class="tei tei-q">“when
+he can be ready to sound.”</span></dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_3" name="note_3" href="#noteref_3">3.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">The constitutional language was,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“By the authority of the senate, and consent of the
+soldiers.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Gibbon</span></span>, vol.
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-variant: small-caps">I.</span></span>, p. 44.</dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_4" name="note_4" href="#noteref_4">4.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">This
+is given on the authority of the London Quarterly
+Journal of Prophecy, for 1852, p. 330, which states that the
+edict will be found in the <span class="tei tei-q">“Theodosian Code, XVII. to XX.”</span></dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_5" name="note_5" href="#noteref_5">5.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext"><span class="tei tei-q">“Ubi
+cogniti fuerint illius hæresis sectatores, ne receptaculum
+iis quisquam in terra sua præbere præsumat: sed
+nec in venditione aut emptione aliqua cum iis omnino commercium
+habeatur.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Hard.</span></span>, vi. ii.
+1597.</dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_6" name="note_6" href="#noteref_6">6.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">The following philological
+law or canon of criticism is universally
+admitted, and all dictionaries, grammars, and translations,
+are formed in accordance with it:
+</p>
+<p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">
+<span class="tei tei-q">“Every word not specially explained or defined in a particular
+sense, by any standard writer of any particular age and
+country, is to be taken and applied in the current or commonly
+received signification of that country and age in which the
+writer lived and wrote.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Campbell.</span></span>
+</p></dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_7" name="note_7" href="#noteref_7">7.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">This
+possession by demons is similar to the mode by which
+pretended spirits claim that they communicate through mediums.
+One of them, purporting to be the spirit of a departed son of Adin
+Ballou, in answer to the question, by his father, <span class="tei tei-q">“Can you
+describe how you are able to write through a medium?”</span> says,
+<span class="tei tei-q">“I feel as though I enter into her for the time being, or as if
+my spirit entered into her. I am disencumbered of my spiritual
+form, and take hers. More than one spirit can enter the medium
+at once. The mediums all go into the trance by means of
+several spirits entering the body at one time.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Spiritual
+Telegraph, May 8, 1852.</span></span></dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_8" name="note_8" href="#noteref_8">8.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">The word is
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demon</span></span> or <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">demons</span></span>
+in all the instances referred to.</dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_9" name="note_9" href="#noteref_9">9.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">Necromancy is
+derived from the Greek words <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">nekros</span></span>, dead,
+and <span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">mantis</span></span>, a diviner. The Greek,
+<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Necromantia</span></span>, is defined:
+<span class="tei tei-q">“The revealing future events by communication with the
+dead; necromancy.”</span> And Nekromantis: <span class="tei tei-q">“One who reveals
+future events by communication with the dead; a necromancer.”</span></dd><dt class="tei tei-notelabel"><a id="note_10" name="note_10" href="#noteref_10">10.</a></dt><dd class="tei tei-notetext">This is in the Syriac, <span class="tei tei-q">“Until the fulness of the time of
+all things.”</span> Irenæus says, <span class="tei tei-q">“Till the time of the exhibition
+or disposal of all things;”</span> and Œcumenius, <span class="tei tei-q">“Till the
+time of all things does come to an end;”</span> and we have the
+suffrage of Thesychius and Phavorinus, that <span class="tei tei-q">“ἀποκατάστασις
+is τελειωσις, <span class="tei tei-q">‘the consummation’</span> of a
+thing.”</span>—<span class="tei tei-hi"><span style="font-style: italic">Whitby.</span></span></dd></dl>
+ </div>
+ <hr class="doublepage" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 5.00em; margin-top: 5.00em">
+ <div id="pgfooter" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 4.00em; margin-top: 4.00em"><pre class="pre tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em">***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK A BRIEF COMMENTARY ON THE APOCALYPSE***
+</pre><hr class="doublepage" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em"><a name="rightpageheader9" id="rightpageheader9"></a><a name="pgtoc10" id="pgtoc10"></a><a name="pdf11" id="pdf11"></a><h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">Credits</span></h1><table summary="This is a list." class="tei tei-list" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em"><tbody><tr><th class="tei tei-label tei-label-gloss">September 16, 2008  </th></tr><tr><td class="tei tei-item"><table summary="This is a list." class="tei tei-list" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em"><tbody><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item">Project Gutenberg TEI edition 1</td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item"><span class="tei tei-respStmt">
+ <span class="tei tei-name">
+ Produced by Heiko Evermann, David King, and the Online
+ Distributed Proofreading Team at &lt;http://www.pgdp.net/&gt;.
+ (This file was produced from scanned images of public domain
+ material from the Google Print project.)
+ </span>
+ </span></td></tr></tbody></table></td></tr></tbody></table></div><hr class="doublepage" /><div class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em"><a name="rightpageheader12" id="rightpageheader12"></a><a name="pgtoc13" id="pgtoc13"></a><a name="pdf14" id="pdf14"></a><h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">A Word from Project Gutenberg</span></h1><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">This file should be named
+ 26639-h.html or
+ 26639-h.zip.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">This and all associated files of various formats will be found
+ in:
+
+ <a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/6/6/3/26639/" class="block tei tei-xref" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em"><span style="font-size: 90%">http://www.gutenberg.org</span><span style="font-size: 90%">/dirs/2/6/6/3/26639/</span></a></p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Updated editions will replace the previous one — the old
+ editions will be renamed.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Creating the works from public domain print editions means that
+ no one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the
+ Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
+ States without permission and without paying copyright royalties.
+ Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this
+ license, apply to copying and distributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works
+ to protect the Project Gutenberg™ concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered
+ trademark, and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks,
+ unless you receive specific permission. If you do not charge
+ anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the rules is
+ very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as
+ creation of derivative works, reports, performances and research.
+ They may be modified and printed and given away — you may do
+ practically <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">anything</span></em> with public domain eBooks.
+ Redistribution is subject to the trademark license, especially
+ commercial redistribution.</p></div><hr class="page" /><div id="pglicense" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 3.00em; margin-top: 3.00em"><a name="rightpageheader15" id="rightpageheader15"></a><a name="pgtoc16" id="pgtoc16"></a><a name="pdf17" id="pdf17"></a><h1 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 3.46em; margin-top: 3.46em"><span style="font-size: 173%">The Full Project Gutenberg License</span></h1><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em"><em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Please read this before you distribute or use this
+ work.</span></em></p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">To protect the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting the free
+ distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing
+ this work (or any other work associated in any way with the
+ phrase <span class="tei tei-q">“Project Gutenberg”</span>), you agree to comply with all the terms
+ of the Full Project Gutenberg™ License (<a href="#pglicense" class="tei tei-ref">available with this file</a> or online
+ at <a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/license" class="tei tei-xref">http://www.gutenberg.org/license</a>).</p><div id="pglicense1" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Section 1.</span></h2><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">General Terms of Use &amp; Redistributing Project Gutenberg™
+ electronic works</span></h2><div id="pglicense1A" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">1.A.</span></h3><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg™ electronic
+ work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+ and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual
+ property (trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree
+ to abide by all the terms of this agreement, you must cease
+ using and return or destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic
+ works in your possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a
+ copy of or access to a Project Gutenberg™ electronic work and you do not
+ agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement, you may
+ obtain a refund from the person or entity to whom you paid the
+ fee as set forth in paragraph <a href="#pglicense1E8" class="tei tei-ref">1.E.8.</a></p></div><div id="pglicense1B" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">1.B.</span></h3><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em"><span class="tei tei-q">“Project Gutenberg”</span> is a registered trademark. It may only be used on or
+ associated in any way with an electronic work by people who agree to be
+ bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few things that you
+ can do with most Project Gutenberg™ electronic works even without complying with the
+ full terms of this agreement. See paragraph <a href="#pglicense1C" class="tei tei-ref">1.C</a> below. There are a lot of things you can
+ do with Project Gutenberg™ electronic works if you follow the terms of this
+ agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg™ electronic
+ works. See paragraph <a href="#pglicense1E" class="tei tei-ref">1.E</a> below.</p></div><div id="pglicense1C" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">1.C.</span></h3><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (<span class="tei tei-q">“the Foundation”</span> or PGLAF), owns a compilation
+ copyright in the collection of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works. Nearly all the
+ individual works in the collection are in the public domain in the
+ United States. If an individual work is in the public domain in the
+ United States and you are located in the United States, we do not claim
+ a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
+ displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as all
+ references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support
+ the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+ freely sharing Project Gutenberg™ works in compliance with the terms of this
+ agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg™ name associated with the work. You can
+ easily comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in
+ the same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg™ License when you share it
+ without charge with others.</p></div><div id="pglicense1D" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">1.D.</span></h3><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+ what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+ a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+ the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+ before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+ creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project Gutenberg™ work.
+ The Foundation makes no representations concerning the copyright status
+ of any work in any country outside the United States.</p></div><div id="pglicense1E" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">1.E.</span></h3><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:</p><div id="pglicense1E1" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.1.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+ access to, the full Project Gutenberg™ License must appear prominently whenever any
+ copy of a Project Gutenberg™ work (any work on which the phrase <span class="tei tei-q">“Project Gutenberg”</span>
+ appears, or with which the phrase <span class="tei tei-q">“Project Gutenberg”</span> is associated) is
+ accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
+
+ </p><div class="block tei tei-q" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 0.90em"><span style="font-size: 90%">This eBook is for the use of
+ anyone anywhere at no cost and with almost no
+ restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it
+ away or re-use it under the terms of the Project
+ Gutenberg License included with this eBook or
+ online at </span><a href="http://www.gutenberg.org" class="tei tei-xref"><span style="font-size: 90%">http://www.gutenberg.org</span></a></p></div></div><div id="pglicense1E2" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.2.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is derived from the public
+ domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is posted with
+ permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied and
+ distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees or
+ charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work with
+ the phrase <span class="tei tei-q">“Project Gutenberg”</span> associated with or appearing on the work, you
+ must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs <a href="#pglicense1E1" class="tei tei-ref">1.E.1</a> through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for
+ the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg™ trademark as set forth in paragraphs
+ <a href="#pglicense1E8" class="tei tei-ref">1.E.8</a> or 1.E.9.</p></div><div id="pglicense1E3" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.3.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is posted with the permission
+ of the copyright holder, your use and distribution must comply with both
+ paragraphs <a href="#pglicense1E1" class="tei tei-ref">1.E.1</a> through 1.E.7 and any
+ additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will
+ be linked to the Project Gutenberg™ License for all works posted with the permission
+ of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.</p></div><div id="pglicense1E4" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.4.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg™ License terms from
+ this work, or any files containing a part of this work or any other work
+ associated with Project Gutenberg™.</p></div><div id="pglicense1E5" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.5.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+ electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+ prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph <a href="#pglicense1E1" class="tei tei-ref">1.E.1</a> with active links or immediate access
+ to the full terms of the Project Gutenberg™ License.</p></div><div id="pglicense1E6" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.6.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+ compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
+ any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
+ to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg™ work in a format other than
+ <span class="tei tei-q">“Plain Vanilla ASCII”</span> or other format used in the official
+ version posted on the official Project Gutenberg™ web site (http://www.gutenberg.org), you must, at
+ no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a copy, a
+ means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+ request, of the work in its original <span class="tei tei-q">“Plain Vanilla ASCII”</span> or
+ other form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg™ License
+ as specified in paragraph <a href="#pglicense1E1" class="tei tei-ref">1.E.1.</a></p></div><div id="pglicense1E7" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.7.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, performing,
+ copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg™ works unless you comply with
+ paragraph <a href="#pglicense1E8" class="tei tei-ref">1.E.8</a> or 1.E.9.</p></div><div id="pglicense1E8" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.8.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing access to
+ or distributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works provided that</p><table summary="This is a list." class="tei tei-list" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em; margin-top: 1.00em"><tbody><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label">•  </th><td class="tei tei-item"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg™ works calculated using the method you already use to
+ calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed to the owner of the
+ Project Gutenberg™ trademark, but he has agreed to donate royalties under this
+ paragraph to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid within 60 days
+ following each date on which you prepare (or are legally required to
+ prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty payments should be clearly
+ marked as such and sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in <a href="#pglicense4" class="tei tei-ref">Section 4, <span class="tei tei-q">“Information about donations to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation.”</span></a></p></td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he does
+ not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg™ License. You must require such
+ a user to return or destroy all copies of the works possessed in a
+ physical medium and discontinue all use of and all access to other
+ copies of Project Gutenberg™ works.</p></td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">You provide, in accordance with paragraph <a href="#pglicense1F3" class="tei tei-ref">1.F.3</a>, a full refund of any money paid for a
+ work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the electronic work is
+ discovered and reported to you within 90 days of receipt of the
+ work.</p></td></tr><tr class="tei tei-labelitem"><th class="tei tei-label"></th><td class="tei tei-item"><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg™ works.</p></td></tr></tbody></table></div><div id="pglicense1E9" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.E.9.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg™ electronic work or
+ group of works on different terms than are set forth in this agreement,
+ you must obtain permission in writing from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+ Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg™ trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
+ forth in <a href="#pglicense3" class="tei tei-ref">Section 3</a> below.</p></div></div><div id="pglicense1F" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h3 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">1.F.</span></h3><div id="pglicense1F1" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.F.1.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable effort to identify,
+ do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread public domain works
+ in creating the Project Gutenberg™ collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg™
+ electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
+ contain <span class="tei tei-q">“Defects,”</span> such as, but not limited to, incomplete,
+ inaccurate or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+ intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other
+ medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be
+ read by your equipment.</p></div><div id="pglicense1F2" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.F.2.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES — Except for the <span class="tei tei-q">“Right of
+ Replacement or Refund”</span> described in <a href="#pglicense1F3" class="tei tei-ref">paragraph
+ 1.F.3</a>, the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project Gutenberg™ trademark, and any
+ other party distributing a Project Gutenberg™ electronic work under this agreement,
+ disclaim all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including
+ legal fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+ LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+ PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE TRADEMARK
+ OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE LIABLE TO
+ YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR INCIDENTAL
+ DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.</p></div><div id="pglicense1F3" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.F.3.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND — If you discover a defect in
+ this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can receive a
+ refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a written
+ explanation to the person you received the work from. If you received
+ the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with your
+ written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with the
+ defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+ refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+ providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+ receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+ is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+ opportunities to fix the problem.</p></div><div id="pglicense1F4" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.F.4.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth in
+ <a href="#pglicense1F3" class="tei tei-ref">paragraph 1.F.3</a>, this work is provided
+ to you 'AS-IS,' WITH NO OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR
+ FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.</p></div><div id="pglicense1F5" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.F.5.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied warranties or
+ the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. If any
+ disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the law of
+ the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+ interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+ the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+ provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.</p></div><div id="pglicense1F6" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h4 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em">1.F.6.</h4><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">INDEMNITY — You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+ trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+ providing copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in accordance with this
+ agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, promotion
+ and distribution of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works, harmless from all
+ liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, that arise directly
+ or indirectly from any of the following which you do or cause to occur:
+ (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg™ work, (b) alteration,
+ modification, or additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg™ work, and (c) any
+ Defect you cause.</p></div></div></div><div id="pglicense2" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Section 2.</span></h2><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg™</span></h2><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Project Gutenberg™ is synonymous with the free distribution of electronic works
+ in formats readable by the widest variety of computers including
+ obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists because of the
+ efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from people in all walks
+ of life.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+ assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg™'s goals and
+ ensuring that the Project Gutenberg™ collection will remain freely available for
+ generations to come. In 2001, the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a
+ secure and permanent future for Project Gutenberg™ and future generations. To learn
+ more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
+ Sections <a href="#pglicense3" class="tei tei-ref">3</a> and <a href="#pglicense4" class="tei tei-ref">4</a> and the Foundation web page at <a href="http://www.pglaf.org" class="tei tei-xref">http://www.pglaf.org</a>.</p></div><div id="pglicense3" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Section 3.</span></h2><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation</span></h2><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit 501(c)(3) educational corporation
+ organized under the laws of the state of Mississippi and granted tax
+ exempt status by the Internal Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or
+ federal tax identification number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter
+ is posted at <a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf" class="tei tei-xref">http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf</a>. Contributions
+ to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by U.S.
+ federal laws and your state's laws.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr.
+ S. Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are
+ scattered throughout numerous locations. Its business office is
+ located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801)
+ 596-1887, email business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date
+ contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
+ official page at <a href="http://www.pglaf.org" class="tei tei-xref">http://www.pglaf.org</a></p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">For additional contact information:
+
+ </p><div class="block tei tei-address" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em"><span class="tei tei-addrLine"><span style="font-size: 90%">Dr. Gregory B. Newby</span></span><br /><span class="tei tei-addrLine"><span style="font-size: 90%">Chief Executive and Director</span></span><br /><span class="tei tei-addrLine"><span style="font-size: 90%">gbnewby@pglaf.org</span></span><br /></div></div><div id="pglicense4" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Section 4.</span></h2><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation</span></h2><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Project Gutenberg™ depends upon and cannot survive without wide spread public
+ support and donations to carry out its mission of increasing the number
+ of public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed in
+ machine readable form accessible by the widest array of equipment
+ including outdated equipment. Many small donations ($1 to $5,000) are
+ particularly important to maintaining tax exempt status with the
+ IRS.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+ charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+ States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+ considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+ with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations where
+ we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
+ DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state
+ visit <a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate" class="tei tei-xref">http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate</a></p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+ have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+ against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+ approach us with offers to donate.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+ any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+ outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation methods and
+ addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other ways including
+ checks, online payments and credit card donations. To donate, please
+ visit: <a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate" class="tei tei-xref">http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate</a></p></div><div id="pglicense5" class="tei tei-div" style="margin-bottom: 2.00em; margin-top: 2.00em"><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: left; margin-bottom: 2.88em; margin-top: 2.88em"><span style="font-size: 144%">Section 5.</span></h2><h2 class="tei tei-head" style="text-align: center; margin-bottom: 2.40em; margin-top: 2.40em"><span style="font-size: 120%">General Information About Project Gutenberg™ electronic
+ works.</span></h2><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em"><span class="tei tei-name">Professor Michael S. Hart</span> is the
+ originator of the Project Gutenberg™ concept of a library of electronic works that
+ could be freely shared with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and
+ distributed Project Gutenberg™ eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer
+ support.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Project Gutenberg™ eBooks are often created from several printed editions, all of
+ which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. unless a copyright
+ notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily keep eBooks in
+ compliance with any particular paper edition.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Each eBook is in a subdirectory of the same number as the eBook's
+ eBook number, often in several formats including plain vanilla ASCII,
+ compressed (zipped), HTML and others.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Corrected <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">editions</span></em> of our eBooks replace the old file
+ and take over the old filename and etext number. The replaced older file
+ is renamed. <em class="tei tei-emph"><span style="font-style: italic">Versions</span></em> based on separate sources are treated
+ as new eBooks receiving new filenames and etext numbers.</p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
+ facility:
+
+ <a href="http://www.gutenberg.org" class="block tei tei-xref" style="margin-bottom: 1.80em; margin-left: 3.60em; margin-top: 1.80em; margin-right: 3.60em"><span style="font-size: 90%">http://www.gutenberg.org</span></a></p><p class="tei tei-p" style="margin-bottom: 1.00em">This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg™, including how to
+ make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and
+ how to subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.</p></div></div></div>
+ </div>
+</div>
+</div>
+</body></html>